Infrastructure version 1.1 (PDF 13304 KB)
Transcription
Infrastructure version 1.1 (PDF 13304 KB)
Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 1.7 PART 2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 PART 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 INTRODUCTION............................................................................................................. 1 Title ................................................................................................................................ 1 Purpose of this planning scheme policy...................................................................... 1 Structure of this planning scheme policy .................................................................... 1 Commencement ............................................................................................................ 1 Relationship to the Sustainable Planning Act 2009..................................................... 1 Applicability of this planning scheme policy ............................................................... 1 Reference documents ................................................................................................... 1 INFORMATION REQUIREMENTS .................................................................................. 2 Competency to prepare a report .................................................................................. 2 Engineering drawings and reports ............................................................................... 2 2.2.1 General standards for engineering drawings ..................................................... 6 2.2.2 Filling and excavation plan................................................................................ 7 2.2.3 Erosion and sediment control plan .................................................................... 8 2.2.4 Compressive soils ............................................................................................ 8 2.2.5 Retaining walls ................................................................................................. 8 2.2.6 Geotechnical reports ........................................................................................ 8 2.2.7 Water reticulation plan ...................................................................................... 8 2.2.8 Sewerage reticulation plan................................................................................ 9 2.2.9 Inter-allotment drainage plan .......................................................................... 10 2.2.10 Stormwater drainage catchment plan .............................................................. 11 2.2.11 Car parking assessment report ....................................................................... 11 2.2.12 Road works and drainage plan ....................................................................... 12 2.2.13 Service provider and conduit plan ................................................................... 14 2.2.14 Road lighting design plan ............................................................................... 14 2.2.15 Electricity reticulation plan .............................................................................. 14 2.2.16 Entry statement design drawings .................................................................... 15 2.2.17 Bridge and major culvert drawings .................................................................. 15 2.2.18 Pedestrian bridge report and drawings............................................................ 15 Landscape documentation ......................................................................................... 15 2.3.1 General .......................................................................................................... 15 2.3.2 Standards for landscape documentation ......................................................... 15 2.3.3 Landscape site analysis.................................................................................. 16 2.3.4 Landscape concept plan ................................................................................. 18 2.3.5 Working drawings ........................................................................................... 19 2.3.6 Maintenance management ............................................................................. 23 2.3.7 Revegetation or rehabilitation plan .................................................................. 23 2.3.8 Existing vegetation protection plan.................................................................. 23 2.3.9 Movement infrastructure report ....................................................................... 24 Stormwater infrastructure documentation................................................................. 24 2.4.1 Conceptual site based stormwater management plan ..................................... 24 2.4.2 Detailed site based stormwater management plan .......................................... 28 Flooding documentation............................................................................................. 29 2.5.1 Flood study report .......................................................................................... 29 2.5.2 Filling and excavation plan in the flooding and inundation area ....................... 30 2.5.3 Numerical modelling requirements .................................................................. 31 STANDARDS................................................................................................................ 32 Purpose ....................................................................................................................... 32 Design and construction of work ............................................................................... 32 3.2.1 Standards and specifications .......................................................................... 32 3.2.2 Application of standards ................................................................................. 32 Filling and excavation standards ............................................................................... 33 3.3.1 Standards and specifications .......................................................................... 33 3.3.2 Cover of infrastructure .................................................................................... 33 3.3.3 General standards .......................................................................................... 33 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi 3.3.4 3.3.5 3.3.6 3.3.7 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.9 3.10 3.11 3.12 PART 4 4.1 4.2 PART 5 5.1 5.2 Clearing and preservation of trees .................................................................. 36 Dams and embankments ................................................................................ 36 Batters and retaining walls .............................................................................. 37 Drainage, sediment, erosion and dust control (including works in a dispersive soil area) ........................................................................................................ 40 Movement infrastructure standards ........................................................................... 40 3.4.1 Planning guidelines for the movement network ............................................... 40 3.4.2 Design standards for footpaths ....................................................................... 48 3.4.3 Design standards for cycle paths .................................................................... 49 3.4.4 Design standards for roads ............................................................................. 53 3.4.5 Design standards for access and driveways ................................................... 59 3.4.6 Design standards for car parking .................................................................... 60 3.4.7 Intersection work ............................................................................................ 62 3.4.8 Road pavement design ................................................................................... 62 3.4.9 Road drainage ................................................................................................ 65 3.4.10 Traffic islands, traffic signs and road markings ................................................ 67 3.4.11 Roadworks on unpaved or common boundary roads....................................... 68 3.4.12 Bridge and major culvert works ....................................................................... 69 3.4.13 Noise barriers ................................................................................................. 71 3.4.14 Construction standards for movement infrastructure ....................................... 72 Road lighting standards ............................................................................................. 72 Stormwater infrastructure standards ......................................................................... 76 3.6.1 Planning the stormwater network .................................................................... 76 3.6.2 Design standards for stormwater infrastructure ............................................... 79 3.6.3 Stormwater quantity infrastructure .................................................................. 91 3.6.4 Channels ........................................................................................................ 93 3.6.5 Overland flow ................................................................................................. 98 3.6.6 Detention systems .......................................................................................... 99 3.6.7 Stormwater quality, frequent flow management and waterway stability infrastructure ................................................................................................ 103 Landscaping standards ............................................................................................ 104 3.7.1 Standards for landscaping ............................................................................ 104 3.7.2 Coverage of infrastructure ............................................................................ 104 3.7.3 Water sensitive urban design ........................................................................ 104 3.7.4 Landscaped buffers ...................................................................................... 104 Electricity reticulation standards ............................................................................. 104 3.8.1 Underground electricity reticulation ............................................................... 104 3.8.2 Electricity reticulation - overhead .................................................................. 105 3.8.3 Electrical service connection......................................................................... 106 Gas and telecommunication reticulation standards................................................ 107 3.9.1 Service trenches........................................................................................... 107 3.9.2 Coverage of infrastructure ............................................................................ 107 3.9.3 Maintenance structures (access chambers) .................................................. 107 3.9.4 Conduits ....................................................................................................... 107 Water supply infrastructure standards .................................................................... 108 Sewerage infrastructure standards .......................................................................... 108 Park infrastructure standards................................................................................... 108 3.12.1 Planning the park network ............................................................................ 108 3.12.2 Standards for park ........................................................................................ 108 3.12.3 Minimum size of park.................................................................................... 111 3.12.4 Minimum post development flood immunity for park ...................................... 112 3.12.5 Maximum post development grade for park .................................................. 112 3.12.6 Typical embellishments for recreation park ................................................... 112 3.12.7 Typical embellishments for sport park ........................................................... 114 GUIDELINES .............................................................................................................. 117 Guidelines for satisfying Flood hazard overlay code .............................................. 117 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code ......................................................... 125 LOCAL GOVERNMENT INFRASTRUCTURE WORK................................................. 148 Preliminary ................................................................................................................ 148 5.1.1 Purpose of Part 5 ......................................................................................... 148 Pre-construction ....................................................................................................... 148 5.2.1 Pre-start meeting .......................................................................................... 148 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pii 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 5.7 5.8 5.9 PART 6 PART 7 7.1 7.2 7.3 PART 8 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 PART 9 9.1 9.2 Inspection and testing .............................................................................................. 149 5.3.1 Compliance with inspection and testing plan ................................................. 149 5.3.2 Sub-grade evaluation test results .................................................................. 157 5.3.3 Sub-grade inspection.................................................................................... 157 5.3.4 Pre-seal inspection ....................................................................................... 157 5.3.5 Landscaping work inspections ...................................................................... 158 5.3.6 On-maintenance inspections ........................................................................ 158 5.3.7 Off-maintenance inspections ........................................................................ 160 Acceptance of local government infrastructure work on-maintenance.................. 161 5.4.1 Criteria for acceptance.................................................................................. 161 5.4.2 Maintenance security deposit ....................................................................... 162 5.4.3 Approval of plan of survey ............................................................................ 162 Acceptance of local government infrastructure work off-maintenance ................. 162 5.5.1 Maintenance period ...................................................................................... 162 5.5.2 Acceptance of local government infrastructure work off-maintenance............ 163 As-constructed information...................................................................................... 163 5.6.1 General standard for as constructed information ........................................... 163 5.6.2 Requirements for full set of approved engineering drawings amended with as constructed information ................................................................................ 165 5.6.3 As constructed standard drawings prepared as follows: ................................ 166 5.6.4 Requirements for one CD (or DVD or other electronic device): ...................... 166 5.6.5 As constructed documentation ...................................................................... 167 5.6.6 As Constructed information for water supply infrastructure for water asset management ................................................................................................ 168 5.6.7 As Constructed drawings for sewerage infrastructure for water asset management ................................................................................................ 168 Video formats for inspection and testing of local government infrastructure work ........................................................................................................................... 168 5.7.1 Requirements for video format ...................................................................... 168 Requirements for ADAC Schema for stormwater and movement infrastructure assets ........................................................................................................................ 168 Summary of final package of as-constructed information for submission ............ 169 BONDING OF DEVELOPMENT .................................................................................. 170 PLANNING LAYOUTS................................................................................................ 171 Road infrastructure ................................................................................................... 171 7.1.1 Planning layouts for road infrastructure ......................................................... 171 General planning layouts.......................................................................................... 172 7.2.1 General planning layouts for areas ............................................................... 172 Road encroachment maps........................................................................................ 180 7.3.1 Road encroachment maps............................................................................ 180 STANDARD DRAWINGS............................................................................................ 181 Movement infrastructure .......................................................................................... 181 8.1.1 Standard drawings for movement infrastructure ............................................ 181 8.1.2 Standard drawings for parking area .............................................................. 183 Water supply infrastructure ...................................................................................... 184 8.2.1 Standard drawings for water supply infrastructure ......................................... 184 Sewerage infrastructure ........................................................................................... 185 8.3.1 Standard drawings for sewerage infrastructure ............................................. 185 Landscaping .............................................................................................................. 187 8.4.1 Standard drawings for landscaping ............................................................... 187 Stormwater infrastructure ........................................................................................ 188 8.5.1 Standard drawings for stormwater infrastructure ........................................... 188 STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS.................................................................................. 190 Introduction ............................................................................................................... 190 9.1.1 Application of Standard Specifications .......................................................... 190 Interpretation of the standard specifications........................................................... 191 9.2.1 Administrative Definitions ............................................................................. 191 9.2.2 Interpretation of the standard specifications .................................................. 191 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Piii Part 1 1.1 (1) Title This planning scheme policy may be cited as planning scheme policy 5-Infrastructure. 1.2 (1) Purpose of this planning scheme policy The purpose of this planning scheme policy is to ensure that development adheres to the local government's standards for the planning, design, location and construction of infrastructure that reflects acceptable standards in engineering, asset management, environmental management and natural resource planning by: (a) specifying information requirements; (b) specifying standards and guidelines; (c) specifying administrative arrangements; (d) specifying the circumstances in which the local government may accept a security for the completion of work. 1.3 (1) 1.4 (1) 1.5 (1) 1.6 (1) 1.7 Introduction Structure of this planning scheme policy This planning scheme policy is divided into nine parts, being: (a) Part 1: Introduction; (b) Part 2: Information requirements; (c) Part 3: Standards; (d) Part 4: Guidelines; (e) Part 5: Local government infrastructure work; (f) Part 6: Bonding of development; (g) Part 7: Planning layouts; (h) Part 8: Standard drawings; (i) Part 9: Standard specifications. Commencement This planning scheme policy commences on the date of the Logan Planning Scheme 2015. Relationship to the Sustainable Planning Act 2009 This planning scheme policy is made pursuant to the Sustainable Planning Act 2009. Applicability of this planning scheme policy This planning scheme policy applies to self-assessable, compliance assessable and assessable development. Reference documents (1) Unless otherwise specified, a document referenced in this planning scheme policy refers to the most recent edition of that document including an amendment to the document. (2) A local government publication is available for viewing at the local government's administration building or online. (3) All forms (e.g. as-constructed certificates, pre-commencement notification) will be made available by the local government in both hard copy and electronic form. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) (2) 2.2 (1) Information Requirements Competency to prepare a report A person preparing a report, a plan or a drawing relating to development must have demonstrated competency and experience relating to the subject matter of the report, plan or drawing and must; (a) in the case of geotechnical, hydraulic, stormwater infrastructure, civil, structural or electrical engineering issues be a Registered Professional Engineer of Queensland (RPEQ); or (b) in the case of landscaping issues be a Registered Landscape Architect with the Australian Institute of Landscape Architects (or other qualification suitable to the local government); or (c) in the case of erosion and sediment control plans be a Certified Professional in Erosion and Sediment Control (CPESC) or a RPEQ who has undertaken the Erosion and Sediment Control training provided by the International Erosion Control Association with demonstrated specialist expertise in the relevant subject matter. The report, plan or drawing must include a certification signed by the relevant expert that the report, plan or drawing is fit for its intended purpose and can be relied upon by the local government for that purpose. Engineering drawings and reports Infrastructure documentation is to be submitted in accordance with Table 2.2.1–Summary of the minimum infrastructure documentation required. Table 2.2.1–Summary of the minimum infrastructure documentation required Column 1 Documentation Site based stormwater management plan Column 2 Material change of use Concept plan required - when stormwater quantity, quality, frequent and flood flow management or waterway stability infrastructure is provided. Detailed information on stormwater system (i.e. dimensions, levels and outlet details of detention basin) to be provided if no operational work or compliance assessment application is required. Column 3 Reconfiguring a lot Column 4 Operational work Column 5 Compliance assessment Concept plan required - when stormwater quantity, quality, frequent and flood flow management or waterway stability infrastructure is provided. Detail plan required - when stormwater quantity, quality, frequent and flood flow management or waterway stability infrastructure is provided. Detail plan required - when stormwater quantity, quality, frequent and flood flow management or waterway stability infrastructure is provided. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.1 Competency to prepare a report Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-2 Column 1 Documentation Column 2 Material change of use Column 3 Reconfiguring a lot Column 4 Operational work Flood study report Required Required Required if not presented in earlier application. As constructed plans can be assessed against approvals. Electricity reticulation plan Concept plan required NA Required, if not addressed in Column 2. Required. Erosion and sediment control plan NA NA. Required. Required if not addressed in Column 4. Filling and excavation plan Concept plan required. Concept plan required. Detail plan required. Detail plan required. Inter allotment drainage plans Required where downstream discharge involves other private properties. Required where downstream discharge involves other private properties. Required where downstream discharge involves other private properties. Required where downstream discharge involves other private properties. Landscape site analysis Required Required NA NA Landscape concept plan Required Required NA NA Landscape detailed working drawings NA NA Required where landscaping is proposed Required Landscape detailed maintenance program for onmaintenance NA NA Required where land or infrastructure will be managed by the local government. Required Movement infrastructure report Preliminary approval of concept plan required where development: Preliminary approval of concept plan required where development: NA NA (a) generates 3000 or more vehicle trips per average weekday; (a) generates 3000 or more vehicle trips per average weekday; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Column 5 Compliance assessment Sc6.2.5-3 Column 1 Documentation Column 2 Material change of use Column 3 Reconfiguring a lot (b) is outside a local plan area; or (c) is in a local plan area and does not comply with the relevant placemaking and movement network. (b) is outside a local plan area; or (c) is in a local plan area and does not comply with the relevant placemaking and movement network. Sewerage reticulation plan Concept plan required in accordance with South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Concept plan required in accordance with South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. NA Required. Sewerage reticulation detailed design drawings NA NA Detailed design and construction drawings in accordance with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Detailed design and construction drawings in accordance with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Water reticulation plan Concept plan required in accordance with South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Concept plan required in accordance with South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. NA NA. Water reticulation detailed design drawings NA NA Detailed design and construction drawings in accordance with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Detailed design and construction drawings in accordance with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. (2) Column 4 Operational work Column 5 Compliance assessment All landscape and engineering drawings must include, where relevant: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-4 (a) a cover sheet, which includes a location plan and a list of the drawing numbers and the titles of the drawings and the revision number and date; (b) a layout plan; (c) staging plan; (d) a filling and excavation plan; (e) an erosion and sediment control plan; (f) a roadworks and drainage plan; (g) the longitudinal section of each road; (h) standard cross-sections; (i) cross-sections of each road; (j) detailed plans of each intersection, cul-de-sac, traffic calming device and road lighting; (k) the longitudinal section of each stormwater and roofwater drain line; (l) a sewerage reticulation plan including any trunk infrastructure required for the project; (m) the longitudinal section of each sewer line; (n) the longitudinal section of each pressure main; (o) a recycled water reticulation plan; (p) the longitudinal section of each water main if >DN200; (q) an interallotment drainage plan; (r) a stormwater drainage catchment plan; (s) the stormwater drainage calculations; (t) the design of the stormwater network; (u) a stormwater quality and quantity management plan; (v) flood study report if the development is located on or proximate to land identified on the Flood hazard overlay trigger map (OM-05.00) or supporting maps. (w) a service provider and conduit plan; (x) a road lighting design plan; (y) an electricity reticulation plan; (z) landscape documentation in accordance with section 2.3–Landscape documentation of this planning scheme policy; (aa) one copy of: (i) an inspection and testing plan for engineering work in accordance with this planning scheme policy, or as otherwise approved by the local government which includes: (ii) (iii) (A) details of the inspections and testing to be carried out for each stage of the work; (B) the nature, type and standard of the test; (C) the frequency of the test; (D) the inspections to be carried out by the consultant; an inspection and testing plan for landscaping; a job specification and any technical specifications for the work. (bb) a record of any pre-lodgement meeting with the local government including confirming correspondence; (cc) a copy of a letter of approval from the owner of affected premises in relation to easements, a discharge approval, drainage works and any other operational work required within the premises; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-5 (3) (dd) details of the pavement design criteria including records of the geotechnical tests indicating the subgrade CBR’s, the adopted traffic load, the requirement for sub-soil drainage and the sub-soil design by a geotechnical engineer; (ee) a geotechnical report relating to slope and batter stability and insitu materials including sodic and dispersive soils;; (ff) a structural and geotechnical certification of the design of a structure such as a retaining wall, a non-standard headwall, a drainage structure and a reservoir; (gg) the design parameters, operating regime, and design specifications for a water pump station and a sewerage pump station; (hh) evidence of an approved power supply agreement with an electricity service provider; (ii) an approved service plan from a communications service provider; (jj) a copy of an approval or correspondence from a public sector entity and a service provider; (kk) other detailed drawings which may be reasonably required by the local government. For the purposes of section 2.2(1) of this planning scheme policy: (a) a location plan must locate the development in relation to an adjacent town, main road, major road and a north point; (b) a layout plan must show the relationship of all new roads to each other and to an existing road adjoining the development; (c) a staging plan must show the boundaries of the proposed stages and identify the stages by numbering; (d) the local government may require detailed drawings of: (i) a stormwater outlet structure, other than a standard headwall; (ii) the manhole details where a pipe alignment is critical for a clearance or flow consideration; (iii) a soil and water quality management structure; (iv) a surcharge structure; (v) an overland drainage path; (vi) changes to the flood extent under the Designated Flood Event; (vii) a sewer pump station; (viii) a footbridge; (ix) a reservoir; (x) an entry structure; (xi) a retaining wall; (xii) a building; (xiii) a variation from a standard drawing; (xiv) a water pump station. 2.2.1 (1) General standards for engineering drawings The engineering drawings and plans must: (a) be at the scale of 1:1, 1:2, 1:5 or a multiple of 10 of these scales; (b) in the case of: (i) a sewerage reticulation and interallotment drainage layout plan, be at 1:500 or 1:1000; (ii) a plan other than a sewerage reticulation and interallotment drainage layout plan, be at 1:500; (iii) a longitudinal section horizontal, be at 1:1000 or 1:500; (iv) a longitudinal section vertical, be at 1:100 or 1:50; (v) an intersection detail, be at 1:200, 1:100 or 1:250; (vi) a cross-section, be at 1:100; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-6 (vii) (2) (3) (c) show the linear dimensions on all road works plans in metres, with the exception of a detailed plan of a small structure such as a manhole and a standard plan for kerb and channel, which may be in millimetres; (d) show dimensions in accordance with Appendix A of AS 1100.401-1984, Technical Drawing, Part 401: Engineering survey and engineering survey design drawing; (e) express the chainage on plans in metres to 3 decimal places; (f) reduce all levels to AHD and expressed to 3 decimal places; (g) show the road grades as a percentage to 2 decimal places; (h) provide cross sections minimum 20.0 metre intervals; (i) show pipe grades as a percentage to 2 decimal places or as a gradient to one decimal place. The engineering drawings must: (a) unless otherwise approved by the local government be on an A1 sheet or in the case of minor works, an A3 sheet; (b) be certified by a RPEQ (Registered Professional Engineer of Queensland); (c) comply with Institute of Public Works Engineering Australia (IPWEA) Asset Design As Constructed (ADAC) compliant schema unless otherwise approved; (d) be provided in electronic format if required by the local government. The engineering drawings must have a title block which includes: (a) the name and contact details of the RPEQ responsible for the engineering drawings; (b) the approved development name; (c) the street address or suburb; (d) the real property description; (e) the person who has the benefit of the development approval name; (f) the local government’s application reference number; (g) the scale; (h) the drawing, sheet and revision number; (i) a Schedule of amendments; (j) the level datum and reference permanent survey marks; (k) a design certificate signed by an experienced designer; (l) a checking certificate signed by a RPEQ (Civil); (m) details of other consultants involved in preparing the development application; (n) the date. 2.2.2 (1) an engineering detail, be at 1:20 or 1:10; Filling and excavation plan A filling and excavation plan must include: (a) a north point and a legend; (b) the road boundary and the road name; (c) the existing and proposed lot number and boundary; (d) the existing contours and the finished surface contours; (e) the limit and level of major cut and fill, distinguished by hatching or cut and fill contours; (f) the location of cut and fill batters relative to the lot boundary; (g) a batter slope; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-7 (2) (h) the location and levels of a retaining wall if relevant; (i) the defined flood line for regional flood plains or local overland flow paths and a line depicting the freeboard line, certified by a registered surveyor (Queensland); (j) the location and level of permanent survey marks and the reference stations used as datum for the development; (k) the location and identity of an existing service including any alterations required to the service and a structure and plants to be retained; (l) the quantities of excess spoil to be generated by the development if any and the proposed spoil dumping area; (m) the pre and post development impervious areas; (n) imported quantity of materials and net increase in land volume. Provide cross-sections at regular intervals showing the extent of cut and fill works to confirm earthworks and, if applicable, loss of floodplain storage. 2.2.3 (1) Erosion and sediment control plan An erosion and sediment control plan is prepared and submitted to the local government that complies with Best Practice Erosion and Sediment Control Guidelines (IECA 2008) and in accordance with the design objectives set out in the State planning policy. 2.2.4 (1) Compressive soils Design drawings must identify areas comprising compressive soils and the proposed filling and excavation. Drawings to advise whether compressive soils are to be reused on site and in which locations or alternatively the quantity to be removed from site. 2.2.5 (1) Retaining walls Engineering drawings that include retaining walls must show a plan and cross-sectional elevation views including the property boundaries of adjoining properties. 2.2.6 (1) 2.2.7 Geotechnical reports A geotechnical report must address the following issues: (a) compaction; (b) geotechnical supervision; (c) imported fill material; (d) potential for filling and excavation to cause vibration that could cause damage to nearby structures; (e) excavations in areas of rock with a stable batter slope; (f) land instability; (g) steep slopes; (h) areas prone to land slips; (i) areas prone to subsidence; (j) dispersive soils, including recommended treatment methods to counteract the impact of trenching in dispersive soils; (k) geotechnical hazard areas (landslip/rockfall/shrink/swell of soils, areas with large mining voids). Water reticulation plan (1) A water reticulation plan must include design and construction drawings in accordance with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. (2) As a guide a water reticulation plan includes the following: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-8 (a) a north point and a legend; (b) the road boundary and the road name; (c) the existing and proposed lot number and boundary; (d) the boundary of the proposed development; (e) the location and diameter of an existing water reticulation main; (f) the location, diameter, material and class of a new water reticulation main; (g) the location of a service which crosses the water reticulation main; (h) the location and angle of each bend; (i) the location, material and type of each valve (e.g. scour, air, sluice valve), a hydrant, a scour and a cap, Tee and reducer; (j) the diameter, material and class of pipe for a cross road conduit; (k) the thrust block detail; (l) in the case of a staged development, details of a water reticulation network, showing all stages and main sizes with stage 1 of the development and supplied in disc format; (m) the type of bedding and depth of mains unless otherwise shown in cross-sectional drawings. 2.2.8 Sewerage reticulation plan (1) A sewerage reticulation plan must include design and construction drawings in accordance with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. (2) As a guide a sewerage reticulation plan includes: (a) a north point and a legend; (b) the road boundary and the road name; (c) the existing and proposed lot number and boundary; (d) the boundary of the development; (e) the location, diameter and levels of existing sewers; (f) the location, diameter and type of class of each existing sewer pipe and new sewer including the line number and the manhole or the end of the line number; (g) the location of a service which crosses a sewer line; (h) the location of a manhole or the end of a line; (i) the identification of a lot which is currently sewered; (j) the finished surface contours sufficient to enable verification of the house connection design; (k) the location of a private drainage system; (l) details of the permanent survey marks to AHD from which levels are to be transferred; (m) details of a pumping station, including its location, inlet and outlet levels, cut off levels, electrical and water supply and the size of the pumping plant; (n) the diameter, class and route of a pressure main; (o) clear identification of any alteration or connection to an existing sewer to be completed by the local government at the cost of the person who has the benefit of the development approval; (p) the upstream and downstream invert levels; (q) the manhole type, cover type and drop type. Bolt down lids to be clearly indicated where used; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-9 (3) (4) (r) the sewer plan shall show the location of each house connection branch, together with the type and invert level of the branch. Surface level at the house connection branch shall also be shown; (s) the sewer plan shall show the location and type of each valve on pressure pipelines, i.e. scour, air sluice valve. As a guide a plan of a longitudinal section of a sewer line must include: (a) the line number and the manhole or the end of the line number; (b) the upstream and downstream invert levels; (c) the existing and finished surface levels; (d) the depths to invert; (e) the diameter, material and class of pipe; (f) the chainages; (g) the distance and grade between manholes and between a manhole and the end of a line; (h) the manhole size, type, cover type and drop type; (i) the concrete stops where required and associated backfill requirements; (j) the location, diameter and invert level of an underground service at a point of intersection with the sewer line; (k) the design location and measurements of each house connection branch indicated with an X and the type and invert level of the branch. As a guide a plan of the longitudinal section of a pressure main must include: (a) the existing and finished surface levels; (b) the invert levels at a critical point; (c) the depth to invert; (d) the location, material and types of a bend and a fitting; (e) the diameter, material and class of pipe; (f) the chainages; (g) the thrust block details; (h) the location, diameter and invert level of an underground service at a point of intersection with the pressure main. 2.2.9 (1) Inter-allotment drainage plan Inter-allotment drainage plans must include: (a) a north point and a legend; (b) the road boundary and the road name; (c) the existing and proposed lot number and boundary; (d) the boundary of the development; (e) the existing and finished surface contours; (f) the location, material and size of an inter-allotment drainage line; (g) the invert and surface levels at a pit; (h) the location and sizing of the stormwater drainage to which the inter-allotment drainage system is connected; (i) the location and size of the pit and a house connection; (j) the diameter, material, type and class of pipe; (k) details of connections to the kerb and channel if appropriate including the design finished surface level and the location of the invert level of the kerb outlet; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-10 (l) the lengths and grades to an inter-allotment drain line; (m) a label for an inter-allotment pit and a receiving stormwater structure. 2.2.10 Stormwater drainage catchment plan (1) (2) (3) A stormwater drainage catchment plan must include: (a) a north point and a legend; (b) a plan of the development showing the road and the lot boundary; (c) the approved road name; (d) the existing surface contours; (e) the finished surface contours (in different line types) at an interval close enough to define the terrain and to allow a definition of the sub-catchments, and extending beyond the limits of the premises to fully define the limits of the external catchments; (f) the boundary of the external and internal sub-catchment which is labelled; (g) a tabulation of all attachment labels and areas including Strahler stream order; (h) a line diagram of the location of each drain line, manhole, gully and outlet; (i) the labelling of each stormwater structure; (j) details of any elements incorporating water sensitive urban design principles; (k) the DFE line and any coastal hazard level line. Stormwater drainage calculations must: (a) be in an A3 size standard calculation spreadsheet form in accordance with the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual requirements including flow widths at approaches to pits and the local government’s requirements; (b) contain calculations in relation to a detention basin, a dissipater, an outlet structure, a surcharge chamber, scour protection, a gross pollutant trap, an overland flow path, a table drain and an open channel; (c) be provided in electronic form upon request. A stormwater and stormwater quality management plan must include the overall objectives of the plan and include: (a) a north point and a legend; (b) a site plan showing the road boundary and the road name; (c) the existing and finished surface contours, extending beyond the limits of the proposed development to fully define the limits of an external catchment; (d) a line diagram of a drain line and a drainage structure; (e) the type and location of a soil and water quality management control device proposed for the construction, maintenance and permanent phases of the development; (f) a program of implementation of the above devices during the construction and maintenance phases of the development which includes temporary drainage works (The State planning policy limits the duration of temporary works); (g) a recommended maintenance program that reflects a risk management assessment; (h) the location and type of fencing for a restricted area; (i) the location of existing significant vegetation, a significant tree and other plants which function as habitat. 2.2.11 Car parking assessment report (1) A car parking assessment report must address the following issues: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-11 (a) the specific nature of the development to be undertaken and the method of operation and all facilities proposed to be provided; (b) the maximum number of employees and contractors likely to be engaged on the premises; (c) the maximum number of persons, other than employees and contractors, anticipated to attend the premises at any time; (d) the hours of operation; (e) the existing on-road parking situation and operating conditions of the road in the vicinity of the site; (f) the anticipated demand for on-site loading by trucks and other delivery vehicles; (g) the anticipated demand for bus, coach and taxi set down and parking; (h) the likely use of other modes of transport or pedestrian access, and the frequency and proximity of existing public transport services; (i) the assignment of development-generated traffic to the road network, and prediction of operating conditions within and without the proposed development for the appropriate design years; (j) if the car park site is lower than the DFE or coastal hazard level, information on the maximum depth of inundation and flow velocity for the DFE and the coastal hazard. 2.2.12 (1) Road works and drainage plan A road works and drainage plan must include: (a) a north point and a legend; (b) the road boundary and the road name; (c) the existing and proposed lot number and boundary; (d) the details of connections to existing roads including kerb types and transitions; (e) the centreline or other construction line, chainages on the centreline or the construction line and bearings or set-out coordinates of the centreline or the construction line; (f) the tangent point chainages, radius, arc length, tangent length and secant distance of each curve; (g) the chainage and intersection point of the road centreline or the construction line; (h) the kerb line, kerb radii and chainage of the tangent point on the kerb line; (i) the edge of the pavement where no kerb is to be constructed; (j) the width of a road, a pavement and a verge where it differs from the standard cross section; (k) the existing and finished surface contours, highlighting a cut and a fill area; (l) the location of a gully, a manhole and a stormwater drain line; (m) the location of a stormwater drainage structure; (n) the likely extent of surface inundation under both the minor and major drainage design floods and coastal hazard extents; (o) the likely depth of surface inundation (serviceability requirements to prevent aquaplaning); (p) the location and identity of an existing service including any alterations required to the service and existing works within the premises; (q) the location and levels of the bench marks and the reference pegs; (r) the location of plants to be retained; (s) the pedestrian paths, cycle paths and ramp locations; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-12 (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (t) the log fencing and access points to a park; (u) road signs. A plan of the longitudinal section of a road must include: (a) the road name; (b) the chainages; (c) the existing surface or peg levels; (d) the design road centreline and kerb lip levels; (e) the cut or fill depths; (f) the design grades; (g) the chainages and levels of grade intersection points, the tangent points of vertical curves and the crest and sag locations; (h) the lengths and radii of the vertical curves; (i) the sections on control lines on superelevated curves such as pavement edges, kerb or lane edges and the superelevation tabulation, incorporating transitions; (j) the road hierarchy classification and design ESA; (k) a sight distance diagram for each direction of travel where necessary; (l) the minimal AC surfacing and pavement thickness; (m) the future grading of a road extension as necessary. A plan of a standard cross-section must include: (a) the road name; (b) the width of a road, a pavement and a verge; (c) the crossfalls of the pavement and the verge; (d) the minimum pavement depth; (e) the type of the kerb and channel and the pavement surfacing; (f) the sub-soil drainage; A plan of the cross-section of a road must include: (a) the road name; (b) the road boundary; (c) the pavement centreline and other construction lines; (d) the natural surface; (e) the design cross-section; (f) the cross fall of the pavement and the verge, the pavement and verge widths and the pavement depths, where these differ from the standard cross-section. A detailed plan of each intersection, cul-de-sac and traffic control device must include: (a) the information set out in section 2.2.12(1) of this planning scheme policy; (b) the details of the kerb levels on all kerb returns, the pavement contours, the channelisation works, the linemarking and the signing; (c) the set out details for channelisation and linemarking works. A plan of the longitudinal section of a stormwater drain line must include: (a) the chainages; (b) the existing surface levels; (c) the design finished surface and invert levels; (d) the manhole chainages and offsets and inlet and outlet invert levels; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-13 (e) the distance between manholes; (f) the grade of each pipe; (g) the size, material and class of each drain line length; (h) the hydraulic grade line; (i) the manhole diameters or a reference to a separate drawing; (j) the lid class types to AS3996-2006; (k) the gully types. 2.2.13 Service provider and conduit plan (1) A service provider and conduit plan must include: (a) a north point and a legend; (b) the road boundary and the road name; (c) the kerb and channel or the edge of the pavement; (d) the diameter, material and class of pipe for a cross road conduit; (e) a service marker; (f) the location of a street light; (g) details of the electrical reticulation and the street lighting; (h) the location of a pad mount transformer; (i) details of the telecommunication reticulation; (j) the location of a roadside cabinet and shelter; (k) the location of a gas valve, syphon point and a storage facility; (l) evidence of a supply of electricity certificate, reticulation street lighting plan and an approved service plan from a communication service provider; (m) details of water conduits (depth, material, diameter, location). 2.2.14 Road lighting design plan (1) A road lighting design plan must: (a) be prepared by a registered professional engineer who is registered and qualified by the electricity provider in the design of public lighting installations in Queensland; (b) demonstrate that road lighting does not conflict with services, including electricity pillars; (c) minimise impacts to wildlife; (d) be submitted to the local government for approval prior to commencement of work. 2.2.15 Electricity reticulation plan (1) An electricity reticulation plan must: (a) be prepared by a registered professional engineer who is registered and qualified by the electricity provider in the design of electricity reticulation in Queensland; (b) demonstrate electricity reticulation does not conflict with other services; (c) include installation of conduits for future use if required by the electricity provider; (d) include provision of road reserve for future pad mounted transformer sites if required by the electricity provider; (e) include the diameter and class of pipe for cross road conduits; (f) be submitted to the local government for approval; (g) be approved by the electricity provider. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.2 Engineering drawings and reports Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-14 2.2.16 Entry statement design drawings (1) Detail of feature walls and civil structures used as entry statements are included on engineering drawings and their design is to consider the design life legacy of the structure and the following: (a) pedestrian safety and convenience; (b) vehicle safety including sight distances; (c) access to services and utilities; (d) aesthetics and visual amenity; (e) economy including the use of low maintenance, anti-graffiti materials; (f) water conservation principles. 2.2.17 Bridge and major culvert drawings (1) Design drawings must include: (a) borehole locations and logs with design parameters; (b) design flood, velocity and level, existing ground or riverbed profile and allowable excavation or scour depths at each pier and abutment; (c) serviceability wind speed, design traffic loading and design dead loads on deck; (d) design bearing pressures and pile and pier capacities; (e) design maximum and minimum temperatures that the bridge structure can sustain; (f) exposure classification of the structure; (g) replacement or repair procedures for elements, which have a theoretical life of less than 100 years; (h) specification codes and design loads used for loading calculations; (i) anti-flotation provisions and calculations. 2.2.18 Pedestrian bridge report and drawings (1) Prior to commencement of detailed design of a proposed pedestrian bridge, a design report and general arrangement drawings are submitted to the local government for 'approval in principle'. 2.3 Landscape documentation 2.3.1 General (1) Landscape documentation is to be submitted in accordance with Table 2.2.1–Summary of the minimum infrastructure documentation required of this planning scheme policy. 2.3.2 (1) Standards for landscape documentation To ensure legibility of the landscape documentation and to expedite the checking process, the consultant must submit landscape documentation in the following format: (a) Drawing format: (i) electronic - PDF; or (ii) paper; (b) drawing quality: (i) line work and text is to retain legibility through the processes of photocopying, scanning and PDF; (ii) text should be easily read when reduced to A3; (iii) ensure hatch and other symbology is legible; (c) sheet size: (i) A0, B series requires prior approval; (ii) A1 is the preferred size; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.3 Landscape documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-15 (iii) (iv) (d) reduced drawings: (i) full scale landscape drawings are required for checking of plan views (1 copy); (ii) three copies of full scale drawings reduced to A3 must be submitted; (iii) electronic copies of drawings in PDF format may be provided either on CD or via email; (e) preferred scales of landscape drawings are as follows: (i) concept plans - minimum 1:500 preferred 1:100/1:200; (ii) sketch plans and working drawings - minimum 1:200; (iii) construction details - minimum 1:50; (f) base sheet information is to include: (i) a title block containing: (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) (vi) (vii) (viii) (ix) (g) 2.3.3 A3 is acceptable for minor works and construction details; A4 is acceptable for specification and details; (A) project or estate name; (B) street address and suburb; (C) real property description; (D) the person who has the benefit of the development approval name; (E) the local government's application reference number as well as development permit number; (F) design certification, signed by landscape architect or approved designer; (G) scale; drawing and sheet number; date; schedule of amendments; north arrow; legend; locality map; property, reserve and easement boundaries; notation of any preceding and future related landscape drawings including open space management plan, vegetation management plan, stormwater management plan, concept plan, working drawings. dimensioning: (i) linear dimensions are to be indicated in metres and millimetres where applicable; (ii) chainage to be indicated to 0.01m; (iii) levels to be reduced to Australian Height Datum and indicated to 0.001m; (iv) slope batters to be indicated in percentage or ratio format. Landscape site analysis (1) The purpose of the site analysis is to assist in assessing the most beneficial development layout that optimises the existing 'natural' assets of the site. (2) The site analysis indicates the location, identification and extent of vegetation and the effect and use of this vegetation in the proposed layout of development. A site analysis is to be submitted in a conceptual format. Refer to Figure 2.3.3.1–Example 1 of a site analysis and Figure 2.3.3.2–Example 2 of a site analysis of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.3 Landscape documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-16 (3) (4) Figure 2.3.3.2–Example 2 of a site analysis: A site analysis plan identifies opportunities and constraints including but not limited to the following: (a) existing contours of the site with reference made to suitable and unsuitable building sites, road access and drainage patterns; (b) existing access roads to the site; (c) surveyed locations and extent of mass vegetation including locations of trees with diameters of 200 mm or greater located amongst the mass vegetation; (d) surveyed locations of any free standing trees in open areas not associated with mass vegetated areas; (e) individual trees to be identified by species and/or genera and mass vegetation to be identified by vegetation type; notate information on drawing and include the condition, average diameter of the trunk of individual trees and 'significance' value (high, medium, low) per identification; (f) photos of the vegetation are to be submitted with the plan; include a 'known' object in the photo to demonstrate the scale of the picture; (g) abutting land uses and/or vegetation description including residential, commercial, industrial, farm or grazing land, bushland, wetlands and established parkland; (h) road and allotment layout; (i) major stormwater or drainage elements. The development layout should show an obvious intent to conserve the significant vegetation and utilise the inherent features of the site with minimum disturbance and minimum development works expenditure. Figure 2.3.3.1–Example 1 of a site analysis Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.3 Landscape documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-17 Figure 2.3.3.2–Example 2 of a site analysis 2.3.4 (1) Landscape concept plan Concept plans indicate the location, size and function of the proposed landscape works. Refer to Figure 2.3.4.1–Example 1 of a concept plan of this planning scheme policy. Concept plans are to include the following, where applicable: (a) location and type of circulation patterns between various buildings, open spaces and public amenities; (b) description and resolution of land use conflicts between the site and adjoining properties; (c) location, type and function of buffer strips and other privacy provisions in relation to any land use conflicts; (d) extent and description of landscape works in general; (e) function of vegetation mass; (f) flood levels; (g) general description of expected 'on-going' maintenance regime and persons responsible for implementation; e.g. a body corporate or Council; (h) brief description of the site conditions and soil characteristics; (i) key site levels and contours; (j) general identification of the areas to be landscaped notating: (i) form - lawn, groundcover, vine, shrub, tree; (ii) function - buffer, feature, ornamental, environmental; (iii) culture - native (local), exotic, mixed; (iv) size - describe the maximum/minimum size of plants by defining the restriction or provision of the view generated by the plant's placement e.g. Shrubs in car park median - traffic site visibility not restricted by shrubs at maturity CPTED principles; (k) general identification of the hard scape materials; (l) irrigation strategy; (m) drainage strategy; (n) maintenance strategy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.3 Landscape documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-18 Figure 2.3.4.1–Example 1 of a concept plan Figure #: Example Landscape Concept Plan Image Source: Logan City Council Indicative plant palette Trees Backhousia citriodora Lemon Myrtle 25 L Bracychiton acerifolius Flame tree 25 L Cordyline Red Sensation Red Sensation 140 mm Cycas revoluta Sago Palm 140 mm Dietes bicolor Iris 140 mm Themeda mingo Mingo 140 mm Shrubs Groundcovers 2.3.5 Working drawings (1) Working drawings are to be sufficiently detailed to enable accurate construction of the proposed landscaping works. Refer to Figure 2.3.5.1–Example of a working drawing of this planning scheme policy. (2) Where a concept plan has been submitted and approved, the information is to be 'overlaid' onto the working drawing. (3) Working drawings are to include the following, where applicable: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.3 Landscape documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-19 (a) identification and detail of hard scape and soft scape materials and treatments, including garden areas, paved areas, walkways, street and park furniture; (b) location, identification and quantification of individual plants by means of a diagrammatic plant symbol, indicative of mature canopy of spread width, with arrow or line to the botanical name symbol and relevant quantity; (c) schedule of plants to include the botanical name symbol, full botanical name, size of specimens at planting (metric container size), type of staking (marker, protection) and total number of plants per species; (d) detail of protection of environmentally significant vegetation during development works and notated reference to the VMP; where staging of the development requires early protection of vegetation, include the tree protection details and relevant specification section with the VMP. Refer to AS 4970-2009 Protection of trees on development sites; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.3 Landscape documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-20 (e) site elevations, reduced levels and contours; (f) location and detail of WSUD drainage systems, including points of connection to stormwater system, detention basins, bio-retention devices and stormwater harvesting devices; (g) location of irrigation controller, valve boxes and point of connection to stormwater harvesting tanks and power source; (h) where the civil works is to supply; points of connection, service conduits, subsurface drainage and storm water connection - notate reference to the appropriate Engineering drawings and location of each appropriate item on the landscape drawing; (i) inundation levels and period of inundation of detention basins; (j) notation of external surface finishes of any hard scape items, including rendered retaining walls and entrance features; (k) elevations showing the relationship of built forms with the mature landscape; (l) cross-section detail showing projected sightlines from development to neighbour, confirming the proposed success of required buffer strips; (m) location of built forms in relation to landscape areas showing doors, windows, verandas (patios) and internal rooms; (n) construction details of hard and soft elements; (o) street trees. (4) Notation on the landscape drawings, regarding construction and installation methods and the quality of materials and workmanship, is preferred by the local government over a separate specification document. (5) Where the project is complex or reference to the local government's landscape specification will not cover certain development works to the satisfaction of the consultant, specifications may be submitted. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.3 Landscape documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-21 Figure 2.3.5.1–Example of a working drawing Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.3 Landscape documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-22 2.3.6 Maintenance management (1) The maintenance management is to be directly related to landscape and plant establishment works included in the landscape specification. (2) Where a specification has not been used the maintenance management is still required to be submitted with the landscape drawings. (3) The maintenance management is to include accepted horticultural practices necessary to establish the proposed landscape works in the specified maintenance period. (4) The consultant may choose to adopt of Standard Specification 2–Landscaping in Part 9 of this planning scheme policy, or submit their own for approval. 2.3.7 (1) Revegetation or rehabilitation plan A revegetation or rehabilitation plan must include: (a) the aim of the proposed works including: (i) the encouragement of natural regeneration; (ii) the restoration or enhancement of the natural environment; (iii) the establishment or enhancement of habitat; (iv) the enhancement of wildlife movement; (b) the enhancement of the aesthetic value of the development; (c) the current description of the site including: (i) stands of existing vegetation; (ii) a list of the dominant native species; (iii) a list of the weeds and non-native plants; (d) significant features such as large trees, habitat trees, endangered species, vulnerable species, rare species, rocky outcrops, waterways and slopes; (e) the location of existing structures and various services on site, including sewerage and water pipes and easements, power easements and communication lines; (f) proposed works for the site including: (i) how areas of natural regeneration will be encouraged, managed and monitored; (ii) how the site will be prepared; (iii) any areas to be thinned, the species and average size of plants to be thinned, the percentage of each species to be removed and the method of removal; (g) sediment and erosion control measures including implementation, monitoring and timeframes; (h) weeds to be removed, method of removal and monitoring of weed regeneration timeframes; (i) planting works to be undertaken on site an details for planting installation; (j) fencing works to be undertaken on the site; (k) an action plan for the establishment period and for the on-going maintenance period giving a detailed description of each task and the sequence of work to be undertaken including timeframes, resources, erosion and sediment control measures and staging of works compatible with those measures, habitat enhancement, monitoring and maintenance of rubbish removal, weed removal, site preparation and mitigation of threatening processes, planting and supplementary seeding. 2.3.8 (1) Existing vegetation protection plan An existing vegetation protection plan must be in accordance with AS 4970-2009 Protection of Trees on Development Sites and include: (a) the location, identification and extent of plants; (b) the effect of the development on existing plants; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.3 Landscape documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-23 (c) the use of plants in the development; (d) a site analysis or land use suitability drawing, which includes: (i) the existing contours of the premises, the suitable and unsuitable building areas, the road access and drainage pattern; (ii) the existing access road to the premises; (iii) the surveyed location and extent of mass plants including the location of native habitat trees located amongst the mass planted area; (iv) the surveyed location of a free standing tree in an open area not associated with the mass planted area; (v) individual trees identified by the species and the genera and the mass plants identified by the plant type; (vi) the condition, average trunk diameter and significance value of the plants; (vii) photographs of the plants, including identification information and real property description noted on the back of each photo and an object in the photo to demonstrate the scale of the picture; (viii) details of an adjoining use and the description of adjoining plants; (ix) the notional road and lot layout; (x) the notional major stormwater drainage discharge point. 2.3.9 Movement infrastructure report 2.3.9.1 Integrated movement concept report (1) An integrated movement concept report must include: (a) all key destinations within a comfortable cycling distance (nominally five kilometres or 20 minutes) from the premises; (b) one metre contours; (c) existing and planned movement infrastructure; (d) an analysis of how development complies with a general planning layout in Part 7.2– General planning layouts of this planning scheme policy; (e) pedestrian, cycling, public transport and road concept plans; (f) preferred amendments to the pedestrian, cycle, public transport and road networks demonstrating improved transport effectiveness, efficiencies and cost-savings; (g) gaps in the networks where there is either no existing, or inadequate existing infrastructure; (h) a table of deficient infrastructure that may form the basis for further consideration as to the need for, and how to achieve improvements to the deficient infrastructure. 2.4 Stormwater infrastructure documentation 2.4.1 Conceptual site based stormwater management plan (1) The conceptual site based stormwater management plan is to include all information required to assess development against: (a) the standards for stormwater quantity infrastructure; (b) the stormwater management design objectives for: (i) stormwater quality which aims to protect receiving water quality by limiting the quantity of key pollutants discharged in stormwater from urban development; (ii) frequent flow management which aims to protect in-stream ecosystems from the significant effects of increased runoff frequency by capturing the initial portion of runoff from impervious areas. This approach ensures that the frequency of hydraulic disturbance to in-stream ecosystems in developed catchments is similar to pre-development conditions; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.4 Stormwater infrastructure documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-24 (iii) (2) waterway stability which aims to prevent exacerbated in-stream erosion downstream of urban areas by controlling the magnitude and duration of sedimenttransporting flows. Development being a material change of use or a reconfiguring a lot where stormwater quality infrastructure, frequent flow management or waterway stability infrastructure is being provided must provide: (a) an application for a stormwater quality offset. (3) A deemed to comply solution is available to all types and scales of development as an alternative to addressing the design objectives for stormwater quality, frequent flow management or waterway stability in the conceptual stormwater management plan, if all documentation and requirements of the Water sensitive urban design deemed to comply solutions stated in Water Sensitive Urban Design Deemed to Comply Solutions for South East Queensland (2009) are met. (4) Stormwater quality offsets may be applied in accordance with State Planning Policy 4/10 Healthy Waters (SPP4/10) in lieu of on-site treatment for development if: (5) (a) the design objective for waterway stability and the design objective for frequent flow management do not apply to the development; and (b) on-site treatment is determined to be unfeasible. Where the design objective for waterway stability and the design objective for frequent flow management are not applicable, the proposed development would typically be a smaller scale, infill development in a predominantly urbanised catchment and it is likely on-site treatment would be considered unfeasible; or (c) the local government has available to it at the time the development application is made, designed and costed stormwater quality infrastructure projects that are able to be implemented by the local government to achieve at least the same water quality outcome that is required by the proposed development. An application for a stormwater quality offset in lieu of providing and implementing an approved conceptual stormwater management plan addressing the design objectives for stormwater quality, frequent flow management or waterway stability or deemed to comply solution must comply with section 2.4.1(4) of this planning scheme policy. The amount of a stormwater quality offset for a particular development will be calculated as the cost to the local government of designing, constructing and establishing stormwater quality projects to achieve at least the same outcome required by the particular development. 2.4.1.1 (1) Core matters to be included in a conceptual site based stormwater management plan A conceptual site based stormwater management plan must include: (a) an assessment of the existing site which includes: (i) a description of the existing topography and drainage, upstream and downstream of the development site, including details about the size, location and levels of any existing drainage measures; (ii) a description of the site's soils. The level of investigation depends on the proposed design of the stormwater treatment. A detailed soil evaluation in accordance with AS/NZS 1547:2000 Clause 4.1.3 is required to support any bio-retention system or constructed wetland designed without an impermeable liner or if stormwater infiltration is proposed; (iii) identification of any acid sulfate soils; (iv) a site plan showing: (A) contours; (A) development boundaries; (B) catchment details; (C) flow paths; (D) piped drainage; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.4 Stormwater infrastructure documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-25 waterway and drainage invert levels; (F) stormwater detention systems; (G) soil types; (H) culverts; (I) other structures; (J) drainage easements; (K) road drainage; (L) the lawful point of discharge; (M) stormwater quality and frequent flow management infrastructure; (N) easements; (O) existing vegetation; (P) vegetation to be retained; (Q) overland flow path areas; (R) local and regional flood levels for the 10, 5, 2 and 1% AEP flood; (b) details of site configuration in a table form including the total area of: (i) road surfaces; (ii) driveways; (iii) roof surfaces; (iv) landscape areas; (v) stormwater treatment areas; (vi) any other categories specific to the site; (vii) pavement areas; (c) earthworks and catchment details including: (i) conceptual earthworks; (ii) catchments and sub-catchments; (iii) proposed stormwater networks including conceptual surface and invert levels; (iv) cross-sections at regular intervals showing the extend of cut and fill works to confirm earthworks and, if applicable, no loss of floodplain storage; (d) development scale plan layout indicating: (i) catchment details; (ii) conceptual drainage network with invert levels; (iii) location of stormwater treatment measures; (iv) location of existing, planned and proposed infrastructure such as sewerage and water; (v) information on pre and post development flood volumes. 2.4.1.2 (1) (E) Specific matters to be included in conceptual site based stormwater management plan - design objective for frequent flow management A conceptual site based stormwater management plan for the purposes of reporting on stormwater quantity and quality management shall provide details which include: (a) the lawful point of discharge; (b) proposed no-worsening measures; (c) the pre-development stormwater quantity characteristics and any potential development impacts assessed; (d) a description of the modelling method and methodology used in any hydraulic or hydrologic modelling, or in the sizing of infrastructure; (e) a description of all stormwater and overland flow management measures and stormwater infrastructure; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.4 Stormwater infrastructure documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-26 (f) future ownership details of stormwater and drainage infrastructure. (g) the total stormwater capture volume in cubic metres (m3), calculated as follows: (i) capture volume (m3) equals the impervious area (m2) multiplied by the target design runoff capture depth (mm/day) divided by 1000; (ii) The spatial distribution of the required capture volume may be adapted to suit individual site conditions, provided that the required volume from all impervious areas is captured before leaving the site; (iii) The design objective for frequent flow management requires that the capacity to capture the volume of runoff is available each day. The management system (whether reuse, infiltration or diversion) must therefore be capable of draining the captured stormwater within 24 hours; (iv) Capturing the required volume of runoff reduces pollutant load and simultaneously improves water quality. Therefore, it may eliminate the need for separate additional storage to meet the objective for frequent flow management; (h) how the captured stormwater will be managed. This should include one or more of the following: (i) reuse of stormwater (including collection and use of roof water); (ii) infiltration to native soils (where adverse impacts will not arise); (iii) diversion of surplus flows around sensitive downstream receiving environments; (iv) evaporation of stormwater. 2.4.1.3 (1) Specific matters to be included in conceptual site based stormwater management plan - design objectives for stormwater quality For the purposes of reporting on the design objectives for stormwater quality, a conceptual site based stormwater management plan shall provide details including: (a) descriptions of each treatment train for each sub-catchment ensuring that all types of pollutant (primary, secondary and tertiary) is treated in the appropriate order - primary pollutant treatment measures are located at the beginning of the treatment train and tertiary treatment measures are positioned at the end; (b) details of each individual treatment device including total footprint, treatment area, invert levels, coarse sediment management, maintenance access and design flows. Specify whether the stormwater treatment system will be privately maintained or handed over to the local government; (c) a scale plan and section drawings showing: (i) how stormwater is conveyed to the stormwater treatment devices; (ii) the location of all stormwater treatment devices including filter areas and batters with respect to the development layout; (iii) surrounding ground levels; (iv) conceptual design levels for each treatment device and receiving drainage invert levels; (v) scour protection and coarse sediment management devices; (vi) maintenance access; (vii) likely maintenance intervals; (d) section drawings showing: (i) conceptual design levels for each treatment device and receiving drainage invert levels; (ii) scour protection and coarse sediment management devices; (iii) batters, embankments or retaining walls; (e) proof that all modelling and reporting has been undertaken in accordance with the Model for Urban Stormwater Improvement Conceptualisation (MUSIC) and the Water by Design MUSIC Modelling Guidelines. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.4 Stormwater infrastructure documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-27 2.4.1.4 (1) For the purposes of demonstrating compliance with the design objective for waterway stability, a conceptual site based stormwater management plan shall provide details including the methodology used to achieve the design objective for waterway stability in accordance with Appendix C of Water Sensitive Urban Design: Developing Design Objectives for Urban Development in South East Queensland, Version 2, November 2007, published by the South East Queensland Healthy Waterways Partnership. 2.4.1.5 (1) Detailed site based stormwater management plan The detailed site based stormwater management plan is to document all information required to assess development against the design objectives for: (a) stormwater quality; (b) frequent flow management; (c) waterway stability. 2.4.2.1 (1) Modelling requirements All modelling files used to demonstrate compliance with the design objectives must be provided to the local government on a CD with the development application. If modelling is required, the modelling regime and scope will be agreed between the applicant and the local government prior to the commencement of the modelling. 2.4.2 (1) Specific matters to be included in conceptual site based stormwater management plan - design objective for waterway stability Core matters to be included in a detailed site based stormwater management plan A detailed site based stormwater management plan must include: (a) (b) an assessment of the existing site which includes: (i) a description of the existing topography and drainage; (ii) a description of the site's soils; (iii) identification of any acid sulfate soils; (iv) a site plan showing: (A) contours; (B) development boundaries; (C) catchment details (D) flow paths; (E) piped drainage (F) waterway and drainage invert levels; (G) stormwater detention systems; (H) culverts; (I) drainage easements; (J) road drainage; (K) the lawful point of discharge; (L) stormwater quality and frequent flow management infrastructure; (M) easements; (N) existing vegetation; (O) vegetation to be retained; (P) future ownership and maintenance responsibility; (Q) overland flow path areas; details of site configuration in a table form including the total area of: (i) road surfaces; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.4 Stormwater infrastructure documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-28 (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) (c) 2.4.2.2 (1) earthworks and catchment details including: (i) conceptual earthworks; (ii) proposed stormwater infrastructure; (iii) cross-sections at regular intervals showing the extent of cut and fill works to confirm earthworks and, if applicable, no loss of floodplain storage. Specific matters to be included in detailed site based stormwater management plans stormwater quantity A detailed site based stormwater management plan for the purposes of reporting on the design objectives for frequent flow management must include: (a) a detailed design of all stormwater quantity and or quality management methods and infrastructure; (b) the location and network connection details; (c) a description of the modelling method and methodology used for any hydraulic or hydrologic modelling; (d) detailed engineering drawings showing: (i) the areas of earthworks including cross-sections at regular intervals showing the extend of cut and fill works to confirm earthworks and, if applicable, no loss of floodplain storage; (ii) final site contours; (iii) final road layout; (iv) final lot arrangement; (v) location, size and type of proposed stormwater quantity and or quality management measures including all invert levels; (vi) maintenance access; (vii) location of lawful points of discharge and receiving waters/environs. 2.4.2.3 (1) driveways; roof surfaces; landscape areas; pavement areas; Modelling requirements All modelling files used to demonstrate compliance with the design objectives must be provided to the local government on a CD with the development application. 2.5 Flooding documentation 2.5.1 Flood study report Editor's note––Access to the local government's adopted flood model can be obtained by entering a data sharing agreement. Completing a flood study in accordance with the tenets identified in appendix 2 of SPP Guideline 01/03 is acceptable. (1) A flood study report shall include: (a) an assessment of the catchment, as pertaining to the development area, for the full range of design flood events, specifically, the 50, 20, 10, 5, 2 and 1% AEP events and lower probability flood events if applicable to the type of development proposed; (b) where in the coastal zone the provisions made for storm surge; (c) details of the tail water level (5, 2 and 1% AEP flood levels) adopted during the assessment of the catchment; (d) details of sensitivity analysis undertaken, assessing the influence of, but not limited to: (i) variation of all Mannings ‘n’ values by 10% to 20%; (ii) variation of the tail water level; (iii) blockage considerations as outlined in the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual and Australian Rainfall and Runoff Project 11 Blockage of Hydraulic Structures; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.5 Flooding documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-29 (e) details of, where possible, calibration of the model to known, recorded flood levels within the catchment or waterway or equivalent; (f) an assessment of flood level, flow or velocity with a view to ensuring that no increase occurs in any of these; (g) an assessment demonstrating that no significant or sudden change in distribution of the defined flood event flow, flood level or velocity shall occur which may result in: (i) the failure of a levee; (ii) blockage and/ or breakout; (iii) excessive scour; (iv) realignment of the waterway; (v) sedimentation; (vi) bank instability and collapse; (vii) a reduction in flood warning times; (viii) extension of the duration of inundation; (ix) hindrance to emergency evacuation routes; (x) disruption to critical infrastructure, services, or access routes; (xi) exacerbation of risk to people, property and community infrastructure; (h) general decrease in amenity; (i) an assessment of any impacts of the development upon the uses identified in Column 1 in Table 8.2.5.3.3–Minimum flood levels of the Flood hazard overlay code of the planning scheme; (j) details of safe access and egress for the development, including the calculation and documentation of access road flood depths and depth*velocity products; (k) details of all flood level and flow calculation made in the assessment of the existing site and the proposed development impact; (l) details of the methodology and input data for any hydraulic or hydrologic modelling undertaken; (m) provision of flood maps depicting the following: (i) flood extents for the full range of ARI storm events modelled for various scenarios including pre-developed (existing case), developed case, and if applicable, ultimate developed case; (ii) velocity-depth profiles; (iii) flood hazard mapping; (iv) flood velocity range and vectors; (v) shear stress; (vi) the effects of sensitivity analyses; (vii) impact maps portraying effects of various increment levels to demonstrate compliance with the Flood hazard overlay code. 2.5.2 (1) Filling and excavation plan in the flooding and inundation area A filling and excavation plan and supporting information shall include: (a) a plan showing: (i) existing and finished surface level contours (to AHD) of the development site, including survey point density and accuracy in accordance with Council Standards; (ii) the compensatory free-draining excavation area for any proposed filling within the flood plain; (iii) the alignment of the toe of the batter slope which is proposed to retain the fill; (iv) the grading of the proposed cut and fill surfaces demonstrating the finished surface is free draining; (v) level notations that identify the line of the defined flood event and the proposed area of filling and excavation (before and after filling); Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.5 Flooding documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-30 2.5.3 (1) (b) section drawings showing level notations which identify the line of the defined flood event and the proposed area of filling and excavation (before and after filling); (c) details of: (i) the hydraulic design of the development, using topographic data which includes at least one surveyed cross-section of the floodway aligned through the proposed fill area; (ii) pre and post development finished surface level and the defined flood event level; (iii) the flood modelling undertaken; (iv) any adverse effects on the behaviour of a flood in excess of the defined flood event; (v) any proposed batter slopes and retaining walls on the premises; (vi) the provisions for stormwater run-off from any proposed area of filling and excavation; (vii) how the natural drainage of adjacent premises has been catered for; (viii) calculations of the cut, fill and balance to confirm compensatory earthworks and loss of floodplain storage; (ix) plots of pre and post earthworks flood storage against depth; (x) plots of pre and post earthworks conveyance against depth; (xi) cross-sections at regular intervals showing the extent of cut and fill works to confirm earthworks and if applicable no loss of floodplain storage. Numerical modelling requirements All modelling used to demonstrate compliance with the flood plain management requirements shall be provided to the local government on a CD with the development application. Note––Please refer to the SPP Guideline for further modelling methods and techniques. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 2.5 Flooding documentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-31 Part 3 3.1 (1) Standards Purpose The purpose of this part is to specify the local government's standards that must be met by development for: (a) filling and excavation; (b) movement network infrastructure; (c) stormwater infrastructure; (d) water supply infrastructure; (e) sewerage infrastructure; (f) park infrastructure; (g) electricity reticulation infrastructure; (h) gas and telecommunication reticulation infrastructure; (i) road lighting infrastructure; (j) landscaping. 3.2 Design and construction of work 3.2.1 Standards and specifications (1) (2) 3.2.2 (1) All work is to be in accordance with: (a) the standards identified in this planning scheme policy; (b) the standard specifications identified in this planning scheme policy; (c) the standard drawings identified in this planning scheme policy. If the standards and specifications for the design and construction of specific infrastructure are not provided in this planning scheme policy, guidance may be obtained in reference to the Australian Standards, Queensland Development Code – Mandatory Parts or: (a) for transport infrastructure: (i) Complete Streets; (ii) Austroads publications; (iii) Manual for uniform traffic control devices (MUTCD); (b) for stormwater infrastructure: (i) Queensland Urban Drainage Manual; (ii) Australian Rainfall and Runoff; (iii) Healthy Waterways Water by Design Guidelines and Standard Drawings; (c) for ecological restoration, rehabilitation and revegetation: (i) SEQ Ecological Restoration Framework; (d) for flood modelling software user manuals and guidelines: (i) Floodplain management in Australia: Best practise principles and guidelines (2000); (e) for sewerage and water supply: (i) South East Queensland – Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Application of standards Design and construction of work identified in section 3.1–Purpose of this planning scheme policy shall comply with the standards. Where standards and/or specifications are not stipulated Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.1 Purpose Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-32 for certain infrastructure elements guidance may be obtained in Part 4: Guidelines of this planning scheme policy. 3.3 Filling and excavation standards 3.3.1 Standards and specifications 3.3.1.1 General (1) A filling and excavation plan and supporting information will be required for development where the development involves filling or excavation which exceeds: (a) 10m3 and where land is wholly or partly within the Flood hazard overlay Map–OM 05.00 identified in Schedule 2–Mapping of the planning scheme; (b) 20m3 and in Centre, Community facilities, Low density residential, Low-medium density residential, Medium density residential; Low impact industry, Medium impact industry, Mixed use or Specialised centre zone; or (c) 100m3 and in the Emerging community, Environmental management and conservation, Recreation and open space, Rural residential or Rural zone. (2) The filling and excavation plan and supporting information shall provide the necessary information to demonstrate compliance with the Flood hazard overlay code as it relates to filling and excavation. (3) Filling and excavation must comply with the standard specifications in Part 9–Standard specifications identified in this planning scheme policy. 3.3.1.2 (1) Material used for filling The quality and composition of material used for filling must comply with the following sections of Standard specification No. 1–Earthworks 2015, identified in Part 9–Standard specifications of this planning scheme policy: (a) section 8.3(1); (b) section 9.3(3). 3.3.2 Cover of infrastructure (1) The cover to a water reticulation main is to comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. (2) During construction works: (3) (a) no existing hydrant cover or marker post is covered, obstructed or obscured; (b) stormwater infrastructure is not pierced. A sewerage reticulation main and a house connection is provided in accordance with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code so that: (a) the property can be commanded; (b) other services are not fouled; (c) stormwater infrastructure is not pierced. 3.3.3 General standards 3.3.3.1 Site disturbance (1) Soil disturbance associated with filling and excavation is limited to the minimum necessary to perform the required filling and excavation. (2) A previously undisturbed area of soil is not exposed to erosion where: (a) a slope is greater than 1 in 10; or (b) a highly erosive or clay-based soil is present. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.3 Filling and excavation standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-33 3.3.3.2 Site and waste management (1) Waste water from the washing of tools and painting equipment and the cutting of concrete, masonry, tiles or other products is discharged on the site and over a porous grassed surface or well-drained, loosened soil. (2) All waste water generated on the site is: (3) (4) (a) prevented from flowing off the site and is allowed to infiltrate the soil; or (b) filtered through a porous, fine-grained embankment lined with filter cloth before it is allowed to exit the site. Sand, soil or other material from the site that is deposited on a paved road or within a gutter or a drain is removed: (a) immediately, if rain is occurring or is imminent; or (b) upon the completion of the day’s work, if rain is not occurring or is not imminent. Where sand, soil or other material from the site is deposited on a paved road or within a gutter or a drain as a result of the filling and excavation on the site, the sand, soil or material is: (a) first shovelled, then swept from the gutter, drain or paved surface; (b) not washed from the surface unless directed by the local government. (5) Solid or liquid waste from a concrete truck and equipment is contained on the site. (6) Cement residue from works associated with filling and excavation, including concreting and the preparation of exposed aggregate concrete surfaces are: (7) (a) washed onto a pervious surface such as a grassed or open soil area; or (b) contained in a temporary collection trench formed near the concrete surface; or (c) filtered through a fine-grained, porous embankment lined with an appropriate filter cloth. An erosion and sediment control measure is kept in working order until: (a) the disturbed parts of the site have been effectively stabilised; (b) a damaged erosion and sediment control measure is repaired as soon as practicable. (8) Site signage identifying erosion and sediment control measure and its purpose is installed and maintained. (9) All solid waste collected in erosion and sediment control measure is disposed at an approved landfill site. 3.3.3.3 Damage (1) No damage will be caused to grass, cultivation, fences, existing services, buildings or stock by fire, falling timber or other causes arising from the filling and excavation. (2) Where damage occurs to fences and areas outside the site, the contractor is responsible for the cost and full reinstatement of those areas. (3) During the clearing of lines and designated areas, care is taken not to disturb any bench marks, survey pegs or level pegs. (4) The relevant service authority is informed when damage occurs to services, or is suspected to have occurred, and the cost of repairs is borne by the contractor. 3.3.3.4 Treatment of adjoining properties (1) Cross-section plans for filling and excavation that show the adjoining property boundaries where filling and excavation are adjacent to existing developments. (2) The affect on the drainage of adjoining properties from any cut and fill operation is considered and designed to ensure that no pondage of water or nuisance stormwater runoff occurs. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.3 Filling and excavation standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-34 3.3.3.5 (1) Protection of structures Precautions are taken to ensure that filling and excavation for the construction of an embankment or for an excavation, do not cause movement of, or undue strain to, any structure. 3.3.3.6 Use of explosives and blasting in rock (1) Rock is carefully excavated by blasting procedures where blasting operations comply with the conditions of an approval or licence. (2) The handling, storage and use of explosives complies with the following: (a) State Acts; (b) AS 2187.1: 1998: Explosives–Storage, transport and use–Storage; (c) AS 2187.2: 2006: Explosives–Storage and use–Use of explosives. (3) During blasting operations a vibograph or other similar instrument is used to observe and record vibrations. The record of vibrations is provided to the local government. (4) Where the record of vibrations indicates non-compliance with the conditions of an approval or licence or the provisions of an Act or Australian Standard: (a) the amount of charge is reduced; or (b) another action approved by the local government is taken to ensure compliance. (5) Trial blasting may be required to determine the likely vibration that may be caused and the maximum charge to be employed. (6) The local government is to be notified at least three business days prior to any excavation by blasting and any excavation by blasting is only to be carried out at the times identified by the local government. (7) Protective devices are provided to limit the affect of blasting. (8) The contractor is responsible for any loss, damage or injury caused directly or indirectly by blasting. (9) Explosives are kept in secure storage places that are clearly marked with warning signs. (10) No explosive is to be fired until: (a) an audible warning, clearly different to other sounds on the site, has been sounded; (b) all persons within the radius of danger have been evacuated. (11) Where explosives are used to excavate rock, the amount of charge used does not loosen rock outside the intended excavation lines shown on engineering drawings. (12) Where rock outside excavation lines shown on engineering drawings has been loosened as a result of blasting and may slide or fall, the loosened rock is to be removed and replaced with suitable material. 3.3.3.7 (1) Property pegs Survey pegs or survey marks that identify areas not to be cleared, excavated or covered by embankments, and which are disturbed, displaced, damaged, or covered, are replaced by a licensed surveyor. 3.3.3.8 Environmental weeds (1) Environmental weeds such as declared plants or noxious weeds are identified and managed in accordance with the Land Protection (Pest and Stock Route Management) Act 2002. (2) Where earthmoving equipment is moved from an area with environmental weeds to a new site, reasonable measures, including the cleaning of earthmoving equipment and vehicles, are taken to ensure equipment does not transport the environmental weeds. 3.3.3.9 (1) Fire ants In a fire ant restricted area, construction complies with: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.3 Filling and excavation standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-35 (a) the Plant Protection Act 1989; (b) any guidelines published by the relevant State Government Department regarding the commercial movement of high risk material. 3.3.3.10 Acid sulfate soils (1) Areas identified as containing acid sulfate soils or potential acid sulfate soils are to be treated in accordance with: (a) Acid sulfate soils overlay code in Part 8.2.1 of the planning scheme; (b) Queensland Government - Instructions for the Treatment and Management of Acid Sulfate Soils, 2001. 3.3.3.11 Compressive soils (1) Filling and excavation in areas comprising compressive soils that are intended to be developed for an urban use, including roads and parks, achieve consolidation and stability by: (a) pre-loading the soil in accordance with the local government’s requirements; or (b) another method approved by the local government. 3.3.3.12 Dispersive soils (1) Filling, excavation, and construction in areas comprising of dispersive and sodic soils/soils exhibiting dispersive soil characteristics need to be managed so as to not exacerbate the erosive and sedimentation potential. (2) Works should comply with the tenets set out in Best Practice Erosion and Sediment Control Guidelines (2008)(IECA). 3.3.4 Clearing and preservation of trees 3.3.4.1 Clearing (1) Clearing associated with filling and excavation complies with Standard Specification No 1 (Earthworks) 2015 in Part 9–Standard specifications of this planning scheme policy. (2) Prior to clearing land associated with filling and excavation, the land is inspected by appropriately qualified persons accredited and licensed under the Queensland Nature Conservation Act, 1992 to conduct and/or supervise the preparation and implementation of Wildlife Protection and Management plans and the detection, capture removal and disposal of wildlife from sites proposed to be developed. 3.3.4.2 Trees to be preserved (1) Filling and excavation is undertaken to preserve without damage, trees and vegetation identified by the local government. (2) Trees and vegetation identified by the local government to be of significance are identified, marked and left standing and undamaged. (3) Trees and vegetation that form part of a riparian or other buffer zone along rivers, creeks or waterways are clearly identified and preserved. (4) The management of trees to be preserved is undertaken in accordance with AS 4970-2009 Protection of Trees on Development Sites. 3.3.5 Dams and embankments 3.3.5.1 Dams (1) Embankments, spillways and associated water flow channels are designed and constructed in accordance with the requirements of the Queensland Department of Environment and Heritage and the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. (2) Constructed waterways, embankments and associated outlet structures are not constructed within: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.3 Filling and excavation standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-36 (3) (a) ten metres of property boundaries; or (b) 40 metres of a building. Maintenance dredging of dams: (a) has regard for water quality requirements; (b) is conducted in a manner that prevents siltation of any downstream watercourse or property. 3.3.5.2 Filling of dams (1) Where dams are to be filled, they are dewatered in accordance with best practice, all silt removed and the dam wall levelled to the surrounding ground level. Dewatering of dams should be done in the presence of a spotter catcher. (2) To ensure the integrity of drainage lines to and from any dam that is to be filled, an alternative drainage path is designed applying the principle of no worsening in section 3.6.2.10 of this planning scheme policy and utilising best practise natural channel design and erosion and sediment control measures to replace the original drainage path prior to the dam being filled. 3.3.5.3 (1) Organic material No tree, log or other organic material is placed in any embankment, scour, hole, dam to be filled or other hollow place where transport infrastructure or allotments are planned. 3.3.6 Batters and retaining walls 3.3.6.1 Batters (1) Batters have slopes that are: (a) 1 in 4 for all batters; (b) 1 in 10 for batters in public open space; (c) 1 in 4 for batters to waterways; (d) Rural (i) (ii) (iii) Roads depth of Cut and Fill: <0.5m - 1 in 6; 0.5m - 1.0m 1 in 4; >1.0 m - 1 in 2. (2) Stabilisation by use of vegetation is commenced immediately following completion of bulk filling and excavation to form batters. (3) Batters are constructed as follows: (a) wholly within the property boundary; (b) have adequate drainage at the toe and top of the batter. (4) All batters and retaining walls within a road resulting from cut and fill operations provide for drainage as specified in the standard drawings in Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. (5) Batters are benched where the proposed freestanding batter height exceeds 2.5 metres. (6) Where batters are benched: (a) the minimum benching width is 1.0 metre; (b) the minimum slope is 1 in 100 towards the lower face. (7) Precautions are taken to effectively minimise dust that may occur during construction and that may affect the safety or general comfort of the public and occupants of nearby properties. (8) Where excavation and filling shall take place near existing or proposed stormwater, water and sewer assets, these assets shall be protected by maintaining the appropriate pipe cover, easement width, CCTV survey and any other protection required by section 3.6.2.16–Creating new easements; section 3.6.2.17–Specifications for new easements; section 3.6.2.18–Works Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.3 Filling and excavation standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-37 within existing easements and section 3.6.2.19–Where an easement cannot be obtained of this planning scheme policy . (9) Batters are contained so as not to extend into an existing or proposed road, park or conservation area. 3.3.6.2 Retaining walls (1) Retaining walls, including boulder walls, concrete gravity retaining walls, reinforced concrete cantilever retaining walls and concrete crib walls, are designed with appropriate provision for sub-soil drainage. (2) Timber sleeper walls within an allotment are: (a) used for landscaping purposes only; (b) a maximum of 900mm in height; (c) constructed of timber suitably treated to prevent termite infestation; (d) not constructed within 1.5 metres of the property boundary of private property, public open space or road reserve. (3) Treated timber sleeper walls are not located on boundaries of the premises, or where allotments or transport infrastructure are planned. (4) A retaining structure: (5) (a) does not encroach onto any adjoining property or road reserve; (b) up to and including 1.5 metres in height, is allowed on property boundary provided it has adequate drainage; (c) exceeding 1.5 metres in height, has a minimum boundary clearance equal to the full height of the retaining structure; (d) is designed in accordance with AS 4678: 2002: Earth-retaining structures, Amendment 1 - 2003 and Amendment 2 - 2008; (e) is designed to provide a neat architectural and aesthetic appearance; (f) drains storm water discharge to the street or other lawful point of discharge; (g) wall adjacent to road reserve boundary is fenced for pedestrian safety; (h) wall adjacent to road reserve boundary is fenced with guardrail to deflect vehicles where the retaining wall falls within the clear zone as defined by Austroads. Provide appropriate terminal ends to guardrail; (i) wall adjacent to road reserve boundary includes safety measures to protect pedestrians in the road reserve during construction; (j) roadside design is in accordance with Austroads Guide to Road and Design. For boundary retaining walls for differential allotment levels, a formal submission is made to the local government for approval that demonstrates: (a) compliance with section 3.3.6.1(1) and section 3.3.6.1(3)); (b) that the boundary retaining walls are located within the boundaries of the lower allotment. (6) Retaining walls do not impose any loading on adjoining structures including underground services. Where the area of influence of the load of a proposed retaining structure influences services, the services or the retaining structure, shall be re-located or re-designed so that the wall is supported and does not have an adverse impact on the service. Retaining structures that influence sewer assets shall submit a build over or near sewer application. (7) Retaining walls are not located in a road reserve, however, the local government may consider a retaining structure located in a road reserve upon receipt of a formal submission. (8) Retaining walls: (a) in urban and non-urban areas over 1.5 metres in height are stepped a minimum of 1 metre horizontally for every 1.5 metres in height to a maximum height of 3 metres; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.3 Filling and excavation standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-38 (b) in public open space areas, have a maximum height of 0.6 metres. (9) Retaining structures are not permitted within detention basins. Retaining structures may be located within a bio-retention basin provided the bio-retention basin is not within a detention basin or other stormwater quantity control measure. (10) Where retaining walls to waterways are proposed, development provides: (11) (12) (a) riparian buffers, where assessment has shown that riparian buffers are likely to remain sustainable; or (b) structural edge protection, where assessment has shown that riparian buffers are likely to not remain sustainable. For retaining walls to waterways: (a) certification of the structural design and stability of the retaining structure is provided by an appropriately qualified and experienced structural engineer in accordance with section 2.1–Competency to prepare a report of this planning scheme policy; (b) an assessment is conducted as to the likely performance and stability of the retaining structure for a range of possible waterway changes for a 60 year period; (c) no boulder walls to be used in waterways or flood plains; (d) the design must address the following criteria: (i) the top of the wall is generally no lower than the Highest Astronomical Tide plus 200mm; (ii) changes to water quality; (iii) natural meandering processes; (iv) increased boating traffic; (v) increased tidal volume upstream due to future development; (vi) increased flows due to developed catchments; (vii) changes in sediment transport availability (viii) maintenance requirements of walls including drainage clean out points to be stated and identified. Upon request, the local government may approve a retaining structure that: (a) has a minimum clearance from the boundary of the premises equal to the height of the retaining structure; (b) is terraced and landscaped; (c) does not exceed an angle of repose of 45 degrees to adjoining buildings; (d) has a geotechnical and structural design; (e) in industrial and commercial areas, has a maximum height of 5 metres; (f) in public open space areas, has a maximum height of 0.6 metres; (g) has a design life of not less than 60 years. (13) The person who has the benefit of the development approval is responsible for the stability of filling and excavation until final acceptance by the local government of the works offmaintenance. (14) Prior to the acceptance of the works off-maintenance the person who has the benefit of the development approval will replace any section of the filling and excavation that has for any reason become displaced. (15) Temporary drainage is provided to ensure that pondage, flooding, erosion or siltation does not occur on the site, or external to the site, as a result of the filling and excavation. (16) Certification of the retaining structure by a RPEQ (structural) must be submitted to the local government at the time of on maintenance submission. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.3 Filling and excavation standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-39 3.3.7 (1) Drainage, sediment, erosion and dust control (including works in a dispersive soil area) Drainage, sediment, erosion and dust control are in accordance with Best Practice Erosion and Sediment Control Guidelines (IECA 2008). 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards 3.4.1 Planning guidelines for the movement network 3.4.1.1 Movement network components (1) (2) The movement network comprises the: (a) pedestrian network; (b) cycle network; (c) public transport network; (d) road network. Development provides a movement network that is accessible to the whole community and prioritises access and travel in accordance with the following hierarchy: (a) walking is the preferred mode of movement; (b) cycling is preferable to the use of public transport and private vehicles; (c) public transport use is preferable to the use of private vehicles; (d) private vehicle use is less preferable than public transport use, walking, and cycling. 3.4.1.2 (1) Cycle network The cycle network is planned: (a) to integrate with and ensure the safety and efficiency of the existing and planned infrastructure for the cycle network identified in Figure 3.4.1.2.1—Cycle network of this planning scheme policy; (b) in accordance with section 3.4.3–Design standards for cycle paths of this planning scheme policy; (c) where development is located within 800 metres of a school, to comply with Planning for Safe Transport Infrastructure at Schools prepared by the Department of Transport and Main Roads. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-40 Figure 3.4.1.2.1—Cycle network Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-41 Table 3.4.1.2.1—Cycle network planning guidelines Cycle path classification Network function Typical user Typical location/Types Operational criteria Neighbourhood route Connecting residential development with local neighbourhood centres and facilities. Connect to district routes. School children and other inexperienced cyclists. Within road shared paths (widened footpaths). On-road cycle lanes are not to be used for neighbourhood routes. Located on access streets <3000 vpd, can be route marked as a cycle route, without cycle lanes or paths. Shared verge path. Minimum width: 2m Design speed: 10km/h Local flood immunity: Q1 District route Connecting neighbourhood routes to major routes. Serving shopping centres and parks. Connect residential development with district centres and facilities Higher proportion of inexperienced commuter or recreational cyclists than Major routes. Higher proportion of pedestrians than Major routes. On-road cycle lanes or shared paths. Shared paths connecting to on-road cycle lanes are supplemented with alternative path for younger cyclists and pedestrians. Shared verge paths Exclusive paths Width: 2.5m Design speed: 20km/h Local flood immunity: Q2 Width: 2.0m Design speed: 30km/h Local flood immunity: Q2 Links employment areas and centres and provide access to neighbouring local government areas, road corridor routes or open space corridor routes Catering for experienced commuter, sporting, or touring cyclists. Off-road 'exclusive' paths or on-road cycle lanes. (Desired operational outcomes difficult to achieve on with-in road or shared paths.) Shared paths connecting to on-road cycle lanes are supplemented with alternative path for younger cyclists and pedestrians. Alternative on-road cycle lane. Shared paths Exclusive paths Major route Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-42 3.4.1.3 (1) Public transport network The public transport network is planned: (a) to integrate with and ensure the safety and efficiency of the existing and planned infrastructure for the public transport network identified in Figure 3.4.1.3.1–Public transport network of this planning scheme policy; (b) in accordance with Table 3.4.1.3.1–Desired standard of service for public transport services (Translink) of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 P43 Figure 3.4.1.3.1–Public transport network Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-44 Table 3.4.1.3.1–Desired standard of service for public transport services (Translink) Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Density Development type Standard of service High density (50 dwelling per hectare, 100 residents or jobs per hectare) Multi-storey (5+) CBD and regional centres (i.e. Brisbane CBD) High frequency priority (HPF) service - "turn up and go" 15 minute frequency or better Medium density (20-25 dwellings per hectare, 50 residents or jobs per hectare) Small lots mixed with apartments HFP services on major corridors. Infill by local services. Low density (7-15 dwellings per hectare, 20 residents or 10 jobs per hectare) Newer subdivisions Business parks Local services on hourly frequency. Some access to HFP and peak only services. Non-urban (Fewer than 7 dwellings per hectare, as low as one dwelling per hectare) Acreage subdivisions Rural towns Isolated villages Does not generally support public transport services. Inter-regional service may connect to centres. Park 'n' ride to facilitate access to public transport network. 3.4.1.4 (1) Road network The road network is planned: (a) to integrate with and ensure the safety and efficiency of the existing and planned infrastructure for road network identified in Figure 3.4.1.4.1–Road network and in Table 7.2.1.1–General planning layouts for areas of this planning scheme policy; (b) to comply with Table 3.4.1.4.1–Road network planning guidelines of this planning scheme policy; (c) to comply with the provisions in Queensland Department of Transport and Main Roads Fauna Sensitive Road Design Manual - Volume 2: Preferred Practices; (d) in accordance with the desired maximum annual average weekday traffic for a local government road stated in Table 3.4.1.4.2–Maximum annual average weekday traffic for a local government (mid-block) of this planning scheme policy; (e) to ensure that: (i) the degree of saturation on any approach for an intersection is not greater than one; or (ii) the maximum control delays through intersections in peak periods specified in Table 3.4.1.4.3–Maximum control delays through intersections in peak periods of this planning scheme policy are not exceeded. Editor's note––Peak periods are typically from 6am to 9:30am and 3pm to 6:30pm on week days. Editor's note––The degree of saturation for an approach is the ratio of traffic volume to road capacity. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-45 Figure 3.4.1.4.1–Road network Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-46 Table 3.4.1.4.1–Road network planning guidelines Road Functio n 1 Location Road Type Catchment lots/vpd/Ha 2 3 4 Urban Access Street (UAS) <=75 lots Urban Access Road (UAR) <=300 lots Urban Access Nonurban Rural Access Road (RAR) Industrial Industrial Access Road (IAR) Centres Main Street (MS) <=120 lots or 12Ha Urban Collector single carriageway (UC-2L) <=15,000 Urban Collector dual carriageway (UC-4L) > 15,000 Nonurban Rural Collector (RC) Industrial Industrial Collector (IC) Urban Arterial single carriageway (UA-2L) <=20,000 Urban Arterial dual carriageway (UA-4L) > 20,000 Rural Arterial single carriageway (RA-2L) <=22,000 Rural Arterial dual carriageway (RA-4L) > 22,000 Urban Multimodal On bus routes Multi-Modal Roads (MMR) Intersections Operational Criteria Other Modes 5 Access streets and roads serve residential, industrial or centres development. They are the destination for most traffic and carry very little 'through' traffic. Access streets will be provided by development. Access roads may serve multiple developments. 6 There will be no (driveway) access restrictions, although the use of rear laneways to reduce parking on access streets may be desirable 7 Intersections of Access streets and roads will be typically uncontrolled. Access streets and Access roads intersect with Collector roads typically as roundabouts, but intersections with Arterial roads are avoided. 8 Access streets should be designed as 'places' with priority for meetings, pedestrians and play. Traffic is slowed to <20kph. Shared space treatments may be desirable. Access roads are <50kph. 9 Pedestrians and cyclists and service vehicles, but not buses. Collector roads connect access roads to arterial roads. Collectors generally serve one land use and movements contained within the land use should be on Collectors rather than Arterials. Urban Collector roads typically carry more than 3000 vpd at speeds up to 60kph. Driveway access is controlled but on-street parking is acceptable. Rear laneways or left-in, left-out arrangements are appropriate. Direct frontage access to rural collectors from large properties may be permitted. There will be no parking on, or driveway access to, Urban Arterials. Direct frontage access to Rural Arterials from large properties may be permitted. Intersection between Collectors is likely to be roundabouts. Intersections with Arterials are signalised. Intersections are at 300+m spacing Urban Collectors are speed limited at 60kph. Rural Collectors may have higher speed limits. On-road cycle lanes are provided on Urban Collectors. Provision for buses using parking lanes. Intersections between Arterials are signalised. Intersection spacing is as large as possible and not less than 800m. Arterials will deliver safe operations at speeds >80kph. On-road cycle lanes may be provided on the road shoulders, but where the cycle route is part of the cycle network plan, cyclists are on separate, wide paths in the road verge. Parking lanes on Collectors may be converted to transit lanes. Bus priority treatment at signalised intersections Transit lanes may be introduced on Collector and Arterial roads. Transit roads carrying buses, cyclists and pedestrians but not cars may be introduced on Multi-Modal routes. Arterial roads have a subregional network function crossing land uses. Arterial Nonurban Access/Parking Restrictions 2 city blocks Urban Collector Network Function Multi-modal and transit roads serve primary or secondary bus routes. Transit Roads Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-47 Table 3.4.1.4.2–Maximum annual average weekday traffic for a local government (mid-block) Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Road function Number of lanes Maximum annual average weekday traffic for locality (vehicle per day) Urban out-ofcentre Non urban Arterial Collector Centre 2 22,000 20,000 Not applicable 4 48,000 44,000 Not applicable 2 (median divided) Not applicable 15,000 14,000 4 Not applicable 33,000 30,000 Editor's note––The maximum annual average weekday traffic applies to both multi-modal freight and freight roads. Table 3.4.1.4.3–Maximum control delays through intersections in peak periods Column 1 Column 2 Location Maximum control delay for type of intersection (seconds) Signal controlled intersection Roundabout Sign controlled intersection Centres and on multimodal routes 80 70 50 Urban out-of-centre 55 50 35 Non urban and on freight routes 35 35 25 3.4.2 Design standards for footpaths (1) Development provides land for a pathway which is not less than 10 metres in width. (2) A path, being a footpath or a shared cycle and pedestrian path, constructed within a pathway, is located not less than 1 metre from either side of the pathway. (3) A footpath is not less than 1.5 metres in width. (4) A footpath complies with standard drawings IPWEAQ SEQ R-065, LCC 08-00398 and LCC 0800399 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. (5) Footpaths and paths in a road reserve are in accordance with Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy. (6) A physical barrier to restrict vehicular access to a pathway and to prevent direct pedestrian access to the road at the end of a pathway in accordance with standard drawings LCC 8-00399 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. (7) Kerb ramps are provided for the safe passage of pedestrians including provision for people with disabilities. (8) A kerb ramp is designed and constructed in accordance with: (9) (a) AS 1428.2: 1992: Design for access and mobility - Enhanced and additional requirements - Buildings and facilities; (b) standard drawings in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. A pedestrian crossing in a traffic island is designed so that: (a) pedestrian traffic is at the same level as the road pavement; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 P48 (b) 3.4.3 (1) Design standards for cycle paths Cycle paths comply with the following: (a) the cycle network identified in Figure 3.4.1.2.1—Cycle network of this planning scheme policy; (b) the design standards for a cycle path identified in Table 3.4.3.1.1–Cycle path minimum design standards of this planning scheme policy; (c) the Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices (Queensland); (d) the standard drawings for cycle paths in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.3.1 (1) the path through the island allows a person with disabilities to access the intersection or the pedestrian crossing. Cycle path geometry A pipe and culvert: (a) crossing does not cause a narrowing or perceived narrowing of the width of the approach path; (b) headwall is located a minimum of 1 metre from a cycle path edge. (2) A cycle path bridge, pedestrian bridge or boardwalk does not cause a narrowing or perceived narrowing of the width of the approach path. (3) A banana rail structure: (a) is provided to create a slow point at the approach to a hazard that cannot be avoided; (b) is provided at an approach to a road crossing; (c) has appropriate signage. Table 3.4.3.1.1–Cycle path minimum design standards Network function Shared or exclusive cycle path Major District Neighbourhood 3.4.3.2 Minimum design standard Local flood immunity Design speed (kph) Minimum curve radius (m) Minimum width (m) Shared 10 year ARI 30 25 3.0 Exclusive 10 year ARI 40 40 2.5 Shared 2 year ARI 20 10 2.5 Exclusive 2 year ARI 30 21 2.0 Shared 1 year ARI 10 6 2.5 Cycle path gradients (1) Where the overall longitudinal grade of a cycle path exceeds 5%, it is designed with interspersing short sections of steeper grades with flatter grade recovery sections. (2) The maximum length of steep grade on a cycle path complies with Table 3.4.3.2.1–Maximum length of steep grade of this planning scheme policy. (3) Where existing cycle path grades are in excess of 5%, the cycle path incorporates measures to minimise the potential for accidents including: (a) avoidance of sharp bends; (b) removal or relocation of fixed obstacles adjacent to the cycle path. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-49 Table 3.4.3.2.1–Maximum length of steep grade Grade % 4 150 5 110 6 80 7 60 8 43 9 32 3.4.3.3 (1) Maximum length (m) Cycle path sight distance A cycle path provides sufficient stopping sight distance in accordance with Table 3.4.3.3.1– Minimum stopping sight distance on a cycle path of this planning scheme policy to allow a cyclist to avoid a hazard on the cycle path. Table 3.4.3.3.1–Minimum stopping sight distance on a cycle path Cyclist speed (kph) Minimum stopping sight distance on a downhill grade (m) 4% downhill grade 3.4.3.4 (1) (2) 6% downhill grade 8% downhill grade 15 15 16 17 30 37 40 43 40 58 61 65 Cycle path lateral clearances A cycle path provides a minimum clearance of: (a) 0.5 metre aligned parallel to the path of a smooth feature such as a fence with a smooth face; (b) 1 metre to: (i) an obstacle such as a utility pole, sign, tree, rock, park or street furniture; (ii) the top of a 'down slope' surface or indent; (iii) the base of an 'up slope' surface or indent. Where the lateral clearance required in section 3.4.3.4(1) cannot be achieved, a fence barrier: (a) 3.4.3.5 is provided at the side of a cycle path where it is adjacent to a steep batter or change of level including a bridge or boardwalk that: (i) has a minimum height of 1.2 metres; (ii) is constructed from materials not likely to cause injury. Cycle path lateral sight distance (1) A cycle path has a minimum lateral clearance in accordance with Table 3.4.3.5.1–Minimum lateral clearance to provide sight distance on a cycle path of this planning scheme policy to provide a sight distance for a curve in excess of the minimum stopping sight distance. (2) A cycle path has a safe lateral clearance: (3) (a) for an on-road path located in the road verge; (b) at an approach to an intersection with a path or road; (c) at a bend following a straight section; (d) at a bridge crossing fitted with a guardrail. A cycle path provides a speed warning sign at a location where the stated sight distance or lateral clearance cannot be achieved. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-50 Table 3.4.3.5.1–Minimum lateral clearance to provide sight distance on a cycle path Radius of curve (m) Minimum lateral clearance (m) 30 metres sight distance 40 metres sight distance 30 4 6.5 NA 40 3 5 NA 50 2.5 4 9 60 2 3.3 7.5 70 <2 3 6.5 2.5 5.5 80 3.4.3.6 60 metres sight distance Lighting of a cycle path (1) A cycle path is lit in accordance with section 3.5–Road lighting standards of this planning scheme policy and AS/NZS 1158: 2005 Lighting for roads and public spaces. (2) A cycle path is lit when the minimum usage of the path in any two hour period between: (a) dusk and 9pm exceeds 30 users per hour; or (b) 9pm and dawn exceeds 20 users per hour. 3.4.3.7 (1) (2) (3) Cycle path signage Cycle path signage is in accordance with: (a) AS1742 - 2010 Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices; (b) Austroads. Way finding signage of a cycle path is: (a) consistent with other way finding signage in the area; (b) clearly applies only to cyclists. Guide signs for cyclists on a road include: (a) bicycle symbol with a white legend on blue background; (b) route marker with a white legend on blue background; (c) direction sign with a blue legend on white background. (4) A cycle guide sign includes at least one bicycle symbol, the height of which is to be not less than the height of the principal legend. (5) A route marker: (6) (7) (a) includes a bicycle symbol, arrow and route letters or numbers unique to the route; (b) is provided on all district and major routes; (c) is located at: (i) a minor road and path intersection; (ii) regular intervals between direction signs with a maximum spacing of 1 kilometre. A direction sign: (a) provides information about key destinations, including distance, direction and route name; (b) is located at a major road and path intersection with the sign position and orientation as far as possible from the line of sight of a motorist. A guide sign in a park: (a) may be modified to be consistent with park signage; (b) maintains consistency with the form of cycle signs stated in this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-51 3.4.3.8 (1) An off road cycle path crossing a road carrying less than 3000 vehicles per day: (a) 3.4.3.9 (1) Off road cycle path crossing of a low volume road provides a cycle wheeling ramp that: (i) has a holding rail on the left side of the approach to the road crossing; (ii) is offset from the path alignment; (iii) has terminal fencing where primary school children are the predominant users of the cycle path crossing; (iv) provides good visibility for approaching cyclists; (v) ensures that a cyclist is slowed by a sharp curve in the cycle path close to the road crossing. Controlled crossing A controlled crossing for cyclists provides a: (a) signalised crossing; or (b) zebra pedestrian crossing; or (c) school crossing. (2) Cycle symbols are installed on a cycle route at a signalised intersection. (3) The design of a road intersection including a signalised intersection, un-signalised intersection priority treatment and roundabout provides for a cycle path and cycle lane that is in accordance with Austroads Guide to Road Design Part 6A: Pedestrian and Cyclist. 3.4.3.10 Cycle refuge in the median of a divided road (1) A cycle refuge in the median of a divided road: (a) is a minimum width of 2 metres between median kerbs; (b) is a minimum longitudinal gap of 3 metres; (c) provides holding rails on each side of the median gap and on the left side of an approach crossing ramp to allow cyclist to remain mounted within the median; (d) provides crossing warning signs and parking restrictions for motorists. 3.4.3.11 Shared cycle and pedestrian path (1) A shared cycle and pedestrian path provides: (a) shared path signage in the vicinity of a shopping centre, school or location where older persons may use the path; (b) a maximum cross fall of 2%. (2) A shared path in the road verge is located closer to the lot boundary where the path is alongside a heavily trafficked or high speed road. (3) A shared path in the road verge is located closer to the road where: (a) frequent access paths occur between the path and premises; or (b) it is necessary to achieve a better longitudinal profile by locating the path adjacent to the kerb. 3.4.3.12 Cycle path on a major or district cycle route (1) (2) An exclusive or separate cycle path is provided on a major or district route where: (a) it is not possible to provide kerb separated contra-flow lanes (Copenhagen lanes) with the road carriageway; (b) the projected combined volume of cyclists and pedestrians is such that a shared path would pose a safety risk; (c) the geometry of the path allows cyclists to travel safely in excess of 30kph. An exclusive cycle path provides a maximum superelevation of 1 in 15. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-52 3.4.4 Design standards for roads 3.4.4.1 Road safety (1) The safety of all road users is a primary consideration in the standards set out in section 3.4.4.2Road design standards of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.4.2 (1) (2) Road design standards A road complies with the following: (a) the design standards for a road in Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy; (b) the road network identified in Figure 3.4.1.4.1–Road network of this planning scheme policy; (c) the planning layouts in Table 7.1.1.1–Planning layouts for road infrastructure in Part 7– Planning layouts of this planning scheme policy; (d) the general planning layouts in Table 7.2.1.1–General planning layouts for areas in Part 7–Planning layouts of this planning scheme policy; (e) the road encroachment maps in Table 7.3.1.1–Road encroachment maps in Part 7– Planning layouts of this planning scheme policy; (f) the standard drawings in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy; (g) the standard specifications in Part 9–Standard specifications of this planning scheme policy; (h) the pavement design standards identified in Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road of this planning scheme policy. Where there is inconsistency between the provisions in section 3.4.4.2–Road design standards and Part 7–Planning layouts of the planning scheme policy, the provisions of Part 7–Planning layouts override section 3.4.4.2–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-53 Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 Road function Location Basic road type Likely signed speed Design speed Maximum grade9 Traffic lanes Parking lanes On road cycle lanes Bus stop facilities (if needed) Carriage way width1 Path in one verge Path in other verge1 Minimum verge width Median width Minimu m reserve width kph kph % #/m m Shoulder or breakdown lanes1 m #/m m m m m Urban access street (UAS) NA 50 12 2/3.0 unmarke d unmarked Urban access road (UAR) NA 60 12 2/3.75 unmarke d unmarked Nonurban Rural access (RA) 70 80 12 2/3.0 unmarke d Industrial Industrial access (IA) NA 50 5 2/3.5 2.5 Centres Main Street(MS) 3 40 40 5 2/3.5 6 angled Urban collector single carriageway (UC-2L) 4 60 70 6 2/3.5 2.5 Urban collector dual carriageway (UC-4L) 60 70 6 4/3.5 2.5 Nonurban Rural collector (RC) 70 80 6 2/3.5 Industrial Industrial collector (IC) 50 60 5 2/3.5 Urban6 Urban arterial single carriageway (UA-2L) 70 80 6 2/3.5 Urban arterial dual carriageway (UA-4L) 80 90 6 Rural arterial single carriageway (RA-2L) 100 110 Rural arterial dual carriageway (RA-4L) 100 Transit (T) 70 m m Access Collector Arterial Urban2 6 Urban Nonurban Multimodal5 On bus route 7.5 with 6m sections1 in indent 1 2 3 7.5 1.5 4 15.5 4 15.5 6 20 2.5-3 4 20 1.5 8 in parking lane 12 1.5 1.5 in indent 2/11 3-5 3-5 6 1.5 in parking lane 15 1.5 2.5-3 4 1.5 in parking lane 2/11 1.5 2.5-3 4 on shoulder 11 6 40 23 6 36 8 27 1.5 in parking lane 16 1.5 2.5-3 4 24 3 on breakdown in breakdown 13 1.5 2.5-3 4 21 4/3.5 3 on breakdown in breakdown 2/10 1.5 2.5-3 4 6 2/3.5 3 on shoulder in shoulder 13 8 110 6 4/3.5 3,1 on shoulder in shoulder 2/11 8 80 5 2/4.5 unmarked 9 1.5 2.5-3 4 6 34 29 15 53 17 Note–– 1. Shoulders are provided on rural roads without kerb and channel; breakdown lanes are provided on urban roads. Carriageway width includes traffic lanes and on-road cycle lanes and breakdown lanes or shoulders. 2. Other urban access road types may be appropriate. For example, laneways serving rear access or frontage roads acting as service roads between properties and collector or arterial roads. These are desirable maximum grades. Where approved, the adoption of grades steeper than the maximum may be justified for comparatively short sections, difficult terrain or low number of heavy vehicles. 3. This standard design is for main streets in greenfield developments. There are many possible variations to this design in existing and constrained locations. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-54 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Control of direct driveway access onto urban collectors is desirable. One possible alternative design for lower volume urban collectors would be a '2-lane divided' road having a median that restricts access to left-in, left-out movements. Multi-modal roads are designed to support primary and secondary bus services. This can be achieved by giving priority to busses at signal ised intersections, and/or by the provision of transit lanes on high volume roads. The transit lane must be on a wide (4.5 metre) kerbside lane replacing the 3 metre shoulder. Transit roads are short sections of road for buses, pedestrians and cyclists but not cars or commercial vehicles. Where existing 2 lane collector and arterial roads are severely constrained by development, increased capacity may be achieved by the introduction of 'clearway' operations (ie. banning parking in peak periods). The path in the other verge will generally be a shared pedestrian and cycle path. Where an exclusive cycle path is required, it may be provided as a 3metre wide path alongside a 1.5 metre footpath increasing the verge width, or as kerb separated contra-flow lanes in the carriageway (Copenhagen lanes) replacing the on-road cycle lanes. Where an access street or access road abuts a collector or arterial road the 4 metre verge abutting the collector or arterial road may be omitted to restrict direct driveway access. 9. These are desirable maximum grades. Where approved, the adoption of grades steeper than the maximum may be justified for comparatively short sections, difficult terrain or low number of heavey vehicles. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-55 3.4.4.3 Traveller comfort on a road (1) The vertical alignments and cross-fall changes of a road are designed to minimise motion sickness in vehicle drivers and passengers. (2) When passing from one longitudinal grade to another, the vertical acceleration on a road is less than 0.05g, where g is the acceleration due to gravity. (3) Reverse horizontal curves are not provided unless there is sufficient space between the curves to introduce the full superelevation required for each curve, and without exceeding the standard rate of change of cross-fall for the road design speed in accordance with Austroads. 3.4.4.4 (1) Sight distance of a road The stopping sight distance of a road shall be sufficient to satisfy the design speed of the road specified in Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy and in accordance with Austroads. 3.4.4.5 Design speed of a road (1) The design speed of a road is n accordance with Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy. (2) Physical design elements are incorporated for speed control purposes and are preferred ahead of Local Area Traffic Management (LATM) speed control devices. LATM devices should only be proposed where physical design elements cannot achieve appropriate speed control. (3) Where LATM speed control devices are incorporated in road design the LATM speed control devices are constructed to comply with the requirements of: (a) Austroads; (b) the Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices (Queensland). 3.4.4.6 (1) Horizontal alignment of a road The horizontal alignment of a road complies with the road design standards specified in section 3.4.4.2 (Road design standards) of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.4.7 Vertical alignment of a road (1) The vertical alignment of a road complies with the documents specified in section 3.4.4.2-Road design standards of this planning scheme policy. (2) A vertical curve of parabolic form is provided where the algebraic change on a road exceeds: (3) (a) for Access Roads - 1 %; (b) for Collector and Arterial Roads - 0.6 %. The minimum length of a vertical curve is provided for: (a) an Urban Access Road - 20 metres; (b) an Urban Collector Road - 35 metres; (c) an Urban Arterial Road - 60 metres; (d) non-urban roads - as specified by the Road Planning and Design Manual. (4) A vertical curve of a minimum length of 10 metres along a side road is provided where the side road joins a through road at a three way or 'T' intersection, and it is not possible to maintain sight distance to the pavement on the side road. (5) The tangent point of a vertical curve in a side road is to be located at, or outside of, the kerb line of a through road. (6) A vertical curve does not mask the commencement of a horizontal curve. 3.4.4.8 (1) Grade of a road The minimum grade for a road which includes: (a) kerb and channel, is 0. 6%; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-56 (b) an earth table drain, is 1.0%. (2) A table drain with a minimum grade of 1% is provided where a road has a grade of less than 1%. (3) The maximum grade of a road complies with Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.4.9 (1) Turning area at the end of a road (cul-de-sac) At the end of proposed and existing roads: (a) a vehicle turning area is provided which has a full turning circle with a kerb radii which is: (i) a minimum of: (A) (ii) (iii) (2) 20 metres, for the approach curve tangential to the turning circle; (B) 9 metres, for the turning circle; or within the outer path for the turning of an HRV complies with AS 2890.2: 2002: Parking facilities - Off-street Commercial Vehicle Parking Facilities; or provides access to an industrial use, a vehicle turning area which has a full turning circle with a kerb radii which is a minimum of: (A) 30 metres, for the approach curve tangential to the turning circle; (B) 12.5 metres, for the turning circle. Turning heads at the end of a road are: (a) circular; or (b) with the approval of the local government, "T" shaped; or (c) with the approval of the local government, "Y" shaped that: (i) provide access to a residential use; (ii) incorporate provision for parking. (3) Access to adjoining premises does not conflict with a parking area provided at the end or on the verge of a cul-de-sac. (4) The maximum longitudinal grade at the head of a cul-de-sac is 5 percent. 3.4.4.10 Manoeuvring areas (1) (2) (3) (4) Manoeuvring for garbage trucks is designed so that: (a) no more than one reversing movement is required for access to bin and skip collection areas; (b) where garbage collection vehicles are required to enter a site, the garbage collection vehicle is able to leave the site in a forward gear. Where development is incomplete (such as a road that ends at a stage boundary) but is to be extended in the future, temporary manoeuvring areas are constructed: (a) in the form of a gravel turning area with dimensions in accordance with section 3.4.4.9– Turning area at the end of a road (cul-de-sac) of this planning scheme policy; (b) for a "T" or "Y" turning area that has been approved by the local government, in accordance with section 3.4.4.9 3.4.4.9(2)(b) and 3.4.4.9(2)(c) of this planning scheme policy. Where a turning area is to be outside the road reserve, an easement in favour of the local government is provided which: (a) extends over the full extent of the turning area that is outside the road reserve; (b) is for vehicular access purposes and is otherwise on terms satisfactory to the local government. The manoeuvring area has a maximum gradient of 12 percent. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-57 (5) The manoeuvring area has a minimum vertical distance of: (a) 3.5 metres for a SRV; (b) 4.5 metres for a HRV. 3.4.4.11 Cross-section and minimum road reserve (1) Road type cross-sections comply with: (a) Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy; (b) Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road; (c) the cross section standard drawings in Table 7.1.1.1–Planning layouts for road infrastructure of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.4.12 Auxiliary lanes of a road (1) An auxiliary turning lane: (a) has a minimum width of 3.5 metres; (b) is constructed to the same standard as the adjacent road pavement and not less than the standards in Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards for roads of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.4.13 Carriageway taper of a road (1) A carriageway taper is provided that is constructed to the same standard as the adjacent road pavement and complies with standards of Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards for roads of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.4.14 Truncation of lot boundaries (1) (2) A lot is truncated so that the lane and verge width is maintained at: (a) a speed restriction device; (b) a curve; (c) an intersection. A truncation to a lot boundary is provided at an intersection to maintain the minimum verge width and minimum sight distance. 3.4.4.15 Threshold and entry treatments (1) Entry and threshold treatments to road surfaces may be used to reinforce the relative traffic importance and priority of streets, at intersections and entries to low speed environments where approved by the local government. (2) Where an entry statement is used on the road surface, the entry statement is: (3) (a) stencilled on to the insitu asphalt; or (b) painted with an asphaltic paint that is compatible with the underlying material so that cracking does not occur. Entry statements: (a) do not compromise public safety or public utilities; (b) are basic structures confined to the entrance area only; (c) are constructed of low maintenance materials that can be readily maintained and replaced; (d) are not located on public land and: (i) do not include elements made of wood; or (ii) where for character reasons, wood elements are desirable, incorporate alternative materials with a wood-like appearance with superior durability and crash tolerance; (e) are located on private land: (i) do not include elements made of wood; or Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-58 (ii) where for character reasons, wood elements are desirable, incorporate alternative materials with a wood-like appearance with superior durability and crash tolerance; (f) incorporate approved anti-graffiti treatments; (g) have mowing strips on all sides for ease of maintenance; (h) which incorporate attached individual letters, are designed and constructed so that the letters are securely fastened and difficult to remove. 3.4.5 Design standards for access and driveways (1) Roadwork design, allotment layouts and allotment filling and excavation ensure safe vehicle access to all allotments. (2) The location of driveway crossovers complies with the following: (a) for urban residential driveways, standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0050 in Table 8.1.1.1– Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy and Guidelines for the Construction of Residential Driveways within Road Reserves fact sheet; (b) for non urban residential driveways, standard drawings IPWEAQ R-0056, LCC 8-00395, LCC 8-00396 and LCC 8-00397 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy; (c) the approved operational work plans. (3) Driveway crossovers that incorporate a table drain or pipe culvert are in accordance with standard drawing LCC 8-00395 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. (4) A pipe/box culvert in a driveway crossover has: (a) a minimum pipe diameter or dimension of a box culvert that complies with Section 10 of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual; (b) a minimum pipe length of 6 metres on all existing collector roads. (5) Where a reinforced concrete invert crossing is approved by the local government instead of a pipe culvert, it is provided in accordance with standard drawing LCC 8-00396 in Table 8.1.1.1– Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. (6) For a partial pipe system with shallow table drains, the driveway crossover is constructed in accordance with standard drawing LCC 8-00397 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. (7) Industrial/commercial driveway crossovers are constructed in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0051 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8– Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. (8) A driveway gradient shall be: (a) for residential development, preferably maximum 12% with an absolute maximum of 16 percent; (b) for industrial development, preferably 6 percent with an absolute maximum of 8 percent. (9) The underside vertical clearance of vehicles at crossovers and driveways complies with Appendix C (Ground Clearance Templates) of AS 2890.1: 2004: Parking facilities - Off Street Car Parking. (10) A residential driveway access to rear lots complies with the following criteria: (a) where the access driveway is servicing one (1) rear dwelling: (i) 4 metre wide driveway reserve; (ii) 3 metre wide sealed pavement constructed in accordance with: (A) Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road (urban access street) of this planning scheme policy ; or (B) a reinforced concrete design suitable for the use; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-59 (iii) (b) 0.5 metre wide services corridor; where the access driveway is servicing two (2) to five (5) rear dwellings: (i) 6 metre wide driveway reserve; (ii) 5.5 metre wide sealed pavement constructed in accordance with: (A) (iii) (c) (B) a reinforced concrete design suitable for the use; 0.5 metre wide services corridor; ; where the access driveway is servicing more than five (5) rear dwellings: (i) 8 metre wide driveway reserve; (ii) 6 metre wide sealed pavement constructed in accordance with: (A) (iii) (11) Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road (urban access street) of this planning scheme policy this planning scheme policy ; or (B) reinforced concrete design suitable for the use; 0.5 metre wide services corridor. Non-urban driveway access to rear lots complies with the following criteria: (a) 10 metre wide driveway reserve; (b) 3 metre wide sealed pavement constructed in accordance with: (i) Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road (rural access road) of the of this planning scheme policy ; or (ii) an approved reinforced concrete design; (c) 2 metre wide minimum offset from property line. 3.4.5.1 (1) Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road (urban access street) of this planning scheme policy this planning scheme policy ; or Queuing on a road Roads, driveways and car parking aisles have sufficient queuing space to ensure that vehicles do not queue across intersections. 3.4.6 Design standards for car parking 3.4.6.1 General Standard drawings for a parking area (1) Car parking is in accordance with the standard drawings in Table 8.1.2.1–Standard drawings for a parking area of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.6.2 (1) Off-street parking facilities Off-street parking facilities and associated access driveways are designed in accordance with: (a) AS 2890.1: 2004: Parking facilities – Off-street car parking; (b) AS 2890.6: Off street parking for people with disabilities; (c) AS 2890.2: 2002: Parking facilities—Off-street Commercial Vehicle Parking Facilities; 3.4.6.3 On-street parking facilities (1) On-street parking facilities are designed in accordance with AS 2890.5: 1993: Parking facilities On Street Parking. (2) All line marking and signage is in accordance with: (a) the Australian Standards identified in section 3.4.6.3(1) of this planning scheme policy; (b) the Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices (Queensland). Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-60 3.4.6.4 (1) Bicycle parking facilities are designed in accordance with AS 2890.3: 1993: Bicycle parking facilities. 3.4.6.5 (1) (2) (2) (3) Manoeuvring Car parks provide a vehicle manoeuvring area for the design vehicles specified in Table 9.4.6.3.5–Design vehicle for a manoeuvring area in Part 9–Development codes of the planning scheme: (a) in relation to manoeuvring, are designed in accordance with AS 2890.1: 2004: Parking facilities - Off Street Car Parking and AS 2890.2: 2002 Off-street commercial vehicle facilities RV (12.5 metre) template; (b) in an industrial area, provide areas which cater for manoeuvring of a B-double vehicle as defined in the Transport Operations (Road Use Management – Vehicle Registration) Regulation 2010, where there is direct access onto a road classified as a B-double route. Manoeuvring for docking bays: (a) caters for HRV and semi-trailer access; (b) is designed so that no more than one reversing movement is required for access; (c) is not located within a car parking aisle. 3.4.6.6 (1) Bicycle parking Landscaping Landscaping setbacks from a kerb are as follows: (a) paving - to the back of kerb; (b) planting - to the back of kerb; (c) street furniture - 0.5 metres behind the kerb; (d) street trees - 0.6 metres behind a kerb measured from the centre of the tree trunk. Landscaping complies with: (a) the standard drawings in Table 8.4.1.1–Standard drawings for landscaping of Part 8– Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy; (b) the standard specifications in Part 9–Standard specifications of this planning scheme policy; (c) Austroads guidelines where non-frangible landscaping is provided. Shade tree counts and minimum landscaped areas in car parks are calculated as follows: Shade tree count per car park = Car park area x 25% shade provided per tree (a) where the minimum shade provided by a tree after 5 years growth = pi x radius² of the tree canopy (drip line) (4) This calculation averages out one ‘medium size’ shade tree per 2.5 car parking spaces (5) The intention of this calculation is to give flexibility of design by specifying a minimum shade requirement that may be achieved by many small trees or fewer large trees. (6) A minimum 2.25m² of landscaped area is provided around all shade trees, that allows the free circulation of air and water to and from the tree’s root system and protection from foot and vehicular traffic. (7) A landscaped area is the area that abuts a parking bay or access aisle and includes the minimum 2.25m² per shade trees, but excludes any areas defined as landscaped buffer strips. (8) A landscaped area of at least 10 percent of the site area is provided. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-61 3.4.6.7 (1) Lighting Car park lighting: (a) is provided in accordance with section 4 of AS 2890.1: 2004: Parking facilities – Off-street car parking; (b) illuminates: (i) an open surface car park to 15 lux; (ii) a basement car park to 50 lux; (iii) the first 12 metres of the basement access way from a daylight area to a minimum of 200 lux; (iv) the first six metres for a basement access way from a daylight area to a minimum of 1000 lux; (v) a pay station, ticket spitter and the like to a minimum of 50 lux. 3.4.6.8 Signage and line marking (1) Signs are setback a minimum of 0.5 metres behind a kerb. (2) Car park signage and line marking is provided in accordance with the Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices (Queensland) to identify the location of the car park and the position of an access point for a car park used by the public where: (a) the car park is located at the rear of the premises; (b) access to the premises is not located on the primary frontage of the premises; (c) there are a number of access points serving different parts of the premises. 3.4.6.9 Stormwater (1) If the car park is graded such that stormwater would drain across the verge via a crossover, a grated inlet is provided the full width of the crossover immediately inside the premises; (2) All stormwater collected on a car park is piped to a nominated lawful point of discharge. 3.4.6.10 Road pavement design (1) Car parks to be maintained by the local government have a minimum flexible pavement depth of 250 mm. 3.4.7 Intersection work 3.4.7.1 Geometric standards (1) A four way intersection must provide signalisation or a roundabout at the intersection. (2) An intersection is designed: (3) (a) to accommodate the turning path of the largest vehicle that might be expected to traverse the intersection depending on its role in the network; (b) with a clearance of not less than 0.3 metres between the outer wheel track and the kerb at all points for the turning path. An intersection is designed and located in accordance with current industry best standard. 3.4.8 Road pavement design 3.4.8.1 Pavement design of a road (1) (2) A road has a: (a) 25 year design life for Urban arterial roads, Rural arterial roads, Transit roads, Industrial collector roads and Centres access roads; (b) 20 year design life for all other roads. Roads comply with Austroads Pavement Structural Design Part 2, AGPT02-12. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-62 (3) A rigid pavement complies with Austroads Pavement Structural Design Part 2, AGPT02-12. 3.4.8.2 Pavement design standards for a road (1) Pavement design standards for a road are in accordance with Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road of this planning scheme policy. (2) Roads designated for mechanistic design in Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road of this planning scheme policy will be designed using mechanistic design process defined in Austroads Pavement Structural Design Part 2, AGPT02-12. (3) Road pavement will be designed to resist subgrade rutting, surface fatigue and cement stabilisation fatigue for the design period. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-63 Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road (may be expressed 1xEn e.g. 4.4xE4) Minimum pavement thickness (mm)(4) Minimum AC(2) thickness (mm) Quality of material for base course pavement (CBR(3)) Quality of material for subbase course pavement (CBR) Prime 1.1x105 250 30mm of 10mm mix 80 45 AC Prime 5.9x105 300 30mm of 10mm mix 80 45 Rural access road AC Prime 8.3 x104 250 30mm of 10mm mix 80 45 Industrial access road AC Prime 5.4x106 400 45mm of 14mm mix 80 60 Centres access street (main street) AC Primer seal Mechanistic 500 45mm of 14mm mix 80 60 Urban collector AC Primer seal 6.4x106 400 45mm of 14mm mix 80 60 Rural collector AC Prime 5.5x105 300 30mm of 10mm mix 80 45 Industrial collector AC Primer seal Mechanistic 500 45mm of 14mm mix 80 60 Urban arterial AC Primer seal Mechanistic 500 45mm of 14mm mix 80 60 Rural arterial AC Primer seal Mechanistic 500 45mm of 14mm mix 80 60 Transit road AC Primer seal Mechanistic 500 45mm of 14mm mix 80 60 ESAs(1) Paveme nt surface type Primer type Urban access street AC Urban access road Road type (1) ESA means equivalent standard axles. (2) AC means asphaltic concrete. (3) CBR means California bearing ratio. (4) Pavement thickness excludes surfacing. The minimum base course pavement and minimum sub-base course pavement requirements are determined on site specific conditions Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-64 3.4.8.3 (1) Sub-grade of a road The design CBR for each sub-grade area is calculated as follows: (a) the least of 4 day soaked CBRs (for less than 5 results on the same material); or (b) the 10th percentile of all 4 day soaked CBRs (for more than 4 results on the same material) = C- 1.3 x S where: (i) C is the mean of all 4 day soaked CBRs; (ii) S is the standard deviation of all values. (2) A subgrade that has shrink or swell percentages greater than 2.5 percent is assessed and documented in the pavement design report by the design engineer which shows the potential for subgrade volume changes to reflect through to the road surface (3) Where the shrink or swell percentages exceed 5 percent the mitigation measures shall be incorporated in the design and documented. Note––In cases where the CBR value is less than 3 adopt 3 as the design CBR and add 75mm of CBR 15 material for each 0.5 reduction in the CBR value below 3. 3.4.8.4 Pavement surfacing of a road (1) All road surfacing complies with the standard specifications in Part 9-Standard specifications of this planning scheme policy. (2) Asphaltic concrete surfacing on all roads is provided in accordance with Part 9-Standard specifications of this planning scheme policy. (3) Paving blocks are not provided in a road. (4) Stable and safe road surfaces are provided to enhance the safe and efficient use of the road network by providing sufficient: (a) rolling resistance to ensure safe braking; (b) lateral resistance to ensure safe cornering. 3.4.8.5 (1) Road shoulders A road shoulder is: (a) in accordance with Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy; (b) constructed of the same pavement material and to the same depth as the carriageway. 3.4.9 Road drainage 3.4.9.1 Kerb and channel (1) A concrete kerb and channel that complies with the standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0080 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard Drawings of this planning scheme policy will be provided on all urban roads. (2) For a Non-urban road, kerb and channel is not used. (3) The standard kerb and channel for a road is Type M3, in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0080 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8– Standard Drawings of this planning scheme policy. (4) For a road with a one-way crossfall, a Type M6 flush concrete kerb is used on the high side of the pavement in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0080 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard Drawings of this planning scheme policy. (5) A Type B1 kerb and channel with a 450mm channel is in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0080 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8– Standard Drawings of this planning scheme policy is provided: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-65 (6) (a) on a road adjoining a park; (b) on an Industrial Road, where a heavy duty barrier type is used such as Type B1, with additional 50mm base thickness; (c) on a Major Road; (d) on a Major Urban Collector Road; (e) in a shopping centre; (f) in a location where high pedestrian volumes are likely. A Type SM5 kerb is provided in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0080 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard Drawings of this planning scheme policy: (a) at a median and a traffic island; (b) in the centre island on a roundabout. (7) The minimum longitudinal grade of a kerb and channel is 0.6%. (8) Invert crossings are provided at the intersections of urban roads in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0080 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard Drawings of this planning scheme policy. (9) The grading of a kerb and channel complies with the road centreline grading. 3.4.9.2 Table drains (1) Where a kerb and channel is not constructed a table drain is provided which is no deeper than 500mm on both sides of a road. (2) A table drain is provided: (3) (4) (a) which remains shallow, by the incorporation of a low flow pipe and an overflow chamber where a deep drain is required to discharge stormwater; (b) on both sides of Non-Urban Roads in accordance with the standard drawings in Part 8– Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. A table drain: (a) is in accordance with sections 3.4.4.7–Vertical alignment of a road and 3.4.4.8–Grade of a road of this planning scheme policy; (b) is constructed with either flat or angled beds; (c) is diverted to a side drain, a cut off drain, a cross-road culvert or a watercourse so that runoff does not pond near the road; (d) is designed to prevent the pondage of runoff in the sub-grade or on the road surface; (e) is turfed for the full width and length of the table drain. Where a table drain is provided, sub-surface drainage at the outer edge of the road pavement is also provided in accordance with section 3.4.9–Road drainage of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.9.3 Crossfall of a road (1) A carriageway crossfall complies with the documents listed in section 3.4.4.2–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy. (2) The minimum pavement crossfall for: (a) bitumen sealed roads and shoulders and gravel roads is 3 percent; (b) asphaltic concrete surfacing is 2.5 percent; (c) concrete surfacing is 2.0 percent. (3) A pavement crossfall does not exceed 5 percent. (4) The crossfall on a grassed median on a divided road has an absolute maximum grade of 25 percent. (5) Where minimum cross falls cannot be achieved, the longitudinal grades are used to shed water. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-66 (6) Minimise the chances of vehicles aquaplaning through the appropriate combinations of cross fall and grade and comply with the requirements of Austroads. 3.4.9.4 (1) (2) Sub-surface drainage of a road Where required, all sub-surface drainage of a road complies with: (a) standard drawing IPWEAQ SEQ R-140 and IPWEAQ SEQ R-142 in Table 8.1.1.1– Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard Drawings of this planning scheme policy; (b) Part 9–Standard specifications of this planning scheme policy. Perimeter sub-surface soil drainage is constructed on a median or traffic island which is landscaped in accordance with section 3.4.9.4–Sub-surface drainage of a road and section 3.4.10.1(9) of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.10 Traffic islands, traffic signs and road markings 3.4.10.1 Medians and traffic islands in a road (1) Medians and traffic islands are designed in accordance with Austroads and the Department of Transport and Main Roads - Road Planning and Design Manual. (2) Medians are cast in situ. Precast islands are not permitted unless otherwise approved by the local government. (3) Medians and traffic islands are indicated by conspicuous raised kerbs, pavement markings or flush treatment as detailed in the Queensland Government's Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices (Queensland) and may be classified as follows: (a) channelising (or directional) islands; (b) roundabouts; (c) median islands; (d) medians; (e) separators; (f) pedestrian refuge islands. (4) A median is not less than 1.2 metres wide unless otherwise approved by the local government. (5) In an Urban arterial road, the minimum spacing between median openings is 500 metres. (6) Raised kerbed traffic islands less than 12.0m 2 or less than 2 metres wide between kerb faces are: (7) (a) constructed of concrete; (b) designed for occasional heavy vehicle wheel loadings; (c) where constructed of concrete, are a minimum of 100mm thick reinforced concrete with SL72 mesh on a firm sand bedding (d) constructed directly on top of the existing pavement and connected by dowels. Raised kerbed medians and raised kerbed traffic islands greater than 12.0m2 or wider than 2 metres: (a) are excavated in the road pavement to subgrade level; (b) are landscaped: (i) with grass; or (ii) where landscaping other than grass has been approved by the local government, incorporate a 500mm wide reinforced concrete strip as a working area for garden maintenance in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ SEQ R-140 and IPWEAQ SEQ R-142 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy; (c) include water supply conduits and services every 80 metres with a minimum of one service per median or traffic island; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-67 (d) include an approved conduit for an electricity service to a median or traffic island that is landscaped in a location that allows ease of connection of a future electricity service. (8) Where the slope across a median or traffic island is greater than 1 in 4, the median or traffic island is surfaced with concrete or another treatment approved by the local government. (9) Where a surface treatment other than concrete has been provided for a median or traffic island, sub-soil drainage is installed in the median or traffic island directly behind kerbs in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ SEQ R-140 and IPWEAQ SEQ R-142 in Table 8.1.1.1– Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. (10) Water and electricity services are provided to a median or traffic island which has been landscaped. 3.4.10.2 Traffic signs and road markings (1) Traffic signs and road markings are provided in accordance with the Manual for Uniform Traffic Control Devices (Queensland). (2) A temporary sign, a construction sign and road markings are provided in accordance with Part 3 of the Manual for Uniform Traffic Control Devices (Queensland). (a) A sign post is: (i) set into a concrete slab and installed using "Loc socket" or an equivalent method; (ii) vandal-proof bolts and fittings are used on a permanent sign. 3.4.10.3 Road name signs (1) A road name sign is manufactured and installed in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0130 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard Drawings of this planning scheme policy. (2) Road names: (3) (a) are easy to pronounce; (b) consist of one word; (c) are socially acceptable. Road names may be designated: (a) as avenue, court, crescent, drive, esplanade, lane, parade, road, street or terrace; or (b) in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0130 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard Drawings of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.10.4 Road edge guide posts and guard rails (1) Road edge guide posts are provided at all locations where a concrete kerb and channel is not constructed. (2) A guardrail is provided in the locations specified by the Department of Transport and Main Roads - Road Planning and Design Manual. (3) A guide post and a guardrail are provided which comply with standard drawings DMR 1474 and LCC 8-00401 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8– Standard Drawings of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.11 Roadworks on unpaved or common boundary roads (1) Where development adjoins a road that is unpaved, unformed or substandard for the ultimate design of the road, the road frontage is constructed as: (a) the nominated road hierarchy determined in accordance with Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy; (b) the greater of: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-68 (i) (ii) (2) sealed pavement of one half of the full width of the road for the nominated road hierarchy in accordance with Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road of this planning scheme policy; or a 5.5 metre sealed pavement in accordance with Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road of this planning scheme policy; (c) a 1 metre sealed shoulder; (d) a table drain; (e) if required by the local government, a turning area at the end of the road in accordance with section 3.4.4.9–Turning area at the end of a road of this planning scheme policy. Where it is proposed that a new road is constructed along a common boundary with an adjoining property, the road frontage is constructed as: (a) the nominated road hierarchy determined in accordance with Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy; (b) the greater of: (i) sealed pavement of one half of the full width of the road for the nominated road hierarchy in accordance with Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road of this planning scheme policy; or (ii) a 5.5 metre sealed pavement in accordance with Table 3.4.8.2.1–Pavement design standards for a road of this planning scheme policy; (c) a 1 metre sealed shoulder; (d) a table drain; (e) a minimum of 1 metre wide verge adjacent to the adjoining property boundary; (f) if required by the local government, shall include a turning area at the end of the road in accordance with section 3.4.4.9–Turning area at the end of a road of this planning scheme policy. 3.4.12 Bridge and major culvert works 3.4.12.1 Bridge and major culvert design (1) All road traffic bridges, pedestrian bridges, structures to support road traffic and structures other than bridges but associated with roads are designed in accordance with the following: (a) AS 5100 Set: 2007 Bridge design - Set; (b) AS/NZS 3845: 1999: Road safety barrier systems; (c) Department of Transport and Main Roads' standard drawings; (d) AS/NZS 3725: 2007: Design for installation of buried concrete pipes; (e) AS 1597.1:2010: Pre-cast reinforced concrete box culverts - Small culverts; (f) AS 1597.2: 1996 and supp 1-1997: Pre-cast reinforced concrete box culverts - Large culverts. (2) Prior to commencement of detailed design, the local government's requirements with respect to the form of paths service duct provisions, flood frequency immunity and acceptable construction are obtained. (3) Prior to the commencement of the bridge design process, the local government's requirements with respect to the design criteria need to be obtained. AS 5100.1-2004 /Amdt 1-2010 Bridge design – scope and general - principles Appendix A lists design criteria which need to be resolved prior to commencing the design process. (4) All road bridges: (a) are concrete structures; (b) incorporate minimum 2.5 metre wide paths between handrails and bridge kerbs; (c) include service ducts which are accessible from the paths; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-69 (d) are service ducts with a minimum depth of 400mm deep and a minimum width of 1200mm. (5) Approach embankments are of sufficient width to accommodate a minimum 2.5 metre wide path fitted with handrails abutting the bridge path. (6) Where the approach embankment exceeds 2 metres in height, a minimum 1.2 metre high chain wire fence is to be provided at the top of the embankment. (7) Afflux calculations prove that bridges constructed over waterways result in no worsening of flood levels on properties upstream of the bridge. (8) Copies of all approvals are required from other relevant agencies in relation to bridge construction to be submitted to the local government with the engineering design documentation. (9) The following concrete work is coated in an approved non-sacrificial, anti-graffiti protection system: (a) abutment and wing walls; (b) piers, piles and site caps; (c) facings of reinforced soil structures; (d) service duct covers; (e) barrier walls; (f) easily accessible areas. (10) A brass plug PSM and brass Date-plaque is installed on one of the bridge abutments in a location approved by the local government. (11) Terrestrial and aquatic fauna movement solutions are included in all waterway crossings. 3.4.12.2 Pedestrian bridges (1) (2) (3) (4) Pedestrian bridges are designed in accordance with section 3.4.12.1–Bridge and major culvert design of this planning scheme policy and: (a) AS (Set)-2010: Design for access and mobility Set; (b) the provisions of Austroads with respect to bicycles. The minimum clear width for a pedestrian bridge is: (a) 2.5 metres; or (b) where it is deemed necessary for the local government to access the pedestrian bridge with maintenance vehicles, 3.5 metres. A pedestrian bridge that incorporates timber elements: (a) incorporates termite management systems; (b) is designed: (i) to achieve a 50 year design life; (ii) in accordance with: (A) AS 1720.1-2010: Timber structures-design methods; (B) AS 3660 (Set): Termite management. A design report must include: (a) horizontal and vertical geometry; (b) hydrologic and hydraulic data; (c) statements on environmental impact, aesthetics and future maintenance; (d) specification codes and design loads used for loading calculations. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-70 3.4.13 Noise barriers 3.4.13.1 Acoustic fence design (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) Acoustic fences are designed and constructed: (a) in accordance with the Queensland Department of Transport and Main Roads Specification MRS 15 (Noise Fences) and Technical Standard MRTS 15 (Noise Fences); (b) in accordance with the Road Traffic Noise Management Code of Practice; (c) in accordance with standard drawing LCC 8-00390 in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard Drawings of this planning scheme policy; (d) to not impede fauna movement. The minimum density of panel material used in the construction of an acoustic fence is 12.5 kg/m2, where the minimum panel thickness is: (a) 25mm wood cladding at a moisture content of 8-18% with a protective top capping; (b) 2.5mm for reflective steel sheets; or (c) from a material that meets a minimum surface mass density of 12.5kg/m². Any gaps in the acoustic fence: (a) are less than 1% of the total surface area of the acoustic fence; or (b) where 1% or more of the total surface area of the acoustic fence, are filled with acoustic sealant. An acoustic fence: (a) has a design life of 40 years; (b) is low maintenance; (c) is a minimum of 1.8 metres height; (d) includes water supply conduits and services installed every 80 metres along the carriageway side of the acoustic fence; (e) allows for stormwater/flood movement (and overland flow) without diminishing its overall acoustic performance. Acoustic fences are protected by an approved anti-graffiti treatment and designed to withstand damage by resisting: (a) an impact from a 4 kg steel ball dropped from a height of 3 metres when the panel is supported horizontally; (b) defacement by sharp implements; (c) ignition by cigarettes, cigarette lighters or similar ignition sources. 3.4.13.2 Visual amenity of acoustic fences (1) An acoustic fence is screened by three levels of trees, shrubs and other plants within a landscaped frontage area in accordance with the following: (a) the acoustic fence is located a minimum of 6 metres from a road carriageway; (b) the minimum 6 metre area between an acoustic fence and a road carriageway provided in paragraph (a), includes: (i) a minimum 2 metre wide landscaped frontage area between the acoustic fence and the road carriageway; (ii) a minimum 4 metre wide clear verge between the road carriageway and the landscaped frontage area associated with the acoustic fence; (c) the minimum 2 metre wide landscaped frontage area screens the acoustic fence by planting in the 1 metre wide area closest to the acoustic fence, trees or shrubs are: (i) planted at spacings to ensure full screening at maturity; (ii) that have a mature height of approximately the same height as the acoustic fence; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.4 Movement infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-71 (d) in the 1 metre wide area closest to the carriageway, shrubs: (i) planted at 0.9 metres spacings; (ii) that have a mature height of approximately 0.9 metres. 3.4.13.3 Earth mounds (1) An earth mound proposed as a noise barrier is landscaped in accordance with the standard specifications in Part 9–Standard specifications of this planning scheme policy. (2) Earth mounds are constructed: (3) (a) within the road reserve; (b) to provide a minimum 4 metre wide clear verge between the edge of an earth mound and a road carriageway. An earth mound is designed to: (a) ensure sufficient road reserve width is provided for the mound to achieve the required height while ensuring the slope of the batter is a maximum of 1 in 4; (b) have a minimum top width of 1 metre; (c) include drainage of the mound and adjoining area to the roadway drainage system; (d) ensure a 3.5 metre clearance from the toe of the batter to the property boundaries to permit access by maintenance vehicles; (e) include water supply conduits and services installed every 80 metres along the carriageway side of the earth mound. 3.4.14 Construction standards for movement infrastructure (1) Pedestrian paths, cycle paths and roads are constructed in accordance with standard specifications specified in column 1 of Table 9.1.1.1–Application of standard specifications of Part 9–Standard specifications of this planning scheme policy. 3.5 Road lighting standards 3.5.1.1 Design standards for road lighting (1) The objective of road lighting is to increase the safety and amenity of pedestrians in public areas and to improve traffic safety and operation at intersections and hazardous locations. (2) Development is to provide lighting that deters criminal activity and anti-social behaviour and contributes to the amenity of the area through increased aesthetic appeal by using Crime prevention through environmental design (CPTED) principles. (3) Road lighting complies with: (a) AS/NZS 1158 Set: 2010: Lighting for roads and public spaces Set; (b) in respect of lighting roads in rural areas, chapter 17 (Lighting) of the Department of Transport and Main Roads - Road Planning and Design Manual; (c) Part 12 (Roadway lighting) of Austroads; (d) Energex policies and public lighting manuals; (e) the lighting categories in Table 3.5.1.1.1–Lighting categories of this planning scheme policy. (4) Development in a non-urban area provides a minimum lighting standard of M80 unless approved otherwise by the electricity provider, except where the development abuts a Major Road1 where category V lighting may also be required. (5) Supplementary road lighting is provided: 1 See Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.5 Road lighting standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-72 (6) (7) (8) (9) (a) at a pedestrian crossing that is not controlled by traffic signals; (b) that complies with: (i) AS/NZS 1158 Set: 2009: Lighting for roads and other public spaces - Lighting of pedestrian crossings; (ii) the requirements of the electricity service provider. Category P lighting is provided in accordance with AS/NZS 1158 Set:2010: Lighting for roads and public spaces at a: (a) roundabout; (b) local area traffic management device; (c) pedestrian refuge; (d) speed control device on the carriageway. A lesser lighting standard may be provided to that identified in section 3.5.1.1(6) of this planning scheme policy where the local government is satisfied that: (a) the lighting standard does not compromise safety; (b) a local area traffic management device is installed as part of a local area traffic management system. Street lights are installed to achieve a balanced streetscape and street light poles are installed: (a) alternately on the opposite sides of the road in a staggered arrangement; or (b) on the same side of the road that accommodates any footpath or cycleway. Intersection lighting of Non-Urban Roads complies with: (a) Figure 17.1–Warrants for consideration of road lighting of the Queensland Department of Transport and Main Roads - Road Planning and Design Manual; Note––In respect of subsection (a), strict adherence to the warrants in Figure 17.1 is not intended, particularly where traffic volumes suggest no lighting is necessary. Designers are to exercise good engineering judgement and consider all relevant issues including road geometry, visibility, speed environment and accident history of the location. (b) Figure 3.5.1.1.1–Flag lighting at isolated intersections - Non-urban roads of this planning scheme policy in locations that require lighting: (i) for indication purposes; or (ii) to highlight localised conflicts that do not meet the warrants for intersection lighting in Figure 17.3–Warrants for consideration of road lighting of the Queensland Department of Transport and Main Roads - Road Planning and Design Manual. Note––The intersection lighting referred to in section 3.5.1.1(9)(b) is termed 'flag' lighting and is serviced by one or more lights. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.5 Road lighting standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-73 Table 3.5.1.1.1–Lighting categories Road function Location Basic road type Lighting category Access Urban Urban Access Street P4 Urban Access Road P3, P4 Non-Urban Rural Access Intersections, cul-desacs, bends, bridges, potential hazards, night time accident history Industrial Industrial Access P3, V5 Centres Main Street V3, V5 Urban Urban Collector Single P3, V3, V5 Urban Collector Dual Carriageway P3, V3, V5 Non Urban Rural Collector Intersections, cul-desacs, bends, bridges, potential hazards, night time accident history Industrial Industrial Collector P3, V5 Urban Urban Arterial Single Carriageway V3, V5 Urban Arterial Dual Carriageway V3, V5 Rural Arterial Single Carriageway Rural Arterial Dual Carriageway Intersection Lighting Refer to Fig 17.1 of the Road Planning and Design Manual Transit V3, V5 Collector Arterial Non Urban Multi-Model On Bus Route Pathway & Cycleway 1 P1 to P4 Refer to AS/NZS 1158 Set: 2010: Lighting for roads and public spaces Set. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.5 Road lighting standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-74 Figure 3.5.1.1.1–Flag lighting at isolated intersections - Non-urban roads 3.5.1.2 (1) (2) Design standards for road light poles, lamps and luminaries A road light pole is provided which is: (a) made of timber or steel, unless otherwise required by the service provider; (b) one of the following: (i) a frangible/slip base pole in accordance with AS/NZS1158.1.2: 2010: Road lighting - Vehicular traffic (Category V) lighting - Guide to design, installation, operation and maintenance; or (ii) in laneways and other areas inaccessible to an elevated working platform vehicle, a hinged pole with five metre mounting height and 0.5 metre integral outreach; or (iii) on roundabouts, a hinged high mast pole. The outreach bracket length on a road light pole is provided to: (a) be the length of the existing outreach brackets, where there is existing lighting; (b) where there is no existing lighting to be a minimum of: (i) 1.5 metres for a steel pole; (ii) 1.2 metres for a timber pole. (3) A high pressure sodium aeroscreen luminaire is used on a major road, unless otherwise approved by the electricity provider; (4) A mercury vapour lamp or an S70 aeroscreen luminaire is used for low wattage road lighting on a minor road, unless otherwise approved by the electricity provider; (5) An S70 or larger aeroscreen luminaire, unless otherwise approved by the electricity provider, is used to light local area traffic management devices on Lighting Category P3 and P4 roads and: (a) is mounted on a road light pole: (b) has a maximum height of 6.5 metres; (c) where decorative fittings, such as avenue brackets and estate columns, are being used, has an outreach bracket of 0.5 metres and a mounting height of 5.3 metres. (6) New luminaries and brackets match an existing installation where the development joins to an existing installation or is a stage of a staged development. (7) No opal sphere luminaries are provided. (8) Nostalgia and avenue bracketed luminaries are only provided for decorative use on an Urban Access Street, Urban Access Road or match existing lighting on a pathway or a cycleway. (9) No decorative lighting on Lighting Category V, P1 and P2 roads is provided. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.5 Road lighting standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-75 3.5.1.3 (1) (2) Lighting for a public thoroughfare such as a pathway, a cycleway and a pedestrian subway is provided that complies with: (a) Austroads; (b) Category P lighting as described in AS/NZS 1158 Set:2010: Lighting for roads and public spaces; (c) section 3.4.3.6 - Lighting of a cycle path of this planning scheme policy. Unless otherwise approved by the electricity provider, lighting of park pathways or cycleways by S70 or S70A luminaries, mounted on a 6.5 metre steel pole, are provided with an integral outreach of: (a) where there is existing lighting, the length of the existing outreach; or (b) where there is no existing lighting, 0.5 metres. 3.5.1.4 (1) Lighting of public thoroughfares Alignment of road lighting On a verge that: (a) does not exceed four metres, the road light pole alignment is 3.075 metres from the boundary of the premises; (b) exceeds four metres, the road light pole alignment is 1 metre behind the face of a kerb. (2) Pole alignment in street light schedules is shown as the distance from the real property boundary. (3) A road light pole is only placed on a 500mm alignment from a property boundary when it is needed to facilitate a crossover and the property is: (a) a rear lot; or (b) at the head of a cul-de-sac. (4) A road light pole is offset by 1 metre from a water supply road crossing conduit, provided access to a lot is not affected. (5) A road light pole is provided on the approach side of an intersection, a roundabout and a traffic management device. (6) A road light pole is provided on the inside of a bend or curve. 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards (1) A conceptual site based stormwater management plan is required for development being a material change of use or a reconfiguring a lot where stormwater quality, frequent flow management or waterway stability infrastructure is being provided. (2) A detailed site based stormwater management plan is required for development being an operational work application where stormwater quality, frequent flow management or waterway stability infrastructure is being provided. (3) The stormwater network is planned and designed in accordance with the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual and the Australian Rainfall and Runoff (ARR), except as modified by Section 3.6 (Stormwater infrastructure standards). 3.6.1 Planning the stormwater network 3.6.1.1 Relationship with other matters (1) The stormwater network is planned, designed and constructed having regard to: (a) Flood hazard overlay code; (b) the Waterway corridors and wetlands overlay code; (c) the Infrastructure code as it relates to the: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-76 (i) (ii) 3.6.1.2 (1) park network; pedestrian and cycle network. Multifunctional network The function of the stormwater network is to: (a) manage stormwater to ensure that it causes minimal nuisance, damage or danger to people, property or the environment (stormwater quantity infrastructure); (b) minimise the impacts of development on receiving environments through: (i) limiting pollutant loads discharging to receiving waters (stormwater quality infrastructure); (ii) minimising the change in frequency of disturbance to aquatic ecosystems by managing the volume and frequency of surface runoff during small rainfall events (frequent flow management infrastructure); (iii) controlling bed and bank erosion in waterways (waterway stability infrastructure). 3.6.1.3 Stormwater quantity infrastructure (1) Stormwater quantity infrastructure is provided to convey stormwater runoff from the development site to a lawful point of discharge in accordance with Section 3.02 of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. (2) An increase in the runoff rate from a development site is to be mitigated on site unless it can be demonstrated that a regional stormwater system has adequate capacity to cope with the increased runoff and the stormwater infrastructure downstream of the site has adequate capacity to convey the increased runoff. 3.6.1.4 (1) Stormwater quality, frequent flow management and waterway stability infrastructure Stormwater quality, waterway stability and frequent flow infrastructure is provided to achieve the stormwater management design objectives where the development site is a: (a) material change of use for urban purposes where: (i) the size of the premises is greater than 2,500m 2; or (ii) it results in the creation of six or more additional dwellings; or (b) reconfiguring a lot for urban purposes where: (i) the size of the subject premises is greater than 2,500m2 and results in an increased number of non-residential lots (e.g., industrial, commercial, etc); or (ii) it results in the creation of six or more residential lots. (2) Section 3.6.1.4(1)(1)(a) of this planning scheme policy does not apply where the development has less than 25 percent impervious area. (3) Section 3.6.1.4(1) of this planning scheme policy does not apply where the development captures and manages the first 10mm of runoff per day from all impervious areas using: (4) (a) evaporation of stormwater; or (b) reuse of stormwater (e.g. adequately sized rainwater tank with reuse facilities); or (c) infiltration to native soils or filtration through an appropriately designed soil and plant stormwater treatment system. Section 3.6.1.4(1) of this planning scheme policy does not apply for waterway stability and frequent flow infrastructure where run-off from or within the site drains to a receiving waterway that is degraded. (a) A waterway is degraded where: (i) the proportion of impervious area within the catchment, prior to the proposed development, is greater than 30 percent and the waterway stability objective has not been applied to any existing development within the catchment, prior to the proposed development; or Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-77 (ii) (iii) 3.6.1.5 the waterway is designed as 'highly disturbed' in Schedule 1 of the Queensland Environmental Protection (Water) Policy 2009.The stormwater management design objectives; or as determined by the local government. Stormwater management design objectives (1) The design objective for stormwater quality is to achieve the minimum reductions in total pollutant load, compared with that in untreated stormwater runoff, from the development part of the site as set out in the State Planning Policy. (2) The design objective for frequent flow management is to: (a) provide a total stormwater capture volume in cubic metres (m 3) equal to the impervious area (m2) multiplied by the target design runoff capture depth (mm/day) divided by 1000; (b) manage the captured stormwater. This should include one or more of the following: (i) reuse of stormwater (including collection and use of roof water); (ii) infiltration to native soils (where adverse impacts will not arise); (iii) diversion of surplus flows around sensitive downstream receiving environments; (iv) evaporation of stormwater. (3) The spatial distribution of the required total stormwater capture volume in section 3.6.1.5(2)(a) of this planning scheme policy may be adapted to suit individual site conditions, provided that the required volume from all impervious areas is captured before leaving the site. (4) The design objective for frequent flow management requires that the capacity to capture the volume of runoff be available each day. The management system (whether reuse, infiltration or diversion) must therefore be capable of draining the captured stormwater within 24 hours. Editor's note––Capturing the required volume of runoff reduces pollutant load and simultaneously improve water quality. Therefore, it may eliminate the need for separate additional storage to meet the objective for managing frequent flow. (5) The design objective for waterway stability is to limit the post-development peak one-year average recurrence interval (ARI) event discharge within the receiving waterway to the predevelopment peak one-year ARI event discharge. Editor's note––Pre-development is defined in Appendix B of Technical Note: Derivation of Design Objectives January 2009. 3.6.1.6 Trunk and non-trunk stormwater infrastructure (1) The stormwater network comprises the trunk stormwater network and non-trunk stormwater infrastructure. (2) The trunk stormwater network comprises existing trunk infrastructure and future trunk infrastructure planned to be provided up to 2021 in each of the stormwater network planning areas. Editor's note––Future trunk infrastructure for the stormwater network is identified in Table 3.2.3.1–Stormwater network schedule of works in Schedule 3–Priority infrastructure plan mapping and plans of the planning scheme. Editor's note––The trunk stormwater network and the stormwater network planning areas are conceptually identified on Priority Infrastructure Plan Map PIP 06.00–Plan for trunk stormwater infrastructure in Schedule 3–Priority infrastructure plan mapping and plans of the planning scheme. (3) Development within a stormwater network planning area is required to provide stormwater infrastructure for the premises that is consistent with the plan for trunk stormwater infrastructure identified in the priority infrastructure plan. This includes ensuring development does not inhibit: (a) the delivery of the future trunk infrastructure identified in Table 3.2.3.1–Stormwater network schedule of works in Schedule 3–Priority infrastructure plan mapping and plans of the planning scheme; (b) any other future development from connecting to the trunk stormwater network. 3.6.1.7 (1) Minor and major drainage systems The stormwater network comprises a minor and major drainage system. Both drainage systems need to be planned, designed and constructed as one integrated system. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-78 (2) (3) The minor drainage system fully contains and conveys relatively minor and frequent stormwater flow to prevent nuisance from stormwater runoff on-site as well as offsite. It may comprise infrastructure items including, but not limited to: (a) inlets; (b) underground drainage; (c) junction pits; (d) access chambers; (e) outlets; (f) field or kerb inlets installed to collect surface runoff from within allotments as well as the roof water provision for buildings; (g) cross drainage under minor roads such as low flow pipes or box culverts installed under floodways; (h) low flow pipes installed under drainage reserves or park areas. The major drainage system conveys a design major storm event beyond the capacity of the minor drainage system. It may comprise both stormwater quantity and quality infrastructure items including, but not limited to: (a) open space channels, road reserves, grassed or vegetated channels, pavement expanses and other flow paths that can act as overland flow paths in excess of the capacity of the major drainage system; (b) culverts and bridges; (c) natural or constructed waterways; (d) detention or retention basins; (e) underground drainage; (f) other major water bodies. 3.6.2 (1) Design standards for stormwater infrastructure Stormwater infrastructure is provided in accordance with the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual and the Australian Rainfall and Runoff (ARR), except as modified by Section 3.6– Stormwater infrastructure standards of this planning scheme policy. 3.6.2.1 Minor drainage system (1) A minor drainage system is provided that is designed for a storm event in accordance with Table 7.02.1 of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. (2) The underground drainage systems, together with associated inlets, access chambers, outlets and other such infrastructure are designed to convey the discharge for the design minor storm event. (3) A minimum blockage factor of inlets, grates and letter box openings to be considered in designing these components of the minor drainage system is in accordance with Chapter 7 (Urban drainage) of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. (4) Road flows shall be restricted by: (a) the flow spread limitations on the road pavement and the position of kerb inlets as detailed in Section 7.04 of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual; (b) achieving a D*V <= 0.4m2/s for flow transverse to the road alignment, where there is a potential risk to human safety. Otherwise a D*V <= 0.6m2/s may be acceptable for low risk area. Editor's note––Refer to Australian Rainfall and Runoff Project 10 Report (1) ‘Appropriate Safety Criteria for People’ and Report (2) ‘Appropriate Safety Criteria for Vehicles’ for guidance. (5) Where the minor drainage system is conveyed through a park or open space, the total flow for the design minor storm event must be contained within the drainage easement. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-79 3.6.2.2 Major drainage system (1) A major drainage system is designed to convey the developed, unmitigated 100 year ARI storm event. However, the major drainage system must accommodate a provision for managing flows for storm events larger than 100 year ARI, such as an overland flow path with adequate freeboard. (2) The design of the major drainage system: (a) includes provision for the future development of buildings and earthworks on the land; (b) includes provision for an overland flow path; (c) achieves a freeboard of not less than 300mm above the 100 year ARI flood level; Editor's note––’In some instances it may be more appropriate to adopt higher freeboard in steeper streams due to roughness variability and sensitivity of Mannings ‘n’ values. The freeboard to the finished floor level of habitable area to be a minimum 500 mm. (3) (4) (d) achieves a flow depth and velocity product equal to or less than: (i) 0.6m2 per second where there is no obvious danger to human life; or (ii) 0.4m2 per second where there is an obvious danger to human life; (e) does not result in an increase to discharge or velocity rates external to the subject property; (f) makes consideration of blockages within the minor drainage system by adopting an appropriate level of debris blockage to the inlets of the minor drainage system. The major drainage system is designed to comply to a maximum permissible flow depth within the road reserve of: (a) 300mm at the kerb (subject to velocity and pedestrian safety requirements); (b) 200mm in trafficable areas not being the kerb, where: (i) the flow depth is near uniform across its width; or (ii) the width of the trafficable area is a drainage reserve; (c) equal to the height of the kerb where the profile of the footpath prevents the flow from the roadway from entering onto the adjacent property; (d) 50mm above the height of the kerb where: (i) the fall across the footpath to the kerb is greater than 100mm; (ii) the profile of the footpath prevents flow from the roadways from entering onto the adjacent property; (iii) the floor level of the adjacent building is not less than 350mm above the top of the kerb; (e) 300mm above the roadway surface where the road is subject to transverse flow, such as from causeways and culverts overtopping. The total overland flow for the designed major drainage system must be contained entirely within: (a) the road reserve; (b) a drainage reserve; (c) the overland flow path obtained through a park, open space or local government easement. (5) Wherever possible, the major drainage system (e.g., bio-retention and detention basins) shall be designed to be open air systems. (6) Where compliance with section 3.6.2.2(5)(5) of this planning scheme policy cannot be achieved, any underground components shall be supported by an overhead or otherwise appropriately aligned and sized overland flow path. (7) Detention or bioretention basin systems (whether for reuse, infiltration or diversion) must be designed to be capable of draining the captured stormwater flows within 72 hours. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-80 3.6.2.3 Lawful point of discharge (1) All development shall discharge to a legal point of discharge in accordance with Section 3.02 of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. (2) Where the lawful point of discharge is to a park, the receiving waterway shall be an appropriately designed, naturalised and constructed within an existing channel or waterway. Any works undertaken within the park shall ensure that the park function is not degraded and the written permission of the asset owner is obtained prior to application being submitted to the local government. (3) A lawful point of discharge is established for infill (brown field) development where the site slopes downward away from the road reserve and no inter-allotment drainage system exists. If the drainage system passes through a private property, a letter of consent from the owner(s) of downstream property(ies) must be submitted as a part of an approval process for the development application. 3.6.2.4 (1) Safety Stormwater infrastructure is designed to preserve and enhance public safety. This shall be achieved by methods including, but not limited to the following: (a) meeting velocity, depth and velocity*depth limitations for pedestrians and motor vehicles; (b) providing safe egress from detention systems; (c) ensuring that in the event of carpark flooding, flooding is limited to a depth of 600mm and a depth*velocity product of less than 0.4m2/s; (d) applying the principles of crime prevention through environmental design; (e) adequate signage. 3.6.2.5 Design of roads (1) Except where modified by this planning scheme policy, development shall ensure that the drainage system meets flow depth, flow width, pedestrian and vehicle safety requirements for both minor and major storm conditions in accordance with Queensland Urban Drainage Manual, Australian Rainfall and Runoff Project 10 ‘Appropriate Safety Criteria for People’ and ‘Appropriate Safety Criteria for Vehicles. (2) In addition to the requirements of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual and Australian Rainfall and Runoff, development shall ensure that: (a) the road reserve flow capacity is able to convey the minor and major design storm requirements; (b) flood depth over all roads does not exceed 300mm; (c) depth*velocity product assessment is undertaken for the assessment of pedestrian safety; (d) the depth*velocity product in all roads is less than or equal to 0.4 m 2/s, except where it is demonstrated that pedestrians will not be at risk, in which case it is less than or equal to 0.6m2/s. (3) For the purposes of adhering to the road classification specifications of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual, urban collector and urban arterial roads shall be deemed to be major roads and urban access roads shall be deemed to be minor roads. (4) Development provides that non-frangible dome top grates are not used within the clear zone as defined by Austroads. 3.6.2.6 (1) Waterway crossings Waterways crossings such as, but not limited to, bridge and culvert crossings shall be designed and constructed in accordance with: (a) Australian Rainfall and Runoff; (b) Queensland Department of Transport and Main Roads - Fauna Sensitive Road Design Manual - Volume 2: Preferred Practices; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-81 (c) 3.6.2.7 section 3.4.12–Bridge and major culvert works of this planning scheme policy. Allotment and inter-allotment drainage systems (1) Wherever site topography permits, premises shall drain roof and surface water to the adjoining road reserve or stormwater network (i.e. allotment drainage system). (2) Where site topography does not facilitate drainage of roof and surface water in accordance with section 3.6.2.7(1) of this planning scheme policy, then an inter-allotment drainage system is required. (3) The allotment and inter-allotment drainage systems are comprised of a number of key elements. Figure 3.6.2.7.1–Allotment and inter-allotment stormwater drainage system of this planning scheme policy graphically depicts these elements. Figure 3.6.2.7.1–Allotment and inter-allotment stormwater drainage system (4) An allotment and inter-allotment drainage system must be in accordance with Table 3.6.2.7.1– Allotment and inter-allotment drainage system requirements and Table 3.6.2.7.2–Design standards for allotment and inter-allotment drainage system requirements of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-82 Table 3.6.2.7.1–Allotment and inter-allotment drainage system requirements Category Zone Number of lots feeding the system Level of connector pipe design Level of connector pipe and surface water collection design Easement requirements Urban residential Medium density residential zone, Low-medium density residential zone, Suburban and small lot precinct in the Low density residential zone 1 lot Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 2 N/A N/A 2 to 5 lots Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 2 Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 2 N/A >5 lots Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 2 or 3 Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 3 with minimum 300mm diameter pipe or Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 4 Easement in favour of Council over collector pipe 1 lot Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 2 N/A N/A 2 to 5 lots Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 2 Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 2 or appropriately sized overland flow path N/A >5 lots Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 2 or 3 Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 3 with minimum 300mm diameter pipe, or Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 4 Easement in favour of Council over collector pipe 2 to 5 lots Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 2 Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 2 or appropriately sized overland flow path N/A >5 lots Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 2 or 3 Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 3 with minimum 300mm diameter pipe, or Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 4 N/A Suburban residential Rural residential Large suburban, Small acreage and Village precinct in the Low density residential zone. Park residential precinct in the Rural residential zone Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-83 Category Zone Number of lots feeding the system Level of connector pipe design Level of connector pipe and surface water collection design Easement requirements Commercial and industrial Centre zone, Specialised centre zone, Mixed use zone, Low impact industry zone, Medium impact industry zone Impervious area less <1001m2 Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 4 Commercial and industrial areas shall connect directly to the local government stormwater network. N/A Impervious area >1000m2 Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Level 5 Commercial and industrial areas shall connect directly to the local government stormwater network. Note––For any other development type not mentioned in Table 3.6.2.7.1 an appropriate level and type of inter-allotment drainage system is to be adopted based on principles outlined in Queensland Urban Drainage Model and in consultation with local government. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-84 Table 3.6.2.7.2–Design standards for allotment and inter-allotment drainage system requirements Item Level applicable ll lll lV V Minimum pipe size 150mm 225mm 375mm Minimum stub size 150mm 150mm To be designed Pipe material UPVC UPVC, RCP, FRC RCP, FRC Jointing system RRJ, S&S RRJ, S&S RRJ, S&S Flow calculation 10L/s per allotment Rational method Rational method or runoff model ARI for design 2 year for development 20d/ha 10 year for development > 20d/ha 2 year for development 20d/ha 10 year for development > 20d/ha 20 years within the greater network Pipe system design 2 year for development 20d/ha 10 year for development > 20d/ha 2 year for development 20d/ha 10 year for development > 20d/ha Full hydraulic analysis or pipe nomograph plus structure losses Major design storm overland flow check Ensure the land development and its drainage system does not unlawfully concentrate flows onto, or aggravate flooding within, neighbouring properties. The overland flow path is to be identified within the design system and be based on full development (i.e. make allowance for buildings and earthworks etc.) Full hydraulic analysis with determination of H.G.L. Editor's note––. Editor's note––Source: QLD Urban Drainage Manual (Table 7.13.3 - Levels of roof and allotment drainage classification). (5) All pipes must have a minimum longitudinal gradient of 0.1 percent, except as altered by section 3.6.2.8 Inter-allotment drainage systems. (6) Soakage or rubble pits are not permitted in the urban residential, suburban residential, commercial or industrial areas category as identified in Table 3.6.2.7.1–Allotment and interallotment drainage system requirements of this planning scheme policy. Soakage pits are permitted in the rural area category. (7) Charged roofwater systems are not permitted except in exceptional circumstances where no other option is available. Any proposal for such a system must be accompanied by a hydraulic report which demonstrates that the system can adequately discharge the roof water. (8) Drainage pits or inspection manholes are provided at all changes in allotment and interallotment drainage direction and connection points and above and below retaining walls.. 3.6.2.8 Inter-allotment drainage systems (1) This section needs to be read in conjunction with section 3.6.2.7-Allotment and inter-allotment drainage systems of this planning scheme policy. Where there is a conflict between the two sections, this section prevails. (2) All inter-allotment drainage with an easement in favour of the local government achieves a minimum design standard of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual level III with a minimum pipe diameter of 375mm. (3) All collector pipes with an easement in favour of the local government: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-85 (a) are designed to a minimum Queensland Urban Drainage Manual level III standard, including construction with RCP or FRC pipe material, RRJ or S&S joining systems, and sized to convey at a minimum the two year ARI storm event; (b) have a minimum longitudinal gradient of 0.5 percent; (c) are a minimum of 375mm in diameter. (4) Any fences located within an easement in favour of the local government are demountable and removable. (5) Retaining walls are not located within an easement in favour of the local government, such that: (6) (a) the retaining wall is located outside the zone of influence of the easement and the piped network; (b) the easement is located outside the zone of influence of the retaining wall. All collector pipes, whether local government managed or otherwise, are located within a single line of lots, away from the property boundary as identified in Figure 3.6.2.8.1–Location of collector pipes in inter-allotment drainage systems of this planning scheme policy. Figure 3.6.2.8.1–Location of collector pipes in inter-allotment drainage systems Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-86 3.6.2.9 Allotment and Inter-allotment drainage systems for peri-urban areas (1) In the Rural residential, Rural zone and Environmental management and conservation zone areas, the design and construction of the drainage system is the responsibility of the owner. (2) An overland flow path in the Rural residential, Rural zone and Environmental management and conservation zone areas is preserved or an open channel is constructed: (3) (a) in accordance with the provisions of this planning scheme policy; (b) in accordance with depth*velocity safety provisions of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual and Equation 3.6.2.1–Depth and velocity safety standards from Queensland Urban Drainage Manual; (c) to achieve a minimum freeboard of 500mm to all finished habitable floor levels within the site; (d) so batter slopes on any swale are no greater than 1:4 (V:H). Where overland flow is conveyed within a road on site: (a) the maximum depth within kerb and channel is 300mm; (b) a minimum freeboard of 500mm is provided to all finished floor levels within the site. Equation 3.6.2.1–Depth and velocity safety standards from Queensland Urban Drainage Manual dg.Vave0.6m2/s, or 0.4m2/s for areas where risk to personal safety is reasonably foreseeable; Where: dg is the maximum flow depth (m) Vave is the average velocity within the flow path (m/s) 3.6.2.10 No worsening (1) Development must achieve the principle of "no worsening", as per the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual and the provisions of this planning scheme policy. (2) In achieving the principle of no worsening, development: (a) does not result in a detrimental impact on the flooding, or flood risk of any area; (b) does not result in adverse impacts of any other property in terms of changes in peak discharge, flood levels, the frequency of flooding, the shape of the hydrograph, flow velocities, water quality, sedimentation or scour effects for the full range of ARI storm events up to and including the defined flood event; (c) not result in an increase in peak discharge from the development site; (d) ensures that the time of concentration to the peak of the event does not decrease and where it does increase, consideration is given to the impacts upstream, adjacent, and downstream of the property boundary so as to ensure runoff from the site does not bring the hydrograph peak closer to coincidence with the peak flow in adjoining catchments; (e) undertakes a method of modelling agreed with the local government, upstream and, where appropriate, downstream of the site. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-87 Figure 3.6.2.10.1–Peak discharge and allowable change No allowable change in hydrograph (including shape of hydrograph) earlier than the rising limb or above the pre-developed peak flow The above line shows envelope of allowable maximum peak flow for developed case Existing, predeveloped hydrograph (3) Infrastructure which may be appropriate to contribute to compliance with the principle of "no worsening" includes: (a) stormwater detention systems; (b) controlled conveyance within the development site of flow which enters the site from upstream or adjacent areas; (c) infiltration areas; (d) stormwater storage and harvesting subject to availability of storage after a large rainfall event for mitigation of peak discharge; (e) where exceptional circumstance exist such that the existing overland flow path is highly degraded and both ecological and flood risk benefits can be achieved, channel enhancement and other rehabilitation measures. 3.6.2.11 Estimation of stormwater runoff (1) (2) An estimation of runoff is calculated using rainfall-runoff modelling software (e.g. XP-RAFTS, XP-STORM or RORB, etc) where: (a) the catchment area is larger than 5 ha (As per Queensland Urban Drainage Manual’s requirements for use of the Rational Method); or (b) an analysis of storage capacity (e.g. basin storage/stage discharge relationship) is required for an existing or proposed detention basin. The Rational Method can be used for relatively small scale catchment as well as for verifying the rainfall-runoff model. Some parameters for using the Rational Method is provided below 3.6.2.12 Flow Coefficient of runoff and Impervious fraction values (1) Development design shall adopt a coefficient of runoff and fraction imperviousness values in accordance with Section 4.05 of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. 3.6.2.13 Rainfall intensity values (1) Development shall be designed in accordance with the rainfall intensity-frequency-duration (IFD) data for the Logan City Council area. The IFD information used in development assessment and design must be catchment and location specific. 3.6.2.14 Standard inlet times (1) Development shall be designed in accordance with the standard inlet times contained in Section 4.06.4 of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. 3.6.2.15 Sensitivity analysis (1) Sensitivity analysis shall be undertaken for all modelled results. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-88 (2) The sensitivity of all results shall be assessed with regards to the influence of: (a) an increase in rainfall intensity of 10 percent; (b) a variation of all Mannings 'n' values of 10 percent to 20 percent depending on the circumstances on the implications/risk profile; (c) a variation of the tail water depth of +/- 10%; (d) blockage considerations as outlined in Queensland Urban Drainage Manual and Australian Rainfall and Runoff Project 11 Blockage of Hydraulic Structures. 3.6.2.16 Creating new easements (1) An easement is provided over all major drainage system elements, open or piped, that form part of the public stormwater infrastructure network and is not located within property under the control of the local government. (2) The easement shall be for the entire length of the drainage infrastructure that is not located within property controlled by the local government. (3) The easement shall be created in accordance with the Land Title Act 1994. (4) A formal written agreement between the owner of the intervening land and the person who has the benefit of the development approval shall be provided to the local government prior to a registrable lease or easement being created. (5) For further detail on easements with regards to inter-allotment drainage see section 3.6.2.7– Allotment and inter-allotment drainage systems of this planning scheme policy. 3.6.2.17 Specifications for new easements (1) Easements shall be of a size so as to enable necessary works including, but not limited to construction, maintenance or inspection, to be carried out. (2) Easement widths shall be no less than the greater of: (a) three metres for all single pipes from 300mm up to 1350mm diameter; (b) one metre wider than the width of the outer edges of the pipes or box culverts; (c) the width of the flow path required to carry: (i) the difference between the peak discharge for the 100 year ARI event and the capacity of the underground system; or (ii) freeboard of 300 mm or greater and as outlined in Section 7.03 of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual; (d) the width of: (i) any open channel; (ii) a maintenance track for the operation of maintenance vehicles along at least one side of the channel, in accordance with Sections 9.02 and 9.07.2 of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual; (iii) freeboard in accordance with section 9.03.4 of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. (3) In highly constrained situations, mainly for brownfields developments, it may be acceptable that the width of easements over Queensland Urban Drainage Manual level II drainage systems be a minimum of two metres. (4) All drainage easements shall be sized and located so as to ensure they are not effected by, and do not impact on an existing building's footing zone of influence and give consideration to any future building footings on the subject or adjoining premises. 3.6.2.18 Works within existing easements (1) Where development seeks to use an existing easement that is part of the local government's stormwater network, the local government's written consent is required prior to lodging a development application. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-89 3.6.2.19 Where an easement cannot be obtained (1) (2) Where a downstream property owner will not grant an easement, the local government may, at its discretion, accept a signed letter of agreement from the downstream property owner that: (a) states the owner agrees to the installation of stormwater drainage across or within their property without the encumbrance of an easement; (b) outlines the conditions by which the owner agrees to maintain the drainage infrastructure; (c) forms a legally binding agreement that will be placed as a property note on all premises involved. For the management of allotment and inter-allotment drainage: (a) all allotment drainage, connector pipes and surface water collection as depicted in Figure 3.6.2.7.1–Allotment and inter-allotment stormwater drainage system of this planning scheme policy shall remain the responsibility of the lot owner; (b) where a collector pipe, as depicted in Figure 3.6.2.7.1–Allotment and inter-allotment stormwater drainage system of this planning scheme policy: (i) drains 2 to 5 lots in the Residential zone category excluding the Acreage precinct a private easement shall be provided over the entire length of the pipe in favour of all lots benefiting from and affected by the pipe; (ii) drains to greater than 5 lots in the Residential zone category excluding the Acreage precinct - an easement shall be provided that: (A) is in favour of the local government; (B) extends over the entire collector pipe; (C) results in the collector pipe becoming a local government asset. 3.6.2.20 Stormwater infrastructure located in a park or open space (1) A stormwater infrastructure item is only to be provided in or adjacent to a park or open space where it results in an: (a) increase in the continuity of greenspace area; (b) improvement in overall amenity of the area. (2) If development cannot achieve the requirements of section 3.6.2.20(1) of this planning scheme policy, the stormwater infrastructure item must be located within a drainage reserve dedicated for the purpose of stormwater drainage. (3) A stormwater infrastructure item located within a park, open space, or drainage reserve shall be designed to: (a) reflect the natural character of the land and its surrounds; (b) preserve community safety; (c) allow for maintenance activities to be undertaken. 3.6.2.21 Stormwater infrastructure located in a waterway and wetland buffer area (1) A stormwater infrastructure item may only be provided in a waterway and wetland buffer area where the buffer area is degraded to such an extent that the construction of the stormwater infrastructure item would result in an enhancement to the condition and ecological function of the buffer area. (2) A stormwater infrastructure item may not be located within the waterway and wetland buffer area where the buffer area: (a) contains intact riparian vegetation; or (b) is located below the 20 year ARI flood level; or (c) adjoins a stream order 1 or 2 minor waterway as mapped in Logan City Council’s Waterway corridors and wetlands overlay mapping; or Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-90 (d) (3) where the mapped waterway or wetland buffer is less than 30m in width, measured from the top bank. Where a stormwater infrastructure item is located within a waterway or wetland buffer area, it shall be located a minimum distance of: (a) 10m extending perpendicularly outwards from the top of bank for waterways of stream order 3 or minor wetlands that is retained, restored or rehabilitated; or (b) 25m extending perpendicularly outwards from the top of bank for waterways of stream order 4 and 5 major wetlands or significant wetlands that is retained, restored or rehabilitated. 3.6.2.22 Stormwater infrastructure located in a road reserve (1) A stormwater infrastructure item may only be located within a road reserve where the item is a: (a) bioretention street tree approved in accordance with Table 4.2.1–Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcomes of the landscape code of this planning scheme policy; or (b) streetscape bioretention system. 3.6.3 Stormwater quantity infrastructure 3.6.3.1 Minor drainage system (1) Minor drainage system elements are designed and constructed in accordance with the standard drawings identified in Table 8.5.1.1–Standard drawings for stormwater infrastructure in Part 8– Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. 3.6.3.2 Pipe locations (1) Where sufficient verge width is available, stormwater pipes may be located in the verge to suit the service allocations of the local government. (2) In divided roads, stormwater pipelines may be located within the median and should be offset 1.5 m from the centreline. (3) Where a minor pipe connects directly from one kerb inlet to another in the upper reaches of the street drainage system, it may be located underneath the kerb and channel. (4) Where a pipeline is greater than 600 mm in diameter, it should be located 2.0 m from the invert of the kerb and channel towards the road centreline. (5) The minimum vertical and horizontal clearance between pipes of differing services shall be 300 mm. 3.6.3.3 Pipe size (1) Drainage pipes intended to be local government assets must be a minimum size diameter of 375 mm. (2) The local government may accept a minimum pipe size diameter of 300 mm for: (a) a low flow pipe; (b) a kerb and channel collection pipe; (c) an inter-allotment drainage collector pipe that drains six or more lots. 3.6.3.4 (1) Pipe cover Development shall provide minimum cover over pipes in accordance with Queensland Urban Drainage Manual, except as altered by: (a) Table 3.6.3.4.1—Minimum cover over pipes of this planning scheme policy Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-91 Table 3.6.3.4.1—Minimum cover over pipes Location Minimum cover (mm) Rigid type pipes (e.g. Concrete, FRC) Residential private property and parks not subject to traffic 300 Private property and parks subject to occasional traffic 450 Footpaths 450 Road pavement and under kerb and channel 600 Source: Queensland Urban Drainage Manual 2007: Section 7.10 Minimum cover over pipes. 3.6.3.5 Pipe velocity limits (1) Pipe velocities are in accordance with Queensland Urban Drainage Manual and Table 3.6.3.5.1–Acceptable flow velocities for pipes and box sections of this planning scheme policy. (2) It should be noted that hydraulic consideration may require the velocity be controlled to well below the "Desirable Maximum" and/or the pipe size increased to minimise drainage structure losses and the slope of the hydraulic grade line. (3) Where possible, development should ensure: (a) A minimum pipe velocity of 1.2m/s; and (b) A maximum pipe velocity of 4.0ms. Table 3.6.3.5.1–Acceptable flow velocities for pipes and box sections Flow condition Absolute minimum1 (m/s) Desirable minimum1 (m/s) Desirable maximum2 (m/s) Absolute maximum2 (m/s) Partially full 0.7 1.2 4.7 7.0 Full 0.6 1.0 4.0 6.0 Note––1 Minimum flow velocities apply to 1 year ARI design storm and apply to all pipe materials. Note––2 Maximum flow velocities apply to concrete pipes and other types subject to damage by abrasion or erosion. Note––It should be noted that hydraulic consideration may require the velocity be controlled to well below the "Desirable Maximum" and/or the pipe size increased to minimise structure losses and the slope of the hydraulic grade line. 3.6.3.6 (1) Pipe grade limits Development must achieve the maximum and minimum grades for pipes specified in Table 3.6.3.6.1–Acceptable pipe grades for full flowing pipes of this planning scheme policy. Table 3.6.3.6.1–Acceptable pipe grades for full flowing pipes Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Pipe diameter (mm) Maximum grade (%) Minimum grade (%) 300 375 450 20.0 15.0 11.0 0.50 0.40 0.30 525 600 675 9.0 7.5 6.5 0.25 0.20 0.18 750 900 1050 5.5 4.5 3.5 0.15 0.12 0.10 1200 1350 3.0 2.5 0.10 0.10 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-92 1500 2.2 0.10 1650 1800 1950 2.0 1.7 1.5 0.10 0.10 0.10 2100 2250 2400 1.4 1.3 1.2 0.10 0.10 0.10 Editor's note–– 1. Based on maximum velocity for pipe flowing pull of 6.0m/s. 2. Based on minimum velocity for pipe flowing pull of 1.0m/s except where Note 4 is applicable. 3. Manning's n = 0.013 for all cased (concrete pipes). 4. The minimum grade of 0.10% is based on construction tolerance requirements. 5. The Maximum grade requirement (Column 2) applies to both the pipe grade and the hydraulic grade. 6. The Minimum grades (Column 3) apply to the pipe grade only. 7. Where the pipe is flowing less than half full for the design flow being considered, it is permissible to exceed the above maximum grades provided the velocity limits are not exceeded. 3.6.4 (1) Channels Where development is to provide a constructed stormwater drainage channel, it shall be constructed in accordance with the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual, Australian Rainfall and Runoff and the Brisbane City Council Technical Guidelines for Natural Channel Design, except as modified by this planning scheme policy. 3.6.4.1 Unlined channel flow velocities (1) Flow velocities in unlined channels shall be in accordance with Table 9.05.3 of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. (2) Where Table 9.05.3 of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual does not specify a permissible velocity for a given combination of gradient and vegetation cover, then that combination of gradient and vegetation cover shall be taken to be unacceptable. 3.6.4.2 (1) The maximum bank slope gradients for constructed channels are 1:4 (V:H). 3.6.4.3 (1) Bank slope requirements for constructed channels Allowable channels types The seven types of allowable channel designs that can be constructed are listed in Table 3.6.4.3.1–Allowable channel types of this planning scheme policy. Table 3.6.4.3.1–Allowable channel types Channel type description C1 C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 Hard lined channel Grass channel with low-flow pipe Grass channel with low-flow channel Vegetated channel Vegetated channel with low-flow channel Vegetated channel and floodway Vegetated channel with low-flow channel and floodway Typical Catchment Area <30ha <30ha Tolerance to Sediment Flow High Medium to High Medium to High Low 30 to 60ha Low Yes Yes >60ha Low Yes Yes >60ha Low Yes Yes <30ha <30ha No Terrestrial Passage Corridor No No Limited Limited Limited Possible Yes Fish Passage Corridor Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-93 Source: Queensland Urban Drainage Manual 2007: Table 9.02.1 Typical attributes of various constructed drainage channels. (2) Development in residential and rural areas shall use channel types C4, C5, C6 and C7. (3) Development in commercial and industrial areas shall use channel types C1, C2 and C3. (4) Where a proposed channel in a commercial or industrial area is located: (a) adjacent to: parkland; environmental and/ or habitat corridors; open space; or (b) where a natural overland flow path exists across or adjacent to the development site, then channel types C4, C5, C6 and C7 shall be used. 3.6.4.4 (1) Type C1 channel - Hard lined channel A type C1 channel is provided in accordance with Figure 3.6.4.4.1–Type C1 channel of this planning scheme policy. Figure 3.6.4.4.1–Type C1 channel Source: Queensland Urban Drainage Manual 2007: Section 9 Open Channel Hydraulics. 3.6.4.5 (1) Type C2 channel - Grass channel with low-flow pipe A type C2 channel is provided in accordance with Figure 3.6.4.5.1–Type C2 channel of this planning scheme policy. Figure 3.6.4.5.1–Type C2 channel Source: Queensland Urban Drainage Manual 2007: Section 9 Open Channel Hydraulics. 3.6.4.6 (1) Type C3 channel - Grass channel with low-flow channel A type C3 channel is provided in accordance with Figure 3.6.4.6.1–Type C3 channel of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-94 Figure 3.6.4.6.1–Type C3 channel Source: Queensland Urban Drainage Manual 2007: Section 9 Open Channel Hydraulics. 3.6.4.7 (1) Type C4 channel - Vegetated channel with no formal low-flow channel A type C4 channel is provided in accordance with Figure 3.6.4.7.1-Type C4 channel of this planning scheme policy. Figure 3.6.4.7.1-Type C4 channel Source: Queensland Urban Drainage Manual 2007: Section 9 Open Channel Hydraulics. (2) (3) The channel banks shall have a maximum gradient of 1 in 4, except: (a) on the outside of bends where steeper gradients may be appropriate; or (b) where shading of the channel bed from overbank trees is required to provide water temperature control, in which situation steeper gradients may be appropriate. Public safety is maintained and enhanced through: (a) the provision of batter slopes with a maximum gradient of 1 in 4; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-95 (b) the design, provision and maintenance of bank and overbank vegetation; (c) where applicable adopting the principles of Crime Prevention Through Environmental Design (CPTED) into the design of the channel. 3.6.4.8 (1) Type C5 channel - Vegetated trapezoidal channel with low-flow channel A type C5 channel is provided in accordance with Figure 3.6.4.8.1–Type C5 channel of this planning scheme policy. Figure 3.6.4.8.1–Type C5 channel Source: Queensland Urban Drainage Manual 2007: Section 9 Open Channel Hydraulics. (2) (3) The channel banks shall have a maximum gradient of 1 in 4, except: (a) on the outside of bends where steeper gradients may be appropriate; or (b) where shading of the channel bed from overbank trees is required to provide water temperature control, in which situation steeper gradients may be appropriate. Public safety is maintained and enhanced through: (a) the provision of batter slopes with a maximum gradient of 1 in 4; (b) the design, provision and maintenance of bank and overbank vegetation; (c) where applicable adopting the principles of Crime Prevention Through Environmental Design (CPTED) into the design of the channel. 3.6.4.9 (1) Type C6 channel - Two stage vegetated channel and floodway Where applicable, development shall provide a type C6 channel in accordance with Figure 3.6.4.9.1–Type C6 channel of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-96 Figure 3.6.4.9.1–Type C6 channel Source: Queensland Urban Drainage Manual 2007: Section 9 Open Channel Hydraulics. (2) (3) The channel banks shall have a maximum gradient of 1 in 4, except: (a) on the outside of bends where steeper gradients may be appropriate; or (b) where shading of the channel bed from overbank trees is required to provide water temperature control, in which situation steeper gradients may be appropriate. Public safety is maintained and enhanced through: (a) the provision of batter slopes with a maximum gradient of 1 in 4; (b) the design, provision and maintenance of bank and overbank vegetation; (c) where applicable adopting the principles of Crime Prevention Through Environmental Design (CPTED) into the design of the channel. 3.6.4.10 Type C7 channel - Multi-stage vegetated channel with low-flow channel (1) A type C7 channel is provided in accordance with Figure 3.6.4.10.1–Type C7 channel of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-97 Figure 3.6.4.10.1–Type C7 channel Source: Queensland Urban Drainage Manual 2007: Section 9 Open Channel Hydraulics. (2) (3) The channel banks shall have a maximum gradient of 1 in 4, except: (a) on the outside of bends where steeper gradients may be appropriate; or (b) where shading of the channel bed from overbank trees is required to provide water temperature control, in which situation steeper gradients may be appropriate. Public safety is maintained and enhanced through: (a) the provision of batter slopes with a maximum gradient of 1 in 4; (b) the design, provision and maintenance of bank and overbank vegetation; (c) where applicable adopting the principles of Crime Prevention Through Environmental Design (CPTED) into the design of the channel. 3.6.5 Overland flow 3.6.5.1 Overland flow hydrology (1) With respect to overland flow hydrology and associated design, overland flow is comprised of both sheet flow and concentrated flow. (2) The maximum overland sheet flow length is: (3) (a) 50m in urban areas; or (b) 200m in rural residential areas. Overland sheet flow travel time is calculated using either: (a) Friend’s Equation; or (b) the Kinematic Wave Equation. Editors Note—Council's preference is that Friend’s Equation (Queensland Urban Drainage Manual Equation 4.06) is used for this purpose. (4) Concentrated overland flow travel time shall be determined using Manning's equation and fall within the accepted time periods identified in the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. 3.6.5.2 (1) Overland flow design standards Overland flow is to be provided such that: (a) the developed 100 year ARI flow is conveyed; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-98 (b) it is designed in accordance with Section 9 of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual, ARR and the Brisbane City Council Technical Design Guidelines for Natural Channel Design; (c) existing overland flow paths are retained, maintained and protected; (d) existing waterway values are protected, enhanced and rehabilitated; (e) waterway stream flow lengths are not reduced; (f) no worsening of overland flow and potential associated flooding is achieved; (g) a minimum 500mm freeboard between the overland flow path 100 year ARI flow level and all finished floor levels is achieved; and (h) aesthetic amenity is enhanced. (2) Where modification of the overland flow path is unavoidable or necessary - the new overland flow path design must conform to the principle of no worsening and provide beneficial environmental enhancement. (3) Where possible and having regard for the type and scale of infrastructure concerned development should provide interpretive/ educational opportunities. 3.6.6 (1) Detention systems Where development is to provide a detention system, it shall be constructed in accordance with the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual, ARR and the provisions of this planning scheme policy. 3.6.6.1 Acceptable types of detention systems (1) A variety of different detention systems are acceptable for use, provided they are suitable for site constraints, development type and intended ownership. (2) Detention basins are an acceptable type of detention system in all developments except where attenuated flood peaks from tributaries coincide with the main stem flood wave in a manner that causes or worsens overfloor flooding downstream. (3) Detention basins, incorporating stormwater quality treatment infrastructure items, are an acceptable type of detention system in all developments, subject to the bioretention basin's suitability to in-situ soil conditions. (4) Development may provide underground tanks, but this type of detention system will not be accepted as a local government asset. (5) Development may provide above ground tanks where site constraints prohibit the use of all other detention systems. However this type of detention system will not be accepted as a local government asset. (6) The local government will not accept the use of rainwater tanks as a detention system in any development. 3.6.6.2 (1) (2) (3) Location of detention basins Detention systems are designed and constructed to be: (a) at or above the 50 year ARI local flood level; (b) at or above the 50 year ARI regional flood level. Flood plain storage and function, and detention system functions are maintained. This shall include ensuring that: (a) detention system design does not remove flood plain storage; (b) detention systems continue to operate effectively during a major storm event. Detention basins falling within the flood plain area will be provided with compensatory excavation equal to the volume of the basin including both bunds and storage volume between the natural surface level and the invert of the detention weir. The pre and post development stage-storage relationships should remain essentially unchanged unless part of the local government approved flood mitigation scheme. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-99 (4) Detention basins shall not be provided in locations that prevent easy access to or maintenance of the detention basin. In particular, detention basins within residential subdivisions shall be designed, located and constructed on land solely dedicated for stormwater management. (5) Detention systems are to be designed as off-line systems. (6) Off-line detention systems are to receive and detain stormwater prior to it entering: (7) (a) a waterway, wetland or overland flow path that originates upstream of the development site; or (b) a waterway or wetland as shown in the Waterway corridors and wetlands overlay code; or (c) any other applicable overland flow path that originates within the development site itself. Figure 3.6.6.2.1–Off-line detention systems in this planning scheme policy graphically show the principle expressed in section 3.6.6.2(5) above. Figure 3.6.6.2.1–Off-line detention systems 3.6.6.3 (1) Design requirements Detention basins shall be designed and constructed such that: (a) the shape of the base maximises storage area and minimises flooded depth; (b) basin batter gradients are no steeper than 1:4 (V:H); (c) embankments have a top with a minimum width of 3m; (d) the inundation depth during the 20 year ARI event is equal to or less than 1.2m. However, where the system is a carpark - the depths shall be limited to 600mm during a 100 year ARI event; (e) freeboard is provided according to Table 3.6.6.3.1–Freeboard requirements of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-100 Table 3.6.6.3.1–Freeboard requirements Location Freeboard requirements Assessable basin in urban area 0.3m with preferred minimum storage depth of 1.2m Detention basin adjacent to road embankment 0.3m below edge of shoulder Detention basin adjacent to railway embankment Underside of ballast Detention basins within urban development designed with high level spillways 0.3m or 10% of the 100 year ARI storage depth, whichever is the greater. 3.6.6.4 Vegetation specifications (1) Detention basins shall be either grassed or planted with vegetation native to the local area, and appropriate to an inundated or intermittently wet environment. (2) Trees are not generally considered appropriate within detention basins. (3) If trees are provided within a detention basin, the design shall incorporate as far as possible the principles of Crime Prevention Through Environmental Design (CPTED). (4) If trees are provided within a detention basin, the basin’s size shall be increased by the volume of storage occupied by those trees at maturity. This volume shall be calculated using the equation below. Volume at maturity = no. of trees * (pi*((Dbhm)2)/4)*dw Where: (a) Dbhm is the diameter at breast height of a mature specimen of the specified tree; (b) dw is the maximum depth of water in a design event. 3.6.6.5 (1) Basin floor design The minimum cross gradient of a detention basin shall be: (a) 1:80 (V:H) for grassed basins; or (b) 1:100 (V:H) for vegetated basins. 3.6.6.6 Outflow characteristics (1) All detention basins shall be designed and constructed with a minimum two staged outlet. (2) The low level outlet is located low in the basin and is designed to allow normal flow discharge, with due consideration to any potential blockage of the outlet. The low level outlet may consist of: (3) (4) (a) pipes; (b) culverts. Flows greater than the normal flow discharge shall be conveyed via a weir and pipe or spillway system with no increase in flow from all flood events up to the design event. Weir and pipe, or spillway systems shall be designed: (a) with a depth*velocity value across the weir or spillways of less than or equal to 0.6m 2/s; (b) to ensure structural integrity of the basin is retained during any event, including spilling of the basin. All outlets are to be designed such that: (a) blockages are prevented; (b) safety of the public and maintenance personnel is preserved; (c) intake provisions comply with Queensland Urban Drainage Manual; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-101 (d) 3.6.6.7 scour protection and energy dissipation are provided within the development site boundary for the detention basin inflow and discharge. Maintenance (1) Detention basins shall be designed to provide for maintenance. (2) All detention basins shall be designed and constructed with a reinforced concrete heavy vehicle access into the base of the detention basin, or equivalent. (3) Maintenance access must be provided for: (a) removal of sediment deposits from within the basin; (b) removal of debris and rubbish after flood events; (c) repair of cracking, erosion and leakage; (d) removal of undesirable tree and vegetation growth; (e) mowing; (f) reinstatement of basin materials and planting. 3.6.6.8 Detention basin size (1) Suitable sized detention basins are to be provided in accordance with ARR, Sections 4, 5.05.2 and 6 of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual and the provisions of this planning scheme policy. (2) Detention basin size shall: (a) be determined using an appropriate computer model; (b) consider the function of the detention system within the catchment; (c) assess and satisfy the requirements for no worsening for the full range of ARI storm events up to and including the 100 year ARI event. Editor's note––1. For sub-section (a) above - the use of only the Rational Method and/ or the methods detailed in Section 5.05.1 of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual is not acceptable. Editor's note––2. For sub-section (c) above - it is not acceptable to assess only the largest peak discharge from a designed basin, nor only the critical storm. 3.6.6.9 Management of detention systems (1) All detention systems, designed and constructed to become a Council asset, other than a detention system identified in a Priority Infrastructure Plan, shall be provided on land dedicated in favour of Council at no cost to Council. (2) All private on-site systems shall be maintained and managed by the private property owner. Such systems shall not be established on Council owned land, nor will they be accepted by Council as a Council managed asset. 3.6.6.10 Secondary uses for detention systems sites (1) Detention systems sites are to be designed and constructed primarily for flood mitigation purposes. (2) However detention systems sites can also be designed for a secondary purpose, that include: (a) usable recreational space during dry periods; or (b) carparking and hardstand areas. (3) Detention systems sites designed as usable recreational space during dry periods will not be included as park land. Table 3.12.4.1–Minimum post development flood immunity for park of this planning scheme policy, provides suggestion on flood immunity levels for various park types. (4) Detention systems sites designed to provide usable open space during dry periods shall be designed and constructed such that: (a) it dries rapidly after rainfall; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-102 (5) (b) it is inundated to a maximum depth of 1.2m during the 20year ARI event, except where the system is a carpark, in which case depths shall be limited to 600mm during a 100 year ARI event; (c) it is safe; (d) includes a low flow channel, flow path or pipe to maximise community benefit from the area; (e) provides pedestrian access to disabled grades and access. Carparking space may be configured to provide stormwater detention in private development. Where this occurs, development shall ensure that: (a) it satisfies the requirements for carpark design and stormwater detention system design; (b) safety is maintained or enhanced; (c) flood free or low flood hazard access for the entry and exit points of the car park are provided. 3.6.7 Stormwater quality, frequent flow management and waterway stability infrastructure 3.6.7.1 Standards for stormwater quality, frequent flow management and waterway stability infrastructure (1) Except as altered by the provisions of this planning scheme policy, stormwater quality, frequent flow management and waterway stability infrastructure is designed and constructed in accordance with the most recent versions of: (a) the Water by Design Water Sensitive Urban Design Technical Design Guidelines for South East Queensland; (b) the Construction and Establishment Guidelines: Swales, Bioretention Systems and Wetlands; (c) the Concept Design Guidelines for Water Sensitive Urban Design; (d) Standard Drawings WSUD-001 to WSUD-012 produced by the Queensland Division of the Institute of Public Works Engineering Australia; (e) the MUSIC modelling guidelines for South East Queensland; (f) the Deemed to Comply Solutions for Stormwater Management in South East Queensland; (g) the Water Sensitive Urban Design Asset Handover Guideline; (h) Southeast Queensland Regional Plan Implementation Guideline 7 Water sensitive urban design: Design objectives for urban stormwater management (2009); (i) Water by Design Asset Maintenance Guidelines; (j) Water by Design Asset Rectification Guidelines. (2) All computer modelling undertaken for the design of stormwater quality infrastructure uses the Model for Urban Stormwater Improvement Conceptualisation (MUSIC) software and is in accordance with the most current version of the Water by Design MUSIC Modelling Guidelines for South East Queensland. (3) All runoff routing computer modelling undertaken for the design of waterway stability infrastructure is in accordance with: (a) Water by Design's Developing Design Objectives for South East Queensland Report; (b) the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual; (c) the Australian Rainfall and Runoff; (d) the provisions of this section 3.6–Stormwater infrastructure standards of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.6 Stormwater infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-103 3.7 Landscaping standards 3.7.1 Standards for landscaping (1) Landscaping complies with: (a) the standard drawings in Table 8.4.1.1–Standard drawings for landscaping of Part 8– Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy; (b) the standard specifications in Part 9–Standard specifications of this planning scheme policy; (c) Austroads guidelines where non-frangible landscaping is provided. 3.7.2 (1) Coverage of infrastructure Development ensures that the minimum cover to water supply infrastructure, sewerage infrastructure and stormwater infrastructure is maintained in accordance with section 3.3.2– Cover of infrastructure of this planning scheme policy. 3.7.3 (1) Water sensitive urban design Where water sensitive urban design principles are incorporated into the landscaping design, development is in accordance with the Water by Design Guidelines. 3.7.4 (1) Landscaped buffers Where a proposed development abuts an existing development and the planning scheme codes require the provision of landscaping; a planted buffer strip is to be used as follows: (a) locate and landscape a buffer strip or combination planting strip, screen fencing or earthen mound, on the abutting common boundary and within the proposed development; (b) locate and landscape a buffer strip to side and rear building elevations, utility structures, trade entrances, storage and disposal areas, property boundaries and areas of high noise and air pollution generation; (c) specify and detail species and spacing that will provide the total required screening function within 3 years of plant growth; (d) specify and locate district street trees to the frontage of the building; (e) specify and detail an in ground, automatic irrigation system and subsurface or swale drainage system to all landscaped areas and tree stations; (f) specify a concrete dwarf wall or, where appropriate, car stops and bollards to landscaped areas and tree stations that abut road frontages, car park aisles and bays, driveways and any other landscaped area accessible by vehicles. 3.8 Electricity reticulation standards 3.8.1 Underground electricity reticulation 3.8.1.1 Circumstances where underground electricity reticulation is required (1) Underground electricity reticulation is provided to every new registered lot unless otherwise specified in section 3.8.2–Electricity reticulation – overhead of this planning scheme policy. 3.8.1.2 Designing the underground infrastructure network (1) Underground electricity reticulation complies with Energex Subdivision Standards and Specification Underground Distribution and Construction. (2) A shared trench for an electrical conduit is not provided with another service unless it is: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.7 Landscaping standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-104 (3) (a) for a telecommunication service or for a service of the Department of Transport and Main Roads; (b) at a road crossing. An electrical conduit at a road crossing is: (a) at a right angle to the road boundary; or (b) at an angle of up to 45° to the road boundary, where the road crossing is directly between electrical service pillars on both sides of a road. (4) A road crossing for an electrical conduit within an area defined as an intersection under the Transport Operations (Road Use Management - Road Rules) Regulation 1999, is provided on a standard electricity reticulation alignment of 0.3 metres from a projection of the lot boundary. (5) A road crossing for an electrical service pillar conduit is provided at the opposite boundary to a road crossing for a water service conduit unless the road crossing for the: (6) (a) electrical conduit is at an angle of 45°; (b) water service conduit is perpendicular. An electrical service pillar: (a) is not located on a truncated boundary; (b) is located at the; (i) vehicular entry point to the premises; or (ii) side boundary of the premises where on an alternate boundary to a hydrant or water service connection; or (iii) tangent point of a marked boundary; or (iv) entry points to a park. (7) An 11kV entry point to an internal transformer provides a "cabmark" cable marker post approved by the electricity provider at the entry point to the premises. (8) An overhead to an underground cable crosses the verge at right angles to an electrical service pillar of a “cabmark” post in accordance with the electricity provider's standard drawing. 3.8.1.3 Transformers (1) A new transformer is pad mounted (PMT). (2) A pad mounted transformer is located in the road reserve. (3) A pad mounted transformer in road reserve adjacent to a park provides: (a) a screen fence with a minimum height of two metres erected on the boundary of the road adjacent to the park to minimise any negative impacts on visual amenity of the park and road frontage; (b) landscaping, maintained by the electricity provider, adjoining the fence and within the park. (4) The upgrading of an existing pole transformer (PT) occurs only where the replacement pole is at the same location. (5) An existing pole mounted transformer is replaced by a new pole mounted transformer only: (a) where there is no additional pole provided; (b) where there is no extension to the overhead electricity reticulation; (c) for a development of up to five lots where those lots are provided with underground reticulation. 3.8.2 Electricity reticulation - overhead 3.8.2.1 Circumstances where overhead electricity reticulation is provided (1) Overhead electricity reticulation may be provided in the: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.8 Electricity reticulation standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-105 (a) Environmental management and conservation zone; (b) Rural residential zone; (c) Rural zone; (d) in the urban footprint as identified in Figure 3.1-Strategic Intent of Part 3–Strategic framework of the planning scheme as a temporary installation to service the balance area of a development where further development, being a reconfiguring of a lot, is possible and underground electrical reticulation supply can be readily obtained in a further development permit. 3.8.3 Electrical service connection 3.8.3.1 Underground electricity service connection (1) An underground electricity service connection is provided unless specified in section 3.8.3.2(1) of this planning scheme policy. 3.8.3.2 (1) (2) Overhead electricity service connection may be provided: (a) in an urban residential zone where: (i) there is existing overhead electricity reticulation; (ii) it does not involve a new road; (iii) it does not involve a property pole, a cross street service pole or a flying fox overhead property connection; (b) in a rural or rural residential zone where: (i) there is existing overhead electricity reticulation; (ii) it does not involve a new road. (c) in a rural or rural residential zone where new rear lots are created, providing the access handle has a minimum width of 20 metres. Where a new road is created, an underground electricity service connection is provided to all new lots with frontage to the new road. 3.8.3.3 (1) (2) Circumstances where overhead electricity service connection may be provided Designing the overhead service connection An overhead electricity service connection does not result in a connection that crosses: (a) premises other than the premises being serviced; or (b) the road; except in section 3.8.3.2(1) of this planning scheme policy. Where an overhead electricity reticulation pole already services the new premises and is intended to be retained for wider reticulation purposes, development provides an electrical conduit: (a) where the new premises is located on the same side of the road as the electricity reticulation pole: (i) at right angles across the verge to the underground power reticulation alignment, and then parallel to and adjacent the road reserve boundary up to the pillar into the premises being serviced, where the electricity reticulation pole is located within the frontage of the new premises; or (ii) at right angles across the verge from the electricity reticulation pole to the underground electricity alignment, and then parallel to and adjacent the road reserve boundary up to the pillar into the premises being serviced, where the electricity reticulation pole is not located within the frontage of the new premises; (b) where the new premises is located on the opposite side of the road as the electricity reticulation pole, at right angles across the road from the electricity reticulation pole to the underground electricity alignment (with kerb markers at the appropriate locations on both sides of the road crossing), and then parallel to and adjacent the road reserve boundary up to the pillar into the premises being serviced; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.8 Electricity reticulation standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-106 (c) 3.9 by thrust boring under the existing road unless approved otherwise. Gas and telecommunication reticulation standards (1) Gas and telecommunication services are in accordance with the service provider’s requirements. (2) Unless otherwise stipulated by telecommunications legislation at the time of construction, developments must be provided with all necessary conduits, pits and pipes to accommodate the future connection of optic fibre technology telecommunications. 3.9.1 Service trenches (1) Trenches are excavated so that conduits can be laid with a 75mm clearance all around. (2) The bottom of a trench: (a) is firm and smooth; (b) is level or where there is a change in level from the footpath to the roadway or an embankment, the change is gradual. (3) Conduits shall be bedded for 120 degrees of their circumference on at least 75mm of compacted sand or trench backfill material as approved by the local government. (4) Trenches across roadways and pavement areas: (5) (a) are excavated before pavement material has been placed; (b) along footpaths, are excavated before topsoiling and grassing has been carried out; (c) comply with standard drawings in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. The alignments and nominal depths for each utility shall be specified with minimum separation distances. 3.9.2 (1) Coverage of infrastructure The minimum cover to water supply infrastructure, sewerage infrastructure and stormwater infrastructure is maintained in accordance with section 3.3.2–Cover of infrastructure of this planning scheme policy. 3.9.3 (1) Maintenance structures (access chambers) Where filling has occurred over existing infrastructure: (a) maintenance structures are: (i) extended to the new surface level; or (ii) reconstructed to the new surface level; (b) filling adjacent to maintenance structures is retained and shaped to allow access to the maintenance structure where the area around the maintenance structure is self-draining. 3.9.4 (1) (2) Conduits All PVC pipe conduits, joints and couplings comply with: (a) AS/NZS 1477:2006 and Amdt 1:2009 PVC pipes and fittings for pressure applications; (b) AS/NZS 2053.1:2001 Conduits and fittings for electrical installations-general requirements; (c) AS 2439.1-2007 Perforated plastics drainage and effluent pipe and fittings-perforated drainage and associated fittings. Brass marker discs are supplied and installed in accordance with the standard drawings in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.9 Gas and telecommunication reticulation standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-107 (3) 3.10 (1) 3.11 (1) 3.12 Where there is no kerb and channel, concrete marker blocks are constructed in accordance with the standard drawings in Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of Part 8–Standard drawings of this planning scheme policy and the following: (a) using grade N25 concrete; (b) 225mm x 75mm x 450mm long; (c) with indentation for the indicator disc centrally placed on the top face of each block. Water supply infrastructure standards Water supply infrastructure is to be designed and constructed in accordance with the South East Queensland - Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Sewerage infrastructure standards Sewerage infrastructure is to be designed and constructed in accordance with the South East Queensland - Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Park infrastructure standards 3.12.1 Planning the park network (1) The park network is planned in accordance with Part 4–Priority infrastructure plan (section 4.5.5.1 (Park network)) of the planning scheme. 3.12.2 Standards for park (1) Park infrastructure is provided in accordance with Table 3.12.2.1–Design standards for park of this planning scheme policy. Table 3.12.2.1–Design standards for park Column 1 Park classification Column 2 Design standards Local recreation Local recreation park: (a) is fair average land; (b) is on an urban access road in a residential area; (c) is easily accessible for pedestrians and cyclists in accordance with Part 4–Priority infrastructure plan (Table 4.4.5.2–Accessibility standard for park) of the planning scheme; (d) is configured such that the land can be expanded by the addition of adjoining land; (e) has an area in accordance with Table 3.12.3.1–Minimum size of park of this planning scheme policy; (f) is of a compact shape free of irregular boundaries; (g) has a post development flood immunity in accordance with Table 3.12.4.1–Minimum post development flood immunity for park of this planning scheme policy; (h) has a post development grade in accordance with Table 3.12.5.1– Maximum post development grade for park of this planning scheme policy; (i) has road frontage of not less than 50 percent; (j) has vehicular access for maintenance and management purposes; (k) has clear and visible lines of sight from formalised park entries and pedestrian crossings; (l) provides for casual surveillance to and from the park. Planning scheme policy 1–CPTED provides additional guidance; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.10 Water supply infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-108 Table 3.12.2.1–Design standards for park Column 1 Park classification Column 2 Design standards (m) provides embellishments in accordance with Table 3.12.6.1–Typical embellishments for recreation park of this planning scheme policy. Local recreation - Civic park (Village green, Town square and Plaza) Local recreation - Civic park: (a) is fair average land; (b) has a minimum area in accordance with Table 3.12.3.1–Minimum size of park of this planning scheme policy; (c) is square, rectangular or semicircular in shape with a minimum width of 20 metres; (d) has a post development flood immunity in accordance with Table 3.12.4.1–Minimum post development flood immunity for park of this planning scheme policy; (e) has a post development grade in accordance with Table 3.12.5.1– Maximum post development grade for park of this planning scheme policy; (f) has a minimum 50 per cent road frontage, or 25 per cent road frontage where it is integrated with premises with an active frontage; (g) has vehicular access for maintenance and management purposes; (h) has clear and visible lines of sight from formalised park entries and pedestrian crossings; (i) provides for casual surveillance to and from the park. Planning Scheme Policy 1–CPTED provides additional guidance; (j) provides embellishments in accordance with Table 3.12.6.1–Typical embellishments for recreation park of this planning scheme policy. District recreation District recreation park: (a) is fair average land; (b) is adjacent to a trunk road; (c) is easily accessible for pedestrians and cyclists in accordance with Part 4–Priority infrastructure plan (Table 4.4.5.2 - Accessibility standard for park) of the planning scheme; (d) has an area in accordance with Table 3.12.3.1–Minimum size of park of this planning scheme policy; (e) is of a compact shape free of irregular boundaries; (f) has a post development flood immunity in accordance with Table 3.12.4.1–Minimum post development flood immunity for park of this planning scheme policy; (g) has a post development grade in accordance with Table 3.12.5.1– Maximum post development grade for park of this planning scheme policy; (h) has a minimum 40 per cent road frontage; (i) has an area above the defined flood event for locating buildings, structures and facilities liable to damage by flooding; (j) has clear and visible lines of sight from formalised park entries and pedestrian crossings; (k) provides for casual surveillance to and from the park. Planning scheme policy 1–CPTED provides additional guidance; (l) has vehicular access for maintenance and management purposes; (m) provides embellishments in accordance with Table 3.12.6.1–Typical embellishments for recreation park of this planning scheme policy. Metropolitan recreation The land: (a) is fair average land; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.12 Park infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-109 Table 3.12.2.1–Design standards for park Column 1 Park classification Column 2 Design standards (b) is adjacent to a trunk road; (c) is easily accessible for pedestrians and cyclists in accordance with Part 4–Priority infrastructure plan (Table 4.4.5.2–Accessibility standard for park) of the planning scheme; (d) has an area in accordance with Table 3.12.3.1–Minimum size of park of this planning scheme policy; (e) is of a compact shape, free of irregular boundaries; (f) has a post development flood immunity in accordance with Table 3.12.4.1–Minimum post development flood immunity for park of this planning scheme policy; (g) has a post development grade in accordance with Table 3.12.5.1– Maximum post development grade for park of this planning scheme policy; (h) has a minimum 40 per cent road frontage; (i) has clear and visible lines of sight from formalised park entries and pedestrian crossings; (j) provides for casual surveillance to and from the park. Planning scheme policy 1–CPTED provides additional guidance; (k) has an area above the defined flood events for locating buildings, structures and facilities liable to damage by flooding; (l) has vehicular access for maintenance and management purposes; (m) provides embellishments in accordance with Table 3.12.6.1–Typical embellishments for recreation park of this planning scheme policy. Corridor recreation Corridor recreation park: (a) is part of a safe, linked open space and park network; (b) is suitable for cycle and pedestrian paths; (c) has a minimum 40 per cent road frontage; (d) has clear and visible lines of sight from formalised park entries and pedestrian crossings; (e) provides for casual surveillance to and from the park. Planning scheme policy 1–CPTED provides additional guidance; has vehicular access for maintenance and management purposes; (f) does not include: (i) land subject to cut and fill with a batter slope with a batter slope which does not comprise the provisions of (a) to (g); (ii) any land required for stormwater infrastructure; (iii) any areas of land less than 20 metres wide; (g) provides embellishments in accordance with Table 3.12.6.1–Typical embellishments for recreation park of this planning scheme policy. Metropolitan and district sport Metropolitan and district sport park: (a) is fair average land; (b) is adjacent to a trunk road; (c) is easily accessible for pedestrians and cyclists in accordance with Table 4.4.5.2-Accessibility standard for park in Section 4.4.5–Park and land for community facilities network of Part 4–Priority infrastructure plan of the planning scheme; (d) has an area in accordance with Table 3.12.3.1–Minimum size of park of this planning scheme policy; (e) is of a compact shape, free of irregular boundaries; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.12 Park infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-110 Table 3.12.2.1–Design standards for park Column 1 Park classification Column 2 Design standards (f) has a post development flood immunity in accordance with Table 3.12.4.1–Minimum post development flood immunity for park of this planning scheme policy ; (g) has a post development grade in accordance with Table 3.12.5.1– Maximum post development grade for park of this planning scheme policy; (h) has a minimum 40 per cent road frontage; (i) has a minimum 60 per cent of the area suitable for sports fields or courts; (j) is connected to infrastructure including power, water and sewerage; (k) has vehicular access for maintenance, management and emergency vehicle purposes; (l) has clear and visible lines of sight from formalised park entries and pedestrian crossings; (m) provides for casual surveillance to and from the park. Planning scheme policy 1–CPTED provides additional guidance; (n) has an area above the defined flood event for locating buildings, structures and facilities susceptible to damage by flooding; (o) provides embellishments in accordance with Table 3.12.7.1–Typical embellishments for sport park of this planning scheme policy. 3.12.3 Minimum size of park (1) Park size must comply with Table 3.12.3.1–Minimum size of park of this planning scheme policy. Table 3.12.3.1–Minimum size of park Column 1 Column 2 Park classification Minimum size of park (hectares) Urban planning region Growth planning region Rural planning region Local recreation 1 1 Not applicable Local recreation - civic park (town square) 0.2 0.2 Not applicable Local recreation - civic park (village green) 0.2 0.2 Not applicable Local recreation - civic park (plaza) 0.04 0.04 Not applicable District recreation 5 10 10 Metropolitan recreation 10 20 20 District sport 5 10 10 Metropolitan sport 10 20 20 Corridor recreation Not applicable Not applicable Not applicable Note––The network planning areas that comprise the Urban, Growth and Rural planning regions for the park network are identified in Table 4.2.5.6-Park and land for community facilities network-Planned demand summary in section 4.2.5– Infrastructure demand of Part 4–Priority infrastructure plan of the planning scheme. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.12 Park infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-111 3.12.4 Minimum post development flood immunity for park (1) Park flood immunity for park must comply with Table 3.12.4.1–Minimum post development flood immunity for park of this planning scheme policy. Table 3.12.4.1–Minimum post development flood immunity for park Column 1 Column 2 Park classification Post development flood immunity (percentage of minimum size of park) 10 year ARI flood event 50 year ARI flood event 100 year ARI flood event Local recreation 100 75 10 Local recreation - civic park (town square / village green / plaza) 100 100 100 District recreation 100 50 10 Metropolitan recreation 100 50 10 District sport 100 75 10 Metropolitan sport 100 50 10 Corridor recreation Not applicable Not applicable Not applicable Editor's note––The minimum park size for a park is identified in Table 3.12.3.1–Minimum size of park of this planning scheme policy. 3.12.5 Maximum post development grade for park (1) Park post development grade must comply with Table 3.12.5.1–Maximum post development grade for park of this planning scheme policy. Table 3.12.5.1–Maximum post development grade for park Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Park classification Maximum grade (percent) Percentage of minimum size of park having a post development grade less than the maximum grade Urban planning area Growth planning area Rural planning area Local recreation 5 50 50 Not applicable Local recreation - civic park (town square / village green / plaza) 2 75 75 Not applicable District recreation 5 30 30 30 Metropolitan recreation 5 25 25 25 District sport 2 60 60 60 Metropolitan sport 2 60 60 60 Editor's note––The minimum park size for a park is identified in Table 3.12.3.1–Minimum size of park. 3.12.6 Typical embellishments for recreation park (1) Embellishments for recreation park are listed in Table 3.12.6.1–Typical embellishments for recreation park of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.12 Park infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-112 Table 3.12.6.1–Typical embellishments for recreation park Column 1 Column 2 Embellishment type Recreation park Activity areas Local District Metropolitan Corridor Yes 11 Yes 42 Yes 82 No Local - Civic (Town square / village green / plaza) Yes 13 Note––1. Local recreation parks should desirably provide a limited number of discrete activity areas for basic recreation, allowing for a few separate groups to safely share the facility. Note––2. District and metropolitan recreation parks provide several discrete activity areas allowing numerous separate groups to safely share the facility. Activity areas cater for specific recreational pursuits including but not limited to young play, major barbecue and picnics, skating/freestyle biking, informal court sport, kick-about, dog off leash and special events. Note––3. Civic parks provide formalised spaces in an urbanised environment. Structured activity areas are designed to integrate with internal and external pathways and the surrounding community facilities. Activity areas are formalised through landscaping and the inclusion of purpose designed event space including but not limited to outdoor stages or auditoriums and hard surface spaces. Artwork No site specific on merit Yes Yes No Yes major interactive Barbecue No Yes Yes No Yes Village green only Bins Yes 2 units Yes 6 units Yes 20 units Yes 1 unit Yes Plaza 1 unit; Village green or town square 2 units Ceremonial space No No Site specific on merit Yes 1 unit No No Site specific on merit Covered seating and table Yes 2m² / 10,000m² Yes 2m² / 10,000m² Yes 2m² / 10,000m² No Yes Village green only 1m² / 1,000 Dog off-leash Site specific on merit Yes Yes No No Potable water Yes 1 unit Yes 4 units Yes 8 units Yes 1 unit / 5km Yes Plaza 1 unit; Village green or Town square 2 units Fencing / bollards / locking rail Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Fitness equipment Yes Yes Yes Yes No Half court Yes Yes Yes No No Internal roads No Yes Yes No No Interpretative signage Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.12 Park infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-113 Table 3.12.6.1–Typical embellishments for recreation park Column 1 Column 2 Embellishment type Recreation park Local District Metropolitan Corridor Local - Civic (Town square / village green / plaza) Landscaping Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Lighting Yes minor 4 units Yes moderate 12 units Yes major 80 units Yes pathway Yes Major Plaza 2 units; Village green or town square 4 units Parking Yes kerbside Yes moderate 40 bays Yes major 120 bays including bus parking and turnaround or pull through No Yes kerbside Pathways/ cycleways / trails Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Platforms / pontoons No Yes Yes No site specific on merit No Multi-activity Play space Yes 300m² soft fall footprint Yes 450m² soft fall footprint Yes 600m² soft fall footprint No No Seating Yes 3 units Yes 6 units Yes 15 units Yes Yes 4m² / 500m² Shading Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Signage Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Skate bowls No Yes Yes No No Surveillance cameras Yes mobile Yes 1 facility Yes 2 facilities No site specific on merit Yes 1 facility Toilets No Yes 1 facility Yes 2 facilities No Yes Village green and town square only 2 facilities 3.12.7 Typical embellishments for sport park (1) The embellishments for sport park are listed in Table 3.12.7.1–Typical embellishments for sport park of this planning scheme policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.12 Park infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-114 Table 3.12.7.1–Typical embellishments for sport park Column 1 Column 2 Embellishment type Sport park District Metropolitan Artwork No site specific on merit Yes interactive Barbecue No Yes 3 facilities Drainage Yes Yes Potable water Yes 6 units Yes 25 units (2 connections) Fencing/bollards/ locking rail Yes Yes Fields / courts Yes 2 rectangular fields and 1 oval Yes 5 rectangular fields, 2 ovals and 6 courts Note––District and metropolitan sport parks provide several discrete playing fields and court facilities allowing numerous separate sporting groups to safely share the facility. Field / court lighting Yes 2 rectangular fields; and 1 oval - competition standard Yes 6 courts; 5 rectangular fields; 3 rectangular fields; and 2 ovals Note––The standard of lighting to be provided at sport parks will be commensurate with the level of use and standard of competition. Where necessary this lighting may be provided to a national competition standard. Goal posts / line marking Yes Yes Internal roads Yes Yes Irrigation Yes Yes Landscaping and earthworks Yes Yes major Lighting (path / activity areas) Yes 8 units Yes 20 units Parking Yes 80 bays including bus parking and turnaround or pull through Yes 400 bays including bus parking and turnaround or pull through Paths Yes Yes Multi-activity play space Yes 300m² soft fall footprint Yes 450m² soft fall footprint Safety fencing Yes Yes Scoreboard Yes 2 units Yes 3 units Signage Yes Yes Spectator seating Yes 20 units Yes 100 units and grandstand seating Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.12 Park infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-115 Table 3.12.7.1–Typical embellishments for sport park Column 1 Column 2 Embellishment type Sport park District Metropolitan Note––The standard of spectator seating to be provided will be commensurate with the level of demand and standard of competition. Sufficient spectator seating will be provided where required to cater for a regional level sporting competition. Sports club facility Yes Yes Surveillance cameras Yes 1 unit Yes 2 units Toilets Yes 1 facility Yes 2 facilities Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 3.12 Park infrastructure standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-116 Part 4 4.1 (1) Guidelines Guidelines for satisfying Flood hazard overlay code Table 4.1.1–Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcomes of the Flood hazard overlay of this planning scheme policy identifies in: (a) column 1, the performance outcome of the flood hazard overlay code; (b) column 2, the guidelines for satisfying the performance outcome. Table 4.1.1–Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcomes of the Flood hazard overlay Column 1 Column 2 Performance outcomes of the Flood hazard overlay code Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcome Risk to people and property PO5 A car park other than a Parking station is only located below the flood level during the defined flood event where there is no increase in risk to: (a) pedestrian and vehicular safety; (b) a building or other structure. (a) Development, being a single car parking space, carport or similar located below the flood level of the defined flood event and not used for storage, is to be designed with finished floor levels at or above the ground level. (b) Development, being more than one car parking space, may be located below the flood level of the defined flood event provided that the following are achieved: (i) any increase in stormwater runoff is mitigated; (ii) car park access is inundated to a maximum depth of 300 millimetres; (iii) car park, excluding access, is inundated to a maximum depth of 600 millimetres; (iv) the depth multiplied by velocity safety standards of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual and equation 3.14.2 (Depth and velocity safety standards). (c) Development, being an open car park not located under a building or structure is to be designed and constructed so that it achieves the following during flood events up to the Defined flood event: (i) is inundated to a maximum depth of 600 millimetres; (ii) complies with the requirements specified in Table 7.03.1 (Flow depth and width limitations) of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual; (iii) achieves a maximum depth multiplied by velocity value of 0.4m2/s; (iv) achieves adequate flood warning times. (d) Development, being a car park located underneath a building or structure which is on stilts and not enclosed, as depicted in Figure 4.1.1–Open car parking located under building built on stilts of this planning scheme policy is to achieve the following: (i) the requirements of open car parking contained in subsection (c); (ii) allow the flow of flood water through the car park without impediment; (iii) preserve flood plain storage. (e) Development, being a car park located underneath a building where less than 50 percent of the total perimeter is enclosed is to achieve the following: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.1 Guidelines for satisfying Flood hazard overlay code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-117 Column 1 Column 2 Performance outcomes of the Flood hazard overlay code Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcome (i) the requirements of open car parking contained in subsection (c); (ii) allow the flow of flood water through the car park without impediment or causing adverse flood impacts external to the site; (iii) preserve flood plain storage. (f) Development, being a car park located underneath a building with more than 50% of the total perimeter is enclosed, as depicted in Figure 4.1.2–Car park under a building with more than 50% enclosed area of this planning scheme policy is to achieve the following: (i) the requirements of open car parking contained in subsection (c); (ii) be used only in highly constrained sites; (iii) provide compensatory flood plain storage; (iv) provide an alternative, secondary pedestrian access to facilitate safe exit. (g) Development, being a car park located underneath a building with more than 50% of the total perimeter is enclosed and part or all of the car park below ground level, as depicted in Figure 4.1.3–Car parking under a building with more than 50% of car parking area located below surface level of this planning scheme policy, is only acceptable if the development: (i) achieves the requirements of open car parking contained in sub-section (c); (ii) provides compensatory flood plain storage; (iii) provides an alternative, secondary pedestrian access to facilitate safe exit; (iv) provides adequate flood warning; (v) the car park entrance is located, where possible, outside the flood plain area. Flood storage and discharge capacity PO8 The natural conveyance of flood waters and natural overland flow paths are protected and maintained without adversely affecting adjoining premises. (a) An overland flow path is designed to achieve the following— (i) convey the unmitigated 100 year ARI storm event; (ii) is designed in accordance with section 9 of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual, Australian Rainfall and Runoff and the Brisbane City Council Technical Design Guidelines for Natural Channel Design; (iii) the existing overland flow paths are retained, maintained and protected; (iv) the existing waterway values are protected, enhanced and rehabilitated; (v) the waterway stream flow lengths are not reduced; (vi) no worsening of an overland flow path and potential associated flooding; (vii) a minimum 500 millimetre freeboard between the overland flow path 100 year ARI flow level and all finished floor levels; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.1 Guidelines for satisfying Flood hazard overlay code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-118 Column 1 Column 2 Performance outcomes of the Flood hazard overlay code Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcome (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) (h) (viii) a naturalised channel design. The overland flow path is to be contained entirely within any of the following: (i) the road reserve; (ii) a drainage reserve; (iii) an overland flow path obtained through a park, open space or local government easement. Where modification of the overland flow path is unavoidable or necessary, the new overland flow path design is to comply with the following requirements of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual: (i) conform to the principle of no worsening; (ii) not increase the duration of the flood; (iii) not result in the loss of or changes to flood paths; (iv) not reduce flood warning times; (v) not reduce flood storage; (vi) provide beneficial environmental enhancement. With respect to overland flow path hydrology and associated design, overland flow is comprised of both sheet flow and concentrated flow. Development is to ensure that the maximum overland sheet flow length is: (i) 50 metres in urban areas; or (ii) 200 metres in rural residential areas. (iii) Development is to ensure that overland sheet flow travel time is calculated using either: (A) Friend’s Equation; or (B) the Kinematic Wave Equation. Concentrated overland flow path travel time is to be determined using Manning's equation and fall within the accepted time periods identified in the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. Development in a rural residential area is to ensure that either an overland flow path is preserved or an open channel is constructed to achieve the following: (i) the depth multiplied by velocity safety provisions of the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual and equation 3.14.2 (Depth and velocity safety standards); (ii) a minimum freeboard of 500 millimetres to all finished floor levels within the site; (iii) the batter slopes on any swale are no greater than 1:4 (V:H). Development in a rural residential area is to ensure that where an overland flow path is conveyed within a road on site: (i) the maximum depth within kerb and channel is 300 millimetres; (ii) a minimum freeboard of 500 millimetres is provided to all finished floor levels within the site. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.1 Guidelines for satisfying Flood hazard overlay code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-119 Column 1 Column 2 Performance outcomes of the Flood hazard overlay code Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcome PO9 Development (or development in combination with other development) for all flood events up to and including the defined flood event does not: (a) cause or have the potential to cause damage; (b) cause ponding of flood water; (c) adversely affect the flood discharge capacity of the floodplain; (d) decrease the flood resilience of properties and infrastructure; (e) cause a cumulative increase in flood levels external to the premises. Achieving this performance outcome needs to be demonstrated through the submission of a flood study report in accordance with section 2.5.1–Flood study report of this planning scheme policy. PO10 Any loss of floodplain storage is compensated with compensatory storage or excavation that: (a) is of equal volume, creating a balance of cut to fill; (b) is free draining; (c) is located within the premises; (d) does not adversely affect the hydraulic conveyance capacity of the flood channel or floodplain; (e) is provided to the corresponding flood level; (f) is landscaped to provide visual amenity and erosion control; (g) is solely for the purpose of compensatory storage. (a) Development, being earthworks, within the flood plain is not to create isolated or non-connected areas of development. (b) Where development results in the loss of flood plain storage capacity, compensatory storage or excavation is to (as depicted in Figure 4.1.4–Earthworks within the floodplain of this planning scheme policy be provided to achieve the following: (i) it is of equal or greater volume to the flood plain storage lost, thus creating a balance of cut to fill; (ii) has a depth-conveyance relationship that is similar to the pre-development depth-conveyance relationship; (iii) it is free draining; (iv) it is located within the premises; (v) it maintains the flood plain function and conveyance; (vi) it has no adverse impact on the hydraulic capacity of the flood channel or flood plain; (vii) it is provided at the corresponding level to that at which the fill occurred; (viii) it results in no increased risk of flooding or impact from flooding on any other property; (ix) it is solely for the purpose of compensatory excavation and storage. (c) Development, being earthworks required for providing a stormwater network (except in the case of open drainage channels) cannot be used as compensatory cut. (d) Any permanent or temporary storage of material on site within the flood plain occurring above the flood level of the 10 year average recurrence interval is to be treated as fill and thus constitute a loss of flood plain storage. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.1 Guidelines for satisfying Flood hazard overlay code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-120 Column 1 Column 2 Performance outcomes of the Flood hazard overlay code Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcome PO11 Development does not adversely change the following flood characteristics for all flood events up to and including the defined flood event: (a) peak flow; (b) flow of any part of the flood before the peak; (c) flood flow velocity; (d) level of flooding; (e) flood time to peak. (a) Development is to achieve the principle of no worsening, in accordance with the Queensland Urban Drainage Manual. (b) In achieving the principle of no worsening, development is to achieve the following: (i) not result in a detrimental impact on the flooding, or flood risk of any area; (ii) not result in adverse impacts of any other property in terms of changes in peak discharge, flood levels, the frequency of flooding, flow velocities, water quality, sedimentation or scour effects for all events up to and including the defined flood event and the major storm event; (iii) not result in an increase in peak discharge as depicted in Figure 3.6.2.10.1–Peak discharge and allowable change or level for the 2, 5, 10, 20, 50 and 100 year average recurrence interval event of this planning scheme policy; (iv) ensure that the time of concentration to the peak of the event does not decrease and where it increases, consideration is given to the impacts up and downstream of the property boundary so as to ensure runoff from the site does not bring the hydrograph peak closer to coincidence with the peak flow in adjoining catchments; (v) undertake modelling upstream of the site and where appropriate downstream of the site. Filling and excavation PO14 Filling and excavation is carried out above the level of the 10 percent AEP event to protect in stream and banks of a waterway and wetland. Earthworks on a floodplain may be considered where: (a) flooding is predominantly due to backflow; (b) the peak velocity is less than the maximum permissible velocity for considerable bare earth channels (typically 0.5m/sec) in accordance with Table 9.05.3 of Queensland Urban Drainage Manual 2007; (c) the cut/fill batter is not steeper than 1V:4H and the exposed earth surface is landscaped with erosion resistant vegetation cover. Access PO15 Development provides vehicular access to a road network that is sufficient to enable safe access and egress. Development is to, during events up to and including the defined flood event, provide access to the road network via: (a) an access which is above the flood level of the defined flood event or is low flood hazard; or (b) a secondary access route which is above the flood level of the defined flood event or is low flood hazard; or (c) a temporary access arrangement which is above the flood level of the defined flood event or is low flood hazard and can be implemented without significant preparation being required. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.1 Guidelines for satisfying Flood hazard overlay code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-121 Column 1 Column 2 Performance outcomes of the Flood hazard overlay code Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcome PO16 Development provides an access area to a building or fill area on which a building is to be constructed where the access is located on land classified as a low flood hazard in the defined flood event. Development where an internal road is proposed is to achieve a low flood hazard internal road network. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.1 Guidelines for satisfying Flood hazard overlay code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-122 Figure 4.1.1–Open car parking located under building built on stilts Figure 4.1.2–Car park under a building with more than 50% enclosed area Figure 4.1.3–Car parking under a building with more than 50% of car parking area located below surface level Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.1 Guidelines for satisfying Flood hazard overlay code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-123 Figure 4.1.4–Earthworks within the floodplain natural ground level minimum freeboard - 500mm finished floor level A fill taken from within the site Defined Flood Event new surface level B Defined Limit compensatory cut within the site (free draining) 10year ARI Editor's note––Compensatory cut volume (B) must equal fill within the site (A). A is only the volume of fill within the site that is at or below the defined flood level. 'Fill taken from within the site' may be imported material so long as it is equivalent in v olume as the compensatory cut and all excavated material is removed from the flood plain. Where preferable, fill should be provided from site material. All earthworks must occur above the defined limit. Editor's note––’Development as drawn will change the fundamental stage-storage relationship and how the floodplain storage will function in a hydrodynamic sense. If this is within a core or peripheral floodway area, it will change the natural conveyance mechanism. The net impacts will have to be determined by hydrodynamic computer modelling to assess the net effects. These will need to be addressed in the flood modelling report which should include graphs of stage-storage and stage-conveyance relationships in the report. The report should also show the pre and post development hydrographs above, across and below the earthworks area as well as at any point downstream where there is an existing flood risk. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.1 Guidelines for satisfying Flood hazard overlay code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-124 4.2 (1) Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Table 4.2.1–Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcomes of the landscape code of this planning scheme policy identifies in: (a) column 1, the performance outcome of the landscape code; (b) column 2, the guidelines for satisfying the performance outcome. Table 4.2.1–Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcomes of the landscape code Column 1 Column 2 Performance outcomes of the Landscape code Guidelines for satisfying the performance outcome PO1 Development provides landscaping that is designed and located to: (a) enhance the visual amenity of premises; (b) provide street trees; (c) protect the movement network by: (i) maintaining pedestrian accessibility; (ii) not obstructing sightlines for pedestrians, cyclists and motorists; (iii) being consistent with the function of the road; (iv) being of a scale that is in proportion with the road width. (d) be responsive to and compatible with soil conditions, topography and micro climate; (e) utilise species selection that: (i) is suitable for the available space and growing conditions; (ii) incorporates, where practicable, native vegetation in public open space and roads; (f) protect, where practicable, existing native trees; (g) conserve energy and water; (h) incorporate water sensitive urban design principles; (i) prevent pondage and manage overland flow; (j) act as a buffer to screen adverse visual impact of development and incompatible uses; (k) rehabilitate degraded areas on the premises; (l) be easily maintained. (a) Landscaping is designed and located to enhance visual amenity of premises by: (i) being compatible with the planned scale of a building and structure; (ii) integrating with the built form; (iii) facilitating a safe, comfortable and attractive movement network; (iv) providing visual interest through the use of form, texture and variations in colour. (b) Landscaping provides street trees that are in accordance with Table 4.2.2–Street landscape typologies of this planning scheme policy and Table 4.2.3–Strategies for street landscape typologies of this planning scheme policy. (c) Existing and proposed site conditions should be identified to ensure that landscaping appropriately responds to the site conditions in accordance with section 2.3.3– Landscape site analysis and section 2.3.4–Landscape concept plan of this planning scheme policy. (d) Landscaping uses easily maintained species which conserve energy and water in accordance with Table 4.2.4–Indicative street tree list; Table 4.2.5–Indicative shrub list; Table 4.2.6–Indicative ground cover list and Table 4.2.7-Indicative native grasses list of this planning scheme policy. (e) Landscaping uses Water Sensitive Urban design (WSUD) objectives for street landscaping and is applied in conjunction with objectives identified in Healthy Waterways Sensitive Urban Design Technical Guidelines for South East Queensland. (f) Existing native trees are protected, where practicable, in accordance with AS 4970 - Protection of trees on development sites. (g) Landscape works include species selection and treatments to conserve use of energy and water in accordance with Part 5–Hardworks, Part 6–Softworks and Part 7–Maintenance of Standard Specification No. 2– Landscaping 2015 of this planning scheme policy. (h) Landscaping is designed to prevent pondage and to manage overland flow and incorporates the use of swales, streetscape bioretention basins, medians and kerbs as well as the strategies contained in Column 2 of Table 4.2.3–Strategies for street landscape typologies of this planning scheme policy. Figure 4.2.14 to Figure Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-125 4.2.21 of this planning scheme policy provide guidance on the design of swales, bioretention basins, medians and kerbs. (i) Buffer planting that consists of trees, shrubs and groundcovers are in accordance with Part 5–Hardworks, Part 6–Softworks and Part 7–Maintenance of Standard Specification No. 2–Landscaping 2015 of this planning scheme policy. (j) Rehabilitation of degraded areas is in accordance with section 6.5–Rehabilitation planting of Standard Specification No. 2–Landscaping 2015 of this planning scheme policy. Table 4.2.2–Street landscape typologies Road types Street landscape typologies Figure number Non urban Access Rural Access Typology 1 Figure 4.2.1 Collector* Rural Collector Typology 2 Figure 4.2.2 Arterial* Rural Arterial Single Carriageway Typology 3 Figure 4.2.3 Rural Arterial Dual Carriageway Typology 4 Figure 4.2.4 Urban Access Street Typology 5 Figure 4.2.5 Urban Access Road Typology 6 Figure 4.2.6 Urban Collector single carriageway Typology 7 Figure 4.2.7 Urban Collector Dual Carriageway Typology 8 Figure 4.2.8 Urban Arterial Single Carriageway Typology 9 Figure 4.2.9 Urban Arterial Dual Carriageway Typology 10 Figure 4.2.10 Access Industrial Access Typology 11 Figure 4.2.11 Collector Industrial Collector Typology 12 Figure 4.2.12 Main Street Typology 13 Figure 4.2.13 Urban Access Collector* Arterial* Industrial Urban Centre Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-126 Notes: 1. Refer Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards for road design standards and Figure 3.4.1.4.1– Road network for road network map of this planning scheme policy. 2. The street landscape typologies show the location of footpaths (1.5m wide) and shared pedestrian/cycle paths (2.5m) wide. Principal and Major cycle routes will have either 3m wide shared paths or a 3m exclusive cycle path with a separate 1.5m footpath alongside (refer note 7 in Table 3.4.4.2.1–Road design standards of this planning scheme policy). This will necessitate a wider verge on one side of the road than shown in the typologies. * Collector and Arterial roads may be designated as multi-modal roads on secondary public transport routes (refer Figure 3.4.1.3.1–Public transport network of this planning scheme policy). On multi-modal roads the parking/shoulder and bike lanes are replaced by 4.5m wide transit lanes. Table 4.2.3–Strategies for street landscape typologies Column 1 Column 2 Land use category Strategies Non-urban Maintain view lines through appropriate selection of plants; Plant trees to frame views; Ensure new vegetation does not block views of existing features; Locate new roads around significant vegetation; Roads are to be widened in one direction in order to maintain roadside vegetation on a least one side; Maintain wide verges incorporating drainage swales; Maintain flush kerbs for natural drainage; Supplement existing vegetation with informal clusters of street tree planting of native species; Roundabout should incorporate native trees and shrubs; Road shoulders should be grassed to enable slashing; Kerb and channel and nature strips are avoided to reduce costs and maintain non-urban character; Encourage wide verges with grassed or planted swales; Utilise run off from surrounding property to irrigate vegetation; Incorporate footpaths and cycle ways on main routes to centres and community facilities; Utilise existing road side vegetation for shade to pedestrians; Supplement existing vegetation with informal street tree and mass planting of native species; Provide off road recreation trails on rural collector and arterial roads for safety and amenity. Urban Street trees are to be incorporated into the road landscape where possible; Where a street contains overhead power lines, shade trees and a footpath are to be located on the opposite side of the street; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-127 Encourage the provision of wider verges or medians where possible to allow for street tree planting; Utilise drought tolerant native plants; Utilise low maintenance plants that do not require regular pruning; Discourage the use of high fences adjacent to street so as to optimise surveillance and access from adjacent residential development to the street; In locations where fences are required, mitigate the visual impact through landscape planting treatments; Provide pedestrian permeability at the end of cul de sacs with casual surveillance; Maintain native vegetation in a new developments where possible; Reinforce existing native vegetation by planting indigenous species; Improve access to community facilities with appropriate streetscape treatment and pedestrian access; Define local identity through gateway tree planting and neighbourhood parks; Provide shaded paths on at least one side of every street for pedestrians; In existing development where wide verges are present, incorporate grassed or planted swales; In new development, incorporate flush kerbs with bollards for water drainage into streetscape bioretention systems. Industrial Retain appropriate vegetation in new developments; Incorporate large scale street trees in road verges and kerb build outs; Utilise planted medians; Provide appropriate locations for bus stops with shade and seating; Provide shaded pedestrian and cycle paths integrated with public transport routes; Incorporate wide verges for planted swales and detention basin in new development; Incorporate storage for appropriate water reuse; Incorporate localised detention basins in existing development where possible; Utilise flush kerbs and swales to roadside for streetscape bioretention systems Centres Reduce car priority and road speed by reducing lane widths an increasing verge widths to allow for tree planting; Combine street tree planting with other street furnishings such as seating and lighting; Utilise street tree species that contribute to the character of the centre; Create a streetscape that highlights the natural and cultural qualities of the local area to establish a strong identity; Use drought tolerant plants; Use low maintenance plants that do not require regular pruning; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-128 Incorporate street trees into the street landscape to achieve continuous cover of the tree canopy over the footpath at maturity; Widen verge space and incorporate kerb build outs or medians where possible to allow for street tree planting; Convert existing garden beds into localised detention basins by breaking through kerbs in low points for water drainage into garden beds; Incorporate permeable paving into hard stand areas; Provide for irrigation from tank supply and or passive collection of runoff. Figure 4.2.1–Rural Access Road - Typology 1 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-129 Figure 4.2.2–Rural Collector - Typology 2 Figure 4.2.3–Rural Arterial Single Carriageway - Typology 3 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-130 Figure 4.2.4–Rural Arterial Dual Carriageway - Typology 4 Figure 4.2.5–Urban Access Street - Typology 5 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-131 Figure 4.2.6–Urban Access Road - Typology 6 Figure 4.2.7–Urban Collector Single Carriageway - Typology 7 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-132 Figure 4.2.8–Urban Collector Dual Carriageway - Typology 8 Figure 4.2.9–Urban Arterial Single Carriageway - Typology 9 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-133 Figure 4.2.10–Urban Arterial Dual Carriageway - Typology 10 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-134 Figure 4.2.11–Industrial Access - Typology 11 Figure 4.2.12–Industrial Collector - Typology 12 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-135 Figure 4.2.13–Main Street - Typology 13 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-136 Figure 4.2.14–Examples of indicative swales Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-137 Figure 4.2.15–Indicative swale designs Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-138 Figure 4.2.16–Indicative bioretention basin design and examples Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-139 Figure 4.2.17–Indicative centre median treatment one Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-140 Figure 4.2.18–Indicative centre median treatment two Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-141 Figure 4.2.19–Indicative centre median treatment three Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-142 Figure 4.2.20–Indicative kerb designs Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-143 Figure 4.2.21–Indicative kerb build out designs Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-144 Table 4.2.4–Indicative street tree list Species Common name Suitable for: Verge planting Roundabout Median planting Under power lines Allocasuarina littoralis Black sheoak Allocasuarina torulosa Forest oak Banksia integrifolia Coastal banksia Barklya syringifolia Crown of gold Brachychiton acerifolius Illawarra flame tree Backhousia citriodora Lemon scented myrtle Backhousia myrtifolia Cinnamon myrtle Bolusanthus speciosus Tree wisteria Buckinghamia celsissima Ivory curl flower Callistemon salignus Willow bottlebrush Callistemon viminalis Weeping bottlebrush Casuarina cunninghamina River she-oak Casuarina glauca Swamp oak Cupaniopsis anacardiodes Tuckeroo Elaeocarpus reticulatis Blueberry ash Elaeocarpus grandis Blue quandong Elaeocarpus emundi Smooth-leaved quandong Flindersia australis Crows ash Fraxinus griffithii Griffith’s ash Grevillea banksii Red silky oak Grevillea robusta Silky oak Glochidion ferdinandii Cheese tree Harpullia pendula Tulipwood Lagerstroemia indica Crape myrtle Lepiderema pulchella Fine-leaved tuckeroo Lophostemon confertus Brush box Lophostemon suaveolens Swamp box Melicope elleryana Pink doughwood Neolitsea dealbata White bolly gum Notelaea longifolia Long-leaved mock olive Podocarpus elatus Plum pine Pullea stutzeri Hard alder Rhodomyrtus psidioides Native guava Schotia brachypetala Weeping schotia Stenocarpus sinuatus Firewheel tree Syzygium francisii Giant water gum Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-145 Species Common name Suitable for: Verge planting Syzygium leuhmanii Small-leaved lilly pilly Tristaniopsis laurina Water gum Xanthostemon chrysanthus Golden penda Roundabout Median planting Under power lines Table 4.2.5–Indicative shrub list Species Common name Austromyrtus dulcis Midyim Banksia (Dwarf species) Banksia Bauhinia galpinii Orchid tree Bauhinia croymbosa Orchid tree Bauhinia multinervia Petite bauhinia Calliandra species Powder puff Callistemon species Bottlebrushes Callistemon salignus White bottlebrush Callistemon viminalis Weeping bottlebrush Camellia reticulata Camillea Cordyline rubra Cordyline Doryanthes excelsa Gymea lily Ficus microcarpa 'Green Island' Chinese banyan Hibiscus heterophyllus Native hibiscus Leptospermum species Tea tree Melaleuca species Paperbarks Strelitzia reginae Bird of paradise Syzgium australe ‘Tiny Trev’ ‘Tiny Trev’ lilly pilly Westringia 'Wynyabbie Gem' Coastal rosemary Westringia fruticosa Coastal rosemary Table 4.2.6–Indicative ground cover list Species Common name Agapanthus varieties Agapanthus Brachyscome basaltica Swamp daisy Callistemon ‘Little John’ Dwarf bottlebrush Callistemon viminalis ‘Rose Opal’ ‘Rose Opal’ bottlebrush Chrysocephalum apiculatum Yellow buttons Cissus antarctica Kangaroo vine Crinum pedunculatum Swamp lily Dietes bicolour Fortnight lily Eustrephus latifolius Wombat berry Evolvulus pilosus 'Blue Sapphire' Shaggy dwarf morning glory Gardenia radicans Creeping gardenia Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-146 Species Common name Geitonoplesium cymosum Scrambling lily Grevillea ‘Poorinda Royal Mantle’ Grevillea ‘Poorinda Royal Mantle’ Grevillea ‘Red Ruby’ Grevillea ‘Red Ruby’ Helichrysum species Helichrysum Hemerocallis hybrids Daylilies Hibbertia species Guinea flower Jasminium didymium subsp. racemosum Native jasmine Jasminium simplicifolium subsp. australiense Native jasmine Jasminium suavissimum Native jasmine Liriope muscari ‘Evergreen Giant’ Turf lily Liriope ‘Stripy White’ Variegated turf lily Myoporum ellipticum Coastal myoporum Myoporum parvifolium Creeping boobialla Pandorea jasminodes Bower of beauty Pandorea pandorana Wonga wonga Patersonia sericea Silky purple flag Pseuderanthemum variable Love flower Xerochrysum bracteatum Golden everlasting Table 4.2.7-Indicative native grasses list Species Common name Use in streetscape bioretention systems Carex appressa Tall sedge Crinum pedunculatum Swamp lily Dianella caerulea Blue flax lily Dianella revolute 'Little Rev' ‘Little Rev’ lily Dianella revolute var. revoluta Flax lily Gahnia sieberiana Red-fruited saw sedge Isolepsis nodosa Knobby club rush Juncus flavidus Yellow rush Juncus usitatus Common rush Lepidosperma laterale Variable sword sedge Lomandra confertifolia Mat rush Lomandra filiformis Wattle mat-rush Lomandra hystrix Slender mat rush Lomandra longifolia Mat rush Lomandra multiflora Club rush Ottochloa gracillima Graceful ottochloa Persicaria decipiens Slender knotweed Poa labillardieri Common tussock grass Themeda australis cv 'Mingo' Dwarf blue kangaroo grass Themeda trianda Kangaroo grass Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 4.2 Guidelines for satisfying the landscape code Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-147 Part 5 Local government infrastructure work 5.1 Preliminary 5.1.1 Purpose of Part 5 (1) The purpose of Part 5–Local government infrastructure work of this planning scheme policy is to identify: (a) the administrative steps for carrying out local government infrastructure work; (b) the inspections and testing regime for local government infrastructure work; (c) when local government infrastructure work will be accepted on-maintenance; (d) when local government infrastructure work will be accepted off-maintenance. 5.2 Pre-construction 5.2.1 Pre-start meeting (1) The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that a pre-start meeting is conducted on the premises between the engineer, the consultant and the contractor before the local government infrastructure work commences on the premises (the pre-start meeting). (2) The pre-start meeting must be based on an agenda which includes: (3) (a) the introduction of the engineer, consultant and contractor; (b) a review of the conditions of the development approval; (c) a review of the standard specifications applicable to the local government infrastructure work; (d) the inspection and identification of any areas of park or plants which are to be retained on the premises; (e) a review of the proposed sediment and erosion control measures; (f) the provision of job construction details and the construction program to the engineer by the consultant; (g) discussion of workplace health and safety issues; (h) the provision of the name of the responsible contractor to the engineer, who has received a notice of appointment of principal contractor under the Workplace Health and Safety Act 1995 by the consultant; (i) any other relevant matters specified by the person who has the benefit of the development approval, the consultant, the engineer and the contractor. The person who has the benefit of the development approval must, at least 24 hours before the local government infrastructure work commences on the premises, advise the local government of: (a) the name, address, telephone number and after hours telephone number of the consultant supervising the local government infrastructure work; (b) the name, address, telephone number and after hours telephone number of the contractor and any major sub-contractor carrying out the local government infrastructure work; (c) the intended date of commencement of the local government infrastructure work and the contract period. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.1 Preliminary Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-148 5.3 Inspection and testing 5.3.1 Compliance with inspection and testing plan (1) (2) The person who has the benefit of the development approval must comply with the inspection and testing plan for engineering work in: (a) Table 5.3.1.1–Part 1 of inspection and testing plan of this planning scheme policy; (b) Table 5.3.1.2–Part 2 of inspection and testing plan of this planning scheme policy; (c) Table 5.3.1.3–Part 3 of inspection and testing plan of this planning scheme policy. The results of each test must: (a) meet the specified standard; (b) be repeated after removal work has been carried out if a test does not meet the specified standard; (c) for water supply and sewerage infrastructure, be undertaken by a REPQ Consultant Engineer (i.e. supervise, conduct inspections and testings) in accordance with Table 5.3.1.1Table 5.3.1.1–Part 1 of inspection and testing plan of this planning scheme policy. (3) Water and sewerage infrastructure inspection and testing is required to comply to the requirements in the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. (4) The REPQ Consultant Engineer may conduct audit inspections on all donated water supply and sewerage asset installations at the discretion of the Engineer. Table 5.3.1.1–Part 1 of inspection and testing plan Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Element of works Test Standard Frequency Bulk filling and excavation Lot filling. Filling of a dam. Quality of material. Visual. Compaction. AS 1289.5.1.1: 2003: Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes Soil compaction and density tests Determination of the dry density/moisture content relation of a soil using standard compactive method. 95% Standard. Compaction. AS 1289.5.1.1: 2003: Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes Soil compaction and density tests Determination of the dry density/moisture content relation of a soil using standard compactive method 95% Standard. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 AS 3798: 2007: Guidelines on earthworks for commercial and residential developments, Table 8.1 Type 1. AS 3798: 2007: Guidelines on earthworks for commercial and residential developments, Table 8.1 Type 1. Sc6.2.5-149 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Element of works Test Standard Frequency Roads and stormwater drainage Road embankments and fill. Subgrade. Quality of material. Grading, Atterberg Limits, and 4 day soaked CBR tests (in situ). AS 3798:2007: Guidelines on earthworks for commercial and residential developments. One test per each job or one test per each type of material. Compaction. AS 1289.5.1.1: 2003: Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes Soil compaction and density tests Determination of the dry density/moisture content relation of a soil using standard compactive method Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme policy. One test per every 100m length per 250 mm layer. Minimum 2 tests per layer. Proof rolling. No discernible movement. One test per each layer. Profile and depth. String line. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme policy. Every 20m. Quality of material – subgrade replacement . Grading, Atterberg Limits, and 4 day soaked CBR tests (in situ). Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme policy. One test per each job or one test per each type of material. Compaction 300mm below the subgrade level. AS 1289.5.1.1: 2003: Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes Soil compaction and density tests Determination of the dry density/moisture content relation of a soil using standard compactive method 95% Standard. One test per 100m length, Minimum 2 tests for any job. Proof Rolling. No discernible movement. One test per each job. AS 1289.5.1.1: 2003: Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes Soil compaction and density tests Determination of the dry density/moisture content relation of a soil using standard compactive method 100% Standard. One test per 100m length, Minimum 2 tests for any job. Proof rolling. No discernible movement. One test per each job. Compaction at the subgrade level. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-150 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Element of works Test Standard Frequency Profile and depth. String line. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme policy. One test every 20m. Quality of Material. Grading, Atterberg Limits, and 4 day soaked CBR tests. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme policy. The higher of: one test per each job; one test per each type of material; or one test per 500 Cu.M. Compaction. AS 1289.5.1.1: 2003: Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes Soil compaction and density tests Determination of the dry density/moisture content relation of a soil using standard compactive method Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme policy. One test per 100m length of road per 250mm layer. Minimum 2 tests for any job. Proof rolling. No discernible movement. One test per each job. String line/Electronic level. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme policy. One test every 20m. Sub-base and base layers. Level and grades Profile and depth. Table 5.3.1.2–Part 2 of inspection and testing plan Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Element of works Test Standard Frequency Quality of material. Mix analysis. - One test per 500 tonne. Compactio n and thickness. Horizontal and vertical alignment profile. String line. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme. One test every 20m. Pipe. AS 2439.1: 2007: Perforated plastics drainage and effluent pipe and fittings-perforated drainage pipe and associated fittings. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme - Wearing surface. Sub-soil drain. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-151 AS 2439.2: 2007: Perforated plastics drainage and effluent pipe and fittings - Perforated effluent pipe and associated fittings for sewerage applications. Filter material. Grading. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme One test per each job. Cleaning joints and markers. Visual. - - Kerb and channel. Horizontal and vertical alignment. Levels and grades. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme Sufficient readings for control. Road crossing conduits. Location markers. Visual. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme Each conduit. Stormwater drainage. Location of structures, FL and IL, of structure. Survey. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme Each Structure. Bedding material. Visual. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme One test per each job. Drainlines. Visual and video check. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme One test per each job. Topsoiling and grassing. - Visual. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme Once. All works prior to “onmaintenance”. - Visual. Infrastructure code (Part 9) of the planning scheme and this planning scheme Once. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-152 Table 5.3.1.3–Part 3 of inspection and testing plan Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Element of works Test Standard Frequency Water Supply Infrastructure Water supply pipelines and fittings Quality of materials. Visual and Supplier certificate Type of materials Infrastructure Products and Material (IPAM) list of the South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code. Boundary set out, Survey, visual. Horizontal and vertical alignments, pipe covers Water supply pipe laying South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code (SEQ-Code) Each delivery for each type of material. and Approved engineering documentation of Development. The whole of all the alignments. Pipeline, valves, hydrants, bends, scours. Survey, visual. Each item. Bedding material Grading. Bulkhead and trench stops Visual Thrust blocks – size and location Visual, photographic (for submission to the Engineer prior to on maintenance) Approved engineering documentation of Development. Before concrete pour Backfilling and compaction AS 1289.5.1.1:2003; South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code One test per 300m length and one test on each road crossing South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code Each delivery for each type of material. Each items and Method of testing soils for engineering purposes – Soil compaction and density tests – Determination of the dry density/moisture content relation of a soil using Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 [Where trenching across Council roads Sc6.2.5-153 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Element of works Test Standard Frequency standard compactive method. or facilities occurs refer Infrastructure Code (s9.4.3) and Planning Scheme Policy No. 5 – Infrastructure]. Thrust boring, enveloper pipe, thrusting work, grout fill works Visual. South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code and the requirements of the owner of the infrastructure under which the bore is made. All thrust bore installation. Pressure test Pressure test All pipelines. Water Quality Bacteriological and chemical test(s) South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code Disinfection Water supply pump Station Structure base and wall, reinforcing steel Visual South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code Each item. Mechanical, electrical and commissioning. Commissioning Plan. South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code IPAM list and Asset Information Specification. Each component and the pumping station in its entirety. Decommissioning plan, unless otherwise agreed, to the water service providers satisfaction Decommissioning Plan to be determined in discussion with water Each component and the pumping station in its entirety Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-154 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Element of works Test Standard Frequency service provider and developer. Wastewater/Sewerage Infrastructure Wastewater pipelines and fittings Wastewater pipelines and fittings Quality of material. Visual and supplier certificate. Type of material. Infrastructure Products and Material (IPAM) list of the South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code. Boundary set, horizontal and vertical alignments, pipe covers Survey and visual Manholes, shafts, access chambers, Survey and visual. Each delivery for each type of material. South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code The whole of all the alignments. and Each item. Approved engineering documentation of Development. junctions, invert and finished levels Wastewater pipe laying South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code. Pipelines, bends. Survey and visual. Bedding material. Grading, visual, supplier certificate. Bulkhead, trench stops Visual, photographic (for submission to the Engineer prior to on maintenance). Backfill and compaction AS 1289.5.1.1:2003; Method of testing soils for engineering purposes – Soil compaction and density tests – Determination of the dry density/moisture content Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 . South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code And Approved engineering documentation of Development. South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code The whole alignment and Each item. Each delivery for each type of material. Each item. One test per 300m length and one test on each road crossing. Sc6.2.5-155 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Element of works Test Standard Frequency relation of a soil using standard compactive method. Thrust boring, Visual. South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code and the requirements of the owner of the infrastructure under which the bore is made. All thrust boring works. All sewer installation Pressure test and Vacuum test All pipelines. CCTV Video and report (for submission to the Engineer prior to On Maintenance). South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code. Wet well base and wall construction, reinforcing, steels, cabinets. Visual. South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code. Each item. Mechanical, electrical and commissioning Commissioning Plan. South East Queensland Water Supply & Sewerage Design & Construction Code, SEQ-Code IPAM list and SEQ-Code Asset Information Specification. Each component and the pumping station in its entirety. Decommissioning plan, unless otherwise agreed, to Decommissioning Plan to be Each component and the pumping enveloper pipe, thrusting work, grout fill works Wastewater pump station [Where trenching across Council roads or facilities occurs refer Infrastructure Code (s9.4.3) and Planning Scheme Policy No. 5 – Infrastructure]. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 As described in SEQ-Code Asset Information Specification. Sc6.2.5-156 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Element of works Test Standard Frequency the water service providers satisfaction determined in discussion with water service provider and developer. station in its entirety 5.3.2 (1) Sub-grade evaluation test results The person who has the benefit of the development approval must, prior to commencing any work on a pavement, provide to the engineer the results of the sub-grade evaluation tests at the approximate box level and recommended pavement depth in accordance with the standard specifications in Part 3–Standards of this planning scheme policy. 5.3.3 Sub-grade inspection (1) The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that before the placement of the pavement materials, the consultant and the local government inspect the subgrade (the sub-grade inspection). (2) The sub-grade inspection must include: (3) (a) the checking of the service conduit locations against the markers, if the kerb and channel is in place; (b) the determination of the location of the mitre drains and the side drains; (c) the proof rolling of the bottom of the box after compaction; (d) the checking of the box depths; (e) the checking of the sub-grade levels and the crossfalls; (f) the checking of all related works. The person who has the benefit of the development approval must at the time of the sub-grade inspection, provide to the engineer: (a) the sub-grade compaction test results; (b) the trench backfill compaction test results. 5.3.4 Pre-seal inspection (1) The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that before the pavement is sealed the developer,consultant and local government, in the presence of the contractor, inspect the pavement (the pre-seal inspection). (2) The pre-seal inspection must include: (a) an inspection of the base course gravel after compaction, including, if required by the engineer, a review of the compaction test results and the gravel quality test results for the base, sub-base and select fill courses; (b) an inspection of the pavement surface before priming takes place to ensure that the profile is correct and the surface is suitable for priming in accordance with the standard specifications in Schedule 3 (Standard specifications) of this planning scheme policy; (c) before priming takes place: (i) (the checking and testing of the side drains and the mitre drains by the engineer and the consultant; (ii) the checking of the conduit markers against the service conduits by the engineer and the consultant; (iii) the completion of the stormwater drainage works affecting the roadworks; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-157 (iv) (v) (vi) (3) The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that before the preseal inspection occurs, the local government has approved: (a) the proposed application rates of primer and binder and the spread rates of pre-coated aggregate for spray seal, if the pavement is a spray seal construction; (b) the proposed application rates of primer and the results of mix acceptance tests for asphaltic concrete, if the pavement is an asphaltic concrete construction. 5.3.5 (1) Landscaping work inspections The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that the engineer and the landscape architect inspect: (a) the means of protection of plants before the pre-start meeting; (b) the completion of the setting out; (c) the sub-soil drainage prior to backfilling; (d) the irrigation trenching and system testing prior to backfilling; (e) the commissioning of the irrigation system; (f) the installation or construction of hardworks; (g) the planting including grassing, hydroseeding and turfing; (h) the cultivation or preparation of sub-grade prepared prior to the placing of topsoil, paving materials or footings. 5.3.6 (1) (2) the completion and certification of all pipe and services crossing roadworks as correctly located by the consultant; the certification of the kerb and channel line and levels as being within the permitted tolerances by the consultant; the checking of the intersection contouring. On-maintenance inspections The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that: (a) at the end of the construction of the local government infrastructure works the local government carries out an on-maintenance inspection; (b) live connection to existing live sewers or water supply mains shall not be made until the requirements of the SEQ Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code Asset Information Specification have been met for the infrastructure up to the point of the remaining connection works; (c) on maintenance inspection shall not be made until the information requirements of the SEQ Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code have been met unless otherwise agreed by the water service provider. The on-maintenance inspection must include: (a) for roadworks, and any landscaping not approved as a separate Operational works approval, an inspection of: (i) the as constructed drawings; (ii) the maintenance program; (iii) the grades and profiles of the roads and the paths; (iv) the topsoiling and seeding of the verges and other areas shown on the approved drawings; (v) the asphaltic concrete texture and the finish; (vi) the road signs and the line-marking; (vii) the lot survey pegs; (viii) the sub-soil drains, clean out points and outlets; (ix) tree planting on roads; (x) the conduit markers against the lot survey pegs; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-158 (xi) (xii) (xiii) (xiv) (xv) (xvi) (xvii) (xviii) (xix) (xx) (xxi) retaining walls (Local government infrastructure only); WSUD (Local government infrastructure only); the filling and excavation; the removal of rubbish, stockpiles and other deleterious materials; the final trimming; the topsoil and grass coverage; the structures including bridges, culverts, earth mounds and the like; the low profile fencing and locking posts and rails; the irrigation system, including backflow prevention devices and taps in parks; the paths, pathways and cycleways; the premises to ensure that they are clean, tidy, free of rubbish, rocks, sticks and unauthorised stockpiles; (xxii) filling and excavation to ensure that they are free draining and in accordance with the approved drawings; (xxiii) the integrity of an area identified in the approved drawings or by the engineer as an environmentally significant area; (xxiv) other salient items; (b) for stormwater drainage, an inspection of: (i) the roads, pipes, structures and flowpaths to ensure that they are clear of silt and debris; (ii) the roads, pipes, structures and kerbs as flow paths to ensure that they are not subject to ponding; (iii) the turfing of turfed areas shown on the approved drawings; (iv) the pipes to ensure they are laid straight to grade and line; (v) the pipes to ensure they are not damaged; (vi) the pipes to ensure that the pipe penetration to a manhole is finished off; (vii) the quality of the concrete work; (viii) the quality of the render work; (ix) manhole lids to ensure that they comply with the standard specifications; (x) the correct drop through manholes; (xi) gullies and grates; (xii) overland flow paths; (xiii) the opening of GPTs to ensure cleanliness ; (xiv) the CCTV of the complete stormwater network; (xv) the water quality control measures; (xvi) the as-constructed drawings if available; (c) for landscaping, an inspection of: (i) the maintenance program; (ii) the landscaping; (iii) the topsoil and grass coverage (parks only); (iv) the irrigation system, including backflow prevention devices and taps in parks; (v) the paths, pathways and cycleways within parks; (vi) (the water quality control WSUD planting only; (d) for water supply reticulation the testing and inspection of: (i) alignment and location check of system; (ii) hydrants and valves in accordance with the approved design and the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code; (iii) hydrant, valve and property service locations markers completed; (iv) specialised infrastructure complete (pumps, PRV's, reservoirs, etc); (v) pressure and Water Quality Testing results have been carried out in accordance with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code and that these results be submitted with an accompanying Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-159 plans (‘as constructed’), for approval prior to any domestic connections to allotments; (e) (3) for Sewerage Reticulation the testing and inspection of: (i) alignment and location check of the system; (ii) manholes have been constructed in accordance with the Approved Engineering Drawings and the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code; (iii) visual inspection of all sewer lines including benching; (iv) where applicable pump and lift stations constructed in accordance with the Approved Engineering Drawings and the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code with all pumping and electrical facilities in working order; (v) pressure and testing results have been carried out in accordance with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code including (where applicable): (A) air testing of sewers; (B) vacuum testing of manholes; (C) ovality testing of sewers; (D) hydraulic testing of pressure mains; (E) CCTV inspection report and video. WSUD hand-over process shall be in accordance with the local government's guidelines. 5.3.7 Off-maintenance inspections (1) The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that at the expiry of the maintenance period, the consultant and the engineer carry out an off-maintenance inspection (an off-maintenance inspection). (2) The off-maintenance inspection must include: (a) for roadworks, an inspection of: (i) the pavements and surfacing for deformation or damage; (ii) the road signs and the line marking; (iii) the tree planting on the road, where relevant; (iv) the removal of rubbish and other deleterious materials; (v) the drainage; (vi) the structures including bridges, culverts, earth mounds and the like; (vii) the low profile fencing and locking posts and rails; (viii) the irrigation system, including taps in parks; (ix) the pathways and cycle paths; (x) the water quality control measures; (xi) the repairs of earlier defects; (xii) the integrity of areas designated on the approved drawings or by the local government officer as environmentally significant areas; (b) for stormwater drainage, an inspection of: (i) the roads, pipes, structures and flow paths to ensure that they are clear of silt and debris; (ii) the turfing of the verges and other turfed areas shown on the approved drawings; (iii) the roads, pipes, kerb or flow paths to ensure there is no ponding; (iv) the pipes for damage and movement; (v) the reinforcing steel for exposure or corrosion; (vi) the profile of overland paths; (vii) the interallotment drainage system for damage or movement; (viii) the manholes to ensure they are not buried or damaged; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.3 Inspection and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-160 (ix) (3) the opening of GPTs to ensure cleanliness; (c) for landscaping, an inspection of: (i) the maintenance program; (ii) the landscaping to ensure that it shows healthy growth typical for the species and season; (iii) the removal of rubbish and other deleterious materials (parks only); (iv) grass coverage which has 95% coverage for a seeded area and has 100% coverage for a turfed area; (v) the irrigation system, including taps in parks; (vi) the pathways and cycleways (parks only); (vii) the water quality control measures planting only; (d) for Water Supply Reticulation an inspection of: (i) hydrants, valves and other fittings functioning and surrounds and associated markings shall be still clearly visible; (ii) ensure height of valves and hydrants in accordance with Council's Standard Drawing No 59607; (iii) signs of any surface subsidence along alignment; (iv) other infrastructure components operational, i.e. reservoirs, pump stations; (e) for Sewerage Reticulation an inspection of: (i) a CCCTV inspection of defective sewer lines; (ii) manholes and associated benching; (iii) no infiltration of groundwater into sewer lines/ system; (iv) signs of any surface deformation along alignment; (v) no ponding of surface water above manholes; (vi) other infrastructure components operational, i.e. sewerage lift and pump stations. The hand-over process shall be in accordance with the local government's WSUD Hand Over process. 5.4 Acceptance of local government infrastructure work onmaintenance 5.4.1 Criteria for acceptance (1) (2) The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that, before local government infrastructure work on-maintenance is accepted by the local government: (a) the local government infrastructure work is completed in accordance with the approved drawings; (b) the on-maintenance inspection is completed to the satisfaction of the local government; (c) the as constructed drawings and documentation have been accepted by the local government; (d) a maintenance security deposit has been lodged with the local government (e) for water supply and sewerage infrastructure: (i) all test results, certificates, CCTV videos, photographs of thrust block installations, as constructed information, reports and the like are submitted to the Engineer for acceptance in accordance with the SEQ Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code Asset Information Specification; (ii) RPEQ engineering certification is provided for all building and structural works associated with water supply and sewerage infrastructure; (iii) building certification is provided for all building and structural works associated with water supply and sewerage infrastructure. The person who has the benefit of the development approval must provide to the local government within 14 days of the on-maintenance inspection date: Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.4 Acceptance of local government infrastructure work onmaintenance Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-161 (a) as constructed drawings and documentation, including electronic formats; (b) a completed bonding summary (application) sheet, including full Schedule of works; (c) the maintenance security deposit; (d) The on-maintenance period will: (i) not commence until the person who has the benefit of the development approval complies with section 5.4.1(2) of this planning scheme policy; (ii) be the period notified in writing by the local government to the person who has the benefit of the development approval. 5.4.2 (1) Maintenance security deposit The person who has the benefit of the development approval must provide a maintenance security deposit which is: (a) in the form of: (i) EFTPOS; or (ii) cheque; or (iii) a banker’s undertaking or, as Insurance Bond, which satisfies the following: (iv) (b) 5.4.3 (1) (A) is in the local government’s favour; (B) is given by a financial institution consented to by the local government; (C) is irrevocable; (D) is unlimited in time; (E) is otherwise unconditional; (F) includes a full property description of the subject premise; (G) includes a full description of the purpose of the bond; (H) is established by the owner of the subject premise; or such other security as the local government may approve; for an amount: (i) of 5 percent of the agreed value of the local government infrastructure work, or the amount prescribed in the local government’s register of fees and charges, whichever is higher; (ii) $200 per drawing page for each as constructed engineering plan, as prescribed in the local government’s register of fees and charges; (iii) the person who has the benefit of the development approval must seek the local government’s approval to the bond content prior to lodging the bond; (iv) the bonding of uncompleted works peripheral to the actual works may be waived at the discretion of the local government. Approval of plan of survey The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that before the local government approves a plan of survey: (a) the local government infrastructure work is accepted on-maintenance by the local government; or (b) any uncompleted local government infrastructure work is bonded in accordance with the relevant planning scheme policy. 5.5 Acceptance of local government infrastructure work offmaintenance 5.5.1 Maintenance period (1) The person who has the benefit of the development approval must maintain the local government infrastructure work for 12 months from the date the local government infrastructure Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.5 Acceptance of local government infrastructure work offmaintenance Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-162 work is accepted on-maintenance or as until such time as the works are accepted off maintenance by the local government. The time period for pump stations is 24 months (or as otherwise conditioned) from the date the local government infrastructure work is accepted onmaintenance. 5.5.2 (1) Acceptance of local government infrastructure work off-maintenance The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that before the local government infrastructure work is accepted off-maintenance by the local government: (a) an off-maintenance inspection is completed to the satisfaction of the local government; (b) any other outstanding matters have been completed to the satisfaction of the local government. 5.6 As-constructed information 5.6.1 General standard for as constructed information (1) (2) The person who has the benefit of the development approval must, prior to the on-maintenance approval, submit to the local government: (a) the as-constructed drawings, CDs and documentation in accordance with the requirements described in sections 5.6.2; 5.6.3; 5.6.4 and 5.6.5. The as-constructed drawings need to comply with IPWEA As Design As Constructed (ADAC) compliant schema unless otherwise approved; (b) a completed statement of compliance, in the format specified in Figure 5.6.1.1–Statement of compliance of this planning scheme policy; The person who has the benefit of the development approval is responsible to rectify any noncompliance unless otherwise agreed by the local government. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.6 As-constructed information Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-163 Figure 5.6.1.1–Statement of compliance Development application number: Consultant: I certify that the following design/ as constructed drawings* submitted herewith have been prepared, checked/ amended* in accordance with the requirements of Planning Scheme Policy No. 5 (Infrastructure). Those aspects of the design/ as constructed drawings* which do not comply with the requirements of Planning Scheme Policy No. 5 (Infrastructure) are listed above. Consultant: RPEQ No./ CP Eng Membership No* : Signature: Date: * Delete whichever does not apply Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.6 As-constructed information Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-164 5.6.2 (1) (2) Requirements for full set of approved engineering drawings amended with as constructed information The following as constructed submission requirements apply to local government infrastructure work: (a) drawings must be A3 size hardcopies (drawn in 1:500 scale); (b) drawings must be certified and signed as 'As Constructed'; (c) the certification text must be in accordance with Figure 5.6.2.1–As Constructed certification of this planning scheme policy; (d) Auto CAD.dwg files must be created in version 2014 (or compatible with current system) and in MGA (Zone 56) co-ordinates on the GDA 94 datum; (e) subdivisions of 10 or less lots are tied into at least 2 permanent survey marks and subdivisions of more than 10 lots are tied into 3 or more permanent survey marks. Permanent survey marks are to have horizontal co-ordinates of at least fourth order; (f) drawings are not to contain wipe out over data; (g) the minimum allowable font size is 2.5 mm on A1 size drawings; (h) the printing colour for AutoCAD drawings is monochrome; (i) as constructed information in XML format is compliant to the current version of the ADAC schema (if applicable); (j) the tolerance for survey, alignment tolerance, is 0.02 metre and the level tolerance is 0.02 metre; (k) easements created as part of the development must be shown on drawings, and must be clearly labelled with the purpose of the easement (e.g. 'Drainage Purposes', 'Access Purposes' etc). Each drawing must include: (a) the approved development name; (b) the approved stage number; (c) the names, addresses and contact numbers of consultants; (d) the drawing number which corresponds with the approved engineering drawing number; (e) revision name as 'As Constructed' ('AC'), with the latest rev. number (e.g. 'AC1', 'AC2' etc.); (f) the approved operational work number (e.g. 'OW/254/2012'); (g) approved street names; (h) north point on each plan; (i) the design values, amended with the surveyed as constructed values, beyond approved tolerances. This is to be denoted by a strikethrough line with the as constructed values noted nearby. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.6 As-constructed information Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-165 Figure 5.6.2.1–As Constructed certification Consulting Engineer's Certification: I, ……………………………………………. hereby certify that the As Constructed information shown on this plan/contained on this electronic device (delete whichever is not applicable) is a true and correct record of the sizes, types, materials, classes etc., and it corresponds with the relevant approved Engineering Drawings. Signed……………………………………... Dated………………………….. RPEQ No………………… Registered Surveyor's Certification: I, ……………………………………………. hereby certify that the horizontal and vertical locations, and dimensions shown on this plan/contained on this electronic device (delete whichever is not applicable) are a true and correct record of the As Constructed information. Signed …………………………………….. …………………………… 5.6.3 (1) (2) As constructed standard drawings prepared as follows: The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that as constructed standard drawings be provided and prepared in: (a) A3 hardcopies (Drawn in 1:500 scale); (b) accordance with Table 8.3.1.1–Standard drawings for sewerage infrastructure of this planning scheme policy; (c) accordance with Table 8.2.1.1–Standard drawings for water supply infrastructure of this planning scheme policy; (d) accordance with Table 8.5.1.1–Standard drawings for stormwater infrastructure of this planning scheme policy. For preparation details refer to the local government; Each drawing must contain certification in accordance with Figure 5.6.2.1–As constructed certification of this planning scheme policy. 5.6.4 (1) Reg. No..………………… Dated Requirements for one CD (or DVD or other electronic device): The CD must contain: (a) certification text completed in accordance with Figure 5.6.2.1–As constructed certification of this planning scheme policy and shown on the label on the face of the CD / accompanying device; (b) individual files of all drawings described in section 5.6.2–Requirements for full set of approved engineering drawings amended with as constructed information and section Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.6 As-constructed information Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-166 5.6.3–As constructed standard drawings prepared as follows, of this planning scheme policy in: (i) AutoCAD.dwg file 2014 format (or compatible with current system) and in MGA (Zone 56) co-ordinates on the GDA 94 datum; (ii) PDF format, saved in A1 size and as individual documents with certification signed and dated; (iii) XML format compliant with the current version of the ADAC schema or when approved asset data excel spreadsheets (in Excel 2013 or compatible with current system) for stormwater details. Asset data spreadsheets are available from the local government 5.6.5 (1) As constructed documentation The person who has the benefit of the development approval must ensure that the asconstructed documentation submitted to the local government before the on-maintenance inspection includes: (a) an inspection and testing certificate signed by the consultant; (b) a certification of foundation conditions signed by the consultant where relevant; (c) copies of test results in respect of: (i) the compaction of fill including compaction of trench backfill; (ii) the sub-grade CBR; (iii) the sub-grade compaction; (iv) the CBR 15 material quality; (v) the CBR 15 compaction; (vi) the sub-soil drain filter media grading; (vii) the grading of all bedding materials used in the works; (viii) the base course material quality; (ix) the base course compaction; (x) the sub-base course material quality; (xi) the sub-base course compaction; (xii) the prime or primer seal spray and application rates; (xiii) the AC core tests; (xiv) any concrete testing required by the standard specifications in Part 3–Standards of this planning scheme policy; (xv) sewer pressure tests; (xvi) water main pressure tests; (xvii) water quality tests in accordance with the document Requirements for water quality test results – Connection of new water mains (to be submitted separately, after approval of As constructed data); (xviii) any other job specific testing carried out or required by the engineer; (d) details of the retesting or rectification actions carried out where any test results specified in paragraph (c) fail to meet the standard specifications in Part 3–Standards of this planning scheme policy; (e) CCTV video for underground stormwater infrastructure work; (f) photographs, video or digital imagery covering major asset attributes for local government infrastructure work not covered in (e), unless otherwise approved by the local government. During construction, digital photographs must: (i) be taken of complex constructions or installations which will be below ground level or not visible after construction completion; (ii) be taken prior to backfilling. (iii) include a chainage or exact location reference in the title of the digital photo file; (iv) be date stamped; (v) be submitted electronically in .jpg format, no less than 4MB per file or 720x576 resolution; Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.6 As-constructed information Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-167 (2) (g) a list of assets and/or major components in editable spreadsheet format comprising assets with design life, geographical, geometrical attributes consistent with the asconstructed drawings; (h) copies of maintenance and operation or vendor manuals for the following (but not limited to) asset types: (i) bridges; (ii) street lighting, traffic lights, electrical assets; (iii) gross pollutant traps (GPT); (iv) water sensitive urban design assets (WSUD). Maintenance and operations or vendor manuals specified in subsection (h) must: (a) be finalised on completion of commissioning; (b) be in pdf format; (c) cover design, construction, operations, maintenance routines and procedures. 5.6.6 (1) As Constructed information for water supply infrastructure for water asset management As constructed information for Water supply infrastructure must be in accordance with the SEQ Total Asset Information Package. 5.6.7 (1) As Constructed drawings for sewerage infrastructure for water asset management As constructed information for Sewerage infrastructure must be in accordance with the SEQ Total Asset Information Package. 5.7 Video formats for inspection and testing of local government infrastructure work 5.7.1 Requirements for video format (1) 5.8 Where the local government requires video of local government infrastructure work for inspection and testing purposes, the video must be: (a) provided in one of the following formats: (i) WINCAM (version 7 or later) or CCTV footage; or (ii) DVD-ROM for digital video file; or (iii) MPEG 4 for a video clip; (b) where it is obtained from the stormwater drainage system, taken: (i) at the first drainage maintenance hole upstream and downstream of the local government infrastructure work; or (ii) at the stormwater entry upstream and stormwater discharge downstream of the local government infrastructure work; (c) where it is obtained for movement infrastructure, it needs to cover the front, rear and top view of the local government's infrastructure work. Requirements for ADAC Schema for stormwater and movement infrastructure assets (1) The ADAC asset data requirements for stormwater and movement infrastructure assets are set out in the latest ADAC schema specifications, as published by IPWEA or as otherwise informed. The document is available on the ADAC website (http://www.engicom.com.au). (2) The ADAC data file must only be generated from accurate survey information as this data is imported into relevant GIS systems. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.7 Video formats for inspection and testing of local government infrastructure work Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-168 (3) For ADAC submissions as-constructed data must only contain final details of construction including the removal of any deletions, addition of any additional items and removal of any previously relocated items. (4) Where ADAC data is provided for stormwater drainage systems: (5) (a) the pipes must be captured in the direction of flow; (b) all features in the ADAC specification must be collected; (c) the ends of line features must be snapped to point features; (d) the stormwater pipe elements must be broken at fittings and changes in pipe attributes; (e) the stormwater pipe elements must be broken by access pits or maintenance shaft points or by changes in pipe attributes. ADAC files: (a) must be provided electronically in .dwg and .xml formats according to the latest version of the ADAC schema; (b) must conform to the ADAC .xml data specification as published by the Institute of Public Works Engineering Australia; (c) must include project cross reference metadata for ADAC xml fillies; (d) have mandatory fields and must be filled in with correct information and never left blank. 5.9 Summary of final package of as-constructed information for submission Table 5.9.1–As constructed information REQUIREMENT FORM OF SUBMISSION As-Constructed Drawings A3 size hardcopies (Drawn in 1:500 scale on A1) AutoCAD .dwg version 2014 A1 PDFs saved as individual documents ADAC data file ADAC compliant schema .dwg and .xml formats As-Constructed Documentation As per 5.6.5 Maintenance / Operations Manuals .PDF format Certification Figure 5.6.2.1 Statement of Compliance Figure 5.6.1.1 Video WINCAM, DVD-ROM or MPEG 4 Photos Electronically in .jpg format, no less than 4MB per file or 720 x 576 resolution Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.9 Summary of final package of as-constructed information for submission Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-169 Part 6 (1) Bonding of development Bonding of development is in accordance with the local government's Bonding of works policy. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 5.9 Summary of final package of as-constructed information for submission Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-170 Part 7 Planning layouts 7.1 Road infrastructure 7.1.1 Planning layouts for road infrastructure (1) Table 7.1.1.1–Planning layouts for road infrastructure of this planning scheme policy identifies in column 3 the planning layouts for road infrastructure in respect of the road scheme identified in column 1 and column 2. (2) Disclaimer: Property boundary data for these drawings has been sourced from the Digital Cadastral Database supplied to Council by Department of Natural Resources and Mines (DNRM). Final horizontal/vertical alignments and any land requirements for roads are subject to prior survey, detailed road design and consultation with land owners. Planning layouts are constantly updated. Ensure the latest drawing version is used. Table 7.1.1.1–Planning layouts for road infrastructure Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Road scheme Parts of the road scheme Planning layouts for roads Green Road - Park Ridge Mount Lindesay Service Road to Rai Drive Drawing 01/25777 to 01/25790 Bumstead Road - Park Ridge Clarke Road to Chambers Flat Road Drawing 01/25798 to 01/25805 Bayliss Road extension - Park Ridge Green Road to Park Ridge Road Drawing 01/25810 to 01/25815 Clarke Road - Park Ridge Bumstead Road to Park Ridge Road Drawing 01/25819 to 01/25823 Unnamed Urban Collector 1 (UA1) - Park Ridge Kantenna Street to Green Road Drawing 01/25826 to 01/25829 Unnamed Urban Collector 3 Park Ridge UA1 to Bayliss Road extension Drawing 01/26053 to 01/26055 Unnamed Industrial Collector 3 (IC3) - Park Ridge Green Road to Park Ridge Road Drawing 01/26072 to 01/26077 Unnamed Industrial Collector 4 - (IC4) - Park Ridge IC3 to IC1 Drawing 01/26081 to 01/26084 Unnamed Industrial Collector 1 (IC1) - Park Ridge Green Road to Park Ridge Road Drawing 01/26057 to 01/26062 Unnamed Industrial Collector 2 (IC2) - Park Ridge Bumstead Road to IC1 Drawing 01/26066 to 01/26069 Gilmore Road Link Road to Pagewood Street Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 7.1 Road infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-171 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Road scheme Parts of the road scheme Planning layouts for roads Wuraga Road Menora Road to BeaudesertBeenleigh Road Greenlink Bridge Pagewood Street to Anderson Road Chambers Flat Road Entrance Street to Park Ridge Road/School Road Drawing 14/00117 to 14/00123 Beaumont Road Lindenthal Road to Chambers Flat Road Drawing 14/00178 to 14/00183 Johanna Street - Jimboomba Cusack Lane to Mount Lindesay Highway Drawing 14/00252 to 14/00256 South Street - Jimboomba Mount Lindesay Highway to Johanna Street Drawing 14/00259 to 14/00261 7.2 General planning layouts 7.2.1 General planning layouts for areas (1) Table 7.2.1.1–General planning layouts for areas of this planning scheme policy identifies in Column 2 the general planning layouts for the areas identified in Column 1. (2) The general planning layouts identified in Table 7.2.1.1–General planning layouts for areas, column 2 of this planning scheme policy, demonstrate an indicative proposed road network. Table 7.2.1.1–General planning layouts for areas Column 1 Column 2 Area Underwood Road General planning layouts Figure 7.2.1.1–Underwood Road general planning layout. Third Avenue Figure 7.2.1.2–Third Avenue general planning layout Short Street Figure 7.2.1.3–Short Street general planning layout Park Ridge Figure 7.2.1.4–Park Ridge general planning layout Berrinba Figure 7.2.1.5–Berrinba general planning layout. Jimboomba Figure 7.2.1.6–Jimboomba general planning layout. Wembley Road Figure 7.2.1.7–Wembley Road general planning layout. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 7.2 General planning layouts Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-172 Figure 7.2.1.1–Underwood Road general planning layout Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 7.2 General planning layouts Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-173 Figure 7.2.1.2–Third Avenue general planning layout Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 7.2 General planning layouts Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-174 Figure 7.2.1.3–Short Street general planning layout Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 7.2 General planning layouts Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-175 Figure 7.2.1.4–Park Ridge general planning layout Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 7.2 General planning layouts Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-176 Figure 7.2.1.5–Berrinba general planning layout Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 7.2 General planning layouts Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-177 Figure 7.2.1.6–Jimboomba general planning layout Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 7.2 General planning layouts Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-178 Figure 7.2.1.7–Wembley Road general planning layout Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 7.2 General planning layouts Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-179 7.3 Road encroachment maps 7.3.1 Road encroachment maps (1) Table 7.3.1.1–Road encroachment maps of this planning scheme policy, identifies in Column 1 the project number, Column 2 the map name, Column 3 the number of encroachment maps prepared for the project (Column 1) and Column 4 the road section. (2) Disclaimer: Property boundary data for these drawings have been sourced from the Digital Cadastral Database supplied to Council by Department of Natural Resources and Mines (DNRM). Final horizontal/vertical alignments and any land requirements for roads are subject to prior survey, detailed road design and consultation with land owners. Planning layouts are constantly updated. Ensure the latest drawing version is used. Table 7.3.1.1–Road encroachment maps Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Project no. Map name Drawing no. Road section 70-144 Loganlea Road (Nujooloo Road to Kingston Road) 5-7 of 9 plans Loganlea Road between Armstrong Road ramp and Queens Road Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 7.3 Road encroachment maps Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-180 Part 8 Standard drawings 8.1 Movement infrastructure 8.1.1 Standard drawings for movement infrastructure (1) Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure of this planning scheme policy, identifies the standard drawings for movement infrastructure. Table 8.1.1.1–Standard drawings for movement infrastructure Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Subject of standard drawing Title of standard drawing Number of standard drawing Cross sections Road Cross Sections - Access Function LCC 8-00373 LCC 8-00374 LCC 8-00375 LCC 8-00376 LCC 8-00377 LCC 8-00378 Road Cross Sections - Collector Function LCC 8-00379 LCC 8-00380 LCC 8-00381 LCC 8-00382 Road Cross Sections - Arterial Function LCC 8-00383 LCC 8-00384 Road Cross Sections - Multi-Modal Function Verge Cross Sections LCC 8-00385 LCC 8-00386 LCC 8-00387 LCC 8-00388 LCC 8-00389 LCC 8-00391 Acoustic Fence Design Noise Barriers LCC 8-00390 Public utilities Service Corridors and Alignment in Road Reserves LCC 8-00392 Public Utilities Typical Services Sections LCC 8-00393 New Roads Service Conduit Crossing Pavement Extension Trenching and Widening LCC 8-00394 IPWEAQ SEQ R-170 Driveways - Residential Driveways Breakout Type IPWEAQ SEQ R-050 Driveways - Heavy Duty Vehicle Crossing IPWEAQ SEQ R-051 Driveways - Residential Driveways Abutting Type IPWEAQ SEQ R-053 Driveways - Rural Driveway IPWEAQ SEQ R-056 Access crossing with pipe culvert Access crossing without pipe culvert Access crossing with box culvert for shallow table drain LCC 8-00395 LCC 8-00396 LCC 8-00397 Crossovers Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 8.1 Movement infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-181 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Subject of standard drawing Title of standard drawing Number of standard drawing Footpaths Concrete Pathway Construction Details IPWEAQ SEQ R-065 Pathway Details and Sections LCC 8-00398 Concrete Footpath Full Width Kerb Ramps on Corners and Median Cut Through Details Kerb Ramp to Grass Verges Type 2 Kerb Ramp to Concrete/Paved Verges Type 3 LCC 8-00399 LCC 8-0411 Kerbs and Channels, Profiles and Dimensions, including Edge Restraints, Median and Invert IPWEAQ SEQ R-080 Kerb and Channel Residential Drainage Connections - Layout IPWEAQ SEQ R-081 Ghost Median Island Using Delineator Bars and RRPM's LCC 8-00400 Kerb Ramp - Ramped Pedestrian Crossings IPWEAQ SEQ R-090 Kerb Ramp - Ramped and Cut Through Treatments for Pedestrian Crossinngs, Slip Lanes and Medians IPWEAQ SEQ R-091 Installation of TGSIs - On Ramped Kerb Crossings Sheet 1 of 2 IPWEAQ SEQ R-092 Installation of TGSIs - On Ramped Kerb Crossings Sheet 2 of 2 IPWEAQ SEQ R-093 Kerb Ramp - Locations and Configurations Kerb Ramp on corners and median cut through details Kerb ramp to grass verges – Type 2 Kerb ramp to concrete/paved verges – Type IPWEAQ SEQ R-094 LCC 8-00411 Road edge guide post Timber and Tubular Steel Post and Installation Detail DMR 1356 Guard rails and barriers Steel Beam Guardrail DMR 1474 Steel Box Beam Median Barrier LCC 8-00401 Street Name Sign (Finger Board) IPWEAQ SEQ R-130 Traffic Sign Installation Details IPWEAQ SEQ R-131 Subsoil Drains Detail IPWEAQ SEQ R-140 Subsoil Drains Access Points IPWEAQ SEQ R-142 Sub-soil Drainage Details at Medians & Islands LCC 8-00402 Bikeway Entrance Control Type 1 - Low Volume IPWEAQ SEQ P-010 Bikeway Entrance Control Type 2 - High Volume IPWEAQ SEQ P-011 Kerb and channel Kerb ramps Signs Sub-surface drainage Cycleways Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 8.1 Movement infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 LCC 8-0412 LCC 8-0413 LCC 8-00412 LCC 8-00413 Sc6.2.5-182 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Subject of standard drawing Title of standard drawing Number of standard drawing Bikepath Slowdown Control Reverse Curve Bikeway Entrance Control Offset Chicane Bikeway Deflection and Rest Rail Detail Bikeway Slowdown Control Double Chicane IPWEAQ SEQ P-013 Timber footbridge Timber Footbridge LCC8-00404 Fencing Chainwire Security Fence Tubular Steel Fence, with and without Chainwire Weldmesh Fencing and Control Fence IPWEAQ SEQ G-041 IPWEAQ G-0044 Fencing 4 and 6 Strand Barbed Wire Fence Fencing- Log Barrier and Alternative Hardwood Timber Bollard Fencing - Locking Rails Types 1,2 and 3. IPWEAQ G-0040 Typical Bus Stop Layout Indented Rural Bus bay IPWEAQ SEQ R-180 IPWEAQ SEQ R-181 Bus Stops 8.1.2 (1) IPWEAQ SEQ P-015 IPWEAQSEQ P-016 LCC 8-00403 IPWEAQ G-0045 IPWEAQ SEQ G-042 IPWEAQ SEQ G-043 Standard drawings for parking area Table 8.1.2.1–Standard drawings for a parking area of this planning scheme policy, identify the standard drawings for a parking area. Table 8.1.2.1–Standard drawings for a parking area Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Subject of standard drawing Parking areas Title of standard drawing Number of standard drawing LCC 8-00405 Behind Kerb Parking Bays Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 8.1 Movement infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-183 8.2 Water supply infrastructure 8.2.1 Standard drawings for water supply infrastructure (1) Table 8.2.1.1–Standard drawings for water supply infrastructure in this planning scheme policy, identify the standard drawings for water supply infrastructure. Table 8.2.1.1–Standard drawings for water supply infrastructure Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Subject of standard drawing Airvalves Title of standard drawing Number of standard drawing IPWEAQ W-0010 As constructed plan Water Reticulation Constructed Plan Backflow Backflow Prevention Device, Slab and Pole Mounted Cubicle IPWEAQ W-0030 Bedding and thrust block Bedding and Backfill for Water Main Construction IPWEAQ W-0040 Borehead Headworks at Bores IPWEAQ W-0050 Hydrants and valves Hydrant and Valve Installation IPWEAQ W-0060 C I Hydrant and Valve Boxes IPWEAQ W-0061 Scour Scour Details IPWEAQ W-0080 Water connections Water Connection, Single, Double and Ghost Above Ground Meter IPWEAQ W-0090 Water Connection, Single and Double, Below Ground Meter IPWEAQ W-0091 Air Valve Pit, o50 and o80 valves Sample As LCC 08-00408 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 8.2 Water supply infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-184 8.3 Sewerage infrastructure 8.3.1 Standard drawings for sewerage infrastructure (1) Table 8.3.1.1–Standard drawings for sewerage infrastructure in this planning scheme policy, identify the standard drawings for sewerage infrastructure. Table 8.3.1.1–Standard drawings for sewerage infrastructure Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Subject of standard drawing Access chambers Title of standard drawing 1050mm nom Dia - Insitu Construction Number of standard drawing IPWEAQ S-0020. 1050 Nom Dia- Precast Components IPWEAQ S-0021. 1500mm Nom Dia - Insitu Construction IPWEAQ S-0022. Alternative Drops - Insitu Construction IPWEAQ S-0023. Rectangular, including Cast Iron Cover and Frame IPWEAQ S-0024. Cast Iron Cover and Frame Cast Iron Concrete Filled Cover IPWEAQ S-0025. Cast Iron Cover and Frame Bolt Down IPWEAQ S-0026. As constructed Sample Sewerage As Constructed Plan LCC House connection branches House Connection Branches IPWEAQ S-0030. Pressure mains Pressure Main Discharge Details. IPWEAQ S-0070. Pump stations Submersible Sewage Pumping Station 08-00407. General Arrangement, 2000mm dia. IPWEAQ S-0050. 7.2 Vent Pole Terrain Cat 2 and 3 IPWEAQ S-0051. 12.0mm Vent Pole Terrain Cat 2 and 3 IPWEAQ S-0052. 2000mm Dia, Reinforcement, Pressure Gauge Arrangement. Air Release Pipework Details IPWEAQ S-0054. Fabricated Metalwork Sheet 1 IPWEAQ S-0055. Fabricated Metalwork Sheet 2 IPWEAQ S-0056. Lift Station Submersible, 1800mm dia (0-20L/sec) IPWEAQ S-0057. Pump Station Overflow IPWEAQ S-0058. General Arrangement, Reinforcement 2400mm dia. IPWEAQ S-0059. Aluminium Covers and Frames, 2400mm dia. IPWEAQ S-0060 LCC Standard-Double Sided Front & Rear Access Master Control CabinetGeneral Arrangement 08-00249 LCC Standard-Schematic Switchboard Master Control Cabinet Wiring Diagram for all Sewerage Pump Stations 08-00250 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 8.3 Sewerage infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-185 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Subject of standard drawing Title of standard drawing Number of standard drawing 08-00251 LCC Standard-Schematic Switchboard Master Control Cabinet Wiring Diagram for all Sewerage Pump Stations Sewer construction LCC Standard-Schematic Switchboard Master Control Cabinet Wiring Diagram for all Sewerage Pump Stations 08-00252 LCC Standard–SPS 2 Pump Telemetry layout for all Sewerage Pump Stations 08-00253 LCC Standard-2 Pump Equipment Schedule for all Sewerage Pump Stations 08-00254 LCC Standard-2 Pump Equipment Schedule for all Sewerage Pump Stations 08-00255 Sewer Construction, Pipeline Construction Types IPWEAQ S-0090 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 8.3 Sewerage infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-186 8.4 Landscaping 8.4.1 Standard drawings for landscaping (1) Table 8.4.1.1–Standard drawings for landscaping in this planning scheme policy, identify the standard drawings for landscaping. Table 8.4.1.1–Standard drawings for landscaping Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Subject of standard drawing Title of standard drawing Number of standard drawing Softworks Landscaping Areas on Verges Plans and Sections LCC 8-00204 Organic Matting Detail LCC 8-00231 Turf Mounding Detail LCC 8-00232 Garden Bed Planting Detail LCC 8-00233 Mounding for Mulched Planting Beds LCC 8-00234 Shade Trees to Car Parks LCC 8-00235 Street Tree Planting Detail and Tree Cage Detail LCC 8-00236 LCC 8-00237 Car Park Planting Detail LCC 8-00238 Tubestocking Detail (Where Natural Regeneration is Present) LCC 8-00239 Tubestocking Detail (Where Natural Regeneration is Not Present) LCC 8-00240 Vegetation Protection Detail LCC 8-00241 Typical Verge Tree Detail LCC 8-00242 Flush Concrete Edging Detail LCC 8-00243 Brick Paver Edging Detail LCC 8-00244 Timber Edging Detail LCC 8-00245 Spade Edge to Garden Beds in Bushland Revegetation Area LCC 8-00246 Standard Bollard Detail LCC 8-00247 Unit Paving Detail LCC 8-00248 Locking Post and Rail Detail LCC 8-00256 Hardworks Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 8.4 Landscaping Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-187 8.5 Stormwater infrastructure 8.5.1 Standard drawings for stormwater infrastructure (1) Table 8.5.1.1–Standard drawings for stormwater infrastructure in this planning scheme policy, identify the standard drawings for stormwater infrastructure. Table 8.5.1.1–Standard drawings for stormwater infrastructure Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Subject of standard drawing Access chamber Title of standard drawing Number of standard drawing Stormwater Access Chamber Detail 1050 to 2100 Diameter IPWEAQ DS-010 Roof Slabs 1050 to 2100 Diameter IPWEAQ DS-011 Roof Slabs, diameter 1500 extended 600 and 900mm IPWEAQ DS-012 Roof Slabs, Rectangular, Standard Reinforcement IPWEAQ DS-013 Manhole Frame (Roadway and Non-Roadway) 1050 to 2100 Diameter IPWEAQ DS-014 Manhole Riser Details (Roadway) IPWEAQ DS-018 Manhole Cover (Roadway) 1050 to 2100 Diameter IPWEAQ DS-019 Manhole Cover (Non-Roadway) 1050 to 2100 Diameter IPWEAQ DS-020 Manhole Cover Concrete Infill (Pedestrian Traffic) 1050 to 2100 Diameter IPWEAQ DS-021 Excavation, Bedding and Backfilling of Stormwater Drainage Pipes Excavation, Bedding and Backfilling of Precast Box Culverts IPWEAQ DS-030 Drainage Inlets - Field Inlet Type 1 and 2 IPWEAQ DS-050 Drainage Pits - Kerb Inlet Kerb in Line General Arrangement IPWEAQ DS-060 Drainage Pits - Kerb Inlet Precast Lintel Details IPWEAQ DS-061 Kerb Inlet - Gate and Frame IPWEAQ DS-062 Drainage Pits - Kerb Inlet - Lip in Line IPWEAQ DS-063 Drainage Pits - Kerb Inlet - Kerb in Line IPWEAQ DS-068 Sediment control Sediment fence entry/exit, sediment traps. Kerb and field inlets, check dams, straw bale bank. IPWEAQ DS-040. IPWEAQ DS-041 Inlets and outlets RC Box Culverts and Slab Link Box Culverts Construction and Reinforced Concrete Wingwalls and Headwalls MR Drg1303 Pipe Culverts - Construction and Reinforced Concrete Wingwalls and Aprons for Pipe Diameter up to 2400 DMR 1304 Ends op pipe Culverts - Construction of Unreinforced Wingwalls, Headwalls and Aprons DMR 1306 Bedding and backfilling Field inlet gully Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 8.5 Stormwater infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 IPWEAQ DS-031 Sc6.2.5-188 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Subject of standard drawing Title of standard drawing Number of standard drawing RC Box Culverts and Slab Link Box Culverts Construction of Unreinforced Wingwalls and RC Headwalls - H=750 - 2400 DMR 1319 Drainage Details Culvert Inlet Screen. IPWEAQ DS-082 Standard for As constructed stormwater presentation layout As constructed detail for roofwater reticulation LCC 08-00410 Construction of reinforced concrete wingwalls and headwalls DMR 1303 Construction of reinforced concrete wingwalls and apron for pipe diameter up to 2400 mm DMR 1304 General alignment and installation of wingwalls, headwalls and aprons DMR 1305 Construction of unreinforced wingwalls, headwalls and aprons DMR 1306 Access chamber details 1050 to 2100 diameter DMR 1307 General arrangements and installation of precast units DMR 1316 Construction of bases with nibs and aprons DMR 1317 Construction of base with recesses and aprons DMR 1318 Construction of unreinforced wingwalls and RC headwalls DMR 1319 Crown unit holding down anchors DMR 1320 Bioretention Standard Profile - Overflow Pit WSUD001 Bioretention Saturated Zone - Overflow Pit WSUD002 Bioretention Standard Profile - Underdrain Cleanout WSUD003 Bioretention Saturated Zone - Underdrain Cleanout WSUD004 Bioretention Basin Large Coarse Sediment Forebay WSUD005 Bioretention Basin Weir Details WSUD006 Bioretention Pod Kerb Cutout WSUD007 Bioretention Swales Flush Kerb Set Down WSUD008 Constructed Wetland Outlet Riser Pit A WSUD009 Constructed Wetland Outlet Riser Pit B WSUD010 Constructed Wetland Outlet Riser Pit C (for very flat sites) WSUD011 Constructed Wetland Inlet Zone Weir Details WSUD012 Stormwater Roofwater Stormwater quality Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 8.5 Stormwater infrastructure Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 LCC 08-00409. Sc6.2.5-189 Part 9 Standard specifications 9.1 Introduction 9.1.1 Application of Standard Specifications (1) The standard specifications specified in column 1 of Table 9.1.1.1–Application of standard specifications apply to the provisions in column 2 of this planning scheme policy. Table 9.1.1.1–Application of standard specifications Column 1 Column 2 Standard specification Provisions Standard specification No. 1 (Earthworks) 2015. Part 1 – Part 17 Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) 2015. Part 1 – Part 8 Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) 2015. Part 1 – Part 9 Standard specification No. 4 (Water supply infrastructure) 2015. Part 1 – Part 10 Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) 2015. Part 1 – Part 11 Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) 2015. Part 1 – Part 7 Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) 2015. Part 1 – Part 8 Standard specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) 2015. Part 1 – Part 6 Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) 2015. Part 1 – Part 11 Standard specification No. 10 (Provision for traffic) 2015. Part 1 – Part 4 Standard specification No. 11 (Construction) 2015. Part 1 – Part 4 Standard specification No. 12 (Sub-soil drainage) 2015. Part 1 – Part 4 Standard specification No. 13 (Asphaltic concrete surfacing) 2015. Part 1 – Part 4 Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) 2015. Part 1 – Part 11 Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 9.1 Introduction Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-190 9.2 Interpretation of the standard specifications 9.2.1 Administrative Definitions (1) 9.2.2 The administrative definitions in Schedule 1–Definitions of the planning scheme defines particular words used in the standard specifications. Interpretation of the standard specifications (1) A term used in the standard specifications which is not defined in Schedule 1–Definitions of the planning scheme is to be given the meaning in this planning scheme policy. (2) A term used in the standard specifications which is not defined in Schedule 1–Definitions of the planning scheme is to be interpreted in accordance with section 1.3-Interpretation of Part 1– About the planning scheme of the planning scheme. Sc6.2.5 Planning scheme policy 5—Infrastructure 9.2 Interpretation of the standard specifications Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc6.2.5-191 Standard specification No. 1 (Earthworks) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of terms ............................................................................................. 1 PART 2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 CLEARING ................................................................................................................ 2 Requirement to clear premises................................................................................ 2 Extent of clearing ..................................................................................................... 2 Removal of trees ...................................................................................................... 2 Removal of material from the premises .................................................................. 2 PART 3 3.1 3.2 GRUBBING ............................................................................................................... 3 Extent of grubbing ................................................................................................... 3 Completion of grubbing ........................................................................................... 3 PART 4 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 DAMAGE ................................................................................................................... 4 Damage to property ................................................................................................. 4 Damage to a service ................................................................................................. 4 Damage to plants ..................................................................................................... 4 Dial before you dig ................................................................................................... 4 PART 5 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 TOLERANCES .......................................................................................................... 5 Horizontal alignment ................................................................................................ 5 Pavement width ........................................................................................................ 5 Batter slope .............................................................................................................. 5 Grade ........................................................................................................................ 5 Crossfall ................................................................................................................... 5 Existing work ............................................................................................................ 5 PART 6 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 6.5 CARRYING OUT EARTHWORKS ............................................................................. 6 Carrying out earthworks .......................................................................................... 6 Test methods............................................................................................................ 6 Testing frequency .................................................................................................... 6 Stripping and stockpiling of topsoil ........................................................................ 6 Rock and non–rippable material.............................................................................. 6 PART 7 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.4 7.5 SUB-GRADE ABOVE THE EXISTING SURFACE ..................................................... 8 Construction of sub-grade....................................................................................... 8 Sub-grade up to 150mm above the existing surface .............................................. 8 Sub-grade to 150mm to 300mm above the existing surface .................................. 8 Sub-grade more than 300mm above existing the surface ...................................... 8 Shoulder ................................................................................................................... 8 PART 8 8.1 8.2 8.3 FILLING ..................................................................................................................... 9 Extension of excavation to win material ................................................................. 9 Imported fill .............................................................................................................. 9 Selected gravel fill or selected backfill.................................................................... 9 PART 9 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 9.5 EXCAVATION CUTTINGS ....................................................................................... 10 General requirements ............................................................................................ 10 Excess material ...................................................................................................... 10 Unsuitable material ................................................................................................ 10 Batter ...................................................................................................................... 10 Sub-grade in rock ................................................................................................... 10 PART 10 10.1 EMBANKMENT CONSTRUCTION AND LOT FILLING ........................................... 12 General standards .................................................................................................. 12 Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi 10.2 10.3 10.4 Springs or seeps .................................................................................................... 12 10.2.1 Benching .............................................................................................. 12 Construction methods ........................................................................................... 12 Slope of an embankment ....................................................................................... 13 PART 11 11.1 DISTURBED AREAS ............................................................................................... 15 Reinstatement of disturbed areas ......................................................................... 15 PART 12 12.1 SPOIL ...................................................................................................................... 16 Spoil ........................................................................................................................ 16 PART 13 13.1 13.2 13.3 BACKFILL AGAINST A STRUCTURE AND A CULVERT ....................................... 17 Type of material ...................................................................................................... 17 Placement of backfill .............................................................................................. 17 Non-cohesive fill material ...................................................................................... 17 PART 14 14.1 14.2 14.3 14.4 STONE PITCHING ................................................................................................... 18 Type of material ...................................................................................................... 18 Abutment, inlet and outlet ..................................................................................... 18 Construction ........................................................................................................... 18 Grouting.................................................................................................................. 18 PART 15 15.1 15.2 15.3 TABLE DRAIN AND A DIVERSION DRAIN ............................................................. 19 General standards .................................................................................................. 19 Diversion drain ....................................................................................................... 19 Table drain on a steep grade ................................................................................. 19 PART 16 16.1 CHANNEL AN INLET, OUTLET AND A FLOODWAY ............................................. 20 Channel to an inlet, outlet and a floodway ............................................................ 20 PART 17 17.1 17.2 17.3 17.4 17.5 CONTRACTUAL PROVISIONS ............................................................................... 21 Alignment ............................................................................................................... 21 Excavation .............................................................................................................. 21 Spoil ........................................................................................................................ 21 Services .................................................................................................................. 21 Measurement and payment.................................................................................... 21 Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pii Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 1–Earthworks 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in section 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being earthworks. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of terms If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, is to have the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, is to have the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 1 Introduction—1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) Requirement to clear premises Where an area of the premises are required to be cleared, the clearing includes the removal of: (a) all artificial obstructions including fences, unnecessary structures, building foundations, obsolete pipelines and the like; (b) plants (including stumps and boulders) other than the plants required to be retained as shown on the approved drawings; (c) rubbish. 2.2 (1) Clearing Extent of clearing The extent of the cleared area is limited to: (a) the minimum area of the premises to be occupied by the completed earthworks; (b) 1 metre on each side of the completed earthworks; (c) the minimum area of the premises required to safely install a service. (2) Clearing does not take place on land outside the premises without the written consent of the owner of the land. (3) Any area which is identified as an area not to be disturbed, is to be fenced off. 2.3 Removal of trees (1) A tree is cut down progressively from the top where necessary to avoid a risk to public health and safety and the property of the community. (2) A tree and a bough is cut down and removed in such a manner so as to avoid damage to another plant if it is: 2.4 (a) overhanging the formation; (b) hung up as a result of clearing; (c) dead, dying or otherwise dangerous. Removal of material from the premises (1) Cleared plants are disposed of by mulching and reusing the mulch on the premises as far as possible. (2) All material, other than plant material that is mulched and reused on the premises, is removed from the premises to a place approved by the local government. (3) Cleared material is not be incinerated. (4) Inflammable material is not to be permitted to accumulate on the premises. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 2 Clearing—2.1 Requirement to clear premises Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-2 Part 3 3.1 (1) 3.2 (1) Grubbing Extent of grubbing Grubbing, being the removal from the ground of trees, roots and stumps to a depth of 300mm below the surface of the ground, is carried out across the entire cleared area. Completion of grubbing A grub hole is filled with selected material and thoroughly compacted. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 3 Grubbing—3.1 Extent of grubbing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-3 Part 4 4.1 (1) 4.2 (1) 4.3 (1) 4.4 Damage Damage to property Any material which falls on property outside of the premises is removed immediately, unless the owner of the property gives a written consent for the material to remain on the property. Damage to a service A utilities infrastructure is protected from damage by a falling tree and other causes arising from the work. Damage to plants Damage to plants is treated in accordance with Standard Specification No. 2–Landscaping 2015. Dial before you dig (1) Before the commencement of any earthworks, current information on the location of underground services is obtained from the “Dial before you dig” service and the relevant service authorities. (2) The location of all underground services contained within the premises identified pursuant to section 4.4(1) of this standard specification are clearly marked on the ground. (3) The exact location and level of all services that may conflict with the work is determined by pot holing. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 4 Damage—4.1 Damage to property Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-4 Part 5 5.1 (1) Horizontal alignment The area of the finished earthworks is such that the top of an embankment batter and the toe of the batter in a cutting, does not vary from its true horizontal location by: (a) 50mm; or (b) +300mm, where +300mm would increase the width of the earthworks. 5.2 (1) Pavement width The location of an excavation for a pavement does not vary from the location shown in the approved drawings such that the overall width of the pavement is reduced below the width shown in the approved drawings, at either: (a) the level of the sub-grade; or (b) the finished level; or (c) the level of the finished pavement. 5.3 (1) Batter slope The slope of a batter does not vary from the slope in the approved drawings. 5.4 (1) (2) 5.5 Tolerances Grade The surface at the finished sub-grade is graded to within the tolerances of +0mm to -50mm on the finished level less the pavement thickness in accordance with: (a) the level shown in the approved drawings; or (b) calculated from data given in the approved drawings, with due allowance being made for the thickness of any pavement required, provided that: (i) the difference between the deviation from the correct levels at any two points 15 metres apart does not exceed 30mm; (ii) the deviation from a straight edge laid parallel to the centre line does not exceed 15mm in 3 metres. Where the finished surface level is not shown in the approved drawings, the surface of the finished sub-grade does not deviate from a straight edge laid parallel to the centre of the road by more than 15mm in 3 metres. Crossfall (1) The crossfall of the surface of the finished sub-grade does not deviate from that shown in the approved drawings by more than 0.5 percent. (2) A template and spirit level used for checking the cross profile is kept on each section of the work. 5.6 Existing work (1) When the section of the road to be constructed adjoins a section which has been constructed, the grade level at the end of the new work conforms to that of the existing work. (2) If the section of the road under construction does not adjoin a previously constructed section, the ends of the new formation are joined to the existing surface level by means of a ramp at a grade which does not vary from the plan gradient by more than 1 in 20. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 5 Tolerances—5.1 Horizontal alignment Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-5 Part 6 6.1 (1) Carrying out earthworks Carrying out earthworks Earthworks are carried out in accordance with AS 3798–2007 and Amendment 1–2008, Guidelines on earthworks for commercial and residential developments, unless otherwise specified. 6.2 Test methods (1) The testing of work associated with the earthworks is carried out in accordance with AS 1289.0– 2000, Method of testing soils for engineering purposes, Part 0: General requirements and list of methods. (2) Testing carried out in accordance with AS 1289.0–2000, Method of testing soils for engineering purposes, Part 0: General requirements and list of methods, is carried out at either level 1 or level 2 in accordance with AS 3798–1996, Guidelines on earthworks for commercial and residential developments. 6.3 Testing frequency (1) Compaction testing for density testing is carried out at the frequency specified in accordance with an approved inspection and testing plan. (2) Compaction testing frequencies not specified in Table 1.5.3 of AS 3798-2007 and Amendment 1–2008, Guidelines on earthworks for commercial and residential developments, are carried out in accordance with Table 8.1 of AS 3798–2007 and Amendment 1-2008, Guidelines on earthworks for commercial and residential developments. (3) If a compaction test referred to in section 6.3(2) of this standard specification fails, retesting is to occur. (4) Where a compaction test or a group of tests is carried out on part of an area which has been subjected to the same preparation and compaction procedures as the rest of the area, the whole of the area is deemed to be represented by the testing. (5) If the testing indicates that compliance with the standard specification has not been achieved, the whole of the area is deemed not to comply with the standard specification, unless it can be demonstrated that the area in which the non-complying test result was taken can reasonably be separated from the whole. 6.4 (1) (2) 6.5 Stripping and stockpiling of topsoil An area is stripped clear of all grass, root growth, wet or spongy natural soil, vegetable matter, and topsoil such that a natural solid undisturbed surface is exposed to provide a solid base before the commencement of earthworks if the area is: (a) to be covered by fill; or (b) to have fill temporarily stored on it ; or (c) to be covered by pavement; or (d) to be excavated. Stripped topsoil is stockpiled in an area approved by the local government in readiness for respreading on footpaths and batters after the completion of the earthworks. Rock and non–rippable material (1) For the purposes of this standard specification, rock is material that cannot be ripped. (2) Non–rippable material is material which cannot be ripped at a production rate exceeding the rate specified in column 2 of Table 6.5.1–Production rates for rippable material of this standard specification in respect of the particular class of crawler tractor specified in column 1 equipped with a heavy duty single tyne matching ripper. (3) All material other than non-rippable material is classified as normal excavation. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 6 Carrying out earthworks—6.1 Carrying out earthworks Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-6 Table 6.5.1–Production rates for rippable material Column 1 Column 2 Class of tractor (as specified in AS2868 M3 per hour 150 C 50 200 C 75 300 C 90 Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 6 Carrying out earthworks—6.5 Rock and non–rippable material Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-7 Part 7 7.1 (1) Sub-grade above the existing surface Construction of sub-grade Construction of sub-grade is to occur in accordance with the compacted layer method or the mechanical interlock method so as to achieve the specifications referred to in Part 7–Sub-grade above the existing surface of this standard specification. 7.2 Sub-grade up to 150mm above the existing surface (1) Where the level of the sub-grade is 150mm or less above the existing surface, the existing soil is scarified to a depth of 150mm and compacted to 95 percent relative dry density standard compaction. (2) Earthworks placed between the existing soil and the sub-grade are also compacted to 95 percent relative dry density standard compaction. 7.3 (1) Sub-grade to 150mm to 300mm above the existing surface Where the level of the sub-grade is between 150mm to 300mm above the existing surface, the whole of the earthworks placed, plus the existing soil directly under the earthworks, is compacted to ensure that a minimum thickness of 300mm immediately below the sub-grade level is compacted to 100 percent relative dry density standard compaction. 7.4 (1) 7.5 (1) Sub-grade more than 300mm above existing the surface Where the level of the sub-grade is more than 300mm above the existing surface: (a) the top 300mm of formation is compacted to 95 percent relative dry density standard compaction; (b) the remainder down to the level of the existing soil is compacted to 95 percent relative dry density standard compaction. Shoulder Where a shoulder is required on new work or on sections of existing work that is to be reconstructed, the whole of any additional shoulder material above the sub-grade level is compacted to 100 percent relative dry density standard compaction. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 7 Sub-grade above the existing surface—7.1 Construction of subgrade Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-8 Part 8 8.1 (1) Filling Extension of excavation to win material If the excavated material is insufficient to complete the earthworks, additional filling may be obtained by uniformly increasing the width of the excavations if approved by the local government. 8.2 Imported fill (1) Where it is necessary to import fill material, the material used for such imported fill has a minimum four day soaked California bearing ratio value of 10 percent in accordance with AS 1289.0–2000, Method of testing soils for engineering purposes, Part 10: General requirements and list of methods. (2) Before any fill is imported and placed in the work, a certificate from an approved National Association of Testing Authorities (NATA) Testing Laboratory is provided to the local government which certifies that the material meets the requirements of section 8.2(1) of this standard specification. (3) The imported fill is placed in embankments so that the better quality material of the onsite material or the imported fill is placed in the embankment to form the upper portion of the embankment directly below the sub-grade level. 8.3 (1) (2) Selected gravel fill or selected backfill Selected gravel fill or selected backfill, being a gravel or decomposed or broken rock which is free from vegetative matter and lumps of clay, is: (a) tested in accordance with AS 1289.0-2000, Method of testing soils for engineering purposes, Part 10: General requirements and list of methods; (b) has a soaked California bearing ratio of 10; (c) material properties and comply with section 14 Embankments of Department of Transport and Main Roads General Earthworks Technical Standard MRTS04. Before any selected fill or gravel fill is placed in the work, a certificate from an approved NATA Testing Laboratory is provided to the local government which certifies that the material meets the requirements of section 8.3(1) of this standard specification. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 8 Filling—8.1 Extension of excavation to win material Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-9 Part 9 9.1 (1) General requirements Where the bottom of an excavation is free of rock or a rock bar: (a) the existing soil is compacted to 95 percent relative dry density standard compaction, for a depth of 300mm below the sub-grade; (b) care is taken to ensure that the topsoil and organic material is removed and replaced with approved selected material for a depth of 500mm and compacted to 95 percent relative dry density standard compaction where the sub-grade passes through the natural surface at the ends of the excavation or anywhere in cross-section. 9.2 (1) Excavation cuttings Excess material If the material excavated from an excavation is in excess of that required to complete the embankments the surplus material is: (a) run to spoil in accordance with section 12.1–Spoil of this standard specification; or (b) used to flatten the slope of an embankment if approved by the local government. 9.3 Unsuitable material (1) Unsuitable material for an embankment, is to be removed and run to spoil in accordance with section 12.1–Spoil of this standard specification. (2) Unsuitable material below the level of the sub-grade in an excavation is: (3) (a) removed and run to spoil in accordance with section 12.1–Spoil of this standard specification; (b) replaced with select backfill in accordance with section 8.3–Selected gravel fill or selected backfill of this standard specification; (c) compacted to 95 percent relative dry density standard compaction. In this section “unsuitable material” means material which contains vegetative matter, a foreign body or any other deleterious matter such that it is not able to adequately support without excessive settlement: (a) a road pavement; or (b) in the case of general fill, the load of the fill or a structure. 9.4 (1) (2) 9.5 (1) Batter The batter of an excavation is: (a) neatly cut to the slope shown in the approved drawings; (b) carried regularly around the curves; (c) flattened to blend into the natural contour at the ends of the excavation. In a rock excavation, the batter shown in the approved drawings applies to the average rate of batter of the face of the excavation, which need not be accurately trimmed provided that: (a) no rock projects beyond the lesser of: (i) the designated batter by more than 300mm; or (ii) one third of the vertical height of the batter; (b) where the approved drawings indicate a vertical batter, no rock is permitted to project beyond the vertical batter. Sub-grade in rock Where rock or a rock bar is encountered at the level of the sub-grade: Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 9 Excavation cuttings—9.1 General requirements Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-10 (a) the rock or the rock bar is shattered or ripped to a depth of 150mm below the sub-grade to the full extent of the excavation; (b) the shattered or ripped material is: (i) removed from the excavation; (ii) used as fill or run to spoil. (2) Excavation is carried out in a manner to avoid the formation of a pocket of shattered or ripped material below the level of excavation. (3) Loose material is removed from the excavation and the excavation is trimmed so that it will shed water. (4) The allowable tolerance for an excavation is: (a) plus 80mm where plus 80mm increases the depth of excavation; or (b) minus 10mm on the sub-grade level less the pavement thickness and less the 150mm of required excavation below the sub-grade. (5) A trench which is 200mm wide and 150mm deep is formed below the revealed rock surface on both sides of the excavation for the purpose of accommodating sub-soil drainage, including the placing of filter material to the full 150mm depth, which is installed in accordance with Standard Specification No. 12–Sub-soil drainage 2015. (6) An over break resulting in a depression in the surface of the excavation outside the tolerance specified in section 9.5(4) of this standard specification is backfilled with 20Mpa concrete. (7) After the completion of the sub-soil drainage, the excavation is: (a) filled back to the sub-grade with selected backfill as specified in section 8.3-Selected gravel fill or selected backfill of this standard specification; (b) compacted to 95 percent relative dry density standard compaction. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 9 Excavation cuttings—9.5 Sub-grade in rock Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-11 Part 10 10.1 Embankment construction and lot filling General standards (1) Embankment construction and lot filling only occurs on an area which has first been stripped in accordance with section 6.4-Stripping and stockpiling of topsoil of this standard specification. (2) Embankment construction and lot filling: (3) (a) occurs in the construction of a road and other embankments, and the general filling of a lot; (b) includes: (i) the preparation of an area upon which an embankment is to be placed; (ii) the placing and compacting of approved material where unsuitable material has been removed; (iii) the placing and compacting of approved material in a hole, pit or other depression in the road or the lot. In addition to the clearing, grubbing, backfilling and compacting of a stump hole: (a) the whole of the surface upon which an embankment is to be constructed is stripped of all grass and other vegetative matter; (b) any loose, soft or saturated area is excavated, surface drained where necessary and backfilled with compacted approved material. 10.2 (1) Springs or seeps The local government is informed immediately if any spring or seep is found during embankment construction or lot filling. 10.2.1 Benching (1) When an embankment is constructed on a natural surface with a side slope exceeding 8 in 1, a bench of adequate width is cut at the toe of the embankment to permit the initial embankment construction to commence with horizontal layers of uniform cross-sectional depth. (2) Where the side slope of the natural surface is 3 in 1 or steeper, the natural surface is ploughed or cut into at least 300mm to provide a key for the embankment. 10.3 (1) Construction methods The compacted layer is carried out such that: (a) each layer of material is placed with controlled moisture content and compacted to a specified density; (b) fill material is deposited and spread in uniform layers to a depth of not more than 250mm loose measurement, to the full extent of the embankment so that a stone with a minimum dimension of 150mm is not included above a plane 150mm below the sub-grade; (c) an individual rock and boulder with a minimum dimension of 150mm may be used below a plane 150mm below the sub-grade provided that: (i) the dimension of the rock and the boulder does not exceed: (A) (ii) one third of the height of the embankment; or (B) a maximum dimension of 600mm; the rock and the boulder is spaced to allow compacting equipment to compact the area between the layers to a thickness not exceeding 250mm loose measurement; (d) all fill material is compacted at the optimum moisture content or within a range of moisture contents to give the specified dry density; (e) after the material has been uniformly spread, each layer is uniformly compacted to the required relative dry density, as follows: Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 10 Embankment construction and lot filling—10.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-12 (i) (ii) (2) (3) 10.4 (1) for all material between the sub-grade level and a plane 300mm below the subgrade level, 95 percent relative dry density standard compaction as measured by AS 1289.0-2000, Method of testing soils for engineering purposes, Part 0: General requirements and list of methods; or for all material below a plane 300mm below the sub-grade level and to the top 300mm of material surfaces upon which embankment construction and lot filling is to occur, 95 percent relative dry density standard compaction as measured by AS 1289.0-2000, Method of testing soils for engineering purposes, Part 0: General requirements and list of methods. Construction involving rocky material, being material in which rocks of a dimension in excess of 150mm but not exceeding 600mm maximum dimension predominate, and the percentage of fine material is such as to prevent surface contact or mechanical interlock of adjacent rocks, is carried out such that: (a) the embankment below a plane 300mm below the sub-grade is constructed by: (i) bringing moisture content to the optimum moisture content; (ii) spreading the material in layers of loose thickness, which does not exceed the maximum size of the rock in the material; (iii) compacting as to produce 95 percent relative dry density standard compaction, in the fine material; (b) where the nature of the material precludes the testing of the fine material for relative dry density, the layers are compacted by equipment approved by the local government as suitable for the particular material until either: (i) there is no visible movement; or (ii) a minimum number, sequence and pattern of passes have been made by the compacting equipment; (c) rocks which may have a tendency to bridge between adjacent material are broken up by compacting or other equipment even if the maximum dimension of such rocks does not exceed 600mm; (d) the maximum vertical dimension of any rock does not exceed one third of the height of the embankment at the section where the rock is placed; (e) the maximum horizontal dimension of any rock does not exceed one half of the height of the embankment at the section where the rock is placed; (f) the embankment is constructed above a plane 300mm below the sub-grade with approved material compacted in accordance with the compacted layer method outlined in section 10.3(1) of this standard specification. Construction involving material which is predominantly coarse material with insufficient fines to fill the voids so that mechanical interlock is relied upon for stability, is carried out such that: (a) the material is placed, dozed, ripped and worked until stable interlock is achieved where side dumping is not allowed and the fill is to be advanced by full width construction; (b) the advancing ends are concave with the shoulder face well in advance of the centre and the top 600mm below the sub-grade level is closed, locked and filled to provide a solid surface to carry the pavement and shoulders without loss of stability or fretting of the pavement and shoulder materials; (c) no rock which is placed in a fill is: (i) greater in vertical dimension than one third of the depth of the section of the embankment where the material is placed; or (ii) greater in horizontal dimension than one half the depth of the section of the embankment where the material is placed. Slope of an embankment The slope of an embankment is neatly finished to the slope indicated in the approved drawings. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 10 Embankment construction and lot filling—10.4 Slope of an embankment Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-13 (2) A slope is stabilised with a suitable landscaping treatment. (3) Where a batter slope on an embankment is not specified it is comprised of the material indicated for the slope in Table 10.4.1–Table embankment slopes of this standard specification. Table 10.4.1–Table embankment slopes Column 1 Column 2 Material Slope Loose sand and soft clay 1 in 3 to 1 in 5 Ordinary earth 1 in 1 to 1 in 2 Rock 1 in 1 to1 in 1.25 Hand packing 1 in 1 Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 10 Embankment construction and lot filling—10.4 Slope of an embankment Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-14 Part 11 11.1 (1) Disturbed areas Reinstatement of disturbed areas An area which is disturbed during clearing and grubbing is reinstated in accordance with the approved drawings and Standard Specification No. 2–Landscaping 2015. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 11 Disturbed areas—11.1 Reinstatement of disturbed areas Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-15 Part 12 12.1 (1) (2) (3) Spoil Spoil Surplus material which is run to spoil is: (a) not loosely tipped over the side of an embankment; (b) neatly spread adjacent to the work; or (c) used to uniformly flatten the slope of an embankment. Spoil which is spread on the site is: (a) compacted as specified in this standard specification; (b) left in a neat, tidy and self draining condition with a slope of not flatter than 1 in 100 unless otherwise shown in the approved drawings. Rock and other material is removed from the site which is: (a) surplus to the requirements of the job; (b) unsuitable for disposal on the site. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 12 Spoil—12.1 Spoil Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-16 Part 13 13.1 (1) Type of material Backfill comprises gravel, sandy loam, sand or river gravel which allows the production of a compacted mass free of voids. 13.2 (1) Backfill against a structure and a culvert Placement of backfill Backfill is not placed until: (a) the structure or the culvert has been completed, inspected and approved; (b) any specified curing period for a material in the structure or the culvert has elapsed. (2) Backfill against an in-place structure is constructed to the shape and other requirements specified in the approved drawings. (3) Placing and compacting operations do not damage an in-place structure. (4) Where the backfill material is placed against a precast or preformed structures, the operation is carried out in accordance with the culvert component manufacturer’s recommendations unless otherwise specified in this standard specification. (5) Material is placed and compacted uniformly in layers which do not exceed 250mm in thickness. (6) Where the material is placed on the opposite sides of a structure, the difference in level of compacted material on the opposing sides does not exceed 150mm. (7) Construction operations which involve the puddling or jetting of material are not used. 13.3 (1) Non-cohesive fill material If a non-cohesive material is used for the backfill material with the approval of the local government, the non-cohesive material is: (a) not used within 300mm of the sub-grade surface; (b) compacted to a density index of not less than 70 in accordance with Table 5.1 of AS 3798–2007, Guidelines on earthworks for commercial and residential developments; (c) compacted by flooding and the use of immersion vibrators or by such other means as will achieve the specified compaction standard. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 13 Backfill against a structure and a culvert—13.1 Type of material Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-17 Part 14 14.1 Stone pitching Type of material (1) Stone pitching is composed of sound igneous, metamorphic, or approved sedimentary rock which does not disintegrate in water. (2) A stone used is not less than: (3) (a) 0.01m3; (b) 200mm in dimension except where the superficial area of the stone is 0.1m 2 or greater in which case the dimension of the stone may be reduced to 150mm. The stones are bedded to even planes on approved loam or sand. 14.2 Abutment, inlet and outlet (1) Where stone pitching is provided at a bridge or a culvert abutment, invert, or inlet and an outlet to a culvert, such pitching is grouted with cement mortar. (2) The depth of the grout is equal to the depth of the stone pitching. 14.3 (1) (2) 14.4 Construction After trimming of the embankment is complete and the bedding material compacted, selected rock is placed: (a) with the face of the greatest area against the bedding and the longest side of the rocks horizontal; (b) so that joints are staggered as much as possible. All rocks are firmly wedged with stone chips driven into the joint so that the finished surface presents an even face with joints of a nominal width of 25mm. Grouting (1) After the placing and finishing of the rocks, a mortar consisting of one part of Portland cement to three parts of approved sand, by volume, is applied as far down as practicable, but to a depth of at least 150mm. (2) The grouted stone is shaded and kept damp for at least 48 hours. (3) If any stones are not firmly held in position after the mortar has set, the mortar is removed around such loose stones and the area re-grouted. (4) Weep holes are left in the grout at two metre intervals, both horizontal and vertical. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 14 Stone pitching—14.1 Type of material Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-18 Part 15 15.1 (1) (2) General standards A table drain is: (a) constructed parallel to the centre line of the road except where curve widening is designated; (b) evenly graded so as to prevent obstruction to the flow of water. A table drain is dished opposite the entrance to premises, at a cross road or wherever access to a road is necessary. 15.2 (1) (2) Diversion drain A diversion drain: (a) is uniformly graded; (b) has an excavated cross sectional area at least equal to the cross sectional area of the table drain carrying water to the diversion drain; (c) is cut to a profile which allows maintenance by a motor grader. Material excavated from the diversion drain may be used in the formation or banked on the low side of the drain at least 0.3 metres from the edge of the drain. 15.3 (1) Table drain and a diversion drain Table drain on a steep grade A paved table drain and shoulder or a scour check in a table drain is constructed where: (a) the grade of the table drain is steeper than five percent; (b) the soil is likely to scour; (c) it is not possible to turn water out at sufficiently frequent intervals. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 15 Table drain and a diversion drain—15.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-19 Part 16 16.1 Channel an inlet, outlet and a floodway Channel to an inlet, outlet and a floodway (1) A channel to an inlet and outlet of a culvert and a floodway is formed as detailed in the approved drawings. (2) The excavated material may be either: (a) used in making the embankment to the channel; or (b) deposited in a neatly trimmed and uniform bank on the lower side of the drain with the toe of the bank being at least 0.3 metres from the edge of the drain. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 16 Channel an inlet, outlet and a floodway—16.1 Channel to an inlet, outlet and a floodway Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-20 Part 17 17.1 (1) Alignment If the finished alignment is approved by the Superintendent as a different alignment from that shown in the approved drawings and in the absence of other requirements for as constructed drawings, the Contractor must provide detailed as constructed drawings of the altered alignment to the satisfaction of the Superintendent. 17.2 (1) Contractual provisions Excavation The Superintendent retains the right to utilise the Principal’s tractor and tractor operator to assess whether or not material is rippable in accordance with section 6.5(3) of this standard specification. 17.3 Spoil (1) Surplus material from the earthworks remain the property of the Principal unless the Superintendent directs otherwise. (2) For spoil sites, the Contractor must provide to the Superintendent a spoil dumping indemnity identifying the property upon which the fill material is to be placed, signed and dated by the property owner and including the following minimum provisions: (3) 17.4 (1) 17.5 (1) (a) that the property owner agrees to indemnify the Principal (including its employees and agents) against any claim, action, liability, loss or damage which may arise in connection with the Principal entering upon the property owner’s property for the purpose of placement of fill material; (b) that the property owner agrees and acknowledges that the Principal bears no responsibility for, nor does it guarantee, the quality of the fill material and any compaction, levelling or trimming of the fill material; (c) that the property owner agrees and acknowledges that the Principal bears no responsibility for: (i) the placement of fill material on the property owner’s property by other persons or authorities; (ii) any contamination arising out of or in connection with the fill material. If a direction is given by the Superintendent pursuant to section 17.3(1) of this standard specification, the cost of such work is deemed to be included in the Contract Sum. Services If any damage occurs to existing services, the Contractor must immediately notify the relevant service authority and the Principal. Measurement and payment All quantities in respect of excavation materials shown in cubic metres in the Contract are solid volumes of excavation as compacted in accordance with this standard specification. Standard Specification No. 1 (Earthworks) Part 17 Contractual provisions—17.1 Alignment Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss1-21 Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of standard specification .................................................................. 1 PART 2 2.1 2.2 MATERIALS .............................................................................................................. 2 Landscaping materials............................................................................................. 2 Removal of material from the premises .................................................................. 2 PART 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 PLANT MANAGEMENT ............................................................................................ 3 Protection of a plant to be retained ......................................................................... 3 Work near a tree ....................................................................................................... 3 Damage to a plant to be retained............................................................................. 3 Maintenance of a plant to be retained ..................................................................... 3 Removal of a plant ................................................................................................... 3 Weed eradication...................................................................................................... 4 Methods for removal of plants ................................................................................. 4 PART 4 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 EARTHWORKS ......................................................................................................... 5 Erosion and sediment control ................................................................................. 5 Clearing and grubbing ............................................................................................. 5 Stockpiles ................................................................................................................. 5 Softworks grades ..................................................................................................... 5 Earth mounds ........................................................................................................... 5 PART 5 5.1 HARDWORKS ........................................................................................................... 6 Edges to a garden area ............................................................................................ 6 5.1.1 General requirements for edges to a garden area ................................... 6 5.1.2 Flush concrete edging ............................................................................ 6 5.1.3 Timber edging ........................................................................................ 6 5.1.4 Spade edging ......................................................................................... 6 Paths ......................................................................................................................... 6 5.2.1 General requirements for paths............................................................... 6 5.2.2 Concrete path ......................................................................................... 6 5.2.3 Unit paving path...................................................................................... 6 Outdoor furniture ..................................................................................................... 7 5.3.1 General requirements for outdoor furniture.............................................. 7 5.3.2 Footings to outdoor furniture ................................................................... 7 5.3.3 Water connection and drainage to outdoor furniture ................................ 7 Play area ................................................................................................................... 7 5.4.1 Play equipment ....................................................................................... 7 5.4.2 Footings for play equipment .................................................................... 7 5.4.3 Soft fall area ........................................................................................... 8 5.4.4 Shade structure ...................................................................................... 8 Bollards .................................................................................................................... 8 5.5.1 Cycleway in a park intersecting with a road ............................................. 8 5.5.2 A park adjacent to a road ........................................................................ 8 5.5.3 Materials................................................................................................. 8 5.5.4 Installation of a bollard ............................................................................ 9 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 PART 6 6.1 6.2 6.3 SOFTWORKS.......................................................................................................... 10 Cultivation .............................................................................................................. 10 Soil .......................................................................................................................... 10 Garden area and tree planting ............................................................................... 11 6.3.1 Fertiliser ............................................................................................... 11 Standard Specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi 6.4 6.5 6.3.2 Plant material ....................................................................................... 11 6.3.3 Tree planting ........................................................................................ 12 6.3.4 Transplanting........................................................................................ 12 6.3.5 Plant sizes ............................................................................................ 13 6.3.6 Mulch ................................................................................................... 13 6.3.7 Composted Forest mulch ...................................................................... 13 6.3.8 Pine bark mulch.................................................................................... 13 6.3.9 Hoop pine bark mulch ........................................................................... 13 6.3.10 Washed river mulch .............................................................................. 13 6.3.11 Organic embankment stabilisation matting ............................................ 14 Turf and grassing ................................................................................................... 14 6.4.1 Fertiliser ............................................................................................... 14 6.4.2 Grass seed ........................................................................................... 14 6.4.3 Turfed area........................................................................................... 14 Rehabilitation planting ........................................................................................... 14 6.5.1 Rehabilitation planting .......................................................................... 14 6.5.2 Plant communities ................................................................................ 15 6.5.3 Specific location requirements .............................................................. 15 PART 7 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.4 MAINTENANCE....................................................................................................... 16 General maintenance ............................................................................................. 16 Spraying of plants .................................................................................................. 16 Maintenance period ................................................................................................ 16 Maintenance works ................................................................................................ 16 7.4.1 Maintenance of a garden area .............................................................. 16 7.4.2 Maintenance of a grassed area ............................................................. 17 7.4.3 Maintenance of a tree ........................................................................... 17 PART 8 8.1 8.2 8.3 CONTRACTUAL PROVISIONS ............................................................................... 18 Materials ................................................................................................................. 18 Damage to plants ................................................................................................... 18 Landscape maintenance works ............................................................................. 18 Standard Specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pii Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 2–Landscaping 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in section 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification also forms part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being landscaping. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of standard specification If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 1 Introduction—1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss2-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) Materials Landscaping materials The materials and workmanship in respect of landscaping complies with: (a) AS 3660/1/2/3 2000 (Set) Termite Management; (b) AS 2156.1:2001 Walking tracks, Part 1: Classification and signage; (c) AS 1289.0:2000 Method of testing soils for engineering purposes, Part 0: General requirements and list of methods; (d) AS/NZS 2878:2000 Timber-Classification into strength groups; (e) AS 1604.1:2005 Specification for preservative treatment - Sawn and round timber; (f) AS/NZS 1604.2:2010 Specification for preservative treatment - Reconstituted woodbased products; (g) AS/NZS 1604.3:2010 Specification for preservative treatment - Plywood; (h) AS/NZS 1604.4:2010 Specification for preservative treatment - Laminated veneer lumber (LVL)); (i) AS/NZS 1604.5:2010 Specification for preservative treatment - Glued laminated timber products; (j) AS/NZS 1428.4.1:2009 Design for access and mobility, Part 4: Tactile indicators; (k) AS 3727-1993 Guide to residential pavements; (l) AS 1141.0-1999 Methods for sampling and testing aggregates - List of methods; (m) AS 4454-2012 Composts, soil conditioners and mulches; (n) AS 4419-2003 Soils for landscaping and garden use; (o) AS 2156.2-2001 Walking tracks, Part 2: Infrastructure design; (p) AS 1657-1992 Fixed platforms, walkways, stairways and ladders - Design construction and installation; (q) AS 4373-2007 Pruning of amenity trees; (r) AS 4685.1-2004 Playground equipment - General safety requirements and test methods; (s) AS 4970-2009 Protection of trees development sites; (t) AS 4687 - 2007 Temporary fencing and hoardings; (u) AS 1319-1994 Safety signs for the occupational environment; (v) AS 4970-2009 Protection of trees on development sites; (w) Specifying Trees NATSPEC 2nd Edition (2003) - Ross Clarke; (x) Chemicals Distribution Control Act 1966. (2) Unless otherwise specified in this standard specification, a manufactured item is used according to the manufacturer’s specification. (3) All landscape materials (soil, plants and mulch) are free from fire ants, certificate or legislation. 2.2 (1) Removal of material from the premises The removal of material from the premises is in accordance with section 2.4–Removal of material from the premises of Standard Specification No. 1–Earthworks 2015. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 2 Materials—2.1 Landscaping materials Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-2 Part 3 3.1 (1) Protection of a plant to be retained If a plant is to be retained the provisions of section 2.1–Protection of plants to be retained of Standard specification No. 11–Construction 2015 are to be complied with. 3.2 (1) Plant management Work near a tree Work near a tree which is to be retained is carried out in accordance with section 2.2–Work near a tree of Standard specification No. 11–Construction 2015. 3.3 Damage to a plant to be retained (1) If a plant to be retained is damaged, the plant is repaired or replaced in accordance with section 2.3–Damage to plants of Standard specification No. 11–Construction 2015. (2) In subsection 3.3(1)“damaged” means: (a) the destruction of a plant; or (b) the breaking of branches or roots; or (c) the debarking of trunks or limbs; or (d) the contamination of root zone soil or plants from drift sprays, dust or contaminated stormwater; or (e) the damage by the placement of fill or building materials within the canopy perimeter or otherwise; or (f) compaction from machinery; or (g) modification of surrounding hydrology; or (h) soil build up around the base of a tree. 3.4 (1) (2) Maintenance of a plant to be retained A plant that is to be retained is maintained by: (a) root and canopy pruning, irrigation and fertilisation of any necessary severing of the root system; (b) continued irrigation and fertilisation during establishment; (c) formative pruning as required in accordance with AS 4373-2007 Pruning of amenity trees; (d) maintenance until the plant demonstrates healthy growth. Tree maintenance work is supervised by an AQF Level 5 qualified arborist. 3.5 Removal of a plant (1) A tree that is not to be retained is removed in accordance with section 2.3–Removal of trees of Standard specification No. 1–Earthworks 2015. (2) A non-native plant is removed from an area requiring natural regeneration, revegetation or rehabilitation. (3) A native plant is only removed if: (a) the removal of the plant is necessary to ensure compliance with section 2.3–Damage to plants of Standard specification No. 11–Construction 2015; or (b) the native plant poses a threat to human health or safety or the functioning of a regional ecosystem. (4) If a native plant community poses a threat to the functioning of a regional ecosystem, thinning is to be carried out in respect of the native plant community. (5) The thinning of a native plant community does not: Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 3 Plant management—3.1 Protection of a plant to be retained Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-3 3.6 (a) focus on or completely eradicate one native plant; (b) reduce the regenerative capacity of the ecosystem; (c) alter the plant composition of the community so that it no longer represents the regional ecosystem; (d) remove all the plants forming part of the understorey or mid-storey of the plant community; (e) result in selective clearing that just retains large or older trees; (f) result in the replacement of the understorey of the plant community with pasture for grazing; (g) have an adverse impact on a remaining forest, erosion, waters, a habitat or a heritage place. Weed eradication (1) An environmental weed is removed from the premises. (2) An environmental weed on stockpiled topsoil is eradicated by the application of a glyphosphate herbicide or a similar herbicide approved by the local government, in accordance with the manufacturer’s specification. (3) An existing plant which is capable of colonising an area is retained where topsoil is not used directly in that area. (4) A weed or grass on an area to be landscaped is eradicated by the application of a herbicide prior to the spreading of topsoil. (5) Weed eradication is to occur in accordance with the SEQ Ecological Restoration Framework. 3.7 Methods for removal of plants (1) A plant that roots directly from its base and has shallow roots is to be removed by hand, by removing the main root system. (2) A weed that grows from a clumped, fibrous root system is to be removed using the crowning method, by cutting the roots from the crown of the weed. (3) A large weed infestation is to be removed in accordance with the SEQ Ecological Restoration Framework. (4) A plant being a tree or a vine is to be removed using the cut and paint method, by cutting the base of the stem close to the ground and immediately applying herbicide to the cut. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 3 Plant management—3.6 Weed eradication Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-4 Part 4 4.1 (1) 4.2 (1) 4.3 (1) 4.4 Earthworks Erosion and sediment control Erosion and sediment control measures are undertaken in respect of earthworks in accordance with Standard specification No. 11–Construction 2015. Clearing and grubbing Clearing and grubbing are to be carried out in accordance with Standard specification No. 1– Earthworks 2015. Stockpiles Stockpiles are created in accordance with Standard specification No. 1-Earthworks 2015. Softworks grades (1) The maximum grade for a garden bed is 1 in 3. (2) The maximum grade for a grassing area is 1 in 4. 4.5 Earth mounds (1) An earth mound is constructed from excavated material or imported fill, approved by the local government, in layers approximately 150mm thick and compacted to minimise slumping. (2) The corners and intersections of a plane of an earth mound is rounded and gradual. (3) The grading from the edgings has horizontal shoulders, with a minimum width of 500mm, before any change of level. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 4 Earthworks—4.1 Erosion and sediment control Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-5 Part 5 Hardworks 5.1 Edges to a garden area 5.1.1 General requirements for edges to a garden area (1) Where an edging crosses over an area of fill, the ground is compacted to the same level of compaction as an undisturbed area. (2) The sub-grade is compacted to the specified depth to form a level bed for the edging material. (3) Sub-grade material is free from extraneous material that will prevent even compaction and cause subsidence. (4) The finished grade of the edge to the garden bed is flush with all abutting hard finished and grass surfaces. (5) The alignment of an edge is a continuous curve or a straight line as shown on the approved drawings. (6) Edges to a garden area is in accordance with standard drawing LCC–8–00246. 5.1.2 Flush concrete edging (1) Flush concrete edging is installed in accordance with standard drawing LCC 8–00243. (2) The concrete used in concrete edging is equivalent to N20. (3) The sub-grade is compacted to a minimum depth of 150mm. (4) The curves for flush concrete edging are set out so that the radii are smoothly connected. (5) Flush concrete edging has control joints on 5 metre centres and at the apex of curves. 5.1.3 Timber edging (1) Timber edging is designed and installed in accordance with standard drawing LCC 8–00245. (2) Timber edging is not used on premises that is a public place or is to become a public place. 5.1.4 Spade edging (1) Spade edging is not used on premises that is a public place or is to become a public place, other than a rehabilitation area and a bush regeneration area. (2) Spade edging is created by using a sharp edge spade, to create a ‘v’ shaped channel to the edge of a garden bed. 5.2 Paths 5.2.1 General requirements for paths (1) A path is constructed in accordance with Standard specification No. 1–Earthworks 2015. 5.2.2 (1) 5.2.3 (1) Concrete path A path is designed and installed in accordance with: (a) standard specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) 2015; (b) standard drawings IPWEAQ R–0065 and LCC 8–00309. Unit paving path Unit paving is designed and installed in accordance with standard drawing LCC 8–00248. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 5 Hardworks—5.1 Edges to a garden area Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-6 5.3 Outdoor furniture 5.3.1 General requirements for outdoor furniture (1) Outdoor furniture is: (a) selected from items of outdoor furniture approved by the local government; (b) vandal proof; (c) suitable for the use to which it is proposed; (d) consistent with the immediate environment and existing outdoor furniture within that environment. 5.3.2 Footings to outdoor furniture (1) Unless the manufacturer specifies otherwise, the footings to outdoor furniture are to be core mounted and footings to be constructed in accordance with Standard specification No. 7– Concrete 2015. (2) The footings to outdoor furniture are installed in accordance with the manufacturer’s specifications or an engineering specification approved by the local government. (3) The concrete footings to outdoor furniture have the minimum strength of 20MPa. 5.3.3 (1) Water connection and drainage to outdoor furniture Outdoor furniture which requires water supply and stormwater drainage is provided with a water connection and stormwater drainage in accordance with Standard specification No. 12–Sub-soil drainage 2015 and the manufacturer’s requirements. 5.4 Play area 5.4.1 Play equipment (1) 5.4.2 (1) Play equipment complies with: (a) AS/NZS 4486.1:1997 Playgrounds and playground equipment, Part 1:Development, installation, inspection, maintenance and operation; (b) AS 4685.1-2004amdt 2 - 2008 Playground equipment–General safety requirements and test methods; (c) AS 4685.2-2004 amdt 2 - 2008 Playground equipment–Particular safety requirements and test methods for swings; (d) AS 4685.3-2004/samdt 1 - 2006 Playground equipment–Particular safety requirements and test methods for slides; (e) AS 4685.4-2004 Playground equipment–Particular safety requirements and test methods for runways; (f) AS 4685.5-2004/amdt 1 - 2006 Playground equipment–Particular safety requirements and test methods for carousels; (g) AS/NZS 4422-1996 Playground surfacing–Specifications, requirements and test method (incorporating Amdt 1 May 1999); (h) AS 2555–1982 Supervised adventure playgrounds, Guide to establishment and administration; (i) As4685.6–2004/amdt 1 - 2008 Playground equipment - Particular safety requirements and test methods for rocking equipment. Footings for play equipment Play equipment is installed to allow for a 50mm clearance from the top of the footing of the play equipment to the top of the surrounding subgrade. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 5 Hardworks—5.3 Outdoor furniture Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-7 5.4.3 (1) Soft fall area A soft fall area: (a) has a minimum 250mm depth soft fall sand bed complying with AS/NZS 4422–1996 Playground surfacing–Specifications, requirements and test method (incorporating Amdt 1 May 1999) above the subgrade; (b) provides for free drainage from the sub-grade and no ponding to the sub-grade; (c) is excavated to the levels shown on the approved drawings. (2) The soft fall area is connected to the stormwater drainage. (3) If the soft fall area cannot be connected to the stormwater drainage: (a) the outlets of the sub-soil drainage pipes are to be provided at a minimum of 3 metres from the play equipment pad; (b) if the premises do have sufficient fall to divert the flow, the flow is diverted via a turfed spoon drain, the profile of which is mowable, to the lowest point on the premises; (c) if the premises do not have sufficient fall to divert the flow, the drainage pipe is to be discharged into a rubble pit of 1m 3 water holding capacity per 5m² of softfall area. Pit is to be a minimum of 300mm below the sub-grade of the play equipment pad. 5.4.4 Shade structure (1) Where a shade structure is installed over play equipment, the shade structure is not to impede the vertical clearance heights of the play equipment. (2) The shade structure is certified by an engineer as structurally sound in the upper range conditions experienced in south east Queensland, including the wind terrain category and design wind speed for a specific site. (3) The shade structure has a minimum clearance of 2 metres between the fabric cover and each play equipment. (4) The shade structure provides a minimum shade shadow to cover of 90 percent of all equipment during the period from 11:30 to 14:30 during December to mid March. (5) The shade structure is rated above 90 percent for UV block out and uses Monotec 370 fabric or equivalent. 5.5 Bollards 5.5.1 Cycleway in a park intersecting with a road (1) A bollard which is provided at the end of a cycle path in a park to prevent direct access to a road is in accordance with standard drawing LCC 8–00702. 5.5.2 (1) A park adjacent to a road A bollard which is provided in a park adjacent to a road to prevent vehicular access to the park is: (a) in accordance with standard drawing LCC 8–00247; (b) provided at 1.5m centres to the sides of the park abutting a road reserve. 5.5.3 (1) Materials A bollard is: (a) 1200mm or 1500mm in length and 150mm in diameter; (b) made from a treated pine post in accordance with AS1604.1–2005 Specification for preservative treatment–Sawn and round timber; (c) circular routed at the top of the post; (d) free from defects, splits and splinters. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 5 Hardworks—5.5 Bollards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-8 (2) 5.5.4 The footing to a bollard: (a) is concrete; (b) has a minimum strength of 20MPa; (c) is installed to a depth of 650mm with a diameter of 400mm. Installation of a bollard (1) A bollard is installed with a maximum spacing of 1.5 metres and no deviations from the line or curve of the bollards shown on the approved drawings. (2) A footing to a bollard is excavated to achieve the footing dimensions and filled with concrete. (3) The bollard is stabilised in a vertical position at the centre of the footing to a depth of 600mm below the finished surface level until the concrete is cured. (4) On completion of the installation of the bollard, the surrounding area is cleaned up, debris is removed and any area disturbed by the work is re-established. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 5 Hardworks—5.5 Bollards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-9 Part 6 6.1 Softworks Cultivation (1) The sub-grade is rotated by rototilling to a minimum depth of 150mm. (2) Where a clay pan or a shale like rock lies within 500mm of the surface, layers are to be ripped to a minimum depth of 500mm. (3) The area in proximity to a service or a tree root is: (4) (a) to be undisturbed; or (b) cultivated by hand where it cannot be left undisturbed. Any stone exceeding 50mm in any direction and any extraneous material brought to the surface during cultivation is removed. 6.2 (1) Soil Soil: (a) is a fine soil type in accordance with Table 6.2.1–Soil type by texture of this standard specification; (b) is friable; (c) is moderately free draining; (d) complies with AS 4419–2003 Soils for landscaping and garden use; (e) is free of fire ants; (f) is free from Nut Grass (Cyperus rotundus); (g) report is to provided at pre-start meeting. (2) Soil is imported from a source approved by the local government or is provided from material upon the premises where approved by the local government. (3) Soil from the premises which is improved to comply with Table 6.2.1–Soil type by texture of this standard specification by the use of additives such as Gypsum, may be used as topsoil where approved by the local government. (4) If an additive is used to improve soil from the premises, the additive is applied in accordance with the manufacturer’s specification. (5) Soil is spread such that: (6) (7) (a) the finished surface of the soil is smooth, free of lumps and free draining; (b) the finished surface levels allows for the settling and spreading of mulch; (c) the soil is lightly compacted over the prepared sub-grade; (d) in a grassed area the edge of the soil is feathered into undisturbed ground. Where soil is next to a kerb, a path, a mowing strip or other hard paved surface: (a) the soil is finished flush for a seeded grass area and bevelled below the abutting finished grade to allow for turf or mulch; (b) the finished grade of the mulch is approximately 10mm below the abutting finished surface level; (c) the finished surface level of the turf is flush with the abutting finished surface level; (d) the finished surface level of a grass area, turf and a garden bed adjacent to a building or other structure is 125mm below the weepholes in the building or the structure. The minimum depth of soil for: (a) a turfed area and a seeded grass area is 100mm; (b) a garden bed is 300mm. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 6 Softworks—6.1 Cultivation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-10 Table 6.2.1–Soil type by texture Column 3 Soil type by texture Column 1 Composition Column 2 Test method Fine (loam) Medium (sandy loam) Coarse (loamy sand) Sand - <52 50-70 70-85 Silt - 28-50 0-50 0-30 Clay - 7-27 0-20 10-15 Organic matter AS1289.4.1.1-1997 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - Soil chemical tests Determination of the organic matter content of a soil Normal method >2 >5 >5 Salt content Electrical conductance <3.0dS/m <3.0dS/m <3.0dS/m Reaction pH value AS1289.4.3.1-1997 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - Soil chemical tests Determination of the pH value of a soil Electrometric method 5-7 5-7 5-7 6.3 Garden area and tree planting 6.3.1 Fertiliser (1) If fertiliser is required to be applied, the fertiliser is applied as determined by the manufacturer's specifications. Application of fertilizer should be in response to site soil conditions, imported soils and plant species to ensure continuous healthy growth. (2) Fertiliser is placed 50mm away from the root ball and at a depth that is equivalent to half the depth of the root ball, but no deeper than 250mm. 6.3.2 (1) Plant material A plant is: (a) free from disease, a pest and nursery weeds; (b) not an environmental weed. (2) A plant is not planted in adverse conditions including extreme weather conditions or waterlogged soils. (3) During planting: (a) the root ball of a plant receives minimum disturbance and exposure; (b) minor root pruning is carried out where necessary; (c) remove all nursery stakes and ties. (4) A tree is of stock quality as specified on standard drawing LCC 8–00237. (5) A plant is prepared for the specific growing conditions of the premises. (6) The mature size of a plant is appropriate for its location. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 6 Softworks—6.3 Garden area and tree planting Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-11 6.3.3 Tree planting (1) A tree planted in a garden area without a root barrier is planted in accordance with standard drawings LCC 8-00236 and LCC 8-00237. (2) A tree planted in a garden area with a root barrier is planted in accordance with standard drawing LCC 8-00235. (3) A street tree planted in a grassed verge is planted in accordance with: (4) (a) LCC 8-00242 Typical footpath setout detail; (b) Table 6.3.3.1–Street tree setback requirements of this standard specification; (c) standard drawings LCC 8–00236 and LCC 8-00237. A street tree planted in a paved area is planted in accordance with: (a) Table 6.3.3.1–Street tree setback requirements of this standard specification; (b) standard drawing LCC 8-00235 modified to provide a metal grate around the base of the street tree, flush with the paved surface and with a maximum 4mm gap between the metal grate and the paved surface. Table 6.3.3.1–Street tree setback requirements Column 1 Column 2 Object Minimum setback (metres) Road light pole 6.3.4 (1) 8 Electricity or telephone pole or pillar 2.5 Powerline 3.5 Water supply system and sewerage system 1.5 Back of kerb 0.6 Road sign 10.0 Path 0.6 from a path running generally parallel to a carriageway and 3.0 from a path which is running generally perpendicular to a carriageway Tangent point of the extension of the property alignment of a side road that intersects with a through road 8.0 if the through road is a minor road 15.0 if the through road is a major road Crossover 3.0 Street tree with a mature height which is less than 4 metres 6.0 Street tree with a mature height of between 4 and 6 metres 7.0 Street tree with a mature height of greater than 6 metres 10.0 Bus stop and bus shelter 10.0 Transplanting A plant is transplanted during its dormant period, where practical. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 6 Softworks—6.3 Garden area and tree planting Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-12 (2) A planting hole is prepared to allow for a minimum width, equivalent to 50 percent of the root ball diameter, to be backfilled beneath and surrounding the root ball. (3) The root ball is prepared for transportation by wrapping the root ball in hessian or a similar material to prevent disturbance of the root ball. (4) A transplanted tree with a calliper greater than 50mm at a height of 1.5 metres from the ground level is guyed with: 6.3.5 (1) (a) three wires spaced equally around the tree and attached at a 45 degree angle, at approximately 40 percent of the trunk height from the ground; (b) wires that are evenly taut and anchored or pegged into the ground; (c) wires with a surrounding rubber hose to protect the tree; (d) wires that are temporarily flagged where conflict with traffic may occur; (e) wires and flags that are removed after the tree has become established. Plant sizes A plant is of a size specified in Table 6.3.5.1–Plant size of this standard specification. Table 6.3.5.1–Plant size 6.3.6 Column 1 Type of plant Column 2 Minimum container size or type Column 3 Staked Tree 25/L Yes Shrub 200 mm As required Groundcover 140 mm No Vine 140 mm No Rehabilitation or revegetation work Tubestock or virocell As required Mulch (1) Mulch is kept free from the stem or the trunk of a plant to a minimum distance of 200mm radius. (2) Mulch is free of foreign matter including rock, soil, weeds and sticks. (3) Mulch in a garden area and at the base of a tree has a minimum depth of 100mm. 6.3.7 Composted Forest mulch (1) Composted Forest mulch comprises chipped tree trunk, branches and leaves of mixed plant species other than an environmental weed. (2) Composted Forest mulch is used on a batter, a mass planting area and in combination with other mulch in a garden area. 6.3.8 Pine bark mulch (1) Pine bark mulch is graded from 25-50mm in length free from other wood products. (2) Pine bark mulch is used around individual trees planted in a grassed area and in combination with forest litter mulch in a garden area. 6.3.9 (1) Hoop pine bark mulch Hoop pine bark mulch is used on a batter, a mass planting area and in combination with pine bark mulch in a garden area. 6.3.10 Washed river mulch (1) Washed river pebble is graded in size to ensure no movement in a peak stormwater event. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 6 Softworks—6.3 Garden area and tree planting Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-13 (2) Stones are free from foreign material and are consistent in colour and size. (3) Washed river pebble is used: (a) around stormwater drainage; (b) around an inlet and an outlet in an organic mulched area; (c) along a garden area where an organic pebble washout is probable or to aid in the drainage of the garden area. (4) The minimum depth of washed river pebble is a minimum of twice the diameter of the largest pebble. (5) Washed river pebble is not used in an area accessible to the public unless indicated on an approved drawing. 6.3.11 Organic embankment stabilisation matting (1) Organic matting shall be pinned and installed in accordance with manufacturers specification to ensure no movement. 6.4 Turf and grassing 6.4.1 Fertiliser (1) Fertiliser is to be applied as per manufacturer's specification to ensure healthy long term growth. 6.4.2 Grass seed (1) Grass seed is mixed and applied at the rates in accordance with the suppliers specifications and guidelines. (2) A failed grassed area is immediately repaired by raking, the seeding of grass and watering. 6.4.3 Turfed area (1) A turf roll has a minimum soil thickness of 20mm. (2) The turf is delivered to the premises within 24 hours of being cut. (3) The turf is laid within 36 hours of being cut. (4) Where the laying of the turf is delayed, the turf is: (a) protected and watered to maintain its condition; (b) not allowed to dry out at any stage from cutting to laying. (5) The turf is laid along the contours of the premises in staggered rows with the butt ends of the turf rolled together. (6) The edges of the finished grade of the turf are bevelled down a maximum 15mm below an abutting hard surface such as a kerb, a path, a mowing strip or other hard paved surface. (7) The turf is rolled to ensure contact between the roots of the turf and the topsoil bed. (8) Loamy sand is worked into the joints and depressions in a turfed area to correct any unevenness in the surface of the turfed area. (9) The turf is not provided on a slope steeper than 1 in 4. (10) A newly turfed area is protected from traffic. (11) A failed turfed area is immediately repaired by raking, the relaying of turf and watering. 6.5 Rehabilitation planting 6.5.1 Rehabilitation planting (1) Rehabilitation shall be carried out in accordance with the SEQ Ecological Restoration Framework (2012). Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 6 Softworks—6.4 Turf and grassing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-14 6.5.2 Plant communities (1) The plant community is representative of the species and density of endemic plant communities. (2) The plant community is self sustaining and self-regenerating. (3) The plant community provides habitat for native animals. 6.5.3 (1) (2) (3) Specific location requirements The upper part of a slope or a bank is planted with: (a) large trees with deep root systems; (b) shrubs that bind the soil; (c) ground covers that can filter stormwater. The lower part of a slope or a bank is planted with: (a) a dense undergrowth of shrubs; (b) native rushes and sedges with matted root systems and flexible branches to protect the bank from scouring; (c) plants that are tolerant of periodic inundation. An area subject to regular tidal inundation is planted with: (a) trees and shrubs suited to areas which are subject to regular tidal inundation; (b) herbs, grasses and vines that increase in density further away from areas which are subject to regular tidal inundation. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 6 Softworks—6.5 Rehabilitation planting Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-15 Part 7 7.1 Maintenance General maintenance (1) The premises is to be kept free of weeds and rubbish. (2) Any damaged, defective or stolen landscaping item is to be repaired or replaced. 7.2 Spraying of plants (1) An insect attack or disease amongst plant material is reported to the local government immediately. (2) A plant is sprayed with an insecticide or a fungicide or herbicide approved by the local government. (3) All spraying is to be undertaken in accordance with Chemicals Distribution Control Act 1966. 7.3 (1) Maintenance period The plants are maintained during the maintenance period such that at the end of: (a) the plant establishment period: (i) a seeded grass area is established with 80 percent grass coverage; (ii) a turfed area is established with 100 percent turf coverage; (iii) trees, shrubs and groundcovers display a level of growth consistent with the species; (iv) plants are in good health and display no evidence of disease, pest infestation or other damage; (v) the landscape area is free from weeds and rubbish; (b) the maintenance period, the provisions of paragraph (a) are complied with except that a seeded grass area is established with 95 percent grass coverage. (2) In section 7.3 “plant establishment period” means a minimum period of 12 weeks from the date of practical completion approval. (3) In this Part 7–Maintenance of this standard specification “maintenance period” means a period of 52 weeks from the Date of Practical Completion unless otherwise required by the local government. 7.4 Maintenance works 7.4.1 Maintenance of a garden area (1) A garden area is maintained during the maintenance period by: (a) watering, mowing, weeding, fertilising, controlling pests and diseases, returfing, reseeding, re-staking and tying, replanting, re-mulching, cultivating, pruning, aerating, renovating, top dressing and keeping the landscape area neat and tidy; (b) replacing a failed, damaged or stolen plant with a plant of the same size and species and equal to the size of a similar plant at the time of replanting; (c) watering each plant as necessary from the date of planting to maintain continuing healthy stress free growth; (d) maintaining a mulched area by keeping the area clean and tidy and reinstating the mulch as necessary; (e) adjusting and replacing a stake and a tie as required; (f) removing a stake as a plant becomes established and no longer needs support unless the stake is for a street tree or a marker staked plant; (g) adjusting any uneven settling or slumps by lifting the mulch, adding or removing approved soil and replacing the mulch to the required level; Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 7 Maintenance—7.1 General maintenance Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-16 (h) carrying out such other activities as are necessary to ensure compliance with this standard specification; (i) keeping mulch clear of plant stems to prevent damage to plants. 7.4.2 (1) Maintenance of a grassed area A grassed area is maintained during the maintenance period by: (a) mowing grass to 50mm height when grass has grown no higher than 75mm and removing grass clippings from the landscape area or as otherwise approved by the local government; (b) applying water at regular intervals to ensure ongoing healthy growth. 7.4.3 (1) (2) Maintenance of a tree A tree is maintained during the maintenance period by: (a) replacing a failed, damaged or stolen plant with a plant of the same size and species and equal to the size of a similar plant at the time of replanting; (b) watering each plant as necessary from the date of planting to maintain continuing healthy stress free growth; (c) maintaining a mulched area by keeping the area clean and tidy and reinstating the mulch as necessary; (d) regularly removing weeds; (e) adjusting and replacing a stake and a tie as required; (f) adjusting any uneven settling or slump by lifting the mulch, adding or removing the approved topsoil and replacing the mulch to the required level; (g) removing the lower branches of a tree planted in a road area as necessary; (h) fertilising and spraying the tree as necessary to ensure healthy growth; (i) pruning a street tree in accordance with AS 4373–1996 Pruning of amenity trees. If tree surgery is required to be carried out on an existing retained tree, a transplanted tree, a newly planted tree, or a damaged tree, the tree surgery is performed by a qualified tree surgeon. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 7 Maintenance—7.4 Maintenance works Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-17 Part 8 8.1 Contractual provisions Materials (1) Without derogating from the obligation of the Contractor to achieve Practical Completion by the Date for Practical Completion, the Contractor must advise the Superintendent immediately the Contractor becomes aware that supplies specified on the approved drawings are not available and provide names of alternative suppliers and proposed alternative materials. (2) The Contractor must obtain the written approval of the Superintendent before ordering alternative materials. 8.2 (1) Damage to plants If the Contract contains a provisional sum for the replacement of stolen or damaged trees, the Contractor must cost that provisional sum item. 8.3 Landscape maintenance works (1) The Contractor is not required to comply with the requirements set out in section 7.3(1)(b) of this standard specification. (2) If the Contactor fails to achieve the requirements set out in section 7.3(1)(a) of this standard specification within the plant establishment period: (3) (4) (a) the Contractor is to achieve the requirements of section 7.3(1)(a) of this standard specification as soon as possible after the plant establishment period; (b) the Contractor is not entitled to lodge its final payment claim under the Contract until such time as, in the Superintendent’s opinion, the Contractor has complied with its obligations under section 7.3(1)(a) of this standard specification. Subject to section 8.3(2) of this standard specification, from the Date of Practical Completion to the expiry of the plant establishment period, the Contractor is required to carry out landscape maintenance in accordance with: (a) Section 7.4–Maintenance Works of this standard specification; (b) the Maintenance Program. For the purposes of section 8.3(3) of this standard specification, the Maintenance Program: (a) is to be prepared by the Contractor and submitted to the Superintendent for approval prior to commencement of work under the Contract; (b) is to be approved by the Superintendent within 21 days of receipt; (c) is to contain details of the frequency with which the Contractor proposes to carry out its obligations under section 7.4– Maintenance Works of this standard specification. Standard specification No. 2 (Landscaping) Part 8 Contractual provisions—8.1 Materials Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Sc2-18 Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of terms ............................................................................................. 1 PART 2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 MATERIALS .............................................................................................................. 2 Materials and workmanship ..................................................................................... 2 Reinforced concrete pipe......................................................................................... 2 Fibre reinforced concrete pipe ................................................................................ 2 Unplasticised PVC (uPVC) ....................................................................................... 2 Precast reinforced concrete box culverts ............................................................... 2 No crack policy......................................................................................................... 3 PART 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 EXCAVATION............................................................................................................ 4 Excavation ................................................................................................................ 4 Drainage of bedding material .................................................................................. 4 Unsuitable trench foundations ................................................................................ 4 PART 4 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 BEDDING LAYING AND JOINTING OF PIPES AND BOX CULVERTS ..................... 5 Bedding and surround ............................................................................................. 5 Pipe laying ................................................................................................................ 5 Jointing pipes ........................................................................................................... 6 Pipe laying compliance testing................................................................................ 6 Laying and jointing of box culverts ......................................................................... 6 PART 5 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 BACKFILLING ........................................................................................................... 8 General standards .................................................................................................... 8 Under proposed pavements .................................................................................... 8 Under existing pavements ....................................................................................... 8 Under footpaths ....................................................................................................... 9 Sand, silt and debris in stormwater drainage pipeline ........................................... 9 Disposal of surplus spoil ......................................................................................... 9 PART 6 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 6.5 6.6 DRAINAGE STRUCTURES ..................................................................................... 10 General standards .................................................................................................. 10 Materials ................................................................................................................. 10 Construction of drainage structures ..................................................................... 10 Stone pitching ........................................................................................................ 11 Hand packed rubble ............................................................................................... 11 Concrete surround ................................................................................................. 11 PART 7 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.4 INTER-ALLOTMENT DRAINAGE SYSTEM............................................................. 12 Pipe bedding and backfill ...................................................................................... 12 Pipe materials ......................................................................................................... 12 Inspection manholes .............................................................................................. 12 Footpath crossing—outfall to kerb........................................................................ 12 PART 8 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 8.6 RESTORATION ....................................................................................................... 13 General standards .................................................................................................. 13 Asphalt pavements ................................................................................................ 13 Kerb and channel ................................................................................................... 13 Concrete pavements .............................................................................................. 13 Grassed areas ........................................................................................................ 13 Connection to water supply infrastructure ........................................................... 13 PART 9 9.1 9.2 CONTRACTUAL PROVISIONS ............................................................................... 14 Excavation in rock.................................................................................................. 14 Drainage of bedding material ................................................................................ 14 Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 3–Stormwater infrastructure 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in section 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being engineering work involving stormwater infrastructure. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of terms If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2 Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 1 Introduction—1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) Materials Materials and workmanship The materials and workmanship in respect of the construction of stormwater infrastructure comply with: (a) AS/NZS 1254:2010 and Amendment 1–2011–PVC Pipes and fittings for storm and surface water applications; (b) AS 1646:1–2007–Elastomeric seals for waterworks purposes–General requirements; (c) AS 4058-2007 Precast concrete pipes (pressure and non-pressure)–incorporating Amdt 1–1996; (d) AS 1597.2–1996 Precast reinforced concrete box culverts–Large culverts (from 1500mm span and up to and including 4200mm span and 4200mm height); (e) AS 1597.2 Supp1-1997 Precast reinforced concrete box culverts–Large culverts (from 1500mm span and up to and including 4200mm span and 4200mm height)–Commentary (Supplement to AS 1597.2–1996); (f) AS 4139–2003 Fibre reinforced concrete pipes; (g) AS 3725–2007 Loads on buried concrete pipes; (h) AS 3725-1989 Supp 1–2007 Loads on buried concrete pipes–Commentary (Supplement to AS 3725–2007). 2.2 Reinforced concrete pipe (1) Unless otherwise noted on the approved drawings all pipes are Class 2 and comply with the requirements of AS 4058–2007. (2) Reinforced concrete pipes are subjected to the load and absorption tests specified in AS 3725– 2007 Loads on buried concrete pipes where the load test is the three edge bearing method. (3) Pipes up to and including 600mm diameter are rubber ring jointed. (4) Pipes larger than 600mm diameter are either: (a) rubber ring jointed; or (b) flush jointed with manufacturer’s external fitting jointing bands. 2.3 Fibre reinforced concrete pipe (1) Unless otherwise noted on the approved drawings all pipes are Class 2 and comply with the requirements of AS/NZS 1254:2010 and Amendment 1-2011 - PVC Pipes and fittings for storm and surface water applications. (2) Fibre reinforced concrete pipes are subjected to the load and absorption tests specified in AS 4139-2003 Fibre reinforced concrete pipes - Appendices E and F. (3) All pipes are double-v-ring jointed (Elastomeric joint). 2.4 Unplasticised PVC (uPVC) (1) All uPVC pipes are Class SN8 minimum. (2) All uPVC pipes and fittings up to and including 225mm in diameter are either solvent welded or rubber ring jointed. (3) Pipes larger than 225mm diameter are rubber ring jointed. (4) Pipes larger than 300mm are not used. 2.5 (1) Precast reinforced concrete box culverts This section applies to a culvert which: (a) does not exceed 3.66 metres in width and 3.66 metres in depth; Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 2 Materials—2.1 Materials and workmanship Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-2 (b) is for installation either directly under a pavement or under a fill up to but not exceeding 1.5 metres in height. (2) The culvert comprises a single inverted U-shaped section forming the deck and the two walls, with a separate invert slab. (3) The invert slab provides a minimum depth of recess (including tolerance) into which the legs are mortared during placement so as to provide lateral restraint in service of: (a) 30mm for precast slabs; (b) 40mm for in-situ slabs. (4) The culvert and spanning slab supplied are suitable for use in fresh water. (5) A propriety “link slab system” may be used where approved by the local government. 2.6 No crack policy (1) Any pipe or culvert exhibiting any visible cracks on delivery is to be rejected. (2) For the purposes of section 2.6(1) of this standard specification ‘crack’ does not include: (a) surface craze cracks (usually of irregular pattern); or (b) hairline cracks (cracks just visible to the naked eye) not extending through the pipe wall. Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 2 Materials—2.6 No crack policy Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-3 Part 3 3.1 Excavation Excavation (1) The site of all excavation is cleared and a hole made as a result of an excavation is filled in. (2) At no time during the progress of the work is a length of trench opened up in advance of the pipe laying greater than can be laid in one working day. (3) All excavated material which is not used on the site as backfill is removed from the site and disposed of lawfully in accordance with all applicable laws. (4) Excavation does not commence until sufficient materials are on site, together with the necessary appliances and plant to ensure the uninterrupted progress and continuance of the works after excavation has commenced. (5) Excavation is made to the alignment and level shown in the approved drawings. (6) Where excavation is carried out in asphaltic concrete sealed pavements, the asphaltic concrete at 150mm beyond the limits of the excavation is cut prior to excavation with saws or other approved tools to near straight lines to facilitate restoration of the pavement to its original state. (7) Where excavation is carried out through grassed areas, turf is taken up and stockpiled for later relaying of the turf within the disturbed area. (8) All trenches are generally vertically sided, however open-cut trenches in which the sides above a level of 300mm over the top of the pipe are battered from the vertical may only be provided if the trenches are clear of structures and improvements. (9) If trenches are sheeted, the clear width between the inside faces of the vertical sheeting equals the trench width shown on the approved drawings. (10) Trenches are not excavated wider than the trench width shown on the approved drawings. (11) All excavations are made in a careful manner to ensure they are rendered secure and safe by sheeting or other means. (12) An excavation is protected to prevent slips or falls. (13) Excavation is shored up by props and intermittent, partial or complete planking in accordance with the Workplace Health and Safety Regulation 1997. 3.2 Drainage of bedding material (1) Upstream of each headwall, manhole, or gully (other than an end of line gully), a 3.0 metre length of 100mm diameter sub-soil drainage pipe is laid in the bedding material. (2) The sub-soil drainage pipe is: (a) Class 400 perforated corrugated PVC pipe Type 1 that complies with AS 2439.1–2007 Perforated plastics drainage and effluent pipe and fittings–Perforated drainage pipe and associated fittings and AS 2439.2–2007 Perforated plastics drainage and effluent pipe and fittings–Perforated effluent pipe and associated fittings for sewerage applications; (b) fitted with an approved geotextile filter sock where sand bedding is used. 3.3 Unsuitable trench foundations (1) Where the excavation encounters ground water or other poor ground conditions, the depth of the bedding and surround material is increased to provide adequate support for the pipe as approved by the local government. (2) If poor trench conditions exist, the pipe, or structure is supported by rock ballast which is: (a) sound igneous or metamorphic material that does not disintegrate in water; (b) of a 50mm nominal size; (c) completely wrapped in a non-woven geotextile fabric 1.9mm minimum thickness; (d) tamped into place. Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 3 Excavation—3.1 Excavation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-4 Part 4 4.1 (1) (2) (3) Bedding laying and jointing of pipes and box culverts Bedding and surround Bedding material conforms with the specifications in respect of: (a) type 1 (Ballast), or type 2 (Screenings), or type 3 (Course sand) as shown on standard drawing IPWEAQ D–0030; (b) the gradings in Table 4.1.1–Bedding material of this standard specification; (c) consists of clean, hard, tough, durable uncoated material of uniform quality, free from clay or any other deleterious matter; (d) is thoroughly compacted under the haunches and around the barrel of pipes; (e) is separated from other approved trench backfill materials by a layer of non-woven geotextile (Terrain 1000 s/uv or approved equivalent). Type 1 (Ballast) bedding material is: (a) used for reinforced concrete pipes, fibre-reinforced concrete pipes and pre-cast drainage structures; (b) is in accordance with standard drawing LCC8–0054. Type 2 (Screenings) bedding material is: (a) used for reinforced concrete pipes and fibre reinforced concrete pipes; (b) is in accordance with standard drawing LCC8–0054. (4) Type 3 (Course sand) bedding material is used: (a) for small u-PVC pipes; (b) in accordance with standard drawing LCC8–0054. Table 4.1.1–Bedding material Column 1 Sieve mm 4.2 37.5 Column 2 Type 1 (Ballast) % Passing 98-100 Column 3 Type 2 (Screenings) % Passing - Column 4 Type 3 (Coarse Sand) % Passing - 26.5 75-90 - - 19 15-25 98-100 - 9.5 0-2 35-50 98-100 4.75 0-1 5-10 95-100 2.36 0-1 0-2 70-98 1.8 - - 33-88 0.6 - - 12-63 0.43 0-1 0-1 8-40 0.3 - - 5-15 0.08 0-1 0-1 0-2 Pipe laying (1) Pipes are laid true to line and grade, and are free draining and firmly bedded. (2) Pipes are laid from the discharge end upstream to the following tolerances: Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 4 Bedding laying and jointing of pipes and box culverts—4.1 Bedding and surround Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-5 (a) invert levels–±50mm; (b) manhole locations–within 1000mm of design; (c) gully locations–within 300mm of design. (3) Circular pipes with elliptical reinforcement are supplied marked “Top” and “Bottom” to indicate the correct position when laid and such pipes are laid correctly according to the marking. (4) For pipes up to and including 600mm diameter, the socketed end of the pipe is laid upstream and a shallow excavation is made under the socket of each pipe so that the pipe fully rests for its full length of barrel upon the bedding material in the trench. (5) Elastomeric ring joints are carefully made ensuring the spigot and socket are clean, and the rubber ring is rolled evenly into place and elastomeric ring lubricant is used for fibre reinforced concrete pipes. (6) For concrete pipes greater than 600mm diameter, internal interlocking joints may be used and the pipes are laid generally as specified in section 4.2 (Pipe laying) of this standard specification. (7) Externally the pipe joint is sealed with an approved proprietary manufactured natural rubber jointing band. (8) Lifting holes in all pipes are plugged by a method approved by the local government. (9) Unless otherwise shown in the approved drawings, pipes are to be bedded as specified in section 4.1 (1) of this standard specification. (10) Pipe laying is in accordance with the recommended pipe laying practice set out in AS 3725– 2007 Loads on buried concrete pipes. 4.3 Jointing pipes (1) Where specified, spigot and socket pipes are joined by elastomeric ring joints which is in accordance with AS 1646–2007 Elastomeric seals for waterworks purposes–General requirements. (2) When a flush jointed pipe is used: 4.4 (a) the first pipe (downstream) is bedded to established line and grade with the groove upstream; (b) the external band is installed after the joint is made, in accordance with manufacturer’s recommendations. Pipe laying compliance testing (1) All pipes lines are subject to internal inspection and approval by the local government before being accepted on-maintenance. (2) The inspection of all pipes is carried out using a remote controlled video camera and the original copy of the unedited video tape with the date and time of the inspection visible on the pictures is submitted to the local government before being accepted on-maintenance. (3) A report on the findings of a remote controlled video camera inspection is to be submitted to the local government in an electronic format suitable for utilisation in “Sewer Rat” compatible applications. (4) Pipes do not show clearly visible cracks of more than one millimetre for a length of 300mm or more on the inside. (5) All rejected pipes are replaced with new pipes which undergo further compliance testing. 4.5 Laying and jointing of box culverts (1) Box culverts are laid on cast in-situ bases. (2) The crown of the culvert may be bedded on a stiff cement mortar made of three parts of sand to one part of portland cement. (3) The transverse joints between the crowns are sealed with a waterproof self-adhesive tape, 225mm wide such as “Denso 760” or equivalent. Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 4 Bedding laying and jointing of pipes and box culverts—4.3 Jointing pipes Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-6 (4) Longitudinal joints between multi cell box culverts are formed by a gap between the crowns of 40mm in width, which is filled with an approved concrete mix of maximum aggregate size of 10mm which is placed in appropriate layers. (5) Recessed mortar joints are provided on the bottom of all box culverts as specified in section 2.5–Precast reinforced concrete box culverts of this standard specification. Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 4 Bedding laying and jointing of pipes and box culverts—4.5 Laying and jointing of box culverts Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-7 Part 5 5.1 Backfilling General standards (1) Backfill is not placed until the pipe drain or box culvert has been inspected and approved. (2) All backfilling is benched in accordance with SEQ R-170-Trenching and widening in 250mm thick layers and compacted as specified in this section. (3) Trenches from a point 300mm above the crown of the pipe or box culvert and the spaces behind concrete drainage structures are backfilled with material approved by the local government from the excavations. (4) Where the onsite excavated material is not approved for use as backfill by the local government, the backfill material is to be an imported selected gravel or decomposed or even broken rock free from vegetable matter and lumps of clay with a four day soaked California bearing ratio of not less than 15. (5) The pipe bedding or box culvert bedding and the lower layers of backfill up to a point 300mm above the crown of the pipe or box culvert are carefully packed and rammed solidly in layers of 150mm, to 95 percent standard compaction as determined by AS 1289.1.1–2001 and Amendment 1–2002 and Amendment 2–2008 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - General requirements and list of methods. (6) Where the use of ballast as bedding material is approved by the local government, compaction of the ballast is not required. (7) The backfill on both sides of the pipe or culvert is placed concurrently and the level of the respective backfilling, after compaction, does not differ by more than 150mm. (8) The backfill material used for backfilling to a point 300mm above the crown of the pipe or culvert consists of approved material from the excavations or other material approved by the local government. 5.2 (1) Under proposed pavements The trench above the approved bedding and pipe surround to subgrade level is: (a) backfilled with approved material of minimum 4 day soaked California bearing ratio of 15 and compacted to 100 percent standard compaction as determined by AS 1289.1.1– 2001and Amendment1–2002 and Amendment 2–2008 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - General requirements and list of methods; or (b) backfilled with coarse sand compacted to a density index of 100 percent as determined by AS 1289.1–2000 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes–General requirements and list of methods or ballast with no compaction. 5.3 (1) Under existing pavements At least 150mm clear of the trench wall, the existing pavement is cut with a clean, straight line prior to excavation and the trench is backfilled as follows: (a) with cement stabilised gravel so that: (i) the trench above the approved bedding and pipe surround to subgrade level is backfilled with the cement stabilised gravel which is thoroughly compacted; (ii) the remainder is backfilled to within 50mm of finished surface level with approved pavement material and compacted to 100 percent modified compaction as determined by AS 1289.1.1-2001 and Amendment 1-2002 and Amendment 2-2008 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - General requirements and list of methods within a tolerance of +5% or – 2%; (iii) the top 50mm of the trench is filled with asphaltic concrete between the clean lines 150mm clear of the trench wall; or (b) with pavement material so that: (i) the trench above the approved bedding and the pipe surround, to within 300mm of subgrade level which is backfilled with material approved by the local government, with a minimum four day soaked California bearing ratio of 15, and compacted to 95 percent standard compaction as determined by AS 1289.1–2000 Methods of Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 5 Backfilling—5.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-8 (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) 5.4 (1) 5.5 testing soils for engineering purposes - General requirements and list of methods within a tolerance of +5% or – 2%; the top 300mm thickness, immediately below the subgrade is compacted to 100 percent standard compaction; the remainder is filled to within 50mm of finished surface level with pavement material approved by the local government and compacted to 98 percent modified compaction; the top 50mm of the trench is filled with asphaltic concrete; the surface is restored to a condition at least equal to that of the original pavement. Under footpaths The trench above the approved bedding, pipe surround or blanket course is filled with approved material from the excavations and compacted to 95 percent of the maximum dry density as determined by AS 1289.1.1–2001 and Amendment 1-2002 and Amendment 2–2008 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes–General requirements and list of methods. Sand, silt and debris in stormwater drainage pipeline (1) All stormwater drainage pipes are cleared of sand, silt and debris before being accepted onmaintenance. (2) If an outlet level is below the permanent water level allowance is to be made for bunding of the outlet and pumping out of the drain line before accepted on-maintenance. 5.6 Disposal of surplus spoil (1) At the completion of backfilling operations surplus spoil is removed from the site or is spread and compacted, as specified, on the site where directed by the local government in order to improve the area as much as possible. (2) All spoil spread on the site is left in a neat, tidy and self-draining condition with slopes of not flatter than 1 in 100 unless otherwise shown in the approved drawings. (3) Any rock or other material surplus to the requirements of the work and which is unsuitable or undesired for disposal on site, as above, is removed from the site. (4) Proposed spoil sites are approved by the local government before use. (5) For spoil sites within the local government area, a spoil dumping indemnity signed by the property owner is provided. (6) No spoil is dumped on any land within the local government area where the owner of such land has not obtained in writing from the local government an approval for the filling of the land. Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 5 Backfilling—5.4 Under footpaths Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-9 Part 6 6.1 (1) General standards A drainage structure includes all work and materials necessary for the construction of gullies, inlet pits and manholes, including excavation, concrete rendering and all necessary frames, curves, gratings, precast units and surrounds, precast troughs, chambers, lintels and shafts for side entry gullies, as specified in the approved drawings and standard drawings. 6.2 (1) Drainage structures Materials The following materials which are proprietary products and are supplied by a manufacturer approved by the local government are used: (a) precast concrete back-units for gullies and precast surrounds; (b) precast concrete side inlet gullies and manholes; (c) grates and frames which comply with AS 3996-2006 Metal access covers, road grates and frames; (d) mild steel components which comply with: (i) AS/NZS 3678:2011 Structural steel - Hot-rolled plates, floorplates and slabs (incorporating Amdt 1:1999); (ii) AS/NZS 3679.1:2010 Structural steel - Hot-rolled bars and sections (incorporating Amdt 1:1997 and Amdt 2:2000); (iii) AS/NZS 3679.2:2010 Structural steel - Welded I sections (incorporating Amdt 1:1998); (iv) AS/NZS 4791:2005 - Hot-dip galvanised (zinc) coatings on ferrous open sections, applied by an in-line process. (2) Cast iron components are fabricated from cast iron, grade T200, and comply with AS 18302007 Grey cast iron and AS 1831-2007 Ductile cast iron. (3) All cast iron components are: (a) thoroughly cleaned of all rust and scale prior to coating; (b) coated with hot bitumen or other system approved by the local government before leaving the manufacturer. (4) Epoxy mortar is a proprietary product from a manufacturer approved by the local government. (5) The class of the concrete is N32 with the exception of precast units which is Class N50 concrete. 6.3 Construction of drainage structures (1) Where necessary, localised excavations are constructed to permit the installation of concrete gullies, inlet pits and manholes. (2) Where in situ material at the bottom of excavations is other than rock, the material is compacted to not less than 95 percent standard compaction as determined by AS 1289.1-2000 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - General requirements and list of methods. (3) Where the sides of excavations are in solid ground, the manhole shafts may be constructed without the use of backforms. (4) Where concrete is placed without the use of backforms, the specified wall thicknesses is increased by not less than 50mm. (5) The walls of gullies and manholes are constructed so the thickness is nowhere less than the minimum shown on the plans nor greater than 300mm above the design thickness. (6) Gullies are generally the side entry type and manholes are the flat top type of the dimensions shown in the standard drawings. (7) Concrete benching is provided to manholes, gullies and inlet pits and is shaped to the shapes specified and has smooth, even surfaces and neat edges. Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 6 Drainage structures—6.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-10 6.4 Stone pitching (1) Stone pitching is composed of sound igneous, metamorphic or approved sedimentary rock which does not disintegrate in water. (2) Pitchers: 6.5 (a) have an average superficial area of not less than 650cm2 and a thickness of not less than 150mm, unless heavier pitching is specified; (b) are properly bedded to even planes on approved loam or sand, wedged together with stone chips and grouted with cement mortar to a depth of 65mm below the surface. Hand packed rubble (1) Hand packed rubble is used where specified and consists of sound igneous, metamorphic or approved sedimentary rock which will not disintegrate in water. (2) The stones are undressed and are not less than 0.015 to 0.02 cubic metres, except stones for wedging. (3) Large stones are selected for the lower row and for the downstream face and are so interlocked and wedged that no single stone can be dislodged. (4) Stones are laid with the side of greatest area perpendicular to the surface of the work and thoroughly wedged with stone chips. (5) Hand packed rubble is either dry packed, dry packed with cement grouted face or solid grouted with cement mortar as indicated on the approved drawings. (6) Mortar for grouting is composed of one part cement to three parts sand. (7) In the case of solid grouted hand packed rubble, stones are laid for their full depth in mortar and all interstices filled with mortar. (8) In the case of grouted face, mortar is worked between the stones to a depth of at least 75mm. (9) The joints are finished by being pointed in a workmanlike manner and stones thoroughly cleaned. After grouting, the mortar is kept moist and shaded for at least 48 hours. 6.6 (1) Concrete surround If drains under pavements have less than 600mm clear cover (from top of pipe to finished pavement level) they are to be surrounded with grade N10 concrete. Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 6 Drainage structures—6.4 Stone pitching Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-11 Part 7 7.1 (1) Pipe bedding and backfill Pipes are bedded: (a) as shown in the approved drawings; (b) on clean sharp river sand or other approved bedding; (c) with a minimum bed depth of 75mm. 7.2 (1) Inter-allotment drainage system Pipe materials Pipe materials used for inter-allotment drainage are: (a) uPVC sewer pipe minimum class SN8; or (b) uPVC drainage pipe PLASCOR or equivalent, of equivalent class to uPVC sewer class SN8; or (c) RC pipe class 2 rubber ring jointed; or (d) FRC pipe class 1 rubber ring jointed; or (e) uPVC pipes, that may be either rubber ring jointed or solvent weld jointed. (2) Standard manufacturer’s fittings are used with all the above pipes. (3) Saddles are not used. 7.3 Inspection manholes (1) Pre-cast systems are constructed by embedding the lower precast shaft section into a wet cast-in-situ concrete base. (2) Cut outs for pipe penetrations are made using concrete saws or drills in such a manner as to minimise damage to the pre-cast units. (3) Lids to cast-in-situ manholes are light duty, close fitting bolt down cast iron or galvanised steel, concrete infill type (Gatic Light Duty, polycrete broadsteel access covers or similar) of approximately the same internal dimensions as the manhole. (4) Lids to FRC and RCP manholes are the manufacturer’s proprietary concrete or concrete infill types. (5) Infill concrete is Grade N25. (6) Lids match the finished surface ground slope and sit 25–50mm proud. (7) Lids are marked “stormwater” impressed into the concrete infill. 7.4 (1) Footpath crossing—outfall to kerb Where the discharge of an inter-allotment drainage system is into the kerb and channel: (a) steel rectangular hollow sections separated by 25mm minimum spacers welded together and hot dip galvanised are used and are placed on compacted sand bedding; (b) the opening is either formed at the time of kerb and channel construction or saw cut and reinstated neatly with mortar. Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 7 Inter-allotment drainage system—7.1 Pipe bedding and backfill Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-12 Part 8 8.1 Restoration General standards (1) All buildings, fences, gardens, walls, paved surfaces, paths and other structures, grass and trees and other property are restored to a condition equivalent to that in which they were found before the commencement of works. (2) Initial cleaning up of the works is carried out as soon as backfilling is completed and restorations are completed within seven days. 8.2 Asphalt pavements (1) Saw cuts are made across the road surface at least 150mm clear of the trench wall prior to excavation. (2) All trenches across either asphalt or bitumen road pavements are restored with asphalt to a standard of finish existing before the work was commenced. (3) The surface of the restored gravel pavement between the saw cuts is: (4) 8.3 (a) dried; (b) given a thorough brooming; (c) uniformly covered with a fine sprayed coating of bitumen emulsion; (d) covered with a minimum 50mm layer of asphalt so as to join smoothly to the existing pavement. The restored surface does not pond water and the variation from a string line stretched across the trench does not exceed 5mm. Kerb and channel (1) Every care is taken to protect the kerb and channel from damage during the construction of the main kerb and channel is protected from damage. (2) When crossing the kerb and channel to lay the pressure main, the water supply infrastructure is burrowed under the kerb and channel. 8.4 Concrete pavements (1) Prior to excavation across concrete pavements, saw cuts are made for the full width of the concrete at least 150mm clear of the trench walls. (2) The depth of the reinstated concrete is not less than the depth of concrete section removed and is not less than 100mm and the concrete is Grade N20. (3) The surface finish of the reinstated section matches the adjoining sections with a neat, even joint. 8.5 Grassed areas (1) In grassed areas, the top 75mm to 80mm of backfilling is carried out with topsoil material which is free of stones and noxious weeds and is at least equivalent to the existing topsoil in the area being restored. (2) The grassed area is returfed with turf that has been stripped and stockpiled from the site. 8.6 Connection to water supply infrastructure (1) All connections to the existing water supply infrastructure are carried out by the local government. (2) All necessary fittings and joints are prepared ready for insertion in the line. Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 8 Restoration—8.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-13 Part 9 9.1 (1) 9.2 (1) Contractual provisions Excavation in rock The actual quantity of rock excavated is to be measured and calculated by the Superintendent from the width of the trench as shown on approved drawings and depths of rock measured along the trench. Drainage of bedding material Payment for drainage of bedding material is deemed to be included in the Contract Sum for construction of stormwater drainage including pipe jointing. Standard specification No. 3 (Stormwater infrastructure) Part 9 Contractual provisions—9.1 Excavation in rock Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss3-14 Standard specification No. 4 (Water supply infrastructure) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of standard specification .................................................................. 1 PART 2 2.1 2.2 MATERIALS .............................................................................................................. 2 Accreditation of pipe layers ..................................................................................... 2 Storage of materials ................................................................................................. 2 PART 3 EXCAVATION............................................................................................................ 3 PART 4 4.1 4.2 LAYING AND JOINTING OF PIPES .......................................................................... 4 General standards .................................................................................................... 4 Laying and jointing of pipes .................................................................................... 4 PART 5 BACKFILLING ........................................................................................................... 5 PART 6 VALVES AND HYDRANTS ........................................................................................ 6 PART 7 7.1 7.2 RESTORATION ......................................................................................................... 7 General standards .................................................................................................... 7 Restoration ............................................................................................................... 7 PART 8 8.1 8.2 8.3 INSPECTION AND TESTING..................................................................................... 8 Hydraulic pressure testing ...................................................................................... 8 Flushing and disinfection ........................................................................................ 8 Connection to existing live mains ........................................................................... 8 Standard specification No. 4 (Water supply infrastructure) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 4–Water supply infrastructure 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in section 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being engineering work involving water supply. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of standard specification If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard specification No. 4 (Water supply infrastructure) Part 1 Introduction—1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss4-1 Part 2 (1) 2.1 (1) 2.2 (1) Materials Materials used in water supply infrastructure comply with the SEQ Accepted Products and Materials in the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Accreditation of pipe layers Where the pipe manufacturer has a formal quality assurance program in place for the laying of its pipes and associated materials, the contractor is to ensure that at least one person who has been accredited to that program is present at the site during all pipe laying activities. Storage of materials Unless otherwise specified construction of water supply infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 4 (Water supply infrastructure) Part 2 Materials—2.1 Accreditation of pipe layers Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss4-2 Part 3 3.1 (1) Excavation Excavation Construction of water supply infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 4 (Water supply infrastructure) Part 3 Excavation—3.1 Excavation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss4-3 Part 4 4.1 (1) 4.2 (1) Laying and jointing of pipes General standards Construction of water supply infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code . Laying and jointing of pipes Construction of water supply infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 4 (Water supply infrastructure) Part 4 Laying and jointing of pipes—4.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss4-4 Part 5 5.1 (1) Backfilling Backfilling Construction of water supply infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 4 (Water supply infrastructure) Part 5 Backfilling—5.1 Backfilling Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss4-5 Part 6 6.1 (1) Valves and hydrants Valves and hydrants Construction of water supply infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 4 (Water supply infrastructure) Part 6 Valves and hydrants—6.1 Valves and hydrants Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss4-6 Part 7 7.1 Restoration General standards (1) All buildings, fences, gardens, walls, paved surfaces, paths and other structures, grass, trees and other property are restored to a condition equivalent to that in which they were found before the commencement of works. (2) Initial cleaning up of the works is carried out as soon as backfilling is completed and restoration is completed within seven days. 7.2 (1) Restoration Construction of water supply infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 4 (Water supply infrastructure) Part 7 Restoration—7.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss4-7 Part 8 8.1 Inspection and testing Hydraulic pressure testing (1) If water is extracted from the water supply system for the purposes of flushing and disinfection, the water abstracted is to be metered with a metered hydrant standpipe obtained from the local government at the contractor’s cost. (2) Testing complies with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. 8.2 (1) (2) Flushing and disinfection Water is extracted from the water supply infrastructure: (a) via a material hydrant stand pipe; (b) with the approval of the local government; (c) at the cost of the person extracting the water. Flushing and disinfection complies with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. 8.3 (1) (2) Connection to existing live mains Water is extracted from the water supply infrastructure: (a) via a metered hydrant stand pipe; (b) with the approval of the local government; (c) at the cost of the person extracting the water. Testing complies with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 4 (Water supply infrastructure) Part 8 Inspection and testing—8.1 Hydraulic pressure testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss4-8 Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of terms ............................................................................................. 1 PART 2 MATERIALS .............................................................................................................. 2 PART 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 CONSTRUCTION ...................................................................................................... 3 Accreditation of pipe layers ..................................................................................... 3 Construction ............................................................................................................. 3 Alignment and levels of a sewerage reticulation main ........................................... 3 Alignment and levels of a sewer rising main .......................................................... 3 PART 4 EXCAVATION............................................................................................................ 4 PART 5 5.1 LAYING AND JOINTING OF PIPES .......................................................................... 5 Laying and jointing of pipes .................................................................................... 5 PART 6 BACKFILLING ........................................................................................................... 6 PART 7 7.1 7.2 7.3 MANHOLES .............................................................................................................. 7 General standards .................................................................................................... 7 Step irons or ladders................................................................................................ 7 Manhole covers ........................................................................................................ 7 PART 8 8.1 RESTORATION ......................................................................................................... 8 General standards .................................................................................................... 8 PART 9 PUMPING STATIONS................................................................................................ 9 PART 10 10.1 INSPECTION AND TESTING................................................................................... 10 Testing of sewers ................................................................................................... 10 Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 5–Sewerage specification 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being engineering work involving sewerage infrastructure. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of terms If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) Part 1 Introduction—1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss5-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) Materials Materials Materials used in sewerage infrastructure shall comply with the SEQ Accepted Products and Materials in the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) Part 2 Materials—2.1 Materials Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss5-2 Part 3 3.1 (1) 3.2 (1) 3.3 Construction Accreditation of pipe layers Where the pipe manufacturer has a formal quality assurance program in place for the laying of its pipes and associated materials, the contractor is to ensure at least one person who has been accredited to that program is present at the site during all pipe laying activities. Construction Construction of sewerage infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Alignment and levels of a sewerage reticulation main (1) A sewerage reticulation main is constructed to the alignment and invert levels shown on the approved drawings. (2) Construction of sewerage infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. 3.4 Alignment and levels of a sewer rising main (1) A sewer rising main is constructed to the alignment and invert levels shown on the approved drawings. (2) Construction of sewerage infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) Part 3 Construction—3.1 Accreditation of pipe layers Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss5-3 Part 4 4.1 (1) Excavation Excavation Construction of sewerage infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) Part 4 Excavation—4.1 Excavation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss5-4 Part 5 5.1 Laying and jointing of pipes Laying and jointing of pipes (1) All pipe lines are constructed of pipes of such sizes and laid to such levels and grades as specified in the approved drawings. (2) Construction of sewerage infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) Part 5 Laying and jointing of pipes—5.1 Laying and jointing of pipes Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss5-5 Part 6 6.1 (1) Backfilling Backfilling Construction of sewerage infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) Part 6 Backfilling—6.1 Backfilling Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss5-6 Part 7 7.1 (1) 7.2 (1) 7.3 (1) Manholes General standards Construction of sewerage infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Step irons or ladders Step irons or ladders are not to be incorporated into sewer manholes unless approved by a specific design request in consultation with the Water Operations Branch. Manhole covers Construction of sewerage infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) Part 7 Manholes—7.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss5-7 Part 8 8.1 Restoration General standards (1) All buildings, fences, gardens, walls, paved surfaces, paths and other structures, grass and trees and other property are restored to a condition equivalent to that in which they were found before the commencement of work. (2) Initial cleaning up of the work is carried out as soon as backfilling is completed and restoration is completed within 7 days. (3) Construction of sewerage infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) Part 8 Restoration—8.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss5-8 Part 9 9.1 (1) Pumping stations Pumping stations Construction of sewerage infrastructure shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) Part 9 Pumping stations—9.1 Pumping stations Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss5-9 Part 10 10.1 Inspection and testing Testing of sewers (1) Testing shall comply with the South East Queensland Water Supply and Sewerage Design and Construction Code. (2) Before the Contractor advises the local government that any pipelines are ready for an inspection, the Contractor must ensure the as constructed information regarding the location and level is available and provided to the local government. (3) The as constructed information for the purpose of this clause is the information agreed by the Contractor and the local government, before any work is backfilled. (4) If any work is backfilled before the as constructed material is obtained, no payment is to be made to the Contractor for that work until the work has been re-excavated and exposed and the relevant as constructed information obtained. (5) Hydraulic pressure testing is to be carried out by the Contractor at its own risk and expense, and the Contractor is to provide all the labour together with all pumps, engines, pipes, temporary valves, plugs or flanges as may be necessary. (6) Temporary thrust blocks associated with testing are to be removed by the Contractor upon completion of testing unless otherwise directed by the local government. Standard specification No. 5 (Sewerage infrastructure) Part 10 Inspection and testing—10.1 Testing of sewers Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss5-10 Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of standard specification .................................................................. 1 1.4.1 Interpretation of terms............................................................................. 1 1.4.2 Definitions .............................................................................................. 1 PART 2 2.1 2.2 PAVEMENT MATERIAL ............................................................................................ 2 Pavement material.................................................................................................... 2 Pavement material specification ............................................................................. 2 PART 3 3.1 3.2 MATERIAL COMPLIANCE TESTS ............................................................................ 5 General requirements .............................................................................................. 5 Test methods............................................................................................................ 5 PART 4 4.1 4.2 PAVEMENT PREPARATION AND CONSTRUCTION ............................................... 6 Pavement preparation .............................................................................................. 6 Pavement construction ............................................................................................ 6 PART 5 5.1 TOLERANCE ON THE ALIGNMENT, GRADE AND CROSSFALL ............................ 8 Tolerance on the alignment, grade and crossfall ................................................... 8 PART 6 6.1 CONSTRUCTION COMPLIANCE TESTING .............................................................. 9 Construction compliance testing ............................................................................ 9 PART 7 7.1 7.2 7.3 TESTING FREQUENCY .......................................................................................... 10 Material quality tests .............................................................................................. 10 Compaction testing and degree of saturation ...................................................... 10 Test locations ......................................................................................................... 11 Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 6–Pavements 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in section 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being engineering work involving pavement. 1.4 Interpretation of standard specification 1.4.1 Interpretation of terms (1) (2) (3) If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance SC1.2– Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. 1.4.2 (1) (2) Definitions Despite the specifications of this standard specification, if the approved drawings specify a minimum soaked CBR value for the structural pavement materials, the value is determined unless otherwise specified: (a) at the degree of compaction specified in Table 6.1.1–Compaction and moisture control standards of this standard specification; (b) after a four day soaking period. The properties of the materials specified in this standard specification, are those of the material in the finished compacted pavement. Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Part 1 Introduction-1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss6-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) Pavement material The pavement material is either: (a) unbound granular material, which is used as base and sub-base courses and which: (i) consists of crushed rocks, soil aggregate or naturally occurring gravel; (ii) has a grading that makes it mechanically stable; (iii) contains sufficient fines for workability and provides a dense material with adequate cohesive properties; or (b) bound or treated granular material, which is used as base and sub-base courses and which consists of crushed rock, soil aggregate or a naturally occurring gravel. 2.2 (1) Pavement material Pavement material specification In the assessment of a material to determine its suitability for a specific function, the following properties of the material are assessed: (a) fines component—the fraction of the total material which passes the AS 0.425mm sieve in accordance with Table 2.2.1–Atterberg limits and fines ratio of this standard specification; (b) coarse component—the fraction of the total material which is retained on the AS 0.425mm sieve in accordance with Table 2.2.2–Mechanical properties of coarse component of this standard specification; (c) particle size distribution—the distribution of various fractions of material within the total product and the grading curve reasonably smooth and free from sharp irregularities in accordance with Table 2.2.4–Grading types of this standard specification; (d) material durability and strength in accordance with Table 2.2.3–Durability and strength criteria for various source material groups and Table 2.2.5–Strength specification of this standard specification. Table 2.2.1–Atterberg limits and fines ratio Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Property Test method Base course Sub-base Minimum - Maximum 25 Minimum - Maximum 28 Liquid limit (Ll). Q104A Plasticity index (Pi). Q105 (1) 3 6 3 8 (1) 1 4 1 8 Linear shrinkage (Ls). (1) (1) Q106 Pi x% passing 0.425mm sieve. - - 150 - 200 Ls x% passing 0.425mm sieve. - - 85 - 110 Dust ratio. - 0.30 - 0.55 0.30 - 0.65 Queensland Transport test procedures. Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Part 2 Pavement material—2.1 Pavement material Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss6-2 Table 2.2.2–Mechanical properties of coarse component Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Property Test Base course Sub-base Crushed particles. Method Q215 Min 70 Min 70 Flakiness index. Q201A Max - - 35 Max - - 40 Table 2.2.3–Durability and strength criteria for various source material groups Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Source material group Degradation factor 10% fines Wet/dry variation (Wet) (minimum) (minimum) (minimum) Test method Q208B Q250B Base 115 Sub-base 85 Q205C Acid igneous. Base 40 Sub-base 30 Base 40 Sub-base 45 Intermediate igneous. 45 35 125 90 35 40 Basic igneous. 50 40 135 100 30 35 Metamorphic. 45 35 125 90 35 40 Sedimentary Duricrust. 40 30 115 85 40 45 Table 2.2.4–Grading types Column 1 Column 2 Sieve size Percentage by weight passing sieve (mm) Grading B Grading C 75 - - Grading D (Subbase only) - 53 100 100 - 37.5 85 - 100 100 - 19.0 55 - 90 80 – 100 100 9.5 40 - 70 55 - 90 80 - 100 4.75 28 - 55 40 - 70 55 - 90 2.36 20 - 45 30 - 55 40 - 70 0.425 10 - 25 12 - 30 20 - 40 0.075 4 - 15 5 - 20 8 - 25 Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Part 2 Pavement material—2.2 Pavement material specification Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss6-3 Table 2.2.5–Strength specification Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Pavement material Sub-grade replacement. Test AS 1289.0-2000* Minimum CBR value 10 Sub-base (for roads below minor urban collector roads). AS 1289.0-2000* 45 Sub-base (for minor urban collector (access permitted) and higher). AS 1289.0-2000* 60 Base (for roads minor urban collector and below). AS 1289.0-2000* 60 Base (for urban collector roads (access permitted) and higher). AS 1289.0-2000* 80a * AS1289.0-2000 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - General requirements and list of methods Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Part 2 Pavement material—2.2 Pavement material specification Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss6-4 Part 3 3.1 Material compliance tests General requirements (1) Pavement material compliance testing is carried out by a NATA registered or equivalent accredited soils testing laboratory. (2) Pavement material accepted for use as sub-base and base courses complies with the test values listed under section 2.2–Pavement material specification of this standard specification. (3) One complete set of pavement material compliance tests is carried out for each material type for each 500 tonnes of material with additional testing carried out if the material source or supplier changes. (4) Prior to the use of road base material, the developer is to submit current certified evidence obtained within the last twelve months, from a Geo-technical consultant indicating that the proposed unbound material does not contain Sulphate amounts in excess of quantities that may induce Sulphate blistering in the bitumen surfacing. (5) A compliance testing certificate is forwarded to the local government prior to the commencement of construction of any pavement course. 3.2 (1) Test methods Testing procedures to determine compliance of the pavement material with section 2.2– Pavement material specification of this standard specification are carried out in accordance with: (a) for all coarse component, fines component and particle size distributions, the Queensland Transport test procedures, as indicated in Table 2.2.1 to Table 2.2.5 of this standard specification; (b) for the California Bearing Ratio (CBR) test, AS 1289.0-2000 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - General requirements and list of methods. Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Part 3 Material compliance tests—3.1 General requirements Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss6-5 Part 4 4.1 (1) Pavement preparation and construction Pavement preparation Work on the pavement does not commence until the subgrade has been inspected and approved by the local government. 4.2 Pavement construction (1) No pavement course is placed until the previous course, that is the subgrade, sub-base, base or existing pavement, has been inspected by the local government. (2) Pavement materials are transported, after the incorporation of water, from the stockpile or processing plant to the spreading area without segregation. (3) The paving material is spread in uniform loose layers on the prepared subgrade, sub-base or base by use of a spreader box or a mechanical spreader. (4) The material is shaped as necessary and compacted to conform with the grades and crosssections, specified tolerances and degree of compaction as indicated in this standard specification. (5) When water is incorporated into the paving material on the site, it is uniformly mixed to the full depth of the layer to be compacted to bring the material within a range of moisture content at which the specified degree of compaction can be achieved. (6) When two or more separate types of materials are mixed to produce a pavement material conforming with the standard specification, the separate materials, including any necessary water, may be uniformly mixed at the source by an approved process or may be uniformly mixed on the existing pavement with the approval of the local government. (7) A steel wheel, vibratory or pneumatic tyred roller or other approved compaction equipment or a combination thereof, is to follow directly behind the spreading and shaping equipment. (8) Under no circumstances are the pavement materials allowed to dry out before compaction. (9) If during the course of compaction, drying of the pavement material occurs, the surface is lightly sprayed so the pavement material moisture content is maintained such that compaction is achieved. (10) Where the required compacted thickness of any pavement course is 200mm or less, the pavement material is spread and compacted in one layer. (11) Where the required compacted thickness of any pavement course is more than 200mm, the pavement material is compacted in two or more layers each not less than 75mm compacted thickness and not greater than 150mm compacted thickness. (12) If a pavement layer has been compacted to the specified degree of compaction, but shows signs of deformation under proof rolling, then further work to improve the stability and density of the pavement material is necessary before subsequent layers can be placed. (13) The compaction criteria for each course is in accordance with Table 5.1.1–Tolerance on the alignment, grade and crossfall of this standard specification. (14) After compaction of the pavement material, the whole of the surface is graded, trimmed, watered and rolled to produce a hard, tight, dense, even surface, free of lenses and caking, in accordance with the tolerances specified in Table 5.1.1–Tolerance on the alignment, grade and crossfallof this standard specification. (15) The compacted surface of the pavement material presents as particles of stone in a matrix of fine material such that: (a) there is not an excessive proportion of stone in that the pavement material is deficient in fines; (b) there is not an excessive proportion of fines in that the pavement material has excessive fines or a fatty area. Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Part 4 Pavement preparation and construction—4.1 Pavement preparation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss6-6 (16) The action of a power broom does not remove an excessive quantity of material from the surface. (17) Compaction testing of the top layer of the base course is not undertaken until the surface has passed the above criteria. (18) Bitumen surfacing does not proceed until the profile, surface, compaction, quality and finish of the pavement has been approved by the local government. (19) If the pavement, for any reason, loses the required quality, stability, density or finish before the surfacing is complete, it is recompacted. (20) Use a loaded water truck, with a single rear axle, and with a gross mass of not less than 15 tonne, or a similar vehicle approved by the local government, for proof rolling. No visible movement shall occur under the rear axle when proof rolling. Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Part 4 Pavement preparation and construction—4.2 Pavement construction Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss6-7 Part 5 5.1 (1) Tolerance on the alignment, grade and crossfall Tolerance on the alignment, grade and crossfall The finished pavement complies with the alignment and dimensions shown on the approved drawings or within the tolerances specified in Table 5.1.1–Tolerance on the alignment, grade and crossfall of this standard specification. Table 5.1.1–Tolerance on the alignment, grade and crossfall Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Course Design level tolerance +10mm -30mm Thickness tolerance N/A N/A Shape tolerance Sub-grade. N/A N/A Sub-base. +10mm -10mm +40mm -20mm 25mm in3 metres maximum Base. +15mm -10mm +15mm -15mm 15mm in 3 metres maximum Wearing course. +10mm - 5mm +15mm - 0mm 7mm in3metres maximum (2) The mean crossfall of the surface of the finished pavement does not deviate from the crossfall shown in the approved drawings by more than ±0.5 percent. (3) Despite the above tolerances and those specified in Standard specification No. 1–Earthworks 2015, the compacted depth of the pavement is not less than that shown in the approved drawings. (4) When the section of the road to be constructed adjoins a section which has been constructed and bitumen surfaced, the grade level at the end of the work conforms to that at the previously constructed section. (5) If the section under construction does not adjoin a previously constructed section, the ends of the new formation are joined to the existing surface level by means of a ramp at a grade which does not vary from the plan gradient by more than 1 in 20. (6) A ramp is joined to the new surface level and to the existing surface level by an easy vertical curve. Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Part 5 Tolerance on the alignment, grade and crossfall—5.1 Tolerance on the alignment, grade and crossfall Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss6-8 Part 6 6.1 Construction compliance testing Construction compliance testing (1) Despite compliance of the pavement material to the requirements in section 2.2–Pavement material specification of this standard specification, acceptance or otherwise of the pavement is based on the compacted material incorporated in the work. (2) Each pavement layer is tested for compaction and degree of saturation in accordance with Table 6.1.1–Compaction and moisture control standardsof this standard specification. (3) Each compacted pavement course is tested for soaked California Bearing Ratio, grading, Atterberg limits and fines ratio values in accordance with section 2.2–Pavement material specification of this standard specification. (4) The material compliance testing is carried out by a NATA registered soils testing laboratory. (5) A compliance testing certificate is forwarded to the local government prior to the commencement of construction of any subsequent course. Table 6.1.1–Compaction and moisture control standards (6) Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Course Degree of compaction Degree of saturation Maximum Subgrade 95% Standard Compaction - Sub-base 95% Modified Compaction 65% Base 98% Modified Compaction 65% Modified compaction may be used in some circumstances, depending on material type and site as determined by the local government. Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Part 6 Construction compliance testing—6.1 Construction compliance testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss6-9 Part 7 7.1 Testing frequency Material quality tests (1) Soaked C.B.R., grading, Atterberg limit tests and fines ratio values tests are carried out on the sub-base and the base course material at a frequency of 1 test per course or 500m 3, whichever requires the greater number of tests. (2) All coarse component, fines component and particle size distributions tests are carried out in accordance with Queensland Transport test procedures as indicated in Table 2.2.1 to Table 2.2.5 of this standard specification. (3) The California Bearing Ratio test is carried out in accordance with AS 1289.0-2000 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - General requirements and list of methods, and the specified type and degree of compaction noted in Table 6.1.1–Compaction and moisture control standardsof this standard specification. 7.2 Compaction testing and degree of saturation (1) A compaction test is required on the subgrade, sub-base and base layers at a frequency of 1 test per 100 linear metres of two lane construction, subject to a minimum of two tests per job. (2) A compaction test is carried out in accordance with AS 1289.0-2000 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - General requirements and list of methods. (3) When compaction testing is carried out on the sub-base and base layers, the degree of saturation of the material tested is determined by the following procedure: Degree of saturation (%) = W -------------DW - 1 Dd Gs Where: DW is the 1.0t/m3 density of water Dd is the in-situ dry density of layer tested t/m3 Gs is the specific gravity of material tested (Q109) W is the in-situ moisture content of layer tested (4) Compaction testing is not carried out on the pavement material while the material to be tested is still green but is tested after the material has cured and a hard, tight, dense, even surface free of lenses and caking has been produced. (5) A pavement layer is not covered by any subsequent layer or wearing course if the degrees of compaction and saturation are outside the limits given in Table 6.1.1–Compaction and moisture control standardsof this standard specification. (6) The testing frequency in section 7.2(1) of this standard specification is based upon a ‘not one to fail’ basis and failure to comply with the criteria in section 7.2(1) of this standard specification will result in the removal or reworking of the failed section or further in-situ testing where compaction test results are within 2 percent of the specified criteria. (7) When a nuclear moisture density gauge is used to determine the in-situ density and moisture content of a pavement material, verification that the gauge’s density and moisture calibration equation are appropriate for the material type are undertaken by carrying out sand replacement tests as required in Section 3: Field Calibration Procedures of the Queensland Nuclear Testing Manual, 2012, Amendment 5 January 2014. Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Part 7 Testing frequency—7.1 Material quality tests Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss6-10 (8) The use of visual appraisal for determining the suitability of the calibration equation for a particular material type is not undertaken until field calibrations on similar material are made available to the local government for consideration. (9) All retest results are submitted to the local government prior to the sealing of the pavement material. (10) Regardless of compliance with the testing, the pavement layer does not suffer deformation under proof rolling as defined in section 5.4 of AS 3798:2007 Guidelines on earthworks for commercial and residential developments. 7.3 Test locations (1) Compaction test locations which are indicative of the general condition of the pavement are selected by the geotechnical testing authority. (2) Only levels 1 or 2 type commissions of a geotechnical testing authority as defined in appendix B of AS 3798:2007 Guidelines on earthworks for commercial and residential developments, are undertaken. (3) A sample taken from the compacted pavement for material compliance testing is sampled from an area which is representative of the material quality and consistency. Standard specification No. 6 (Pavements) Part 7 Testing frequency—7.3 Test locations Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss6-11 Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of standard specification .................................................................. 1 PART 2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 MATERIALS .............................................................................................................. 2 Materials ................................................................................................................... 2 Classes of concrete ................................................................................................. 2 Preliminary mixes..................................................................................................... 3 Consistency.............................................................................................................. 3 Batching ................................................................................................................... 4 PART 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 SAMPLING AND TESTING ....................................................................................... 5 Sampling and testing ............................................................................................... 5 Delivery dockets....................................................................................................... 5 Rejection................................................................................................................... 5 PART 4 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 PLACING AND COMPACTING ................................................................................. 6 Placing and compacting .......................................................................................... 6 Weather conditions .................................................................................................. 7 Placing time limit ...................................................................................................... 7 Placing under water ................................................................................................. 8 Construction joints .................................................................................................. 8 PART 5 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 FORMWORK AND FALSEWORK ........................................................................... 10 General ................................................................................................................... 10 Falsework ............................................................................................................... 10 Formwork................................................................................................................ 10 Formwork for exposed surfaces............................................................................ 11 Formwork for hidden surface ................................................................................ 11 PART 6 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 FINISHING ............................................................................................................... 12 Finishing ................................................................................................................. 12 Removal of forms, falsework and centring ........................................................... 12 Curing ..................................................................................................................... 13 Dimensional tolerances ......................................................................................... 13 PART 7 7.1 CONTRACTUAL PROVISIONS ............................................................................... 15 Cost of testing ........................................................................................................ 15 PART 8 SHOTCRETE AND STONE PITCHING .................................................................... 16 Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Pi Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 7–Concrete 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in section 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being engineering work involving the use of Portland Cement concrete and ordinary reinforced concrete and mass concrete. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of standard specification If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; and (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 1 Introduction–1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-1 Part 2 2.1 Materials Materials (1) Unless otherwise stated, all concrete is composed of Portland Cement, fine aggregate, coarse aggregate, additives if approved and water proportioned and mixed as specified in this standard specification and AS 1379-2007 and Supp 1-2008 Specification and supply of concrete. (2) All cement used: (a) is Type GP Portland Cement of approved brand and Australian manufacture, unless otherwise stated; (b) complies with AS 1379-2007 Specification and supply of concrete, AS 1379-1997/Amdt 1-2000 Specification and supply of concrete. (3) Water is free from matter harmful to concrete and complies with AS 1379-1997 Specification and supply of concrete, AS 1379-2007/Amdt 1-2000 Specification and supply of concrete. (4) Fine aggregate consists of: (5) (6) (a) natural sand or, a combination of natural and manufactured sand containing not less than 50 percent natural sands; (b) particles which are clean hard and durable and comply with AS 2758.1-1998 Aggregates and rock for engineering purposes - Concrete aggregates. Coarse aggregate: (a) is a maximum size of 40mm and consists of clean, durable, uncrushed gravel, crushed stone, or combinations thereof; (b) is free from coatings of clay or dirt, organic and other deleterious matter; (c) complies with AS 2758.1-1998 Aggregates and rock for engineering purposes - Concrete aggregates. Fly ash may be used in concrete if: (a) an intention to use fly ash either separately or as blended cement is notified to the local government together with the proposed proportions when details of the mix design are submitted; (b) fly ash complies with AS 3582.1-1998 Supplementary cementitious materials for use with portland and blended cement - Fly ash (incorporating Amdt 1-1999) and is obtained from an approved source; (c) fly ash is used in accordance with AS 3582.1-1998 Supplementary cementitious materials for use with portland and blended cement - Fly ash (incorporating Amdt 1-1999). (7) Admixtures in concrete are used only with the written approval of the local government and comply in all ways with AS 1478.1-2000 Chemical admixtures for concrete, mortar and grout Admixtures for concrete. (8) Calcium chloride is not used as an admixture. (9) Where air entrainment is allowed, the air content is within the range 3 to 5 percent and a suitable air content gauging device is available so that the air content of the freshly mixed concrete is accurately determined and recorded. 2.2 Classes of concrete (1) Concrete is classified in accordance with AS 1379-2007 and Supp 1-2008 Specification and supply of concrete. (2) The minimum cementitious content and maximum water/cementitious ratio shall be as shown in Table 2.2.1–Minimum cementitious content of this standard specification for the strength grade shown in the drawings. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 2 Materials–2.1 Materials Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-2 Table 2.2.1–Minimum cementitious content Exposure classification Minimum cementitious content (kg/m3) Maximum water cementitious ratio Strength grade (Mpa) B1 320 0.56 32 B2 390 0.46 40 C 450 0.4 50 2.3 (1) Preliminary mixes If insufficient history is available for the specified mix from an approved supplier, preliminary mixes for all grades of concrete are designed, made and tested. 2.4 (1) Consistency The consistency and workability of concrete is such that: (a) it complies with the limits specified in Table 2.4.1–Slump values for plain and reinforced concreteof this standard specification; (b) can be handled and transported without segregation and can be placed, worked and compacted to achieve the desired finish and quality into all corners, angles and narrow sections of forms and around reinforcement. (2) The consistency of the concrete is checked by use of a slump cone in accordance with AS 1012.1-1993 Methods of testing concrete - Sampling of fresh concrete. (3) No extra water is added to the concrete on site unless: (a) the amount of the water being added is measured and recorded; (b) the concrete is thoroughly remixed and a slump test taken to ensure the consistency is still within the specified limits in this standard specification. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 2 Materials–2.3 Preliminary mixes Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-3 Table 2.4.1–Slump values for plain and reinforced concrete Characteristic strength (Mpa)/Application Target Slump range 20/Cast Insitu 70 - 120 25/Cast Insitu 70 - 120 32/Cast Insitu 70 - 150 40/Cast Insitu 60 - 150 50/Cast Insitu 50 - 150 32 - 50/Pumped concrete 100 - 150 32 - 50/Sprayed concrete Slump to suit equipment 32 - 50/Extruded concrete Slump to suit equipment 32 - 50/Tremie concrete 150 - 180 in dry conditions or 180 - 220 in wet conditions 32 - 50/Precast concrete elements 80 - 180 2.5 Batching (1) Concrete is not batched onsite. (2) Ready mixed concrete is supplied by a manufacturer: (3) (a) approved by the local government; (b) which has an accredited quality assurance system. The production, delivery and testing of ready mixed concrete is carried out in accordance with the requirements of AS 1379-2007 and Supp 1-2008 Specification and supply of concrete, except as otherwise specified. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 2 Materials–2.5 Batching Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-4 Part 3 3.1 (1) Sampling and testing The concrete is sampled and tested in accordance with AS 1012.1-1993 Methods of testing concrete - Sampling of fresh concrete, by an approved NATA registered laboratory and the results are provided to the local government. 3.2 (1) (2) 3.3 Sampling and testing Delivery dockets Copies of “delivery dockets” or other similar documentation issued by the manufacturer of the concrete are supplied to the local government which contain the following information: (a) the name of the manufacturer and the place of manufacture of the concrete; (b) the serial number of the certificate; (c) the date of supply of the concrete; (d) the name of the user; (e) the project name and location; (f) the delivery vehicle identification; (g) the quantity of concrete covered by the certificate; (h) the specified class and strength grade of the concrete; and (i) the specified slump values; (j) the maximum nominal size of the aggregate; (k) the time of commencement of the mixing of the concrete; (l) the time of delivery to the site; (m) a copy of the plant control results if requested. If project assessment is required, it is carried out in accordance with AS 3600-2009 Concrete structures (incorporating Amdt 1-2010). Rejection (1) Plastic and hardened concrete is rejected in accordance with the criteria in AS 3600-2009 Concrete structures (incorporating Amdt 1-2010). (2) All rejected concrete is removed from site and made good. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 3 Sampling and testing–3.1 Sampling and testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-5 Part 4 4.1 Placing and compacting Placing and compacting (1) All concrete is placed in dry conditions and no concrete is placed until the formwork, falsework, and reinforcing materials have been inspected and approved by the local government. (2) Concrete is placed in a continuous manner between approved construction joints so as to avoid placement against concrete which has taken an initial set. (3) Any troughs and chutes used as aids in placing concrete are arranged and used in a manner that does not cause segregation. (4) Water is not used to facilitate the movement of concrete along troughs or chutes but all troughs and chutes are kept clean and free of coating of hardened concrete by flushing thoroughly with water which is discharged well clear of concrete in place. (5) Pneumatic placers and concrete pumps are only used if: (a) approved by the local government; (b) the equipment is arranged so that freshly placed concrete is not damaged by vibration; (c) the delivery end of the pipe terminates in a fitting of an approved design which prevents the segregation of the concrete; (d) after the completion of any concreting operations, the equipment is thoroughly cleaned. (6) Concrete is not dropped from a height exceeding 1.5 metres or in such a manner so as to cause segregation or loss of material. (7) After the initial set of the concrete, the forms are not jarred and no strain is placed on the ends of projecting reinforcing bars. (8) All concrete is thoroughly compacted during and immediately after depositing. (9) Concrete other than no-fines concrete is compacted with high frequency internal vibrators in the manner described in this standard specification. (10) Hand compaction in lieu of mechanical vibration is allowed only on works as an emergency measure when approved by the local government. (11) External form vibrators are not permitted. (12) Internal vibrators: (a) are of a type, capable of transmitting vibration to the concrete at frequencies of not less than 8000 impulses per minute at such an intensity as to visibly effect a 25mm slump concrete at a radius of 300mm; (b) for grades of concrete of N32 and stronger are capable of transmitting vibration to the concrete at frequencies of not less than 12000 impulses per minute at such an intensity as to visibly effect a zero slump concrete at a radius of 300mm; (c) are of sufficient number to properly compact each batch immediately after it is placed in the forms where the minimum number of vibrators provided depends on the rate of placing concrete but in no case are there less than 1 vibrator for each 4 cubic metres of concrete or part thereof placed per hour, with a minimum of 2 vibrators; (d) are used such that: (i) a vibrator is inserted into the concrete at successive positions not more than 450mm apart and vibration continues at each position until air bubbles cease to emerge when it is then withdrawn slowly; (ii) a vibrator is inserted so as to thoroughly compact the concrete around the reinforcement and embedded fixtures and into the corner and angles of the forms; (iii) vibration is applied at the point of deposit and in the area of freshly deposited concrete; (iv) where more than one layer is being placed in a continuous operation, the vibrator is inserted through the layer into the layer below; Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 4 Placing and compacting–4.1 Placing and compacting Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-6 (v) (vi) 4.2 (1) vibration is not applied to sections or layers of concrete which have hardened to the degree that the concrete ceases to be plastic under vibration; vibration is not applied directly to reinforcement. Weather conditions Where the ambient temperature is likely to exceed 30°C, all practical precautions are taken to maintain the concrete at a temperature not exceeding 30°C at the time of placing to prevent shrinkage, settlement and presetting cracks, including: (a) the placement of the concrete at a time of day when the concrete temperature is likely to be below 30°C; (b) the shading of aggregate stockpiles; (c) the addition of chilled water to the concrete; (d) the insulating or burying of pipe lines; (e) the painting of water tanks white; (f) the cooling of formwork by damping with water sprays; (g) the shading of work areas; (h) the erection of wind breaks; (i) a reduction in the time for placing and finishing; (j) the application of an evaporation retardant such as aliphatic alcohol. (2) No concrete with a temperature higher than 30°C is placed unless otherwise approved by the local government. (3) No concrete is placed when the shade temperature is likely to be less than 5°C during or within 2 hours of placement. 4.3 Placing time limit (1) Ready mixed concrete is placed and compacted within 1 hour 15 minutes of charging the mixer for concrete temperatures up to 30°C and within 30 minutes of charging the mixer. (2) The quantity of concrete delivered and the timing of delivery is such that the placing operation is continuous. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 4 Placing and compacting–4.2 Weather conditions Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-7 4.4 Placing under water (1) Concrete is only placed under water if: (a) approved by the local government; (b) where the conditions are such that cofferdams or cylinders can be sealed only by placing concrete under water, the work is carried out under the immediate supervision of the local government; (c) the quantity of cement in the concrete is increased by 10 percent above the minimum cement quantity for the approved mix; (d) concrete is not placed in running water and cofferdams or cylinders are sufficiently tight to maintain still water at the location of the placement; (e) the pumping has ceased and the water level is constant when placement commences; (f) the concrete is placed carefully in a compact mass in its final position by a tremie or by other approved means; (g) the concrete seals on the bottom of cylinders are not disturbed after being deposited and the placing is regulated so as to continually maintain an approximately horizontal surface and no tamping or vibration takes place; (h) when a tremie is used, it consists of a watertight tube fitted with a valve or other device so that at no time does concrete in the tube come in contact with water when it is being filled; (i) the means of supporting the tremie is such as to permit free movement of the discharge end and to permit its being lowered rapidly when necessary to choke off or retard the flow of concrete; (j) no water enters the tremie tube; (k) the discharge end of the tremie tube is completely submerged in concrete at all times and the tremie tube is always filled to a height to overcome the head of water; (l) cofferdams or cylinders are not dewatered until at least 48 hours after the completion of placing the concrete seal; (m) after dewatering, the top of the concrete seal has all laitance and weak concrete removed and is thoroughly scabbled and cleaned before subsequent placement of concrete. 4.5 Construction joints (1) The use of construction joints shown on the approved drawings in the concrete work requires the prior approval of the local government. (2) The edges of all construction joints which are exposed to view are carefully finished true to line and level. (3) At horizontal construction joints along all exposed faces, dressed timber strips approximately 25mm square are attached to the inner face of the form and the surface of the lower concrete lift is stopped slightly above the lower edge of the strips so as to provide a uniformly straight edge along the joint when the strips are removed prior to placing the next lift. (4) The surface of the joint is prepared by removing all laitance and sufficient surface mortar to expose the coarse aggregate, but leaving it firmly embedded in the mortar matrix, without undercutting, which is achieved by: (5) (a) the use of sand blasting techniques; or (b) the use of wire brushes, hand tools and pneumatic tools; or (c) the use of a “green cutting” technique whereby the surface laitance and mortar is removed from partially hardened concrete by means of a high pressure combined air or water jet directed through a single nozzle onto the concrete; or (d) the use of surface retarding agents followed by any of the above. Construction joints are dampened prior to the placement of the adjoining concrete. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 4 Placing and compacting–4.4 Placing under water Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-8 (6) Membrane curing agents are not applied to the surface of any construction joint. (7) The joint is cleaned of any foreign material and contaminants present prior to concreting the next lift and the fit of forms along the construction joint is checked to ensure a mortar-tight joint. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 4 Placing and compacting–4.5 Construction joints Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-9 Part 5 5.1 (1) Formwork and falsework General Formwork is in accordance with AS 3610-1995 Formwork for concrete, AS 3610-1995/Amdt 12003 Formwork for concrete, AS 3610 Supp 1-1990/Amdt 1-1995 Formwork for concrete (Supplement to AS 3610-1990), AS 3610 Supp 2-1996 Formwork for concrete - Commentary (Supplement to AS 3610-1995), AS 3610 Supp 2-1996/Amdt 1-2003 Formwork for concrete Commentary (Supplement to AS 3610-1995), AS 3610 Supp 1-1995 Formwork for concrete Blowhole and colour evaluation charts (Supplement to AS 3610-1995) and AS 3610.1-2010. 5.2 Falsework (1) Drawings certified by a Registered Professional Engineer of Queensland for falsework are supplied to the local government prior to any falsework being erected. (2) Falsework which cannot be founded on a satisfactory footing is supported on piling which is spaced, driven and removed in a manner approved by the local government. (3) Falsework may be supported on constructed portions of the substructure provided the structure is not overstressed or rendered unstable. (4) Allowance is made for a deflection during the placement of falsework. 5.3 Formwork (1) All forms are built mortar tight and of sufficient rigidity to prevent distortion by the pressure of the concrete and other loads incident to the construction operations. (2) Forms are: (a) constructed and maintained so as to prevent warping and the opening of joints due to shrinkage of the timber; (b) substantial and unyielding; (c) designed and set so that the finished concrete conforms to the proper dimensions and contours within the tolerances specified in Table 6.4.1–Tolerances of this standard specification. (3) The design of the forms takes into account the effect of vibration of the concrete as it is placed. (4) When forms are re-used: (a) their original shape, strength, rigidity, mortar tightness and surface smoothness is maintained at all times; (b) material previously used in formwork is cleaned off and oiled before re-use; (c) warped timber is not used. (5) Forms which are unsatisfactory in any respect are not re-used. (6) The formwork and reinforcing is inspected by the local government prior to the placing of the concrete. (7) All timber is free from knotholes, loose knots, cracks, splits, warps and other defects, which would affect the strength of the structure or the appearance of exposed surfaces. (8) For narrow walls and columns where the bottom of the form is otherwise inaccessible, openings are provided so that they may be cleaned before the placing of the concrete, and for purposes of compaction and inspection. (9) All forms are treated with the lightest practical coating of release agent before the reinforcement is placed provided that the release agent is not placed on reinforcement or construction joints. (10) All forms are set and maintained to the line and level designated and remain in place for the periods specified in Table 6.2.1–Times for removal of formwork of this standard specification. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 5 Formwork and falsework–5.1 General Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-10 (11) When forms appear to be unsatisfactory in any way, either before or during the placing of concrete, the work does not proceed until the defects have been corrected to the approval of the local government. (12) Metal form ties are of an approved type and, if cast in, are constructed so as to permit their removal to a depth of at least 32mm from the face without injury to the concrete. (13) Ordinary wire ties are not used. (14) Cavities left when the end fitting of ties are removed are as small as possible and are subsequently filled with cement mortar and the surface left sound, smooth and uniform in colour. (15) Form ties are located in a uniform and symmetrical pattern relative to the finished structure. 5.4 Formwork for exposed surfaces (1) Plastic coated plywood, waterproof plywood, timber forms lined with tempered hardboard, or good fitting unwarped metal formwork free from dents is used on exposed surfaces unless otherwise specified and forms with damaged surfaces are not used for exposed surfaces. (2) Joins between form sheeting are vertical or horizontal unless otherwise specified in the approved drawings. 5.5 Formwork for hidden surface (1) Standard metal forms or undressed timber may be used for surfaces that are not exposed in the finished structure. (2) All timber is shot edged or tongue and grooved. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 5 Formwork and falsework–5.4 Formwork for exposed surfaces Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-11 Part 6 6.1 (1) (2) 6.2 Finishing Finishing Concrete which is: (a) normally exposed to view is finished to Class 3 in accordance with AS 3610-1995 Formwork for concrete, AS 3610-1995/Amdt 1-2003 Formwork for concrete, AS 3610.12010 and is subject to colour control; (b) not normally exposed to view is finished to Class 4 in accordance with AS 3610-1995 Formwork for concrete, AS 3610-1995/Amdt 1-2003 Formwork for concrete, AS 3610.12010 and is not subject to colour control. All surfaces of concrete that are exposed to view in the completed structure are finished such that: (a) immediately after the removal of forms, all fins and other projections are ground off, all pockets and honeycombs are cleaned and filled with a stiff cement mortar having the same proportion of cement and sand as the original concrete, and the surface of the patch is ground flush; (b) decks are roughened slightly by brooming or other approved method before initial set; (c) kerb and channel, invert crossings, vehicle crossings and industrial crossings are finished with an approved steel finishing tool; (d) footpaths and pram ramps are finished with a wooden float and broomed. Removal of forms, falsework and centring (1) The removal of forms is carried out in accordance with AS 3600-2009 Concrete structures (incorporating Amdt 1-2002, Amdt 2-2004 and Amdt 1-2010). (2) Forms are not removed from the concrete until the times specified for each type of formula in Table 6.2.1–Times for removal of formwork of this standard specification have elapsed from the placing of the concrete. (3) If field operations are controlled by cylinder tests, the removal of forms and supports may begin when the strength reaches 70 percent of the specified 28 day strength. (4) Forms are removed with care without hammering and wedging, and so as not to injure the concrete or disturb the remaining supports. (5) Centres are gradually and uniformly lowered in such a manner as to avoid injurious stress in any part of the structure. (6) No load which may cause damage to the work is placed on or against any concrete. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 6 Finishing–6.1 Finishing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-12 Table 6.2.1–Times for removal of formwork 6.3 Column 1 Type of construction Column 2 Period Bridge main falsework On attainment of 70 percent of the specified 28 day cylinder strength, but not less than 7 days. Other non-prestressed members 7 days Underside of slabs less than 1.8m span 3 days Underside of slabs 1.8m span and over 7 days Walls 24 hours Column ( depending on slenderness) 1 to 2 days Side of beams and all other parts 24 hours Curing (1) Concrete surfaces other than slabs are kept continually moist for a period of not less than 7 days. (2) Slabs are kept continually moist for a period of not less than 14 days. (3) Concrete surfaces are kept moist by spraying with: (a) an approved curing compound; or (b) water sprays or wet sand in which case the surfaces are kept moist 24 hours a day for the full period specified without any breaks at weekends or holidays. (4) Curing is commenced immediately on completion of the finishing of exposed surfaces or within 30 minutes of removal of the forms from other surfaces. (5) The only curing compound which is used is a paraffin wax emulsion in water which is applied at the rate recommended by the manufacturer and complies with AS 3799-1998 Liquid membraneforming curing compounds for concrete. (6) Slabs are sprayed with the compound as soon as possible after finishing and before plastic cracking occurs, and are then immediately covered. (7) If the covering is lifted by wind or other action, the area uncovered is re-sprayed and the covering replaced. (8) Any curing compound used is compatible with any specified applied finish. (9) If curing was not applied efficiently, the local government may order the cutting of cores for the testing of the concrete insitu, irrespective of whether test cylinders had been taken previously and irrespective of the test results on such cylinders. (10) All finishing operations shall be completed prior to the application of any curing. The finishing operations shall be such as to provide a dense surface free from visible surface cracking. The concrete surface shall be reworked as necessary to eliminate plastic cracking after the initial set has taken place and before the commencement of curing. 6.4 Dimensional tolerances (1) Where tolerances are not stated in the approved drawings for any individual structure or feature thereof, deviations from established lines, grades and dimensions are not greater than the tolerances listed in Table 6.4.1–Tolerancesof this standard specification and are applied to the completed work. (2) Forms are set and maintained so as to ensure completed work within the tolerance limits. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 6 Finishing–6.3 Curing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-13 Table 6.4.1–Tolerances Column 1 Item measures Column 2 Tolerance (mm) Size of members or thickness of slab: +7mm –0 Cover of concrete over reinforcement: +7mm -3mm Departure from place in exposed surfaces: gradual: sudden: +7mm in 3000mm -2mm Departure from contract dimension where other tolerances do not apply: 0-20 metres Over 20 metres +7mm +13mm Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 6 Finishing–6.4 Dimensional tolerances Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-14 Part 7 7.1 (1) Contractual provisions Cost of testing The cost of testing the concrete in accordance with AS 3600-2009 Concrete structures (incorporating Amdt 1-2010) is to be borne by the Contractor and is to be deemed to be included in the Contract Sum. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 7 Contractual provisions–7.1 Cost of testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-15 Part 8 (1) Shotcrete and stone pitching Shotcrete and stone pitching shall be completed in accordance with Transport and Main Roads Technical Specification MRTS03 - Drainage, Retaining Structures and Protective Treatments. Standard specification No. 7 (Concrete) Part 8 Shotcrete and stone pitching Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss7-16 Standard Specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of standard specification .................................................................. 1 PART 2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 KERB AND CHANNEL .............................................................................................. 2 Kerb and channel ..................................................................................................... 2 Pavement under kerb and kerb and channel .......................................................... 2 Concrete for kerb and kerb and channel ................................................................. 2 Construction ............................................................................................................. 2 Jointing to existing kerb or kerb and channel ........................................................ 3 Kerb and channel crossings .................................................................................... 3 PART 3 3.1 PATHS....................................................................................................................... 4 Paths ......................................................................................................................... 4 PART 4 4.1 4.2 TRAFFIC ISLANDS AND MEDIANS AND HEADWALLS .......................................... 6 Traffic islands and medians..................................................................................... 6 Headwalls ................................................................................................................. 6 PART 5 5.1 CONTRACTUAL PROVISIONS ................................................................................. 7 Payment and measurement ..................................................................................... 7 PART 6 SUPPLEMENTARY SPECIFICATIONS FOR KERB AND CHANNEL REHABILITATION PROJECTS ................................................................................. 8 Removal of existing kerb and channel .................................................................... 8 Preparation of gravel base....................................................................................... 8 Subsoil drainage ...................................................................................................... 8 Pouring of new kerb, kerb and channel .................................................................. 8 6.4.1 Machine poured kerb & channel.............................................................. 8 6.4.2 Hand placed kerb and channel................................................................ 8 Reinstatement .......................................................................................................... 8 6.5.1 Backfill behind kerb & channel ................................................................ 8 6.5.2 Backfill of pavement in front of kerb and channel..................................... 8 Kerb adapters ........................................................................................................... 9 Rehabilitation at residential driveways ................................................................... 9 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 6.5 6.6 6.7 Standard Specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Pi Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard Specification No. 8–Minor concrete works 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in section 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being engineering work involving the use of cast insitu concrete for minor concrete works: (a) a kerb; (b) a kerb and channel; (c) a crossover; (d) a path; (e) a traffic island; (f) a headwall. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of standard specification If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard Specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) Part 1 Introduction—1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss8-1 Part 2 2.1 Kerb and channel Kerb and channel (1) Kerb and channel complies with standard drawing number R-0080 and is one of the following profiles: B1, B2, SM5, M3, Median and Invert. (2) Machine finished (wet kerb) is required for all kerb and channel construction. (3) Machine finished (dry mix kerb) and hand finished kerb are only permitted if approved by the local government. 2.2 Pavement under kerb and kerb and channel (1) Where pavement thickness exceeds 175mm in depth, the pavement extends under the kerb. (2) Where the pavement thickness does not exceed 175mm in depth, the kerb and channel is firmly bedded on 100mm road base aggregate compacted to 95 percent modified dry density as required under AS 1289.0-2000 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - General requirements and list of methods. (3) No concrete is placed until the foundations have been approved by the local government. 2.3 (1) Concrete for kerb and kerb and channel Concrete for kerb and kerb and channel is 32 MPa strength grade complying with the requirements of AS 1379-2007: (a) (2) 2.4 Slump values for the concrete are: (i) machine finished (dry kerb) —12mm minimum—40mm maximum; (ii) hand finished—40mm minimum—80mm maximum; (iii) machine finished (wet kerb)—12mm minimum—40mm maximum. All kerb and channel to be constructed with wet mix concrete placed with a suitable kerb machine unless otherwise approved by the local government. Construction (1) Kerb and channel is constructed by an approved continuous slip-form extrusion kerb and channel machine true to line and grade, and to the profile specified in the standard drawings. (2) The machine is fitted with a tamper and automatic level control capable of maintaining the correct line and level and any kerb and channel not true to line or with noticeable kinks, bends or other faults or not of the required dimensions may be rejected and, if rejected, is broken out and removed from the site. (3) Concrete is thoroughly compacted. (4) A contraction joint is provided at 4 metre centres which is finished square and at right angles to the section of kerb or kerb and channel. (5) The kerb or kerb and channel at a contraction joint is guillotined to the full depth of the concrete and re-finished with a jointing tool to form neat joint lines not exceeding 3mm in width and 6mm in depth. (6) In the case of kerb, a joint is cut and cork jointing is inserted every 20 metres with a cut joint midway between cork joints and jointing is placed in such a manner as to dissect the kerb for its full thickness. (7) Provide stormwater kerb adaptors provided for all stormwater connections to kerb in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0081. (8) Finishing is free from any holes or roughness. (9) The channel is shaped in accordance with the approved drawings. Standard Specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) Part 2 Kerb and channel—2.1 Kerb and channel Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss8-2 (10) Notwithstanding the allowable tolerances, the invert of the channel is finished true to grade and alignment and channelling in which water is found to pond is not accepted and is removed immediately. (11) The allowable tolerance to kerb or kerb and channel is +10mm/-10mm on grade levels always provided that: (12) The difference between the deviations from the correct levels at any two points 30 metres apart does not exceed 30mm; (13) The deviation from a straight edge laid parallel to the centreline does not exceed 10mm in 3 metres; (14) Crossfall is maintained within +/- 0.50 percent of the design; (15) The allowable lateral tolerance is +50mm and –20mm relative to the pavement centreline, with positive being in the direction to make the pavement wider. (16) A concrete test per 100 lineal metres. (17) The kerb or kerb and channel is inspected by the local government for damage at the pre-seal stage and any damaged sections are replaced as directed by the local government. 2.5 (1) Jointing to existing kerb or kerb and channel The concrete kerb or kerb and channel joins neatly with the existing kerb or kerb and channel over a minimal transitional length of 2 metres. 2.6 Kerb and channel crossings (1) A vehicular crossing of a verge for entry to a lot is constructed in accordance with standard drawings IPWEAQ R-0050, IPWEAQ R-0051 or IPWEAQ R-0052 whichever is applicable. (2) The foundation for a crossover is at least equivalent to that for kerb and channel in the same location as specified in section 2.2–Pavement under kerb and kerb and channel of this standard specification. (3) A vehicular crossover of one lot does not encroach on the frontage of an adjacent lot. (4) Concrete kerb ramps are provided at all locations where a concrete or paved path intersects with a kerbed road. (5) The kerb ramp is: (a) a Type 1 kerb ramp which is constructed in accordance with standard drawing LCC 800314 where a concrete or paved path intersects with a kerbed road in a location where the requirements for a Type 2 Kerb Ramp is not met; (b) a Type 2 kerb ramp which is constructed in accordance with standard drawing LCC 800315 where a concrete or paved path intersects with a kerbed roadway in a location which is: (i) in the immediate vicinity of a development involving more than one business activity centre; or (ii) in the immediate vicinity of an educational establishment; or (iii) in the immediate vicinity of a community facility; or (iv) at any other location requested by people with disabilities and approved by the local government; or (v) at a location identified as having a significant concentration of people with disabilities residing within the area; (c) a Type 3 kerb ramp which is constructed in accordance with standard drawing LCC 800316 where the Type 2 kerb ramp criteria applies and the verge is fully paved or concreted over its entire width. Standard Specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) Part 2 Kerb and channel—2.5 Jointing to existing kerb or kerb and channel Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss8-3 Part 3 3.1 (1) Paths Paths A concrete path is constructed in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0065 including the following: (a) thickness: (i) 100mm; or (ii) 125mm at a residential driveway; or (iii) 175mm at a commercial driveway; (b) concrete—grade N25 Mpa/20; (c) reinforcement: (i) F62; or (ii) F72 for driveways; (d) finish—broomed; (e) expansion joints—R12, 300mm long at 300mm centres centrally located. (2) Foundations for a concrete path is thoroughly compacted by watering and rolling or ramming and are thoroughly damp, but not muddy, when concrete is placed thereon. (3) No concrete is placed until the foundations have been approved by the local government. (4) Contraction joints: (5) (a) are provided at centres matching the width of the footpath and not more than 3.0m; (b) are formed by a jointing tool; (c) do not exceed 35mm in depth or 6mm in width; (d) are at right angles to the edge of the path. Expansion joints: (a) are placed at 15 metre centres except for 2.0m footpath which can be 16m to match dimension multiplier; (b) are at right angles to the edge of the path; (c) extend for the full depth of the concrete path and are 10mm in width. (6) The expansion joint is filled with a double sided foam joint and is dowelled together with a R12 (plain galvanised) bar 300mm long centrally located and half the bar is greased and encased in a 20mm O.D. PVC sleeve with end cap. Dowels are placed 150mm off edge and at 300mm maximum centres. (7) Steel reinforcement is: (a) a minimum of F62 grade; (b) centrally placed; (c) supported so that it does not touch the foundation at any point. (8) The cross fall of the concrete path is 2.5 percent towards the kerb and channel as shown on standard drawing LCC 8-00305 except that in the case where the level of the property at the alignment is level with or lower than that of the top of the kerb, the path is graded such that it achieves a level of at least 110mm above the top of the kerb within 1 metre of the property alignment. (9) Table 3.1.1–Joint spacing of this standard specification reflects the contraction joint spacing and expansion requirements. Standard Specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) Part 3 Paths—3.1 Paths Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss8-4 Table 3.1.1–Joint spacing Path width Contraction joint spacing Expansion 1.2 1.2 15 1.5 1.5 15 2.0 2.0 16 2.5 2.5 15 3.0 3.0 15 Standard Specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) Part 3 Paths—3.1 Paths Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss8-5 Part 4 4.1 Traffic islands and medians and headwalls Traffic islands and medians (1) A semi mountable kerb is provided on a traffic island (adjacent to traffic signals and pedestrian crossings, where a barrier kerb is used), unless otherwise shown on the approved drawings. (2) An infill that is not subject to traffic is in accordance with the following: (a) thickness—100mm; (b) concrete—N25 Mpa/20; (c) finish—steel float and broom finish and texture coated with approved product to specified colour and pattern. (3) A raised kerbed island less than 12m 2 or 2 metres wide between the kerb faces is constructed with a 100mm thickness, N25 reinforced concrete on a compacted sand base. (4) A raised kerb island greater than 12m 2 or 2 metres wide is: (a) landscaped or provided with another suitable surface treatment; (b) provided with a water service conduit at 80 metre intervals so that there is a minimum of one service per median. (5) If the fall across an island is greater than 1 in 4, the island is surfaced with concrete. (6) If an island is landscaped: (a) sub-soil drainage is connected to an underground drainage system; (b) plastic sheeting is to be installed to extend 200mm below subgrade level and above bitumen level in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0141 (alternative 1). (7) Expansion joints are installed to coincide with the cork joints in the kerb unless directed otherwise. (8) Contraction joints are at 4 metre centres. (9) Concrete median infills are founded on a minimum 50mm of compacted sand. (10) Where a pedestrian crossing is proposed across a traffic island or a median, the traffic island or median is bisected to allow crossing at the level of the pavement. 4.2 Headwalls (1) Precast headwall units are permissible unless otherwise specified. (2) A cast insitu headwall is to be in accordance with Department of Main Roads drawing numbers 1303, 1304, 1305 and 1306. Standard Specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) Part 4 Traffic islands and medians and headwalls—4.1 Traffic islands and medians Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss8-6 Part 5 5.1 (1) Contractual provisions Payment and measurement Measurement of kerb or kerb and channel is to be exclusive of any vehicle crossings, pram ramps and precast backstones for stormwater gullies. Standard Specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) Part 5 Contractual provisions—5.1 Payment and measurement Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss8-7 Part 6 6.1 Supplementary specifications for kerb and channel rehabilitation projects Removal of existing kerb and channel (1) Sections of existing kerb and channel identified as requiring replacement shall be removed and disposed of off-site.; (2) The interface with existing kerb and channel shall be saw cut square to the kerb face to provide a neat, straight cut surface. Chipping or spalling of the existing kerb will not be accepted. (3) The kerb and channel shall be carefully removed to minimise disturbance to adjoining areas including pavement. 6.2 Preparation of gravel base (1) The areas under the removed sections of kerb and channel shall be excavated to a minimum of 150mm and backfilled with class 2.1 gravel trimmed and compacted to 95 percent modified compaction. Where directed this depth may be increased. (2) The base shall be hard and free from deflection under loading. 6.3 Subsoil drainage (1) Where an outlet can be achieved subsoil drainage shall be constructed under or directly behind back of kerb and channel. (2) Reinstates existing subsoil drainage if damaged during work. 6.4 Pouring of new kerb, kerb and channel 6.4.1 Machine poured kerb & channel (1) Where a kerb and channel machine is used to place the replacement kerb and channel, a 20MPa kerb mix with maximum aggregate size of between 5mm and 10mm shall be used. (2) A minimum slump of 12mm shall be adopted for this mix. The concrete shall be fully compacted and finished with a high strength sand/cement slurry to the profile as specified. 6.4.2 Hand placed kerb and channel (1) Where the replacement kerb and channel is placed and finished by "hand" an N25/20 grade concrete shall be used with a minimum 40mm and maximum 80mm slump. (2) The concrete shall be fully compacted with vibratory equipment, shaped and trowel finished to match the profile of the adjoining kerb and channel or to a profile as otherwise specified. (3) Transitions between different kerb types shall be done over a distance of at least 2.0 metres. 6.5 Reinstatement 6.5.1 Backfill behind kerb & channel (1) When suitably cured, the kerb and channel shall be backfilled with a suitable granular material, compacted and finished with 50mm of topsoil and turfed with a minimum 'B' grade couch turf. Excavated pavement material may be reused as kerb backfill. (2) The turfed area shall be maintained until the grass roots have established into the topsoil. 6.5.2 (1) Backfill of pavement in front of kerb and channel When the kerb and channel has cured sufficiently, the pavement in front of the kerb shall be backfilled with type 6 asphalt (20mm mix) in compacted layers of up to 80mm. Pavement backfill shall be finished 25mm below the lip of kerb and channel to allow for the subsequent overlay of pavement. Standard Specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) Part 6 Supplementary specifications for kerb and channel rehabilitation projects—6.1 Removal of existing kerb and channel Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss8-8 6.6 (1) 6.7 Kerb adapters Proprietary kerb adapters shall be placed in the kerb and channel and securely fixed in place using either a high strength sand mortar or concrete. Rehabilitation at residential driveways (1) Where the kerb and channel is to be replaced at concrete driveways and there is a laid-back crossover in the existing driveway, the crossover will be reinstated in accordance with the local government standard drawings R0050, R0051 and R0052. (2) Driveways shall be saw cut neatly and squarely at a point up to 1m from the existing invert of kerb and channel (unless directed otherwise) and replaced with a new crossover consisting of N25/20 concrete (minimum 40mm, maximum 80mm slump) 125mm thick with a single layer of F72 mesh placed centrally and laid from invert to the cut face of the driveway, for the full width of the existing driveway. (3) Where the new kerb and channel at the drive way is mountable kerb (types M1 or M3) the existing driveway shall be cut back a maximum of 300mm from back of kerb and channel and finished to the top of the new M3 kerb and channel. (4) All new slabs at driveways shall be dowelled horizontally, to existing driveway slab with galvanised R12 dowels 300mm long at 300mm centres. Standard Specification No. 8 (Minor concrete works) Part 6 Supplementary specifications for kerb and channel rehabilitation projects—6.6 Kerb adapters Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.0 Ss8-9 Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of standard specification .................................................................. 1 PART 2 2.1 MATERIALS FOR REINFORCEMENT....................................................................... 2 Materials for reinforcement...................................................................................... 2 PART 3 3.1 PROTECTION............................................................................................................ 3 Protection ................................................................................................................. 3 PART 4 4.1 CUTTING AND BENDING ......................................................................................... 4 Cutting and bending................................................................................................. 4 PART 5 5.1 SURFACE CONDITION OF REINFORCEMENT ........................................................ 5 Surface condition of reinforcement......................................................................... 5 PART 6 6.1 PLACING AND FIXING.............................................................................................. 6 Placing and fixing..................................................................................................... 6 PART 7 7.1 TOLERANCE ON POSITION OF REINFORCEMENT ................................................ 7 Tolerance on position of reinforcement .................................................................. 7 PART 8 8.1 SPLICING .................................................................................................................. 8 Splicing ..................................................................................................................... 8 PART 9 9.1 SUBSTITUTIONS ...................................................................................................... 9 Substitutions ............................................................................................................ 9 PART 10 10.1 FIBRE REINFORCEMENT ....................................................................................... 10 Fibre reinforcement ................................................................................................ 10 PART 11 11.1 11.2 CONTRACTUAL PROVISIONS ............................................................................... 11 Substitution ............................................................................................................ 11 Measurement and payment.................................................................................... 11 Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 9–Reinforcement 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in section 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being engineering work involving the use of bar and steel wire fabric reinforcement in concrete, road transport infrastructure and incidental concrete construction. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of standard specification If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard specification 9 (Reinforcement) Part 1 Introduction–1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss9-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) Materials for reinforcement Materials for reinforcement All materials for reinforcement comply with: (a) AS ISO 1302-2005 Geometrical product specifications (GPS) - Indication of surface texture in technical product documentation: Steel reinforcing bar; (b) AS/NZS 4671:2001 Steel reinforcing materials (Amdt 1 see DR 02474): Hard-drawn steel reinforcing bar; (c) AS/NZS 4671:2001 Steel reinforcing materials (Amdt 1 see DR 02474): Reinforcing wire fabric; (d) AS 3600-2009 Concrete structures (incorporating Amdt 1-2010): Concrete structures code; (e) ASTM C1116 Standard Specification for Fibre Reinforced Concrete and Shotcrete. (2) The manufacturer’s test certificates are provided to the local government. (3) Where specified in the approved drawings, reinforcement is galvanised to AS/NZS 4680:2006 Hot-dip galvanized (zinc) coatings on fabricated ferrous articles and AS/NZS 4792:2006 Hot-dip galvanized (zinc) coatings on ferrous hollow sections, applied by a continuous or a specialized process, and the galvanised reinforcing bars are passivated in a 0.2 percent sodium dichromate solution applied by the galvaniser. Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) Part 2 Materials for reinforcement–2.1 Materials for reinforcement Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss9-2 Part 3 3.1 Protection Protection (1) The reinforcement is protected from damage at all times. (2) During storage, reinforcement is stacked in racks or on timber above ground and kept clear of any contamination. (3) If accidental contamination occurs, the reinforcement is cleaned as specified in section 4.1– Cutting and bending of this standard specification. Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) Part 3 Protection–3.1 Protection Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss9-3 Part 4 4.1 Cutting and bending Cutting and bending (1) Reinforcement is free of kinks or other unwanted deformations and is cut to length and bent in accordance with the approved drawings. (2) Fabric reinforcement shipped in rolls, is straightened into flat sheets before use. (3) All bends in the reinforcement are made in accordance with AS 3600-2009 Concrete structures (incorporating Amdt 1-2010), unless otherwise shown in the approved drawings. (4) If a deformed bar has been bent and subsequently bent in the reverse direction or straightened, it is not bent again within 20 bar diameters of the previous bend. (5) After cutting and bending, bars are bundled or stored in a manner which permits clear identification of their bending schedule mark. (6) Reinforcement is only bent hot on the site if: (7) (a) authorised by the local government; (b) the steel is heated uniformly through and beyond the portion to be bent; (c) the temperature does not exceed 600oC; (d) approved temperature indicating crayons or equivalent are used to determine the temperature; (e) the bar is not cooled by quenching or compressed air blast; (f) the design yield strength of the steel after bending is taken as 250 Mpa if the temperature of the bar exceeds 450oC. Reinforcement is fabricated to the shape and dimensions shown in the approved drawings and within the following tolerances: (a) on any overall dimension for bars and fabric except where used as a fitment: (i) length up to 600mm, 25mm, +0; or (ii) length over 600mm, 40mm, +0; or (b) on any overall dimension of bars or fabric used as a fitment: (i) for deformed bars and fabric, 15mm, +0; or (ii) for plain round bars and wire, 10mm, +0; or (c) on the overall offset dimension of a cranked column bar -0,+10mm; or (d) for the sawn or machined end of a straight bar intended for use as an end-bearing splice, the angular deviation from square measured in relation to the end 300mm is within 2 degrees. Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) Part 4 Cutting and bending–4.1 Cutting and bending Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss9-4 Part 5 5.1 Surface condition of reinforcement Surface condition of reinforcement (1) At the time concrete is placed, reinforcement is free from mud, oil, grease, other non-metallic coatings and loose rust which reduces the bond between the concrete and the reinforcement. Rust is not deemed to be loose if on rubbing with the thumb it leaves only a stain. (2) A deformed bar complying with AS ISO 1302-2005 Geometrical product specifications (GPS) Indication of surface texture in technical product documentation, or a welded wire fabric complying with AS/NZS 4671:2001 and Amdt 1-2003 Steel reinforcing materials, which have mill scale, rust or both, are deemed to comply if, for a specimen which has been wire-brushed by hand, the dimensions of cross-section, including the height of deformations and the mass, are not less than the dimensions and mass required by AS ISO 1302-2005 Geometrical product specifications (GPS) - Indication of surface texture in technical product documentation, or AS/NZS 4671:2001 and Amdt 1-2003 Steel reinforcing materials, as applicable. (3) Any reinforcement projecting from a previous concreting operation is cleaned free of adhering concrete or loose slurry prior to any further embedment. (4) Reinforcement which has been submerged by tidal or flood water is cleaned with a high pressure fresh water jet prior to pouring concrete. Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) Part 5 Surface condition of reinforcement–5.1 Surface condition of reinforcement Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss9-5 Part 6 6.1 Placing and fixing Placing and fixing (1) Reinforcement is placed in position as shown in the approved drawings. (2) In the case of bar reinforcement, the bars are tied together by wiring, with each intersection using annealed wire not less than 1.25mm in diameter or such other appropriate fastening device as may be approved by the local government, provided that where the bar spacing is 300mm or less, alternate intersections only need to be tied. (3) Clearance from the form is maintained by use of an approved chair. (4) The shape of the chair is such that there is minimum obstruction to the formation of the homogeneous concrete both within and around the chair. (5) Tubular or cylindrical types of chairs are not used. (6) Bar chairs that are suitable for soffit use only are not used against side forms. (7) Bar chairs are of sufficient structural strength to support the weight of reinforcement and workmen at the temperatures experienced on the site. (8) Plastic tipped metal chairs are not approved for any locations other than those where the loading on the chairs is such that there is no possibility of the metal on the tips of the feet of the chairs becoming exposed. (9) Precast mortar blocks are not used. (10) Blocks manufactured from vibrated concrete of strength equivalent to that of the main concrete are used if: (a) the size and shape is approved by the local government; (b) the blocks have suitable fixing wires cast in. (11) Layers of bars are separated by means of approved bar spacers. (12) Stirrups and ligatures pass around the main reinforcement and are securely tied to it. (13) The system of fixing forms a rigid cage which maintains dimensional tolerances under the loads experienced during the placement of concrete. (14) The welding of reinforcement to form a rigid cage is used if: (a) approved by the local government; (b) the welding is in accordance with AS/NZS 1554.3:2008 Structural steel welding - Welding of reinforcing steel; (c) the tack welds: (i) do not substantially reduce the cross-section of the reinforcing steel nor adversely affect its strength; (ii) have a throat thickness not less than 4mm; (iii) have a length not less than the diameter of the smaller bar; (d) the welding is not carried out within 75mm of any portion of a bar which has been bent or will be bent; (e) not more than one-third of the main reinforcement at any cross-section is so welded; (f) hard drawn wire and fabric reinforcement are not welded or heated. Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) Part 6 Placing and fixing–6.1 Placing and fixing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss9-6 Part 7 7.1 (1) Tolerance on position of reinforcement Tolerance on position of reinforcement The deviation from the specified position of reinforcement and tendons do not exceed: (a) for positions controlled by cover: (i) in beams, girders, slabs, columns and walls, –5mm and +10mm; (ii) in slabs-on-ground including footings of walls and culverts, –10mm and +20mm; (iii) in footings cast in the ground where the depth of the footing is 500mm or more, –20mm and +40mm; (b) for positions not controlled by cover: (i) the location of reinforcement on a profile, 10mm; (ii) the position of the ends of reinforcement along the line of the bar, 50mm; (iii) the spacing of bars in walls and slabs and of fitments in beams and columns, whichever is the greater of: (A) 10 percent of the specified spacing; or (B) 15mm, whichever is the greater. Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) Part 7 Tolerance on position of reinforcement–7.1 Tolerance on position of reinforcement Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss9-7 Part 8 8.1 Splicing Splicing (1) The splicing of reinforcement occurs only in the locations shown in the approved drawings. (2) Where practical, splices in bar reinforcement are staggered. (3) Reinforcement is spliced by lapping, welding or approved mechanical splices. (4) Fabric reinforcement is lap spliced only. (5) The length of lap splices in bar reinforcement is as shown in the approved drawings. (6) All reinforcement is spliced to maintain a specified clear cover to the surface of the concrete. (7) Splicing of fabric reinforcement is achieved so that the two outermost transverse wires of one sheet of fabric overlap the outermost transverse wire of the sheet being lapped. (8) The splicing of bar reinforcement by welding only occurs if: (a) approved by the local government; (b) all welding of reinforcement is carried out in accordance with AS/NZS 1554.3:2008 Structural steel welding - Welding of reinforcing steel; (c) all welding electrodes used comply with AS/NZS 1553.1:1995 Covered electrodes for welding - Low carbon steel electrodes for manual metal-arc welding of carbon steels and carbon-manganese steels or AS/NZS 2717.1:1996 Welding - Electrodes - Gas metal arc Ferritic steel electrodes; (d) splices are made by butt or by fillet welding where butt welds are qualified complete penetration joints in accordance with AS/NZS 1554.3:2002 Structural steel welding Welding of reinforcing steel, AS/NZS 4856-2006 and AS/NZS 4857-2006; (e) welders who are proved competent by tests, and are approved in writing by the local government are used; (f) each welder proposed to be used for the splicing of bar reinforcement by welding is tested with 2 pieces such that: (i) each test piece is 300mm long with a joint of the type proposed to be used at the centre; (ii) test pieces are prepared from the same size and grade of reinforcement as that to be welded on the job; (iii) welding of test pieces is carried out on the job; (iv) welding of test pieces is carried out using the equipment and consumables to be used on the job and the least advantageous welding position likely to be experienced in the works; (v) all information regarding the welding of test pieces required by the local government is provided to the local government; (vi) one test piece is tested in tension; (vii) the tensile test piece when ruptured under tensile load allows an ultimate strength at least equal to that of the parent metal; (viii) the other test piece is tested as described in AS/NZS 1554.3:2002 Structural steel welding - Welding of reinforcing steel, AS/NZS 4856-2006 and AS/NZS 4857-2006; (ix) the testing is conducted by an approved laboratory; (x) in the event of the failure of any of the test pieces to meet the above requirements, 4 further test pieces are made and tested; (xi) two of the test pieces are tested in tension and the remaining two in bending; (xii) if any of the re-tests fail, the welder is deemed to have failed the test and is not used on the work. Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) Part 8 Splicing–8.1 Splicing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss9-8 Part 9 9.1 (1) Substitutions Substitutions Different sizes of reinforcement are only substituted if the structure is not adversely affected by the change and an application for the approval of the substitution is made at least 4 weeks before the day on which the reinforcement is to be placed. Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) Part 9 Substitutions–9.1 Substitutions Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss9-9 Part 10 10.1 (1) Fibre reinforcement Fibre reinforcement Fibre reinforcement is only incorporated into the works if: (a) approved by the local government; (b) it meets all the requirements of ASTM C1116 Standard Specification for Fibre Reinforced Concrete and Shotcrete; (c) it is used in accordance with the manufacturer’s specifications; (d) it is polypropylene fibre; (e) it is not used to replace structural reinforcement. Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) Part 10 Fibre reinforcement–10.1 Fibre reinforcement Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss9-10 Part 11 11.1 (1) Substitution If different sizes of reinforcement are substituted in accordance with section 9.1–Substitutions of this standard specification, the Contractor is not entitled to any additional payment as a result of the substitution. 11.2 (1) Contractual provisions Measurement and payment Reinforcement quantities is to be determined as follows: (a) for bar reinforcement, the quantity in tonnes is to be the calculated mass of the various sizes of each grade of bar (plain or deformed) as shown on the approved drawings and incorporated in the reinforcement; (b) where a continuous bar or welded or other type of splice is used instead of a lapped splice, the mass will be calculated as for a lapped splice; (c) the mass is to be calculated from Table 11.2.1–Unit mass of reinforcement of this standard specification; (d) for wire fabric reinforcement: (i) where scheduled, measurement is to be in square metres, as shown on the approved drawings and incorporated in the reinforcement; or (ii) where not scheduled, the mass of fabric reinforcement will be included with bar reinforcement; (e) no allowance will be made for laps. Table 11.2.1–Unit mass of reinforcement Bar Size (mm) Mass (kg/m) 10 0.62 12 0.89 16 1.58 20 2.47 24 3.55 28 4.83 32 6.31 36 7.99 40 9.86 Standard specification No. 9 (Reinforcement) Part 11 Contractual provisions–11.1 Substitution Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss9-11 Standard specification No. 10 (Provision for traffic) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of standard specification .................................................................. 1 PART 2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.9 2.10 TRAFFIC CONTROL ................................................................................................. 2 Traffic management plan ......................................................................................... 2 Traffic control devices ............................................................................................. 2 Detouring of traffic ................................................................................................... 2 Entrances to private properties ............................................................................... 2 Dust control .............................................................................................................. 3 Pedestrian movements ............................................................................................ 3 Traffic controller qualifications ............................................................................... 3 Temporary pavement marking ................................................................................. 3 Maintenance outside normal working hours........................................................... 3 Side-tracks................................................................................................................ 3 PART 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 CONTRACTUAL PROVISIONS ................................................................................. 5 Speed limits .............................................................................................................. 5 Detouring of traffic ................................................................................................... 5 Maintenance outside working hours ....................................................................... 5 PART 4 PERMANENT LINE MARKING .................................................................................. 6 Standard specification No. 10 (Provision for Traffic) Part 1 Introduction–1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 10–Provision for Traffic 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being engineering work involving the control of vehicle and pedestrian traffic. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of standard specification If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard specification 10 (Provision for Traffic) Part 1 Introduction–1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss10-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) (2) (3) Traffic management plan A traffic management plan for the works is provided to the local government prior to the commencement of the work which: (a) sets out the safety measures, signs, speed limits and personnel which will be involved in maintaining the protection and control of vehicular and pedestrian traffic for the duration of the works; (b) complies with the requirements of the Queensland Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices (QMUTCD) and any statutory requirements. Work which is likely to reduce traffic flow: (a) is carried out between 9.30 am and 2.30 pm only; (b) is organised so as to cause minimum disruption to pedestrians and access to adjacent premises; (c) ensures that one lane of traffic under traffic control remains open at all times across a road. Any variation to the traffic management plan made during the work, is provided to the local government. 2.2 (1) (2) Traffic control devices A traffic control device: (a) complies with the requirements of the QMUTCD; (b) is maintained in an effective and clean condition at all times; (c) is placed in accordance with the requirements of the QMUTCD. A traffic control device which is damaged or worn, or which does not conform to the standard specification is not used. 2.3 (1) 2.4 Traffic control Detouring of traffic If traffic is to be detoured away from the work via an existing road: (a) the arrangements are to be approved by the local government; (b) the arrangements are to provide for: (i) matters as the issuing of public notices in respect of the detour, any repair or upgrading work which may be required prior to the detouring of traffic on the roads concerned; (ii) the maintenance of the roads concerned during the detour period; (iii) the inspection of the route for adequacy for the entire length of the detour; (iv) any restoration work which may be necessary following cessation of the detour period. Entrances to private properties (1) The work is carried out in a manner so that an existing entrance to premises affected by the work are either maintained in a useable condition during the period of the work or alternative entrance arrangements are made which are acceptable to the residents concerned. (2) The work does not block an entrance to premises for a period exceeding 24 hours. (3) Any damage to an entrance to premises is made good at the completion of the work. Standard specification No.10 (Provision for Traffic) Part 2 Traffic control–2.1 Traffic management plan Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss10-2 2.5 Dust control (1) Adequate precautions are taken to minimise dust or dust-related conditions which may affect the safety and general comfort of any person. (2) Regular applications of water or other palliative measures are carried out along the sections of the work and side-tracks traversed by the travelling public. (3) Measures are taken to minimise dust or rectify any structures affected by dust. 2.6 Pedestrian movements (1) Pedestrian traffic is to be provided for in accordance with the requirements of the QMUTCD. (2) Where pedestrian traffic has to cross the work site, appropriately constructed and protected crossings are provided. (3) Signs and warning lamps are to be installed and adequate illumination provided to identify and illuminate pedestrian access. 2.7 (1) Traffic controller qualifications Where a traffic controller is used to control traffic around or through the works, the traffic controller is trained and certified in accordance with the Queensland Transport’s “Code of Practice for Traffic Controllers”. 2.8 Temporary pavement marking (1) Temporary pavement markings are provided in accordance with a traffic management plan. (2) Temporary pavement markings comply with the QMUTCD, using a proprietary brand removable reflective tape. (3) Temporary pavement markings are to be maintained during the works and removed at the end of the works. (4) Details of proposed temporary pavement markings are submitted to the local government for approval at least two working days prior to the proposed installation of the temporary pavement. 2.9 (1) Maintenance outside normal working hours A traffic control device and side-track is inspected outside normal working hours to ascertain its effectiveness and any corrective action that is necessary in respect of the traffic control device or side-track is carried out immediately. 2.10 (1) Side-tracks Where a side-track is constructed to divert traffic around the work: (a) a side-track is aligned, formed, graded and drained so as to provide for safe, comfortable passage of vehicles at the indicated speed limit with a surface crossfall not less than 4 percent; (b) not less than 6m vertical clearance is provided from the trafficked surface to any overhanging obstacle; (c) the widening of a side-track is provided at crests, transitions and curves; (d) if the normal width of the side-track is less than 6 metres, suitable passing facilities, not less than 30 metres in length and providing an available width of not less than 6m, are located at minimum intervals of 800 metres along the side-track and at locations where conditions are such that the sight distance is effectively greater than 100 metres; (e) if a waterway is encountered along the route of the side-track: (i) an adequate culvert crossing or adequately paved floodway is constructed for at least the full width of the side-track; Standard specification No.10 (Provision for Traffic) Part 2 Traffic control–2.5 Dust control Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss10-3 (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) the edges of the culvert crossings and paved floodways are delineated effectively both day and night, using appropriate delineators mounted on approved guide posts; depth indicator posts are installed which permit assessment of the maximum depth of water above the surface of the side-track; waterway crossing materials are removed and are not disposed of on-site; the waterway is restored to its original profile and cross-section following the closure of the side-track; (f) the side-track is paved and sealed; (g) the side-track is maintained in a safe, trafficable condition for the duration of their use during the construction of the work; (h) side-track materials are removed and the area is restored to its original profile and crosssection following closure of the side-track; (i) the location of a side-track is to be approved by the local government. Standard specification No.10 (Provision for Traffic) Part 2 Traffic control–2.10 Side-tracks Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss10-4 Part 3 3.1 (1) Speed limits The Contractor is not to impose a restricted speed limit on traffic on the Site without the approval of the Superintendent, which approval is to be sought at least 21 days prior to the proposed imposition of the restricted speed limit. 3.2 (1) 3.3 Contractual provisions Detouring of traffic The Contractor is to only detour traffic on the Site, if the Contractor has: (a) provided the Superintendent with details of the proposed detour within seven days of commencement of the detour; (b) obtained the Superintendent’s approval to detour traffic prior to the commencement of detouring. Maintenance outside working hours (1) Prior to the commencement of work under the Contract, the Contractor is to notify the Superintendent of the name, address and telephone number of a supervisor who can be contacted at any time and who has the authority to carry out immediate repairs to and maintenance of traffic control devices and side-tracks. (2) If the supervisor nominated by the Contractor is replaced, the Contractor is to immediately notify the Superintendent of the new supervisor’s name, address and telephone number. Standard specification No.10 (Provision for Traffic) Part 3 Contractual provisions–3.1 Speed limits Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss10-5 Part 4 4.1 (1) Permanent line marking Permanent line marking Work shall include the following: (a) all longitudinal line markings; (b) transverse lines and other markings, including but not limited to: (i) diagonal and chevron markings; (ii) messages on the pavement including words, numerals, arrows and symbols. (2) The removal of painted road markings, unless otherwise approved by the local government, shall be carried out with abrasive blasting techniques and/or cold planning/grinding. The Contractor shall remove the nominated road markings as specified on the drawings regardless of the colour, number of coats, type and age of paint. Blasting shall be carried out until at least 90 percent of the original areas of each road marking have been removed. (3) The Contractor shall clean up and remove from the roadway all materials and debris from the operations and leave the roadway clear for use by the public. (4) Beads shall be applied uniformly to all markings and shall be applied to the paint prior to the surface skinning to produce an uniform, properly bonded coverage over the entire marking. (5) The minimum application rates for the paint and glass beads is specified in Table 4.1– Application rate for beads and paint of this standard specification. Table 4.1–Application rate for beads and paint Work type Coverage (minimum per coat) Wet application rate Longitudinal lines - first coat (Type B drop-on beads). > 300g/m² 0.375 l/m² ±25 (6) All pavement markings shall be uniformly and neatly applied and finished with sharp edges. Longitudinal markings shall have a smooth and even appearance located within the tolerances specified. New markings shall be smoothly transitioned to match existing markings at the limits of the work. (7) All completed pavement markings shall be uniform in appearance, texture, width and thickness and the surface shall be free from un-beaded areas, traffic damage or other defects. Markings shall be straight or with smooth even curves where intended. All edges shall have a clean sharp cut off. Any marking material beyond the defined marking shall be removed to leave a neat marking on the wearing surface of the pavement. (8) All transverse pavement marking shall be installed in thermoplastic line marking paint. Bus zones and loading zones shall be yellow thermoplastic line marking paint. Standard specification No.10 (Provision for Traffic) Part 4 Permanent line marking–4.1 Permanent line marking Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss10-6 Standard specification No. 11 (Construction) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION............................................................................................................. 1 Title ................................................................................................................................ 1 Purpose of the standard specification ......................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Interpretation of standard specification ....................................................................... 1 PART 2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8 2.9 ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION ................................................................................. 2 Protection of plants to be retained ............................................................................... 2 Work near a tree ............................................................................................................ 2 Damage to plants .......................................................................................................... 2 Erosion and sedimentation ........................................................................................... 3 Temporary erosion and sediment control measures................................................... 3 Permanent erosion and sediment control measures................................................... 3 Construction of erosion and sediment control measures ........................................... 3 Maintenance of erosion and sediment control measures ........................................... 3 Trucking......................................................................................................................... 3 PART 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 OPERATIONAL REQUIREMENTS ................................................................................. 4 Dial before you dig ........................................................................................................ 4 Hours of construction ................................................................................................... 4 Blasting.......................................................................................................................... 4 Workplace Health and Safety Act 1995 ........................................................................ 4 Work within a road reserve ........................................................................................... 4 Work within a park ........................................................................................................ 4 Existing fences .............................................................................................................. 5 Bench marks and survey pegs ..................................................................................... 5 PART 4 4.1 4.2 4.3 CONTRACTUAL PROVISIONS ...................................................................................... 6 Protection of plants....................................................................................................... 6 Work within road reserve .............................................................................................. 6 Disposal of surplus spoil .............................................................................................. 6 Standard specification No 11 (Construction) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 11–Construction 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in section 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being engineering work. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of standard specification If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard specification No. 11 (Construction) Part 1 Introduction–1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss11-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) Protection of plants to be retained If an area which is identified in a development approval as an area not to be disturbed: (a) the area is pegged and flagged prior to the pre-start meeting; (b) plants, including individual trees, that abut the limit of work and storage or access areas, are fenced with star pickets and orange para webbing running the entire length of the limit of the work, with the pickets placed a minimum of one metre from the trunk of a tree; (c) warning signs are displayed in prominent positions on the premises, warning that the pegged area and fenced vegetation is to be protected. 2.2 (1) Environmental protection Work near a tree When work is carried out near a tree which is to be retained: (a) topsoil is not removed from within the pegged or fenced vegetation enclosure or within the perimeter of any tree canopy; (b) a concentrated water flow is diverted away from a root zone by the construction of a temporary drain or other method; (c) any temporary drain is removed at the acceptance of the work off-maintenance by the local government; (d) the area within the perimeter of a tree canopy is not used for storage, stockpiling, dumping or access; (e) excavation around the tree roots is carried out with hand tools; (f) visible tree roots that extend beyond temporary enclosures are not cut or damaged; (g) excavations around tree roots are backfilled (but not compacted) with excavated soil, finishing with topsoil to finished grade; (h) backfill does not exceed 100mm above the original ground surface around base of tree trunks; (i) immediately after backfilling, the root zone of a tree is thoroughly watered to eliminate all air pockets. 2.3 Damage to plants (1) If damage is caused to plants in an area that is not to be disturbed, the damaged plants are to be repaired or replaced. (2) In section 2.3(1) of this standard specification, ‘damaged’ means: (a) the destruction of a plant; or (b) the breaking of branches or roots; or (c) the debarking of trunks or limbs; or (d) the contamination of root zone soil or plants from drifting sprays, dust or contaminated stormwater flows; or (e) the damage by the placement of fill or building materials within the canopy perimeter or otherwise. (3) Work that is carried out on a tree is done by an approved tree arborist. (4) Where repair work to damaged plants is impractical or is attempted and fails then, the tree and root system is removed and the area reinstated and the plants replaced and established with replacement plants of the same species and similar size. Standard specification No. 11 (Construction) Part 2 Environmental protection–2.1 Protection of plants to be retained Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss11-2 2.4 Erosion and sedimentation (1) All work associated with erosion and sediment control is in accordance with the Soil Erosion and Sediment Control Engineering Guidelines unless otherwise specified. (2) An erosion and sediment control plan for the works is prepared in accordance with section AF of the Soil Erosion and Sediment Control Engineering Guidelines, and is approved by the local government prior to the commencement of works. 2.5 Temporary erosion and sediment control measures (1) A temporary erosion and sediment control measure is in accordance with section A5 of the Soil Erosion and Sediment Control Guidelines. (2) Where construction work involves trenching or other ground disturbance within ten metres of existing downstream or downhill properties, turfing of the disturbed areas is the minimum requirement for the protection of the downstream properties. (3) An erosion control device is designed to minimise erosion at a construction site and consequently decrease downstream sediment transport. (4) A sediment control device is designed to remove sediment from runoff before it leaves the site. (5) A temporary erosion and sediment control measure is to be properly maintained in order to remain functional. 2.6 (1) 2.7 Permanent erosion and sediment control measures A permanent erosion and sediment control measure is in accordance with section A5 of the Soil Erosion and Sediment Control Guidelines. Construction of erosion and sediment control measures (1) The construction of an erosion and sediment control measure is carried out in such a manner that erosion and water pollution are minimised. (2) Access is provided and maintained from within the road reserve for cleaning out an erosion and sediment control measure. (3) The sediment removed from such erosion and sediment control measure is disposed of at locations where it will not again erode onto the construction areas or into a waterway. (4) A temporary erosion and sediment control measure is removed when revegetation has established on formerly exposed areas. 2.8 Maintenance of erosion and sediment control measures (1) Any erosion and sediment control measure used is cleaned out until the acceptance of the works off-maintenance by the local government. (2) Any temporary erosion and sedimentation control measure is inspected daily and after each rain period and during periods of prolonged rainfall and any defects revealed by such inspections are rectified immediately and these works are cleaned, repaired and augmented as required to ensure effective control thereafter. (3) Any erosion and sediment control measure is cleaned out whenever the accumulated sediment has reduced the capacity of the erosion and sediment control measures by 25 percent. (4) The removal of the sediment is done in such a manner so as to restore the erosion and sediment control measure and not to damage the erosion and sediment control measure. 2.9 Trucking (1) Any material adhering to the wheels, tracks, or body of a vehicle or machinery leaving the site of the work is effectively removed, prior to the vehicle or machinery entering onto a public road. (2) A vehicle carting material off the site has its loads covered. (3) Any material dropped or tracked onto a road as a result of the works is cleaned up as soon as practicable. Standard specification No. 11 (Construction) Part 2 Environmental protection–2.4 Erosion and sedimentation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss11-3 Part 3 3.1 Operational requirements Dial before you dig (1) Before the commencement of any excavation work, current information on the location of underground services is obtained from the “Dial before you dig” service and the relevant service authorities. (2) The location of all underground services contained within the premises identified pursuant to section 3.1(1) of this standard specification are clearly marked on the ground. (3) The exact location and level of all services that may conflict with the work is determined by pot holing. 3.2 (1) Hours of construction Subject to any other requirements in this standard specification, construction activity does not: (a) take place outside the hours of 7.00 am to 6.00 pm on Monday to Saturday; (b) take place on Sundays or public holidays. 3.3 (1) Blasting Blasting is not permitted. 3.4 (1) Workplace Health and Safety Act 1995 Work complies with the requirements of the Workplace Health and Safety Act 1995. 3.5 Work within a road reserve (1) Work within a road proceeds without interruption to traffic and any steps necessary for the protection of the public during construction are taken. (2) A traffic control device is erected in accordance with the Queensland Manual of Uniform Traffic Control Devices (QMUTCD) and Standard Specification No. 10–Provision for Traffic. (3) An open trench is constructed as shown in the approved drawings. (4) A trench is not left open overnight except where: (a) it cannot be avoided; (b) the work is protected and delineated in accordance with QMUTCD. (5) Work in a road is carried out so as not to detrimentally affect the existing drainage provisions of the road. (6) Prior to an excavation across a sealed road pavement, a straight saw cut is made in the asphalt surface at least 150mm clear of the trench wall and the saw cut edges are maintained as neat, straight edges during the work. 3.6 Work within a park (1) Work within a park is confined to the extent of the works plus an additional six metre wide construction swathe. (2) A temporary barrier fence or marker is erected to define the limits of the construction swathe. (3) Development is limited to the area of the construction swathe. (4) Where it is necessary to clear bushland within a construction swathe, the area is rehabilitated on completion of the work by re-establishing native species of an equivalent density and type to that which existed before the work commenced. Standard specification No. 11 (Construction) Part 3 Operational requirements–3.1 Dial before you dig Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss11-4 3.7 Existing fences (1) A fence, other than a fence which is specifically noted for removal, is maintained at all times and special care is taken to prevent the straying of stock if grazing is carried out on adjoining premises. (2) If a fence is required to be cut or moved, a temporary fence is erected, if necessary, for stock containment. (3) Where a fence is cut for access: (a) wire is drawn tight to the end post and suitably strutted; (b) a gate is provided for closure after working hours or when no work is underway on the premises. (4) A fence which is damaged during the execution of the work is repaired immediately. (5) A fence which is cut or removed during the execution of the work is to be replaced and reinstated to its original alignment and condition on the completion of the work. 3.8 (1) Bench marks and survey pegs A bench mark or survey peg is not to be disturbed during construction. Standard specification No. 11 (Construction) Part 3 Operational requirements–3.7 Existing fences Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss11-5 Part 4 4.1 Contractual provisions Protection of plants (1) Any peg, fence and warning signs used to protect plants in an area not to be disturbed during the construction of the Works is to be removed by the Contractor at the commencement of the defects liability period. (2) The Contractor is not to perform work on a tree, including canopy or pruning and the repair or removal of a branch without the approval of the Superintendent. 4.2 (1) 4.3 Work within road reserve Open cut excavation across an existing road pavement is only to be carried out with the written approval of the Superintendent. Disposal of surplus spoil (1) Surplus soil remaining at the completion of back filling operations remains the property of the Principal unless otherwise directed by the Superintendent. (2) Surplus soil is to be disposed of at a site approved by the Superintendent. (3) If a direction is given by the Superintendent pursuant to section 4.3(1) of this standard specification, the cost of such work is deemed to be included in the Contract Sum. Standard specification No. 11 (Construction) Part 4 Contractual provisions–4.1 Protection of plants Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss11-6 Standard specification No. 12 (Sub-soil drainage) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of standard specification .................................................................. 1 PART 2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 LOCATION OF SUB-SOIL DRAINAGE PIPE ............................................................ 2 Timing of construction ............................................................................................. 2 Location of a longitudinal sub-soil drainage pipe .................................................. 2 Location of a transverse sub-soil drainage pipe .................................................... 2 Excavation for a sub-soil drainage pipe.................................................................. 2 Types of sub-soil drainage pipes ............................................................................ 2 PART 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 BEDDING AND FILTER MATERIALS ....................................................................... 3 General standards .................................................................................................... 3 Filter material type 1................................................................................................. 3 Filter material type 2................................................................................................. 3 PART 4 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 4.7 CONSTRUCTION ...................................................................................................... 5 Pipe laying of a sub-soil drainage pipe ................................................................... 5 Compaction of backfill ............................................................................................. 5 Outlet for a sub-soil drainage pipe .......................................................................... 5 Free inlets ................................................................................................................. 5 Clean outs................................................................................................................. 5 Joining ...................................................................................................................... 5 Treatment of islands and speed control devices .................................................... 5 Standard specification No. 12 (Sub-soil drainage) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 12–Sub-Soil Drainage 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in section 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being engineering work involving sub-soil drainage. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of standard specification If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard specification No. 12 (Sub-soil drainage) Part 1 Introduction—1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss12-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) Timing of construction Sub-soil drainage is constructed either after: (a) preparation of the pavement box; or (b) sub-grade material has been placed and compacted. 2.2 (1) (2) Location of a longitudinal sub-soil drainage pipe Where a kerb and channel is constructed a sub-soil drainage pipe is constructed: (a) immediately below the back of the kerb in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R0140; (b) at least 150mm below the finished sub-grade level. Where a sub-soil drainage pipe is specified in a landscaped area: (a) it is located as specified in the approved drawings; (b) it is at a depth of not less than 600mm below the finished surface level; (c) it is at a grade not less than 1 percent; (d) filter material is placed to a height of 100mm below the finished surface level. 2.3 (1) Location of a transverse sub-soil drainage pipe Where a transverse drain or mitre drain is used it is located to intersect a longitudinal drain at approximately 45 degrees to its direction of fall. 2.4 (1) (2) Location of sub-soil drainage pipe Excavation for a sub-soil drainage pipe A trench for a sub-soil drainage pipe is excavated to: (a) 50mm below the invert level of the sub-soil drainage pipe; (b) a gradient which is specified in the approved drawings or which is a minimum of 1 percent if the gradient is not specified in the approved drawings. A trench is to be a minimum of 100mm wider than the outside diameter of the sub-soil drainage pipe. 2.5 Types of sub-soil drainage pipes (1) A sub-soil drainage pipe is a class 400 perforated corrugated PVC pipe Type 1 in accordance with AS 2439.1-2007 Perforated plastics drainage and effluent pipe and fittings - Perforated drainage pipe and associated fittings. (2) The diameter of a sub-soil drainage pipe is a minimum of 100mm and the perforations do not exceed 1.1mm in width and 7.4mm in length. (3) A strip drain which is a proprietary product: (a) comprises a regular patterned cusp-shaped plastic core of nominal thickness not less than 40mm encased by a non-woven geotextile which permits the passage of high volume water flows; (b) has a crush strength not less than 100 kPa. Standard specification No. 12 (Sub-soil drainage) Part 2 Location of sub-soil drainage pipe—2.1 Timing of construction Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss12-2 Part 3 3.1 (1) Bedding and filter materials General standards The filter and bedding material has: (a) a Type 1 grading as specified in Table 3.2.1–Filter material type 1 gradingof this standard specification; or (b) a Type 2 grading as specified in Table 3.3.1–Filter material type 2 grading of this standard specification or as specified in the approved drawings. 3.2 Filter material type 1 (1) The sub-soil drainage pipe is bedded on a minimum of 50mm of graded filter material. (2) The filter material: (3) (a) comprises a 10mm one size aggregate; (b) consists of clean, hard, tough, durable, uncoated material of uniform quality; (c) complies with the grading specified in Table 3.2.1–Filter material type 1 grading of this standard specification; (d) completely wrap filter material in geotextile of type and grade specified in standard drawings. The trench is backfilled to the sub-grade level with the filter material. Table 3.2.1–Filter material type 1 grading 3.3 Column 1 Column 2 Sieve % Passing 19.0mm 100 13.2mm 90-100 9.50mm 40-70 4.75mm 0-15 2.36mm 0-5 75um 0-2 Filter material type 2 (1) The sub-soil drainage pipe is fully enclosed in a non-woven proprietary brand geotextile sock and is bedded on a minimum of 50mm of graded filter material. (2) The filter material: (3) (a) comprises a coarse sand; (b) consists of clean, hard, tough, durable and uncoated material of uniform quality; (c) complies with the grading specified in Table 3.3.1–Filter material type 2 grading of this standard specification (d) completely wrap filter material in geotextile of type and grade specified in standard drawings. The trench is backfilled to the sub-grade level with the filter material. Standard specification No. 12 (Sub-soil drainage) Part 3 Bedding and filter materials—3.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss12-3 Table 3.3.1–Filter material type 2 grading Column 1 Column 2 Sieve % Passing 9.50mm 100 4.75mm 99-95 2.36mm 98-70 1.8mm 88-33 600um 63-12 300um 15-5 75um 2-0 Standard specification No. 12 (Sub-soil drainage) Part 3 Bedding and filter materials—3.3 Filter material type 2 Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss12-4 Part 4 4.1 (1) Pipe laying of a sub-soil drainage pipe A sub-soil drainage pipe is laid on a prepared filter bed to ensure a uniform grade. 4.2 (1) Compaction of backfill The backfill material in an excavation for a sub-soil drainage pipe is compacted to the specified density for the subgrade or the pavement directly adjacent. 4.3 (1) Construction Outlet for a sub-soil drainage pipe A sub-soil drainage pipe: (a) is connected to a gully pit, as specified in standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0140; or (b) discharges to a culvert head wall or an open channel below the edge of the road shoulder or at the edge of an embankment. (2) If a sub-soil drainage pipe is not connected into a gully pit or a culvert headwall, a concrete headwall is provided to the sub-soil drainage pipe. (3) The headwall is at least 100mm thick and extends for a minimum of 150mm on all sides of the pipe. (4) Where the outlet is through a batter, the surface of the headwall conforms to the batter slope. 4.4 (1) Free inlets A sub-soil drainage pipe which has a free inlet, that is an open pipe end, is constructed in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0140. 4.5 (1) (2) 4.6 Clean outs A clean out is: (a) located at the head of the sub-soil drainage pipe and at subsequent spacings not exceeding 60 metres as specified in standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0140; (b) located at a gully pit, where it is constructed with a cap or a plug as specified in standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0140. A marker is installed in the kerb adjacent to each clean out surface box. Joining (1) A sub-soil drainage pipe is joined in accordance with the manufacturer’s recommendations. (2) The connection of a clean out pipe or the joining of an additional pipe is made with an approved proprietary brand 45 degree tee connection. 4.7 Treatment of islands and speed control devices (1) A mitre drain is constructed in an island or a speed control device, to drain the sub-surface water from the structure into the nearest gully pit or manhole. (2) A landscaped or partly landscaped island has perimeter sub-soil drainage which discharges into the nearest gully pit or manhole in accordance with standard drawing IPWEAQ R-0141. Standard specification No. 12 (Sub-soil drainage) Part 4 Construction—4.1 Pipe laying of a sub-soil drainage pipe Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss12-5 Standard specification No. 13 (Asphaltic concrete surfacing) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION.......................................................................................................... 1 Title ............................................................................................................................. 1 Purpose of the standard specification ...................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ................................................................. 1 Interpretation of standard specification .................................................................... 1 PART 2 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 2.5 2.6 2.7 STANDARDS AND PROPERTIES OF ASPHALT........................................................ 2 Type of asphalt ........................................................................................................... 2 General standards ...................................................................................................... 2 Aggregates ................................................................................................................. 2 Bitumen binder ........................................................................................................... 2 Modified binder .......................................................................................................... 2 Asphalt mix properties............................................................................................... 3 Asphalt mix testing .................................................................................................... 3 PART 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 APPLICATION OF ASPHALT ...................................................................................... 5 Temperature ............................................................................................................... 5 Preparation of pavement............................................................................................ 5 Spreading ................................................................................................................... 5 Compaction ................................................................................................................ 5 Compacted asphalt testing ........................................................................................ 5 PART 4 4.1 CONTRACTUAL PROVISIONS ................................................................................... 7 Reduction in the contract value of compacted asphalt ............................................ 7 Standard specification No. 13 (Asphaltic concrete surfacing) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 13–Asphaltic concrete surfacing 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 (1) Application of the standard specification This standard specification applies to work being engineering work involving the asphaltic concrete surfacing of a pavement. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of standard specification If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard specification No. 13 (Asphaltic concrete surfacing) Part 1 Introduction–1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss13-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) Standards and properties of asphalt Type of asphalt The type of asphalt used complies with Table 2.1.1–Asphalt types of this standard specification. Table 2.1.1–Asphalt types Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Thickness of asphalt (mm) Application of asphalt Type of asphalt 25 Correction material for low volume roads. 1 30 Resurfacing an existing sealed pavement or surfacing new work. 2 45 Surfacing of a new pavement on a major urban collector (access permitted) road or above. 3 Structural layer for high traffic roads 4 50+ 2.2 (1) General standards Asphaltic concrete surfacing complies with: (a) AS 2150-2005 Hot mix asphalt - A guide to good practice; (b) AS 2891-2008 Methods of sampling and testing asphalt - Sampling of asphalt; (c) Queensland Transport Test Methods Q302A, Q302B, Q305, Q306B, Q308A, Q311 and Q314; (d) MRTS 30 - Dens graded and open graded asphalt. 2.3 (1) Aggregates Coarse aggregates and fine aggregates used in the asphaltic concrete mix comply with the requirements of Appendix K of AS 2150-2005 Hot mix asphalt - A guide to good practice. 2.4 (1) Bitumen binder The binder used in the asphaltic concrete mix is bitumen Class 320 which complies with AS 20081997 Residual bitumen for pavements, unless Class 170 is specified. 2.5 (1) (2) Modified binder The bitumen binder may be modified by the addition of various agents (such as S.B.S. or E.V.A. polymers) to enhance the properties of the asphalt for specialised applications to provide for: (a) decreased crack reflection; (b) greater tolerance of deflections; (c) increased durability. Modified binders which are based on Class 170 bitumen are: (a) provided only when specified; (b) used in accordance with the manufacturer’s directions. Standard specification No. 13 (Asphaltic concrete surfacing) Part 2 Standards and properties of asphalt–2.1 Type of asphalt Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss13-2 2.6 Asphalt mix properties (1) The properties of asphalt mix comply with Table 2.6.1–Asphalt mix properties of this standard specification when tested in accordance with column 3. (2) Asphalt complies with Main Roads Technical Standard MRTS 30 - Dense Graded and Open Graded Asphalt. Table 2.6.1–Asphalt mix properties 2.7 Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Column 4 Mix property Description Test method General limits Aggregate grading The general limits of aggregate grading within which the job mix is to be designed and produced Q308A Refer MRTS 30 Dense Graded and Open Graded Asphalt (Table 10.3.1 Grading limits for combined aggregate and filler). Bitumen content Bitumen content expressed as a percentage by mass of total mix. (Class 320 bitumen) Q308A Refer to MRTS30 Dense Graded and Open Graded Asphalt Specification (Table 10.3.2 Asphalt Mix Design Requirements). Stability Stability of the compacted mix as tested by the Marshall Method (50 blows each end) Q305 Refer to MRTS30 Dense Graded and Open Graded Asphalt Specification (Table 10.3.2 Asphalt Mix Design Requirements). Flow Flow of the compacted mix as tested by the Marshall Method (50 blows each end) Q305 Refer to MRTS30 Dense Graded and Open Graded Asphalt Specification (Table 10.3.2 Asphalt Mix Design Requirements). Air voids Percentage air voids in the compacted mix as tested by the Marshall Method (50 blows each end) Q305. Q306B. Q311 3% - 5% Asphalt mix testing (1) A sample of the mix of production asphalt at the asphalt plant is taken at the rate of one sample per lot where a lot is 400 tonnes or one work shift, whichever gives the greater number of lots. (2) A sample of the mix of production asphalt is prepared and tested in accordance with the following test methods: (a) compacted density of dense graded asphalt (two parts only)—Q306B; or (b) binder content and aggregate grading of asphalt—Q308A; or (c) voids calculations for compacted asphalt—Q311. Standard specification No. 13 (Asphaltic concrete surfacing) Part 2 Standards and properties of asphalt–2.6 Asphalt mix properties Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss13-3 (3) The assessment of the acceptability of a lot of production asphalt is based on the number of defect points associated with the requirements for grading and bitumen content specified in Table 2.6.1– Asphalt mix properties of this standard specification where: (a) the number of defect points per lot is calculated as specified in Table 2.7.1–Calculation of defects of this standard specification as the total number of defects in the sample representing the lot; (b) the “Job Reference Density” is calculated as the average of the results of test Q306B for all samples taken for a particular job. Table 2.7.1–Calculation of defects (4) (5) Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Measurement Variations outside the limits specified in Table 2.6.1–Asphalt mix properties Defect points % Passing 9.5mm sieve and larger sieves 1 or 2 occurrences 1 % Passing 4.75 and 2.36mm sieves 1 or 2 occurrences 1 % Passing 0.600 and 0.300 1 or 2 occurrences 1 % Passing 0.150mm sieves 3 occurrences 2 % Passing 0.075mm sieve Each 0.5% reported result 1 Bitumen content % Each 0.1% reported result 1 A lot is acceptable if the lot: (a) has no defects; or (b) has a number of defect points up to a total of two provided the necessary action to prevent recurrence of the defects has been taken; or (c) has a number of defect points between two and six (inclusive) provided it is used for a reduced level of service and the necessary action to prevent recurrence of the defects is taken. A lot is not acceptable if it has a number of defect points above six. Standard specification No. 13 (Asphaltic concrete surfacing) Part 2 Standards and properties of asphalt–2.7 Asphalt mix testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss13-4 Part 3 3.1 Application of asphalt Temperature (1) The asphalt mix temperature is controlled so that it is between 135oC and 175oC when loaded into the delivery truck. (2) The mix temperature is between 110oC and 165oC immediately behind the paver with compaction commencing before the temperature of the mix falls below a minimum of 95oC. (3) Appropriate adjustments to the temperatures stated section 3.1(1) and (2) of this standard specification, are required when using Class 170 bitumen or a modified binder. 3.2 (1) (2) 3.3 Preparation of pavement The pavement to be surfaced is prepared, in the case of: (a) a gravel pavement by ensuring that: (i) the surface is primed with cutback bitumen in order to aid adhesion between the base and the asphalt surface at least two days prior to the asphalt being laid; (ii) the prime is sprayed at a rate of 1.0 litres/m 2 unless otherwise varied by the local government to suit individual site conditions; (iii) emulsion primes or primer seals be used if approved by the local government and if applied according to advice of the manufacturer. (b) a surfaced pavement, by ensuring that: (i) a tack coat of bitumen emulsion is applied to ensure adhesion between the existing layer and that to be placed; (ii) the tack coat is allowed to “break” prior to the asphalt being laid; (iii) the tack coat is sprayed at a rate of 0.3 litres/m 2 unless otherwise varied by the local government to suit individual site conditions; (c) all pavements, by ensuring that the surface is free of loose material. Emulsion primes may be used in the case of gravel pavements if approved by the local government and if applied according to advice of the manufacturer. Spreading (1) A paver run with associated handwork is set out so that the compaction equipment has access onto the surface immediately spreading is completed. (2) The number of joints, both longitudinal and transverse, are kept to a minimum and care is taken to ensure that as many of the joints as practicable are hot joints and not within the wheel paths. 3.4 Compaction (1) Compaction is commenced as soon as possible after spreading, and is completed in the shortest possible time except in the event of significant deformation or an irregularity occurring under the action of the roller in which case, rolling is delayed. (2) The mix is compacted to a dense, smooth mat. 3.5 Compacted asphalt testing (1) For compaction testing, a lot is the same as for a production lot and compaction testing is undertaken in accordance with Q302A, Q302B, Q306B and Q314. (2) After completion of each job, core samples are taken from the compacted asphalt at the rate of one core per 1000m2 of asphalt laid, but with a minimum of three cores per job. (3) The relative compaction of each core is determined as a percentage of the “Job Reference Density” to the nearest .01 percent. (4) Compacted asphalt is acceptable if in the case of: Standard specification No. 13 (Asphaltic concrete surfacing) Part 3 Application of asphalt–3.1 Temperature Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss13-5 (a) Type 3 Asphalt, it has a mean relative compaction which is equal to or greater than 95 percent; (b) Type 2 Asphalt, it has a mean relative compaction which is equal or greater than 93 percent; (c) Type 1 Asphalt, it is supplied and laid in a dense, smooth mat of asphalt free of surface irregularities and imperfections. Standard specification No. 13 (Asphaltic concrete surfacing) Part 3 Application of asphalt–3.5 Compacted asphalt testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss13-6 Part 4 4.1 (1) Contractual provisions Reduction in the contract value of compacted asphalt If the Superintendent accepts compacted asphalt that does not comply with section 3.5(4) (Compacted asphalt testing) of this standard specification in that the lot has a mean relative compaction greater than 90 percent, but less than 95 percent, the Superintendent is to reduce any part of the Contract Sum payable to the Contractor in relation to that asphalt work proportionately to the value of the non-complying compacted asphalt, calculated in accordance with the following formula: Percentage reduction = 2.5 x (95 percent - mean relative compaction percent). (2) If the Superintendent accepts compacted asphalt that does not comply with section 3.5(4)(b) (Compacted asphalt testing) of this standard specification in that the lot has a mean relative compaction greater than 90 percent, but less than 93 percent, the Superintendent is to reduce any part of the Contract Sum payable to the Contractor in relation to that asphalt work proportionately to the value of the non-complying compacted asphalt, calculated in accordance with the following formula: Percentage reduction = 2.5 percent (93 percent - mean relative compaction percent). (3) Section (1) and (2) will only apply in the case where the local government is the Superintendent. Standard specification No. 13 (Asphaltic concrete surfacing) Part 4 Contractual provisions–4.1 Reduction in the contract value of compacted asphalt Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss13-7 Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) 2015 Table of contents PART 1 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 INTRODUCTION........................................................................................................ 1 Title ........................................................................................................................... 1 Purpose of the standard specification .................................................................... 1 Application of the standard specification ............................................................... 1 Interpretation of standard specification .................................................................. 1 PART 2 2.1 MATERIALS .............................................................................................................. 2 Pavement materials.................................................................................................. 2 PART 3 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 SUPPLY AND DELIVERY OF AGGREGATE ............................................................ 3 General standards .................................................................................................... 3 Particle size distribution (grading) .......................................................................... 3 Particle quality.......................................................................................................... 3 Precoating ................................................................................................................ 4 Delivery ..................................................................................................................... 4 PART 4 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 SUPPLY AND DELIVERY OF BITUMINOUS MATERIAL .......................................... 5 General standards .................................................................................................... 5 Storage and transport .............................................................................................. 5 Heating...................................................................................................................... 5 Incorporation of additives or modified bitumen ..................................................... 5 PART 5 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 PREPARATION PRIOR TO SPRAYING .................................................................... 7 Surface preparation ................................................................................................. 7 Protection of services .............................................................................................. 7 Setting out ................................................................................................................ 7 Programming spray runs ......................................................................................... 7 PART 6 6.1 6.2 6.3 RESTRICTIONS TO SPRAYING................................................................................ 8 Pavement surface temperature................................................................................ 8 Weather conditions .................................................................................................. 8 Period between bituminous treatments .................................................................. 8 PART 7 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.4 7.5 7.6 7.7 7.8 SPRAYING ................................................................................................................ 9 General standards .................................................................................................... 9 Method of application .............................................................................................. 9 Spray runs ................................................................................................................ 9 Spraying temperature .............................................................................................. 9 Defects during spraying......................................................................................... 10 Cutting back bitumen ............................................................................................. 10 Spray rate ............................................................................................................... 11 Quantities retained in sprayer tank ....................................................................... 12 PART 8 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 SPREADING PRIME COVER MATERIAL ............................................................... 13 General standards .................................................................................................. 13 Spread rate ............................................................................................................. 13 Time limit ................................................................................................................ 13 Spreading ............................................................................................................... 13 Removal of excess cover material......................................................................... 13 PART 9 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 9.5 SPREADING COVER AGGREGATE ....................................................................... 14 General standards .................................................................................................. 14 Spread rate for cover aggregate ............................................................................ 14 Time limit ................................................................................................................ 14 Spreading ............................................................................................................... 14 Rolling..................................................................................................................... 14 Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pi 9.6 9.7 Removal of excess cover aggregate ..................................................................... 14 Two applications of cover aggregate with a single application of binder ........... 15 PART 10 10.1 10.2 RECORDING AND TESTING................................................................................... 16 Recording details of spraying operations ............................................................. 16 Construction compliance testing .......................................................................... 17 PART 11 11.1 11.2 11.3 11.4 CONTRACTUAL PROVISIONS ............................................................................... 18 Introduction ............................................................................................................ 18 Supply and delivery of aggregate .......................................................................... 18 Utilisation of a rejected lot for a reduced level of service .................................... 18 Measurement and payment.................................................................................... 19 Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Pii Part 1 1.1 (1) Introduction Title This standard specification may be cited as Standard specification No. 14–Sprayed bitumen surfacing 2015. 1.2 Purpose of the standard specification (1) This standard specification forms part of planning scheme policy 5–Infrastructure and as such specifies assessment provisions in respect of which an application for development approval for development being work specified in section 1.3–Application of the standard specification of this standard specification is assessed. (2) This standard specification may also form part of a contract: (a) of which the local government is a principal; or (b) of which the local government is not a principal as a result of a development approval granted by the local government. 1.3 Application of the standard specification (1) This standard specification applies to work being engineering work involving the spray bitumen surfacing of a pavement. (2) The work comprises one or more of the following processes: (a) application of primer, with or without cover material, followed by binder and aggregate; (b) single application of binder with single application of aggregate; (c) single application of binder with separate applications of coarse and fine aggregate; (d) double applications of binder and aggregate. 1.4 (1) (2) (3) Interpretation of standard specification If this standard specification forms part of a contract, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification but is defined in the contract, has the meaning given in the contract; (c) is not defined in this standard specification or the contract, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification is used to assess development, a term used in this standard specification which: (a) is defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in this standard specification; (b) is not defined in this standard specification, has the meaning given in accordance with SC1.2–Administrative definitions of Schedule 1 of the planning scheme. If this standard specification forms part of a contract in which the local government is a principal then, for the purpose of that contract, all references to “local government” will be read as “Principal”. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 1 Introduction–1.1 Title Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-1 Part 2 2.1 (1) Materials Pavement materials The materials and workmanship in respect of sprayed bitumen surfacing comply with: (a) AS 1141.0-1999 Methods for sampling and testing aggregates - List of methods; (b) AS 1289.0-2000 Methods of testing soils for engineering purposes - General requirements and list of methods; (c) AS 2008-1997 Residual bitumen for pavements; (d) MRS 11- Sprayed Bituminous Surfacing (Excluding Emulsion); (e) MRS 12 - Sprayed Bituminous Emulsion Surfacing. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 2 Materials–2.1 Pavement materials Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-2 Part 3 3.1 Supply and delivery of aggregate General standards (1) Aggregate consists of clean, dry, hard, tough, sound crushed stone of uniform quality, which is free from dust, clay, dirt and other deleterious matter and an excess of flat or laminated pieces. (2) Aggregate is of such a nature that when it is thoroughly coated with bituminous material proposed for the work, the coating does not slough off upon contact with water. 3.2 (1) Particle size distribution (grading) The particle size distributions for the relevant nominal sizes of aggregate are given in Table 3.2.1–Particle size distributionsof this standard specification. Table 3.2.1–Particle size distributions Column 1 Column 2 AS sieve size (mm) Percentage passing by mass for each nominal size 20mm 3.3 (1) 16mm 14mm 10mm 7mm 5mm 26.50 100 - - - - - 19.00 85-100 100 100 - - - 16.00 - 85-100 - - - - 13.20 0-20 0-60 85-100 100 - - 9.50 0-5 0-15 0-30 85-100 100 - 6.70 - - 0-5 0-30 85-100 100 4.75 - - - 0-8 0-30 85-100 2.36 0-0.5 0-0.5 0-0.5 0-1 0-10 0-30 1.18 - - - - 0-5 0-5 Particle quality The cover aggregate properties comply with the requirements of Table 3.3.1–Particle qualityof this standard specification. Table 3.3.1–Particle quality Column 1 Column 2 Property Value Flakiness index (nominal sizes 10mm) - 30 Ten percent fines value (Wet) Kn minimum 175 Wet/dry strength variation % maximum 30 Proportion of weak particles % maximum 1 Crushed Particles % minimum 80 Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 3 Supply and delivery of aggregate–3.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-3 3.4 Precoating (1) All aggregate used in sprayed bituminous surfacing is precoated with a suitable precoating material which permits good adhesion of the aggregate to the binder and provides a dust free aggregate. (2) The precoating material is applied by a fine spray or other convenient method to ensure uniform distribution over the surface of the aggregate. (3) Immediately on completion of precoating, each particle is damp but with no tendency for any fluid to flow or drip from a particle suspended between the fingers. (4) Prior to precoating, care is taken so that the screenings are in a clean state. (5) The suitability of the precoating material is checked by means of the Queensland Transport test method No. Q212C and the percentage of stripping as determined by this test method does not exceed 3 percent. (6) Precoating of aggregates is carried out at least one week before bituminous surfacing is commenced. 3.5 Delivery (1) Delivery of materials, if in stockpiles, takes place between 7.00 am to 5.00 pm, Monday to Saturday, inclusive. (2) Aggregate is tipped on level ground in orderly piles, clear of traffic, drains and property. (3) A separate stockpile is made for each nominal size of aggregate at least fifteen metres from the adjoining stockpile. (4) A site selected for stockpiling is; (5) (a) on firm, well drained ground approved by the local government; (b) is cleared for the area of the stockpile and a surrounding area of five metres. Aggregate for use in bituminous surfacing work is not delivered to the site before the approval of the local government. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 3 Supply and delivery of aggregate–3.4 Precoating Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-4 Part 4 4.1 Supply and delivery of bituminous material General standards (1) Grades of cutback bitumen comply with those set out in Table 4.1.1–Cutback bitumen gradesof this standard specification. (2) Bitumen complies with AS 2008-1997 Residual bitumen for pavements. (3) Emulsion primes, primer seals may be used if approved by the local government and if applied according to advice of manufacturer. Table 4.1.1–Cutback bitumen grades 4.2 Column 1 Column 2 Grade Parts of bitumen cutter to 100 parts of Class 170 bitumen (at 150C) AMC00 127 AMC0 78 AMC1 51 AMC2 37 AMC3 27 AMC4 19 MC5 12 MC6 7 MC7 3 Storage and transport (1) Bituminous material is stored and transported in purpose-built containers in such a way that contamination does not occur. (2) If it is necessary to change the type of material in a container and there is a chance of contamination, the container is completely drained and, if necessary, cleaned with a suitable solvent. 4.3 Heating (1) Cutback bitumen with greater than 70 parts of cutter oil to 100 parts of bitumen, is not heated. (2) Other grades of cutback bitumen are not heated without the prior approval of the local government which will only be given in circumstances where the requirement could not have been anticipated and if the heating is in accordance with approved heating procedures. (3) Binder is heated to a temperature necessary to carry out the operations of cutting if required or spraying. (4) A binder is not damaged by overheating. 4.4 Incorporation of additives or modified bitumen (1) Volatile additives, such as cutter oil and flux oil, are not heated and are introduced into the sprayer tank through the sprayer’s pumping system. (2) Volatile additives are not added to the top of hot bitumen. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 4 Supply and delivery of bituminous material–4.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-5 (3) Non-volatile additives, such as an adhesion agent, are introduced into the sprayer tank in a safe manner and in accordance with any relevant standards or manufacturer’s instructions. (4) After the introduction of an additive to the sprayer, the bituminous material is circulated sufficiently to ensure an homogenous mixture result. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 4 Supply and delivery of bituminous material–4.4 Incorporation of additives or modified bitumen Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-6 Part 5 5.1 (1) (2) Preparation prior to spraying Surface preparation The surface that is prepared includes: (a) the surface to be sprayed; (b) an area which is the lesser of: (i) 250mm beyond the surface to be sprayed; or (ii) an area which extends to the edge of the formation. The preparation work is carried out in a manner which: (a) promotes the adhesion of the bituminous material to the surface of the pavement; (b) involves initial treatment where there is no existing bitumen treatment such that: (i) all foreign and loose material, including lenses of pavement material, are removed from the surface; (ii) the surface is swept with a road broom until the larger particles in the surface of the pavement are slightly exposed without dislodgement and excessive erosion of the surrounding finer material; (iii) a light watering is carried out just prior to spraying; or (c) involves re-treatment where there is an existing bituminous treatment such that: (i) all foreign and loose material is removed from the surface; (ii) the surface is swept with a road broom; (iii) where a prime coat has been covered by a cover material, all the cover material is swept off without damage to the prime coat; (d) provides all foreign or loose material is removed from the road formation and utilised or disposed of in a neat manner without any disruption to a service or a waterway. 5.2 Protection of services (1) All necessary precautions are taken to prevent any bituminous material or other material used on the work from entering or adhering to any road furniture or roadside facility. (2) If any bituminous material does adhere to any road furniture or roadside facility, the bituminous material is removed so that the road furniture or roadside facility is left in the condition in which it was found. 5.3 Setting out (1) Marks on the pavement surface are set out to permit the spraying of bituminous material on the required sections of pavement and in accordance with the requirements of this standard specification. (2) The work is set out so that longitudinal joints coincide with lane lines and so that tapers are sprayed separately, unless shown otherwise in the approved drawings. (3) The start and finish point of each spray run is marked. 5.4 (1) Programming spray runs Operations are programmed to ensure that: (a) sufficient loaded aggregate trucks are ready to follow the sprayer to cover the spray run immediately; (b) the minimum specified rolling is achieved on the day of spraying. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 5 Preparation prior to spraying–5.1 Surface preparation Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-7 Part 6 6.1 Restrictions to spraying Pavement surface temperature (1) Spraying does not commence until the temperature on the surface of the pavement is above 200C, for at least 1 hour before spraying commences. (2) Spraying does not continue unless all operations up to completion of the minimum rolling, can be completed before the temperature on the pavement surface drops below 20OC. 6.2 (1) 6.3 (1) Weather conditions Spraying does not take place during rain or if rain is imminent. Period between bituminous treatments The minimum period between a prime and a seal is two days for AMC00 and three days for other primes. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 6 Restrictions to spraying–6.1 Pavement surface temperature Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-8 Part 7 7.1 Spraying General standards (1) The bituminous material is sprayed in a uniform manner and in a way which promotes adhesion of the material to the pavement surface and to the cover aggregate. (2) The design of the application rates of bitumen are submitted for approval to the local government at least two weeks prior to the commencement of sealing. 7.2 (1) 7.3 Method of application Bituminous materials are applied by means of the mechanically operated spray bar of a bitumen sprayer except in areas where the use of the above is not possible, the hand spraying lance from the sprayer may be used. Spray runs (1) All joints, transverse and longitudinal, abut neatly and uniformly to adjacent spray runs, without gap or overlap. (2) Unless otherwise specified, spraying on each spray run starts on a protective strip of approved heavy paper, with a nominal width of 500mm which is laid across the pavement surface for the full width of the spray run and held securely in place. (3) The sprayer commences moving at a sufficient distance in advance of the protective strip to ensure that the road spray for correct application is attained prior to the commencement of spraying. (4) The spraying for each spray run terminates on the protective strip of paper as specified in section 7.3(2) of this standard specification. (5) After spraying, the protective strips of paper are removed ensuring no excess bituminous material is deposited on the pavement surface and the strips of paper are removed from the site of the work at the end of each day’s operation. 7.4 Spraying temperature (1) Bituminous material is sprayed at a temperature which produces a viscosity similar to the viscosity of the fluid used for sprayer calibration. (2) Spraying temperature ranges comply with those given in Table 7.4.1–Spraying temperature range of this standard specification. (3) Spraying does not occur if the temperature of the bituminous material is outside the relevant range given in Table 7.4.1–Spraying temperature rangeof this standard specification. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 7 Spraying–7.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-9 Table 7.4.1–Spraying temperature range Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 Material Grade Spraying temperature range (0C) Minimum 7.5 (1) 7.6 Maximum Cutback AMC00 Ambient Ambient Bitumen AMC0 35.00 55.00 AMC1 60.00 80.00 AMC2 75.00 100.00 AMC3 95.00 115.00 AMC4 110.00 135.00 MC5 120.00 150.00 MC6 135.00 160.00 MC7 150.00 175.00 Class 170 160.00 190.00 Class 320 170.00 195.00 Defects during spraying Spraying ceases immediately if any defect develops in the spraying equipment or operation and does not recommence until the fault has been rectified. Cutting back bitumen (1) Where cutter oil is required to be added to the bitumen for seal or reseal work, the amount of cutter oil is determined in accordance with Figure 7.6.1—Bitumen cutting chart of this standard specification. (2) Incorporation of cutter oil into the bitumen is carried out in accordance with section 3.4– Precoating of this standard specification. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 7 Spraying–7.5 Defects during spraying Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-10 Figure 7.6.1—Bitumen cutting chart Zone A – Aggregate: (a) Clean, dry and dust free; or (b) Precoated and holding some moisture; or (c) Precoating dry and not active. Normal minimum road temperature (Refer to section 6.1 (Pavement surface temperature)). Parts of cold bitumen cutter to add to 100 parts of cold Class 170 bitumen 25 20 15 10 5 Zone B – Aggregate precoating active and covering at least 75% of the surface. Notes: 1. In general, cutter should be near the centre of the zone, except:(a) For rising temperatures, use lower limit. (b) For falling temperature, use upper limit. 2. For high early traffic or high future temperature, reduce cutter by up to 30% and/or increase the minimum road temperature. (Refer to Section 6.1 (Pavement surface temperature). 0 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 Anticipated road temperature at time of spreading aggregate (OC). 7.7 Spray rate (1) The design spray rates approved by the local government and the actual spray rates are the quantities measured in litres per m 2, at 15OC. (2) The allowable bituminous materials are listed in Table 7.7.1–Allowable bituminous materials of this standard specification for the relevant operation. (3) The actual spray rate is within ± 5% of the design spray rate. (4) To comply with actual spray rate adjustments are made to the operation of the sprayer to account for: (a) the increased volume of the material sprayed where the temperature of the material is higher than 15OC; (b) the increased volume of the material sprayed where there are other materials in the bituminous material not listed in Table 7.7.1–Allowable bituminous materials of this standard specification for the relevant operation, such as cutter oil or an adhesion agent in a sealing operation. Table 7.7.1–Allowable bituminous materials Column 1 Column 2 Operations Bituminous materials to be included in the spray rate Prime Cutback bitumen. Seal Bitumen or modified bitumen. Reseal Bitumen or modified bitumen.(1) Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 7 Spraying–7.7 Spray rate Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-11 7.8 (1) Quantities retained in sprayer tank To ensure a uniform spray rate, each sprayer run is programmed so that at least 250 litres of bituminous material is retained in the tank at the completion of the spray run. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 7 Spraying–7.8 Quantities retained in sprayer tank Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-12 Part 8 8.1 Spreading prime cover material General standards (1) The prime cover material is spread so as to produce a complete and even distribution. (2) Wet cover material is not used. 8.2 Spread rate (1) The design spread rate is submitted to the local government prior to the commencement of the spreading operation. (2) The design rate may be adjusted during the spreading operation to ensure a completely even distribution. 8.3 (1) Time limit At least two hours elapse between priming and the application of the cover material to permit penetration of the prime, unless the local government determines that traffic requirements dictate otherwise. 8.4 Spreading (1) Spreading of cover material is carried out with an aggregate spreader. (2) Bare or insufficiently covered areas are re-treated as soon as possible with a further light run, or by hand spreading. (3) The actual spread rate does not vary from the ordered spread rate by more than ± 10%. 8.5 (1) Removal of excess cover material All excess cover material is: (a) lightly swept from the pavement surface with a road broom; (b) completely removed from the road formation; (c) utilised or disposed of as approved by the local government in a neat manner without any disruption to other services or waterways. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 8 Spreading prime cover material–8.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-13 Part 9 9.1 Spreading cover aggregate General standards (1) The cover aggregate is spread in a uniform manner which produces a dense tight mat and also ensures that the bituminous binder adheres to the stone. (2) Wet (free surface water) cover aggregate is not used. (3) The design of the application rates of aggregate are submitted for approval to the local government at least two weeks prior to the commencement of sealing. 9.2 (1) Spread rate for cover aggregate The spread rate for cover aggregate is as specified in section 8.2–Spread rate of this standard specification. 9.3 (1) Time limit The spreading of cover aggregate commences as soon as possible after the spraying of the binder. 9.4 Spreading (1) The spreading of cover aggregate is carried out with an aggregate spreader. (2) Cover aggregate is spread so that, after compaction, it forms a single layer on the pavement surface with the aggregate in shoulder-to-shoulder contact. (3) Every attempt is made to achieve the above spread pattern on the first spreading pass. (4) Bare or insufficiently covered areas are re-treated as soon as possible with a further light spreading run or by hand spreading. (5) Overspreading or underspreading of the aggregate is avoided. (6) If there is an uneven distribution of cover aggregate, it is drag broomed until it is evenly distributed without dislodgement of any embedded cover aggregate. (7) Cover aggregate is spread so that the actual spread rate is: (8) 9.5 (a) not less than the specified spread rate; or (b) greater than 5 percent above the specified spread rate. Any initial underspreading is rectified in accordance with this section. Rolling (1) After satisfactory spreading, one or two passes of a steel-wheel roller are applied, prior to multityred rolling. (2) The cover aggregate is rolled with multi-tyred rollers at the minimum rate of one (1) hour for each 1200 litres of bituminous material sprayed. (3) There are sufficient multi-tyred rollers on site and in use to complete the specified minimum amount of rolling on the same day as the spraying operation. (4) Where the specified minimum rolling cannot be completed on the day of the spraying operation, then the minimum amount of rolling may be completed on subsequent working days, provided that at least 75 percent of the specified minimum amount of rolling is completed on the day of spraying. (5) Moist cover aggregate is not rolled until it has dried sufficiently to promote adhesion. 9.6 (1) Removal of excess cover aggregate All excess cover aggregate is: Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 9 Spreading cover aggregate–9.1 General standards Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-14 (a) lightly swept from the pavement surface with a road broom, without dislodgement of the bedded aggregate; (b) completely removed from the road formation; (c) utilised or disposed of as approved by the local government in a neat manner without any disruption to a service or a waterway. (2) Except where the work is being carried out under traffic, the removal of excess cover aggregate is completed before the work is opened to traffic. (3) Where the work is being carried out under traffic, the speed of traffic is adequately controlled until the excess cover aggregate is removed. 9.7 (1) Two applications of cover aggregate with a single application of binder If two (2) applications of cover aggregate are spread with a single application of binder the specifications in Part 9–Spreading cover aggregate of this standard specification apply except that: (a) the first application of cover aggregate is spread at a 5 percent to 10 percent reduction to the normal spread rate so that small gaps are left; (b) the first application of cover aggregate is rolled with a multi-tyred roller for four complete passes; (c) excess cover aggregate is not removed after the first application. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 9 Spreading cover aggregate–9.7 Two applications of cover aggregate with a single application of binder Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-15 Part 10 10.1 Recording and testing Recording details of spraying operations (1) After each spray run, all details of the sealing operations are recorded on a bituminous materials spraying record sheet. (2) The bituminous materials spraying record sheet is signed by the local government. (3) A copy of the completed bituminous materials spraying record sheet is provided to the local government at the end of each day’s operation. (4) All volume conversions, in relation to changes in temperature of bituminous materials, are carried out in accordance with the relevant factors listed in Table 10.1.1–Equivalent volumes at higher temperatures of 1 litre of bituminous material measured at 150C and Table 10.1.2–Equivalent volumes at 150C of 1 litre of bituminous material measured at higher temperatures of this standard specification. Table 10.1.1–Equivalent volumes at higher temperatures of 1 litre of bituminous material measured at 150C Column 1A 0 Temp ( C) Column 2A Factor Column 1B 0 Temp ( C) Column 2B Factor Column 1C 0 Temp ( C) Column 2C Factor 15 1.0000 80 1.0420 145 1.0861 20 1.0030 85 1.0453 150 1.0897 25 1.0062 90 1.0487 155 1.0932 30 1.0094 95 1.0520 160 1.0967 35 1.0126 100 1.0553 165 1.1003 40 1.0158 105 1.0587 170 1.1038 45 1.0191 110 1.0620 175 1.1074 50 1.0223 115 1.0655 180 1.1109 55 1.0256 120 1.0689 185 1.1145 60 1.0288 125 1.0723 190 1.1180 65 1.0321 130 1.0757 195 1.1216 70 1.0354 135 1.0792 200 1.1252 75 1.0387 140 1.0827 205 1.1287 Table 10.1.2–Equivalent volumes at 150C of 1 litre of bituminous material measured at higher temperatures Column 1A 0 Temp ( C) 15 Column 2A Factor 1.0000 Column 1B Column 2B 0 Factor 0.9597 Temp ( C) 80 Column 1C Column 2C 0 Factor 0.9207 Temp ( C) 145 20 0.9969 85 0.9566 150 0.9177 25 0.9938 90 0.9536 155 0.9148 30 0.9907 95 0.9506 160 0.9118 35 0.9876 100 0.9476 165 0.9089 40 0.9844 105 0.9446 170 0.9060 45 0.9813 110 0.9416 175 0.9031 50 0.9782 115 0.9385 180 0.9002 Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 10 Recording and testing–10.1 Recording details of spraying operations Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-16 Column 1A 0 Temp ( C) 55 10.2 Column 2A Factor 0.9751 Column 1B Column 2B 0 Factor 0.9355 Temp ( C) 120 Column 1C Column 2C 0 Factor 0.8973 Temp ( C) 185 60 0.9720 125 0.9326 190 0.8945 65 0.9689 130 0.9296 195 0.8916 70 0.9658 135 0.9266 200 0.8888 75 0.9627 140 0.9236 205 0.8860 Construction compliance testing (1) The process requirements are checked for compliance with the specified requirements during and after construction on a lot-by-lot basis where a lot is a spray run or a series of spray runs of size as specified in this standard specification. (2) A lot has an actual spray rate which is within ± 10%. of the design spread rate. (3) A lot has an aggregate spread rate which is within -5% or +10% of the design spread rate. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 10 Recording and testing–10.2 Construction compliance testing Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-17 Part 11 11.1 (1) 11.2 Contractual provisions Introduction The design of the application rates for bitumen and aggregate is to be submitted to the Superintendent for approval at least two weeks before the commencement of sealing. Supply and delivery of aggregate (1) The Contractor is to supply and deliver aggregate into stockpiles in accordance with the quantities and locations provided to the Contractor by the Superintendent, or if specifically stated, into road vehicles. Unless directed otherwise by the Superintendent, the Contractor is to select and prepare areas for the stockpiling of aggregate. (2) When requested by the Superintendent, the Contractor must submit a representative sample which is suitably labelled for identification and weighs at least 15kg of each nominal size of aggregate to the location nominated by the Superintendent. 11.3 Utilisation of a rejected lot for a reduced level of service (1) If the Superintendent accepts a lot which has an actual spray rate of between +6 and +9 of the design spray rate, the Superintendent is to reduce any part of the Contract Sum payable to the Contractor in relation to that work accepted by the Superintendent proportionately to the value of the non-complying prime, seal and reseal, calculated in accordance with Table 11.3.1–Reduction in Value, Spray Rate of this standard specification. (2) If the Superintendent accepts a lot which has an aggregate spread rate of between –5% to 0% or +6% to +10% of the design spread rate, the Superintendent is to reduce any part of the Contract Sum payable to the Contractor in relation to that work accepted by the Superintendent proportionately to the value of the non-complying prime, seal and reseal, calculated in accordance with Table 11.3.2–Reduction in Value, Aggregate Spread Rate of this standard specification. Table 11.3.1–Reduction in Value, Spray Rate % Difference in spray Rate % Reduction in value +6 4 +7 8 +8 12 +9 16 + 10 20 Table 11.3.2–Reduction in Value, Aggregate Spread Rate % Difference in spread Rate Less than design (3) % Reduction in value More than design -1 +6 2 -2 +7 4 -3 +8 6 -4 +9 8 -5 +10 10 One (1) and two (2) will only apply in the case where the local government is the Superintendent. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 11 Contractual provisions–11.1 Introduction Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-18 11.4 Measurement and payment (1) The quantities of prime, seal and reseal in litres at 15oC is to be determined from the tally of actual quantities of bituminous material sprayed on each spray run, including materials added to the bituminous material to enhance its performance, such as cutter oil and adhesion agent, but not included in Table 7.7.1–Allowable bituminous materials of this standard specification. (2) The quantity of prime cover material or cover aggregate spread, is to be determined from the tally of quantities of material (in cubic metres) used on each spray run, or the ordered quantity, whichever is the lesser. Standard specification No. 14 (Sprayed bitumen surfacing) Part 11 Contractual provisions–11.4 Measurement and payment Logan Planning Scheme 2015 version 1.1 Ss14-19